In ld/ChangeLog:
[deliverable/binutils-gdb.git] / gdb / doc / gdb.texinfo
CommitLineData
c906108c 1\input texinfo @c -*-texinfo-*-
b6ba6518 2@c Copyright 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,
8a037dd7 3@c 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002
c906108c
SS
4@c Free Software Foundation, Inc.
5@c
5d161b24 6@c %**start of header
c906108c
SS
7@c makeinfo ignores cmds prev to setfilename, so its arg cannot make use
8@c of @set vars. However, you can override filename with makeinfo -o.
9@setfilename gdb.info
10@c
11@include gdb-cfg.texi
12@c
c906108c 13@settitle Debugging with @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
14@setchapternewpage odd
15@c %**end of header
16
17@iftex
18@c @smallbook
19@c @cropmarks
20@end iftex
21
22@finalout
23@syncodeindex ky cp
24
41afff9a 25@c readline appendices use @vindex, @findex and @ftable,
48e934c6 26@c annotate.texi and gdbmi use @findex.
c906108c 27@syncodeindex vr cp
41afff9a 28@syncodeindex fn cp
c906108c
SS
29
30@c !!set GDB manual's edition---not the same as GDB version!
e9c75b65 31@set EDITION Ninth
c906108c
SS
32
33@c !!set GDB manual's revision date
959acfd1 34@set DATE December 2001
c906108c 35
6c0e9fb3 36@c THIS MANUAL REQUIRES TEXINFO 4.0 OR LATER.
c906108c 37
c906108c 38@c This is a dir.info fragment to support semi-automated addition of
6d2ebf8b 39@c manuals to an info tree.
96a2c332
SS
40@dircategory Programming & development tools.
41@direntry
c906108c 42* Gdb: (gdb). The @sc{gnu} debugger.
96a2c332
SS
43@end direntry
44
c906108c
SS
45@ifinfo
46This file documents the @sc{gnu} debugger @value{GDBN}.
47
48
5d161b24 49This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE},
c906108c
SS
50of @cite{Debugging with @value{GDBN}: the @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger}
51for @value{GDBN} Version @value{GDBVN}.
52
8a037dd7
EZ
53Copyright (C) 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995, 1996, 1998,@*
54 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 55
e9c75b65
EZ
56Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
57under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
58any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
59Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
60Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
61and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
c906108c 62
6826cf00
EZ
63(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
64freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
65published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
66development.''
c906108c
SS
67@end ifinfo
68
69@titlepage
70@title Debugging with @value{GDBN}
71@subtitle The @sc{gnu} Source-Level Debugger
c906108c 72@sp 1
c906108c
SS
73@subtitle @value{EDITION} Edition, for @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN}
74@subtitle @value{DATE}
9e9c5ae7 75@author Richard Stallman, Roland Pesch, Stan Shebs, et al.
c906108c 76@page
c906108c
SS
77@tex
78{\parskip=0pt
53a5351d 79\hfill (Send bugs and comments on @value{GDBN} to bug-gdb\@gnu.org.)\par
c906108c
SS
80\hfill {\it Debugging with @value{GDBN}}\par
81\hfill \TeX{}info \texinfoversion\par
82}
83@end tex
53a5351d 84
c906108c 85@vskip 0pt plus 1filll
8a037dd7
EZ
86Copyright @copyright{} 1988, 1989, 1990, 1991, 1992, 1993, 1994, 1995,
871996, 1998, 1999, 2000, 2001, 2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
c906108c 88@sp 2
c906108c
SS
89Published by the Free Software Foundation @*
9059 Temple Place - Suite 330, @*
91Boston, MA 02111-1307 USA @*
6d2ebf8b 92ISBN 1-882114-77-9 @*
e9c75b65
EZ
93
94Permission is granted to copy, distribute and/or modify this document
95under the terms of the GNU Free Documentation License, Version 1.1 or
96any later version published by the Free Software Foundation; with the
959acfd1
EZ
97Invariant Sections being ``Free Software'' and ``Free Software Needs
98Free Documentation'', with the Front-Cover Texts being ``A GNU Manual,''
99and with the Back-Cover Texts as in (a) below.
e9c75b65 100
6826cf00
EZ
101(a) The Free Software Foundation's Back-Cover Text is: ``You have
102freedom to copy and modify this GNU Manual, like GNU software. Copies
103published by the Free Software Foundation raise funds for GNU
104development.''
c906108c
SS
105@end titlepage
106@page
107
6c0e9fb3 108@ifnottex
6d2ebf8b
SS
109@node Top, Summary, (dir), (dir)
110
c906108c
SS
111@top Debugging with @value{GDBN}
112
113This file describes @value{GDBN}, the @sc{gnu} symbolic debugger.
114
5d161b24 115This is the @value{EDITION} Edition, @value{DATE}, for @value{GDBN} Version
c906108c
SS
116@value{GDBVN}.
117
8a037dd7 118Copyright (C) 1988-2002 Free Software Foundation, Inc.
6d2ebf8b
SS
119
120@menu
121* Summary:: Summary of @value{GDBN}
122* Sample Session:: A sample @value{GDBN} session
123
124* Invocation:: Getting in and out of @value{GDBN}
125* Commands:: @value{GDBN} commands
126* Running:: Running programs under @value{GDBN}
127* Stopping:: Stopping and continuing
128* Stack:: Examining the stack
129* Source:: Examining source files
130* Data:: Examining data
b37052ae 131* Tracepoints:: Debugging remote targets non-intrusively
df0cd8c5 132* Overlays:: Debugging programs that use overlays
6d2ebf8b
SS
133
134* Languages:: Using @value{GDBN} with different languages
135
136* Symbols:: Examining the symbol table
137* Altering:: Altering execution
138* GDB Files:: @value{GDBN} files
139* Targets:: Specifying a debugging target
6b2f586d 140* Remote Debugging:: Debugging remote programs
6d2ebf8b
SS
141* Configurations:: Configuration-specific information
142* Controlling GDB:: Controlling @value{GDBN}
143* Sequences:: Canned sequences of commands
c4555f82 144* TUI:: @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
6d2ebf8b
SS
145* Emacs:: Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
146* Annotations:: @value{GDBN}'s annotation interface.
7162c0ca 147* GDB/MI:: @value{GDBN}'s Machine Interface.
6d2ebf8b
SS
148
149* GDB Bugs:: Reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
150* Formatting Documentation:: How to format and print @value{GDBN} documentation
151
152* Command Line Editing:: Command Line Editing
153* Using History Interactively:: Using History Interactively
154* Installing GDB:: Installing GDB
eb12ee30 155* Maintenance Commands:: Maintenance Commands
e0ce93ac 156* Remote Protocol:: GDB Remote Serial Protocol
6826cf00 157* GNU Free Documentation License:: The license for this documentation
6d2ebf8b
SS
158* Index:: Index
159@end menu
160
6c0e9fb3 161@end ifnottex
c906108c 162
449f3b6c 163@contents
449f3b6c 164
6d2ebf8b 165@node Summary
c906108c
SS
166@unnumbered Summary of @value{GDBN}
167
168The purpose of a debugger such as @value{GDBN} is to allow you to see what is
169going on ``inside'' another program while it executes---or what another
170program was doing at the moment it crashed.
171
172@value{GDBN} can do four main kinds of things (plus other things in support of
173these) to help you catch bugs in the act:
174
175@itemize @bullet
176@item
177Start your program, specifying anything that might affect its behavior.
178
179@item
180Make your program stop on specified conditions.
181
182@item
183Examine what has happened, when your program has stopped.
184
185@item
186Change things in your program, so you can experiment with correcting the
187effects of one bug and go on to learn about another.
188@end itemize
189
cce74817 190You can use @value{GDBN} to debug programs written in C and C++.
c906108c 191For more information, see @ref{Support,,Supported languages}.
c906108c
SS
192For more information, see @ref{C,,C and C++}.
193
cce74817
JM
194@cindex Chill
195@cindex Modula-2
c906108c 196Support for Modula-2 and Chill is partial. For information on Modula-2,
cce74817 197see @ref{Modula-2,,Modula-2}. For information on Chill, see @ref{Chill}.
c906108c 198
cce74817
JM
199@cindex Pascal
200Debugging Pascal programs which use sets, subranges, file variables, or
201nested functions does not currently work. @value{GDBN} does not support
202entering expressions, printing values, or similar features using Pascal
203syntax.
c906108c 204
c906108c
SS
205@cindex Fortran
206@value{GDBN} can be used to debug programs written in Fortran, although
53a5351d 207it may be necessary to refer to some variables with a trailing
cce74817 208underscore.
c906108c 209
c906108c
SS
210@menu
211* Free Software:: Freely redistributable software
212* Contributors:: Contributors to GDB
213@end menu
214
6d2ebf8b 215@node Free Software
c906108c
SS
216@unnumberedsec Free software
217
5d161b24 218@value{GDBN} is @dfn{free software}, protected by the @sc{gnu}
c906108c
SS
219General Public License
220(GPL). The GPL gives you the freedom to copy or adapt a licensed
221program---but every person getting a copy also gets with it the
222freedom to modify that copy (which means that they must get access to
223the source code), and the freedom to distribute further copies.
224Typical software companies use copyrights to limit your freedoms; the
225Free Software Foundation uses the GPL to preserve these freedoms.
226
227Fundamentally, the General Public License is a license which says that
228you have these freedoms and that you cannot take these freedoms away
229from anyone else.
230
2666264b 231@unnumberedsec Free Software Needs Free Documentation
959acfd1
EZ
232
233The biggest deficiency in the free software community today is not in
234the software---it is the lack of good free documentation that we can
235include with the free software. Many of our most important
236programs do not come with free reference manuals and free introductory
237texts. Documentation is an essential part of any software package;
238when an important free software package does not come with a free
239manual and a free tutorial, that is a major gap. We have many such
240gaps today.
241
242Consider Perl, for instance. The tutorial manuals that people
243normally use are non-free. How did this come about? Because the
244authors of those manuals published them with restrictive terms---no
245copying, no modification, source files not available---which exclude
246them from the free software world.
247
248That wasn't the first time this sort of thing happened, and it was far
249from the last. Many times we have heard a GNU user eagerly describe a
250manual that he is writing, his intended contribution to the community,
251only to learn that he had ruined everything by signing a publication
252contract to make it non-free.
253
254Free documentation, like free software, is a matter of freedom, not
255price. The problem with the non-free manual is not that publishers
256charge a price for printed copies---that in itself is fine. (The Free
257Software Foundation sells printed copies of manuals, too.) The
258problem is the restrictions on the use of the manual. Free manuals
259are available in source code form, and give you permission to copy and
260modify. Non-free manuals do not allow this.
261
262The criteria of freedom for a free manual are roughly the same as for
263free software. Redistribution (including the normal kinds of
264commercial redistribution) must be permitted, so that the manual can
265accompany every copy of the program, both on-line and on paper.
266
267Permission for modification of the technical content is crucial too.
268When people modify the software, adding or changing features, if they
269are conscientious they will change the manual too---so they can
270provide accurate and clear documentation for the modified program. A
271manual that leaves you no choice but to write a new manual to document
272a changed version of the program is not really available to our
273community.
274
275Some kinds of limits on the way modification is handled are
276acceptable. For example, requirements to preserve the original
277author's copyright notice, the distribution terms, or the list of
278authors, are ok. It is also no problem to require modified versions
279to include notice that they were modified. Even entire sections that
280may not be deleted or changed are acceptable, as long as they deal
281with nontechnical topics (like this one). These kinds of restrictions
282are acceptable because they don't obstruct the community's normal use
283of the manual.
284
285However, it must be possible to modify all the @emph{technical}
286content of the manual, and then distribute the result in all the usual
287media, through all the usual channels. Otherwise, the restrictions
288obstruct the use of the manual, it is not free, and we need another
289manual to replace it.
290
291Please spread the word about this issue. Our community continues to
292lose manuals to proprietary publishing. If we spread the word that
293free software needs free reference manuals and free tutorials, perhaps
294the next person who wants to contribute by writing documentation will
295realize, before it is too late, that only free manuals contribute to
296the free software community.
297
298If you are writing documentation, please insist on publishing it under
299the GNU Free Documentation License or another free documentation
300license. Remember that this decision requires your approval---you
301don't have to let the publisher decide. Some commercial publishers
302will use a free license if you insist, but they will not propose the
303option; it is up to you to raise the issue and say firmly that this is
304what you want. If the publisher you are dealing with refuses, please
305try other publishers. If you're not sure whether a proposed license
42584a72 306is free, write to @email{licensing@@gnu.org}.
959acfd1
EZ
307
308You can encourage commercial publishers to sell more free, copylefted
309manuals and tutorials by buying them, and particularly by buying
310copies from the publishers that paid for their writing or for major
311improvements. Meanwhile, try to avoid buying non-free documentation
312at all. Check the distribution terms of a manual before you buy it,
313and insist that whoever seeks your business must respect your freedom.
72c9928d
EZ
314Check the history of the book, and try to reward the publishers that
315have paid or pay the authors to work on it.
959acfd1
EZ
316
317The Free Software Foundation maintains a list of free documentation
318published by other publishers, at
319@url{http://www.fsf.org/doc/other-free-books.html}.
320
6d2ebf8b 321@node Contributors
96a2c332
SS
322@unnumberedsec Contributors to @value{GDBN}
323
324Richard Stallman was the original author of @value{GDBN}, and of many
325other @sc{gnu} programs. Many others have contributed to its
326development. This section attempts to credit major contributors. One
327of the virtues of free software is that everyone is free to contribute
328to it; with regret, we cannot actually acknowledge everyone here. The
329file @file{ChangeLog} in the @value{GDBN} distribution approximates a
c906108c
SS
330blow-by-blow account.
331
332Changes much prior to version 2.0 are lost in the mists of time.
333
334@quotation
335@emph{Plea:} Additions to this section are particularly welcome. If you
336or your friends (or enemies, to be evenhanded) have been unfairly
337omitted from this list, we would like to add your names!
338@end quotation
339
340So that they may not regard their many labors as thankless, we
341particularly thank those who shepherded @value{GDBN} through major
342releases:
b37052ae 343Andrew Cagney (releases 5.0 and 5.1);
c906108c
SS
344Jim Blandy (release 4.18);
345Jason Molenda (release 4.17);
346Stan Shebs (release 4.14);
347Fred Fish (releases 4.16, 4.15, 4.13, 4.12, 4.11, 4.10, and 4.9);
348Stu Grossman and John Gilmore (releases 4.8, 4.7, 4.6, 4.5, and 4.4);
349John Gilmore (releases 4.3, 4.2, 4.1, 4.0, and 3.9);
350Jim Kingdon (releases 3.5, 3.4, and 3.3);
351and Randy Smith (releases 3.2, 3.1, and 3.0).
352
353Richard Stallman, assisted at various times by Peter TerMaat, Chris
354Hanson, and Richard Mlynarik, handled releases through 2.8.
355
b37052ae
EZ
356Michael Tiemann is the author of most of the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} support
357in @value{GDBN}, with significant additional contributions from Per
358Bothner and Daniel Berlin. James Clark wrote the @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
359demangler. Early work on C@t{++} was by Peter TerMaat (who also did
360much general update work leading to release 3.0).
c906108c 361
b37052ae 362@value{GDBN} uses the BFD subroutine library to examine multiple
c906108c
SS
363object-file formats; BFD was a joint project of David V.
364Henkel-Wallace, Rich Pixley, Steve Chamberlain, and John Gilmore.
365
366David Johnson wrote the original COFF support; Pace Willison did
367the original support for encapsulated COFF.
368
96c405b3 369Brent Benson of Harris Computer Systems contributed DWARF2 support.
c906108c
SS
370
371Adam de Boor and Bradley Davis contributed the ISI Optimum V support.
372Per Bothner, Noboyuki Hikichi, and Alessandro Forin contributed MIPS
373support.
374Jean-Daniel Fekete contributed Sun 386i support.
375Chris Hanson improved the HP9000 support.
376Noboyuki Hikichi and Tomoyuki Hasei contributed Sony/News OS 3 support.
377David Johnson contributed Encore Umax support.
378Jyrki Kuoppala contributed Altos 3068 support.
379Jeff Law contributed HP PA and SOM support.
380Keith Packard contributed NS32K support.
381Doug Rabson contributed Acorn Risc Machine support.
382Bob Rusk contributed Harris Nighthawk CX-UX support.
383Chris Smith contributed Convex support (and Fortran debugging).
384Jonathan Stone contributed Pyramid support.
385Michael Tiemann contributed SPARC support.
386Tim Tucker contributed support for the Gould NP1 and Gould Powernode.
387Pace Willison contributed Intel 386 support.
388Jay Vosburgh contributed Symmetry support.
389
390Andreas Schwab contributed M68K Linux support.
391
392Rich Schaefer and Peter Schauer helped with support of SunOS shared
393libraries.
394
395Jay Fenlason and Roland McGrath ensured that @value{GDBN} and GAS agree
396about several machine instruction sets.
397
398Patrick Duval, Ted Goldstein, Vikram Koka and Glenn Engel helped develop
399remote debugging. Intel Corporation, Wind River Systems, AMD, and ARM
400contributed remote debugging modules for the i960, VxWorks, A29K UDI,
401and RDI targets, respectively.
402
403Brian Fox is the author of the readline libraries providing
404command-line editing and command history.
405
7a292a7a
SS
406Andrew Beers of SUNY Buffalo wrote the language-switching code, the
407Modula-2 support, and contributed the Languages chapter of this manual.
c906108c 408
5d161b24 409Fred Fish wrote most of the support for Unix System Vr4.
b37052ae 410He also enhanced the command-completion support to cover C@t{++} overloaded
c906108c 411symbols.
c906108c
SS
412
413Hitachi America, Ltd. sponsored the support for H8/300, H8/500, and
414Super-H processors.
415
416NEC sponsored the support for the v850, Vr4xxx, and Vr5xxx processors.
417
418Mitsubishi sponsored the support for D10V, D30V, and M32R/D processors.
419
420Toshiba sponsored the support for the TX39 Mips processor.
421
422Matsushita sponsored the support for the MN10200 and MN10300 processors.
423
96a2c332 424Fujitsu sponsored the support for SPARClite and FR30 processors.
c906108c
SS
425
426Kung Hsu, Jeff Law, and Rick Sladkey added support for hardware
427watchpoints.
428
429Michael Snyder added support for tracepoints.
430
431Stu Grossman wrote gdbserver.
432
433Jim Kingdon, Peter Schauer, Ian Taylor, and Stu Grossman made
96a2c332 434nearly innumerable bug fixes and cleanups throughout @value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
435
436The following people at the Hewlett-Packard Company contributed
437support for the PA-RISC 2.0 architecture, HP-UX 10.20, 10.30, and 11.0
b37052ae 438(narrow mode), HP's implementation of kernel threads, HP's aC@t{++}
c906108c
SS
439compiler, and the terminal user interface: Ben Krepp, Richard Title,
440John Bishop, Susan Macchia, Kathy Mann, Satish Pai, India Paul, Steve
441Rehrauer, and Elena Zannoni. Kim Haase provided HP-specific
442information in this manual.
443
b37052ae
EZ
444DJ Delorie ported @value{GDBN} to MS-DOS, for the DJGPP project.
445Robert Hoehne made significant contributions to the DJGPP port.
446
96a2c332
SS
447Cygnus Solutions has sponsored @value{GDBN} maintenance and much of its
448development since 1991. Cygnus engineers who have worked on @value{GDBN}
2df3850c
JM
449fulltime include Mark Alexander, Jim Blandy, Per Bothner, Kevin
450Buettner, Edith Epstein, Chris Faylor, Fred Fish, Martin Hunt, Jim
451Ingham, John Gilmore, Stu Grossman, Kung Hsu, Jim Kingdon, John Metzler,
452Fernando Nasser, Geoffrey Noer, Dawn Perchik, Rich Pixley, Zdenek
453Radouch, Keith Seitz, Stan Shebs, David Taylor, and Elena Zannoni. In
454addition, Dave Brolley, Ian Carmichael, Steve Chamberlain, Nick Clifton,
455JT Conklin, Stan Cox, DJ Delorie, Ulrich Drepper, Frank Eigler, Doug
456Evans, Sean Fagan, David Henkel-Wallace, Richard Henderson, Jeff
457Holcomb, Jeff Law, Jim Lemke, Tom Lord, Bob Manson, Michael Meissner,
458Jason Merrill, Catherine Moore, Drew Moseley, Ken Raeburn, Gavin
459Romig-Koch, Rob Savoye, Jamie Smith, Mike Stump, Ian Taylor, Angela
460Thomas, Michael Tiemann, Tom Tromey, Ron Unrau, Jim Wilson, and David
461Zuhn have made contributions both large and small.
c906108c
SS
462
463
6d2ebf8b 464@node Sample Session
c906108c
SS
465@chapter A Sample @value{GDBN} Session
466
467You can use this manual at your leisure to read all about @value{GDBN}.
468However, a handful of commands are enough to get started using the
469debugger. This chapter illustrates those commands.
470
471@iftex
472In this sample session, we emphasize user input like this: @b{input},
473to make it easier to pick out from the surrounding output.
474@end iftex
475
476@c FIXME: this example may not be appropriate for some configs, where
477@c FIXME...primary interest is in remote use.
478
479One of the preliminary versions of @sc{gnu} @code{m4} (a generic macro
480processor) exhibits the following bug: sometimes, when we change its
481quote strings from the default, the commands used to capture one macro
482definition within another stop working. In the following short @code{m4}
483session, we define a macro @code{foo} which expands to @code{0000}; we
484then use the @code{m4} built-in @code{defn} to define @code{bar} as the
485same thing. However, when we change the open quote string to
486@code{<QUOTE>} and the close quote string to @code{<UNQUOTE>}, the same
487procedure fails to define a new synonym @code{baz}:
488
489@smallexample
490$ @b{cd gnu/m4}
491$ @b{./m4}
492@b{define(foo,0000)}
493
494@b{foo}
4950000
496@b{define(bar,defn(`foo'))}
497
498@b{bar}
4990000
500@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
501
502@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
503@b{baz}
504@b{C-d}
505m4: End of input: 0: fatal error: EOF in string
506@end smallexample
507
508@noindent
509Let us use @value{GDBN} to try to see what is going on.
510
c906108c
SS
511@smallexample
512$ @b{@value{GDBP} m4}
513@c FIXME: this falsifies the exact text played out, to permit smallbook
514@c FIXME... format to come out better.
515@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
5d161b24 516 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
c906108c 517 the conditions.
5d161b24 518There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
c906108c
SS
519 for details.
520
521@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1999 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
522(@value{GDBP})
523@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
524
525@noindent
526@value{GDBN} reads only enough symbol data to know where to find the
527rest when needed; as a result, the first prompt comes up very quickly.
528We now tell @value{GDBN} to use a narrower display width than usual, so
529that examples fit in this manual.
530
531@smallexample
532(@value{GDBP}) @b{set width 70}
533@end smallexample
534
535@noindent
536We need to see how the @code{m4} built-in @code{changequote} works.
537Having looked at the source, we know the relevant subroutine is
538@code{m4_changequote}, so we set a breakpoint there with the @value{GDBN}
539@code{break} command.
540
541@smallexample
542(@value{GDBP}) @b{break m4_changequote}
543Breakpoint 1 at 0x62f4: file builtin.c, line 879.
544@end smallexample
545
546@noindent
547Using the @code{run} command, we start @code{m4} running under @value{GDBN}
548control; as long as control does not reach the @code{m4_changequote}
549subroutine, the program runs as usual:
550
551@smallexample
552(@value{GDBP}) @b{run}
553Starting program: /work/Editorial/gdb/gnu/m4/m4
554@b{define(foo,0000)}
555
556@b{foo}
5570000
558@end smallexample
559
560@noindent
561To trigger the breakpoint, we call @code{changequote}. @value{GDBN}
562suspends execution of @code{m4}, displaying information about the
563context where it stops.
564
565@smallexample
566@b{changequote(<QUOTE>,<UNQUOTE>)}
567
5d161b24 568Breakpoint 1, m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
569 at builtin.c:879
570879 if (bad_argc(TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[0]),argc,1,3))
571@end smallexample
572
573@noindent
574Now we use the command @code{n} (@code{next}) to advance execution to
575the next line of the current function.
576
577@smallexample
578(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
579882 set_quotes((argc >= 2) ? TOKEN_DATA_TEXT(argv[1])\
580 : nil,
581@end smallexample
582
583@noindent
584@code{set_quotes} looks like a promising subroutine. We can go into it
585by using the command @code{s} (@code{step}) instead of @code{next}.
586@code{step} goes to the next line to be executed in @emph{any}
587subroutine, so it steps into @code{set_quotes}.
588
589@smallexample
590(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
591set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
592 at input.c:530
593530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
594@end smallexample
595
596@noindent
597The display that shows the subroutine where @code{m4} is now
598suspended (and its arguments) is called a stack frame display. It
599shows a summary of the stack. We can use the @code{backtrace}
600command (which can also be spelled @code{bt}), to see where we are
601in the stack as a whole: the @code{backtrace} command displays a
602stack frame for each active subroutine.
603
604@smallexample
605(@value{GDBP}) @b{bt}
606#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<QUOTE>", rq=0x34c88 "<UNQUOTE>")
607 at input.c:530
5d161b24 608#1 0x6344 in m4_changequote (argc=3, argv=0x33c70)
c906108c
SS
609 at builtin.c:882
610#2 0x8174 in expand_macro (sym=0x33320) at macro.c:242
611#3 0x7a88 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=209696, td=0xf7fffa30)
612 at macro.c:71
613#4 0x79dc in expand_input () at macro.c:40
614#5 0x2930 in main (argc=0, argv=0xf7fffb20) at m4.c:195
615@end smallexample
616
617@noindent
618We step through a few more lines to see what happens. The first two
619times, we can use @samp{s}; the next two times we use @code{n} to avoid
620falling into the @code{xstrdup} subroutine.
621
622@smallexample
623(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6240x3b5c 532 if (rquote != def_rquote)
625(@value{GDBP}) @b{s}
6260x3b80 535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? \
627def_lquote : xstrdup(lq);
628(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
629536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
630 : xstrdup(rq);
631(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
632538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
633@end smallexample
634
635@noindent
636The last line displayed looks a little odd; we can examine the variables
637@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} to see if they are in fact the new left
638and right quotes we specified. We use the command @code{p}
639(@code{print}) to see their values.
640
641@smallexample
642(@value{GDBP}) @b{p lquote}
643$1 = 0x35d40 "<QUOTE>"
644(@value{GDBP}) @b{p rquote}
645$2 = 0x35d50 "<UNQUOTE>"
646@end smallexample
647
648@noindent
649@code{lquote} and @code{rquote} are indeed the new left and right quotes.
650To look at some context, we can display ten lines of source
651surrounding the current line with the @code{l} (@code{list}) command.
652
653@smallexample
654(@value{GDBP}) @b{l}
655533 xfree(rquote);
656534
657535 lquote = (lq == nil || *lq == '\0') ? def_lquote\
658 : xstrdup (lq);
659536 rquote = (rq == nil || *rq == '\0') ? def_rquote\
660 : xstrdup (rq);
661537
662538 len_lquote = strlen(rquote);
663539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
664540 @}
665541
666542 void
667@end smallexample
668
669@noindent
670Let us step past the two lines that set @code{len_lquote} and
671@code{len_rquote}, and then examine the values of those variables.
672
673@smallexample
674(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
675539 len_rquote = strlen(lquote);
676(@value{GDBP}) @b{n}
677540 @}
678(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote}
679$3 = 9
680(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote}
681$4 = 7
682@end smallexample
683
684@noindent
685That certainly looks wrong, assuming @code{len_lquote} and
686@code{len_rquote} are meant to be the lengths of @code{lquote} and
687@code{rquote} respectively. We can set them to better values using
688the @code{p} command, since it can print the value of
689any expression---and that expression can include subroutine calls and
690assignments.
691
692@smallexample
693(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_lquote=strlen(lquote)}
694$5 = 7
695(@value{GDBP}) @b{p len_rquote=strlen(rquote)}
696$6 = 9
697@end smallexample
698
699@noindent
700Is that enough to fix the problem of using the new quotes with the
701@code{m4} built-in @code{defn}? We can allow @code{m4} to continue
702executing with the @code{c} (@code{continue}) command, and then try the
703example that caused trouble initially:
704
705@smallexample
706(@value{GDBP}) @b{c}
707Continuing.
708
709@b{define(baz,defn(<QUOTE>foo<UNQUOTE>))}
710
711baz
7120000
713@end smallexample
714
715@noindent
716Success! The new quotes now work just as well as the default ones. The
717problem seems to have been just the two typos defining the wrong
718lengths. We allow @code{m4} exit by giving it an EOF as input:
719
720@smallexample
721@b{C-d}
722Program exited normally.
723@end smallexample
724
725@noindent
726The message @samp{Program exited normally.} is from @value{GDBN}; it
727indicates @code{m4} has finished executing. We can end our @value{GDBN}
728session with the @value{GDBN} @code{quit} command.
729
730@smallexample
731(@value{GDBP}) @b{quit}
732@end smallexample
c906108c 733
6d2ebf8b 734@node Invocation
c906108c
SS
735@chapter Getting In and Out of @value{GDBN}
736
737This chapter discusses how to start @value{GDBN}, and how to get out of it.
5d161b24 738The essentials are:
c906108c 739@itemize @bullet
5d161b24 740@item
53a5351d 741type @samp{@value{GDBP}} to start @value{GDBN}.
5d161b24 742@item
c906108c
SS
743type @kbd{quit} or @kbd{C-d} to exit.
744@end itemize
745
746@menu
747* Invoking GDB:: How to start @value{GDBN}
748* Quitting GDB:: How to quit @value{GDBN}
749* Shell Commands:: How to use shell commands inside @value{GDBN}
750@end menu
751
6d2ebf8b 752@node Invoking GDB
c906108c
SS
753@section Invoking @value{GDBN}
754
c906108c
SS
755Invoke @value{GDBN} by running the program @code{@value{GDBP}}. Once started,
756@value{GDBN} reads commands from the terminal until you tell it to exit.
757
758You can also run @code{@value{GDBP}} with a variety of arguments and options,
759to specify more of your debugging environment at the outset.
760
c906108c
SS
761The command-line options described here are designed
762to cover a variety of situations; in some environments, some of these
5d161b24 763options may effectively be unavailable.
c906108c
SS
764
765The most usual way to start @value{GDBN} is with one argument,
766specifying an executable program:
767
768@example
769@value{GDBP} @var{program}
770@end example
771
c906108c
SS
772@noindent
773You can also start with both an executable program and a core file
774specified:
775
776@example
777@value{GDBP} @var{program} @var{core}
778@end example
779
780You can, instead, specify a process ID as a second argument, if you want
781to debug a running process:
782
783@example
784@value{GDBP} @var{program} 1234
785@end example
786
787@noindent
788would attach @value{GDBN} to process @code{1234} (unless you also have a file
789named @file{1234}; @value{GDBN} does check for a core file first).
790
c906108c 791Taking advantage of the second command-line argument requires a fairly
2df3850c
JM
792complete operating system; when you use @value{GDBN} as a remote
793debugger attached to a bare board, there may not be any notion of
794``process'', and there is often no way to get a core dump. @value{GDBN}
795will warn you if it is unable to attach or to read core dumps.
c906108c 796
aa26fa3a
TT
797You can optionally have @code{@value{GDBP}} pass any arguments after the
798executable file to the inferior using @code{--args}. This option stops
799option processing.
800@example
801gdb --args gcc -O2 -c foo.c
802@end example
803This will cause @code{@value{GDBP}} to debug @code{gcc}, and to set
804@code{gcc}'s command-line arguments (@pxref{Arguments}) to @samp{-O2 -c foo.c}.
805
96a2c332 806You can run @code{@value{GDBP}} without printing the front material, which describes
c906108c
SS
807@value{GDBN}'s non-warranty, by specifying @code{-silent}:
808
809@smallexample
810@value{GDBP} -silent
811@end smallexample
812
813@noindent
814You can further control how @value{GDBN} starts up by using command-line
815options. @value{GDBN} itself can remind you of the options available.
816
817@noindent
818Type
819
820@example
821@value{GDBP} -help
822@end example
823
824@noindent
825to display all available options and briefly describe their use
826(@samp{@value{GDBP} -h} is a shorter equivalent).
827
828All options and command line arguments you give are processed
829in sequential order. The order makes a difference when the
830@samp{-x} option is used.
831
832
833@menu
c906108c
SS
834* File Options:: Choosing files
835* Mode Options:: Choosing modes
836@end menu
837
6d2ebf8b 838@node File Options
c906108c
SS
839@subsection Choosing files
840
2df3850c 841When @value{GDBN} starts, it reads any arguments other than options as
c906108c
SS
842specifying an executable file and core file (or process ID). This is
843the same as if the arguments were specified by the @samp{-se} and
19837790
MS
844@samp{-c} (or @samp{-p} options respectively. (@value{GDBN} reads the
845first argument that does not have an associated option flag as
846equivalent to the @samp{-se} option followed by that argument; and the
847second argument that does not have an associated option flag, if any, as
848equivalent to the @samp{-c}/@samp{-p} option followed by that argument.)
849If the second argument begins with a decimal digit, @value{GDBN} will
850first attempt to attach to it as a process, and if that fails, attempt
851to open it as a corefile. If you have a corefile whose name begins with
852a digit, you can prevent @value{GDBN} from treating it as a pid by
79f12247 853prefixing it with @file{./}, eg. @file{./12345}.
7a292a7a
SS
854
855If @value{GDBN} has not been configured to included core file support,
856such as for most embedded targets, then it will complain about a second
857argument and ignore it.
c906108c
SS
858
859Many options have both long and short forms; both are shown in the
860following list. @value{GDBN} also recognizes the long forms if you truncate
861them, so long as enough of the option is present to be unambiguous.
862(If you prefer, you can flag option arguments with @samp{--} rather
863than @samp{-}, though we illustrate the more usual convention.)
864
d700128c
EZ
865@c NOTE: the @cindex entries here use double dashes ON PURPOSE. This
866@c way, both those who look for -foo and --foo in the index, will find
867@c it.
868
c906108c
SS
869@table @code
870@item -symbols @var{file}
871@itemx -s @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
872@cindex @code{--symbols}
873@cindex @code{-s}
c906108c
SS
874Read symbol table from file @var{file}.
875
876@item -exec @var{file}
877@itemx -e @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
878@cindex @code{--exec}
879@cindex @code{-e}
7a292a7a
SS
880Use file @var{file} as the executable file to execute when appropriate,
881and for examining pure data in conjunction with a core dump.
c906108c
SS
882
883@item -se @var{file}
d700128c 884@cindex @code{--se}
c906108c
SS
885Read symbol table from file @var{file} and use it as the executable
886file.
887
c906108c
SS
888@item -core @var{file}
889@itemx -c @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
890@cindex @code{--core}
891@cindex @code{-c}
19837790 892Use file @var{file} as a core dump to examine.
c906108c
SS
893
894@item -c @var{number}
19837790
MS
895@item -pid @var{number}
896@itemx -p @var{number}
897@cindex @code{--pid}
898@cindex @code{-p}
899Connect to process ID @var{number}, as with the @code{attach} command.
900If there is no such process, @value{GDBN} will attempt to open a core
901file named @var{number}.
c906108c
SS
902
903@item -command @var{file}
904@itemx -x @var{file}
d700128c
EZ
905@cindex @code{--command}
906@cindex @code{-x}
c906108c
SS
907Execute @value{GDBN} commands from file @var{file}. @xref{Command
908Files,, Command files}.
909
910@item -directory @var{directory}
911@itemx -d @var{directory}
d700128c
EZ
912@cindex @code{--directory}
913@cindex @code{-d}
c906108c
SS
914Add @var{directory} to the path to search for source files.
915
c906108c
SS
916@item -m
917@itemx -mapped
d700128c
EZ
918@cindex @code{--mapped}
919@cindex @code{-m}
c906108c
SS
920@emph{Warning: this option depends on operating system facilities that are not
921supported on all systems.}@*
922If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the @code{mmap}
5d161b24 923system call, you can use this option
c906108c
SS
924to have @value{GDBN} write the symbols from your
925program into a reusable file in the current directory. If the program you are debugging is
96a2c332 926called @file{/tmp/fred}, the mapped symbol file is @file{/tmp/fred.syms}.
c906108c
SS
927Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions notice the presence of this file,
928and can quickly map in symbol information from it, rather than reading
929the symbol table from the executable program.
930
931The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where @value{GDBN}
932is run. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN} symbol
933table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c 934
c906108c
SS
935@item -r
936@itemx -readnow
d700128c
EZ
937@cindex @code{--readnow}
938@cindex @code{-r}
c906108c
SS
939Read each symbol file's entire symbol table immediately, rather than
940the default, which is to read it incrementally as it is needed.
941This makes startup slower, but makes future operations faster.
53a5351d 942
c906108c
SS
943@end table
944
2df3850c 945You typically combine the @code{-mapped} and @code{-readnow} options in
c906108c 946order to build a @file{.syms} file that contains complete symbol
2df3850c
JM
947information. (@xref{Files,,Commands to specify files}, for information
948on @file{.syms} files.) A simple @value{GDBN} invocation to do nothing
949but build a @file{.syms} file for future use is:
c906108c
SS
950
951@example
2df3850c 952gdb -batch -nx -mapped -readnow programname
c906108c 953@end example
c906108c 954
6d2ebf8b 955@node Mode Options
c906108c
SS
956@subsection Choosing modes
957
958You can run @value{GDBN} in various alternative modes---for example, in
959batch mode or quiet mode.
960
961@table @code
962@item -nx
963@itemx -n
d700128c
EZ
964@cindex @code{--nx}
965@cindex @code{-n}
96565e91 966Do not execute commands found in any initialization files. Normally,
2df3850c
JM
967@value{GDBN} executes the commands in these files after all the command
968options and arguments have been processed. @xref{Command Files,,Command
969files}.
c906108c
SS
970
971@item -quiet
d700128c 972@itemx -silent
c906108c 973@itemx -q
d700128c
EZ
974@cindex @code{--quiet}
975@cindex @code{--silent}
976@cindex @code{-q}
c906108c
SS
977``Quiet''. Do not print the introductory and copyright messages. These
978messages are also suppressed in batch mode.
979
980@item -batch
d700128c 981@cindex @code{--batch}
c906108c
SS
982Run in batch mode. Exit with status @code{0} after processing all the
983command files specified with @samp{-x} (and all commands from
984initialization files, if not inhibited with @samp{-n}). Exit with
985nonzero status if an error occurs in executing the @value{GDBN} commands
986in the command files.
987
2df3850c
JM
988Batch mode may be useful for running @value{GDBN} as a filter, for
989example to download and run a program on another computer; in order to
990make this more useful, the message
c906108c
SS
991
992@example
993Program exited normally.
994@end example
995
996@noindent
2df3850c
JM
997(which is ordinarily issued whenever a program running under
998@value{GDBN} control terminates) is not issued when running in batch
999mode.
1000
1001@item -nowindows
1002@itemx -nw
d700128c
EZ
1003@cindex @code{--nowindows}
1004@cindex @code{-nw}
2df3850c 1005``No windows''. If @value{GDBN} comes with a graphical user interface
96a2c332 1006(GUI) built in, then this option tells @value{GDBN} to only use the command-line
2df3850c
JM
1007interface. If no GUI is available, this option has no effect.
1008
1009@item -windows
1010@itemx -w
d700128c
EZ
1011@cindex @code{--windows}
1012@cindex @code{-w}
2df3850c
JM
1013If @value{GDBN} includes a GUI, then this option requires it to be
1014used if possible.
c906108c
SS
1015
1016@item -cd @var{directory}
d700128c 1017@cindex @code{--cd}
c906108c
SS
1018Run @value{GDBN} using @var{directory} as its working directory,
1019instead of the current directory.
1020
c906108c
SS
1021@item -fullname
1022@itemx -f
d700128c
EZ
1023@cindex @code{--fullname}
1024@cindex @code{-f}
7a292a7a
SS
1025@sc{gnu} Emacs sets this option when it runs @value{GDBN} as a
1026subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to output the full file name and line
1027number in a standard, recognizable fashion each time a stack frame is
1028displayed (which includes each time your program stops). This
1029recognizable format looks like two @samp{\032} characters, followed by
1030the file name, line number and character position separated by colons,
1031and a newline. The Emacs-to-@value{GDBN} interface program uses the two
1032@samp{\032} characters as a signal to display the source code for the
1033frame.
c906108c 1034
d700128c
EZ
1035@item -epoch
1036@cindex @code{--epoch}
1037The Epoch Emacs-@value{GDBN} interface sets this option when it runs
1038@value{GDBN} as a subprocess. It tells @value{GDBN} to modify its print
1039routines so as to allow Epoch to display values of expressions in a
1040separate window.
1041
1042@item -annotate @var{level}
1043@cindex @code{--annotate}
1044This option sets the @dfn{annotation level} inside @value{GDBN}. Its
1045effect is identical to using @samp{set annotate @var{level}}
1046(@pxref{Annotations}).
1047Annotation level controls how much information does @value{GDBN} print
1048together with its prompt, values of expressions, source lines, and other
1049types of output. Level 0 is the normal, level 1 is for use when
1050@value{GDBN} is run as a subprocess of @sc{gnu} Emacs, level 2 is the
1051maximum annotation suitable for programs that control @value{GDBN}.
1052
1053@item -async
1054@cindex @code{--async}
1055Use the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1056@value{GDBN} processes all events, such as user keyboard input, via a
1057special event loop. This allows @value{GDBN} to accept and process user
1058commands in parallel with the debugged process being
1059run@footnote{@value{GDBN} built with @sc{djgpp} tools for
1060MS-DOS/MS-Windows supports this mode of operation, but the event loop is
1061suspended when the debuggee runs.}, so you don't need to wait for
1062control to return to @value{GDBN} before you type the next command.
b37052ae 1063(@emph{Note:} as of version 5.1, the target side of the asynchronous
d700128c
EZ
1064operation is not yet in place, so @samp{-async} does not work fully
1065yet.)
1066@c FIXME: when the target side of the event loop is done, the above NOTE
1067@c should be removed.
1068
1069When the standard input is connected to a terminal device, @value{GDBN}
1070uses the asynchronous event loop by default, unless disabled by the
1071@samp{-noasync} option.
1072
1073@item -noasync
1074@cindex @code{--noasync}
1075Disable the asynchronous event loop for the command-line interface.
1076
aa26fa3a
TT
1077@item --args
1078@cindex @code{--args}
1079Change interpretation of command line so that arguments following the
1080executable file are passed as command line arguments to the inferior.
1081This option stops option processing.
1082
2df3850c
JM
1083@item -baud @var{bps}
1084@itemx -b @var{bps}
d700128c
EZ
1085@cindex @code{--baud}
1086@cindex @code{-b}
c906108c
SS
1087Set the line speed (baud rate or bits per second) of any serial
1088interface used by @value{GDBN} for remote debugging.
c906108c
SS
1089
1090@item -tty @var{device}
d700128c
EZ
1091@itemx -t @var{device}
1092@cindex @code{--tty}
1093@cindex @code{-t}
c906108c
SS
1094Run using @var{device} for your program's standard input and output.
1095@c FIXME: kingdon thinks there is more to -tty. Investigate.
c906108c 1096
53a5351d 1097@c resolve the situation of these eventually
c4555f82
SC
1098@item -tui
1099@cindex @code{--tui}
1100Activate the Terminal User Interface when starting.
1101The Terminal User Interface manages several text windows on the terminal,
1102showing source, assembly, registers and @value{GDBN} command outputs
1103(@pxref{TUI, ,@value{GDBN} Text User Interface}).
1104Do not use this option if you run @value{GDBN} from Emacs
1105(@pxref{Emacs, ,Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}).
53a5351d
JM
1106
1107@c @item -xdb
d700128c 1108@c @cindex @code{--xdb}
53a5351d
JM
1109@c Run in XDB compatibility mode, allowing the use of certain XDB commands.
1110@c For information, see the file @file{xdb_trans.html}, which is usually
1111@c installed in the directory @code{/opt/langtools/wdb/doc} on HP-UX
1112@c systems.
1113
d700128c
EZ
1114@item -interpreter @var{interp}
1115@cindex @code{--interpreter}
1116Use the interpreter @var{interp} for interface with the controlling
1117program or device. This option is meant to be set by programs which
94bbb2c0
AC
1118communicate with @value{GDBN} using it as a back end.
1119
1120@samp{--interpreter=mi} (or @samp{--interpreter=mi1}) causes
1121@value{GDBN} to use the @dfn{gdb/mi interface} (@pxref{GDB/MI, , The
1122@sc{gdb/mi} Interface}). The older @sc{gdb/mi} interface, included in
1123@value{GDBN} version 5.0 can be selected with @samp{--interpreter=mi0}.
d700128c
EZ
1124
1125@item -write
1126@cindex @code{--write}
1127Open the executable and core files for both reading and writing. This
1128is equivalent to the @samp{set write on} command inside @value{GDBN}
1129(@pxref{Patching}).
1130
1131@item -statistics
1132@cindex @code{--statistics}
1133This option causes @value{GDBN} to print statistics about time and
1134memory usage after it completes each command and returns to the prompt.
1135
1136@item -version
1137@cindex @code{--version}
1138This option causes @value{GDBN} to print its version number and
1139no-warranty blurb, and exit.
1140
c906108c
SS
1141@end table
1142
6d2ebf8b 1143@node Quitting GDB
c906108c
SS
1144@section Quitting @value{GDBN}
1145@cindex exiting @value{GDBN}
1146@cindex leaving @value{GDBN}
1147
1148@table @code
1149@kindex quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
41afff9a 1150@kindex q @r{(@code{quit})}
96a2c332
SS
1151@item quit @r{[}@var{expression}@r{]}
1152@itemx q
1153To exit @value{GDBN}, use the @code{quit} command (abbreviated
1154@code{q}), or type an end-of-file character (usually @kbd{C-d}). If you
1155do not supply @var{expression}, @value{GDBN} will terminate normally;
1156otherwise it will terminate using the result of @var{expression} as the
1157error code.
c906108c
SS
1158@end table
1159
1160@cindex interrupt
1161An interrupt (often @kbd{C-c}) does not exit from @value{GDBN}, but rather
1162terminates the action of any @value{GDBN} command that is in progress and
1163returns to @value{GDBN} command level. It is safe to type the interrupt
1164character at any time because @value{GDBN} does not allow it to take effect
1165until a time when it is safe.
1166
c906108c
SS
1167If you have been using @value{GDBN} to control an attached process or
1168device, you can release it with the @code{detach} command
1169(@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running process}).
c906108c 1170
6d2ebf8b 1171@node Shell Commands
c906108c
SS
1172@section Shell commands
1173
1174If you need to execute occasional shell commands during your
1175debugging session, there is no need to leave or suspend @value{GDBN}; you can
1176just use the @code{shell} command.
1177
1178@table @code
1179@kindex shell
1180@cindex shell escape
1181@item shell @var{command string}
1182Invoke a standard shell to execute @var{command string}.
c906108c 1183If it exists, the environment variable @code{SHELL} determines which
d4f3574e
SS
1184shell to run. Otherwise @value{GDBN} uses the default shell
1185(@file{/bin/sh} on Unix systems, @file{COMMAND.COM} on MS-DOS, etc.).
c906108c
SS
1186@end table
1187
1188The utility @code{make} is often needed in development environments.
1189You do not have to use the @code{shell} command for this purpose in
1190@value{GDBN}:
1191
1192@table @code
1193@kindex make
1194@cindex calling make
1195@item make @var{make-args}
1196Execute the @code{make} program with the specified
1197arguments. This is equivalent to @samp{shell make @var{make-args}}.
1198@end table
1199
6d2ebf8b 1200@node Commands
c906108c
SS
1201@chapter @value{GDBN} Commands
1202
1203You can abbreviate a @value{GDBN} command to the first few letters of the command
1204name, if that abbreviation is unambiguous; and you can repeat certain
1205@value{GDBN} commands by typing just @key{RET}. You can also use the @key{TAB}
1206key to get @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest of a word in a command (or to
1207show you the alternatives available, if there is more than one possibility).
1208
1209@menu
1210* Command Syntax:: How to give commands to @value{GDBN}
1211* Completion:: Command completion
1212* Help:: How to ask @value{GDBN} for help
1213@end menu
1214
6d2ebf8b 1215@node Command Syntax
c906108c
SS
1216@section Command syntax
1217
1218A @value{GDBN} command is a single line of input. There is no limit on
1219how long it can be. It starts with a command name, which is followed by
1220arguments whose meaning depends on the command name. For example, the
1221command @code{step} accepts an argument which is the number of times to
1222step, as in @samp{step 5}. You can also use the @code{step} command
96a2c332 1223with no arguments. Some commands do not allow any arguments.
c906108c
SS
1224
1225@cindex abbreviation
1226@value{GDBN} command names may always be truncated if that abbreviation is
1227unambiguous. Other possible command abbreviations are listed in the
1228documentation for individual commands. In some cases, even ambiguous
1229abbreviations are allowed; for example, @code{s} is specially defined as
1230equivalent to @code{step} even though there are other commands whose
1231names start with @code{s}. You can test abbreviations by using them as
1232arguments to the @code{help} command.
1233
1234@cindex repeating commands
41afff9a 1235@kindex RET @r{(repeat last command)}
c906108c 1236A blank line as input to @value{GDBN} (typing just @key{RET}) means to
96a2c332 1237repeat the previous command. Certain commands (for example, @code{run})
c906108c
SS
1238will not repeat this way; these are commands whose unintentional
1239repetition might cause trouble and which you are unlikely to want to
1240repeat.
1241
1242The @code{list} and @code{x} commands, when you repeat them with
1243@key{RET}, construct new arguments rather than repeating
1244exactly as typed. This permits easy scanning of source or memory.
1245
1246@value{GDBN} can also use @key{RET} in another way: to partition lengthy
1247output, in a way similar to the common utility @code{more}
1248(@pxref{Screen Size,,Screen size}). Since it is easy to press one
1249@key{RET} too many in this situation, @value{GDBN} disables command
1250repetition after any command that generates this sort of display.
1251
41afff9a 1252@kindex # @r{(a comment)}
c906108c
SS
1253@cindex comment
1254Any text from a @kbd{#} to the end of the line is a comment; it does
1255nothing. This is useful mainly in command files (@pxref{Command
1256Files,,Command files}).
1257
88118b3a
TT
1258@cindex repeating command sequences
1259@kindex C-o @r{(operate-and-get-next)}
1260The @kbd{C-o} binding is useful for repeating a complex sequence of
1261commands. This command accepts the current line, like @kbd{RET}, and
1262then fetches the next line relative to the current line from the history
1263for editing.
1264
6d2ebf8b 1265@node Completion
c906108c
SS
1266@section Command completion
1267
1268@cindex completion
1269@cindex word completion
1270@value{GDBN} can fill in the rest of a word in a command for you, if there is
1271only one possibility; it can also show you what the valid possibilities
1272are for the next word in a command, at any time. This works for @value{GDBN}
1273commands, @value{GDBN} subcommands, and the names of symbols in your program.
1274
1275Press the @key{TAB} key whenever you want @value{GDBN} to fill out the rest
1276of a word. If there is only one possibility, @value{GDBN} fills in the
1277word, and waits for you to finish the command (or press @key{RET} to
1278enter it). For example, if you type
1279
1280@c FIXME "@key" does not distinguish its argument sufficiently to permit
1281@c complete accuracy in these examples; space introduced for clarity.
1282@c If texinfo enhancements make it unnecessary, it would be nice to
1283@c replace " @key" by "@key" in the following...
1284@example
1285(@value{GDBP}) info bre @key{TAB}
1286@end example
1287
1288@noindent
1289@value{GDBN} fills in the rest of the word @samp{breakpoints}, since that is
1290the only @code{info} subcommand beginning with @samp{bre}:
1291
1292@example
1293(@value{GDBP}) info breakpoints
1294@end example
1295
1296@noindent
1297You can either press @key{RET} at this point, to run the @code{info
1298breakpoints} command, or backspace and enter something else, if
1299@samp{breakpoints} does not look like the command you expected. (If you
1300were sure you wanted @code{info breakpoints} in the first place, you
1301might as well just type @key{RET} immediately after @samp{info bre},
1302to exploit command abbreviations rather than command completion).
1303
1304If there is more than one possibility for the next word when you press
1305@key{TAB}, @value{GDBN} sounds a bell. You can either supply more
1306characters and try again, or just press @key{TAB} a second time;
1307@value{GDBN} displays all the possible completions for that word. For
1308example, you might want to set a breakpoint on a subroutine whose name
1309begins with @samp{make_}, but when you type @kbd{b make_@key{TAB}} @value{GDBN}
1310just sounds the bell. Typing @key{TAB} again displays all the
1311function names in your program that begin with those characters, for
1312example:
1313
1314@example
1315(@value{GDBP}) b make_ @key{TAB}
1316@exdent @value{GDBN} sounds bell; press @key{TAB} again, to see:
5d161b24
DB
1317make_a_section_from_file make_environ
1318make_abs_section make_function_type
1319make_blockvector make_pointer_type
1320make_cleanup make_reference_type
c906108c
SS
1321make_command make_symbol_completion_list
1322(@value{GDBP}) b make_
1323@end example
1324
1325@noindent
1326After displaying the available possibilities, @value{GDBN} copies your
1327partial input (@samp{b make_} in the example) so you can finish the
1328command.
1329
1330If you just want to see the list of alternatives in the first place, you
b37052ae 1331can press @kbd{M-?} rather than pressing @key{TAB} twice. @kbd{M-?}
7a292a7a 1332means @kbd{@key{META} ?}. You can type this either by holding down a
c906108c 1333key designated as the @key{META} shift on your keyboard (if there is
7a292a7a 1334one) while typing @kbd{?}, or as @key{ESC} followed by @kbd{?}.
c906108c
SS
1335
1336@cindex quotes in commands
1337@cindex completion of quoted strings
1338Sometimes the string you need, while logically a ``word'', may contain
7a292a7a
SS
1339parentheses or other characters that @value{GDBN} normally excludes from
1340its notion of a word. To permit word completion to work in this
1341situation, you may enclose words in @code{'} (single quote marks) in
1342@value{GDBN} commands.
c906108c 1343
c906108c 1344The most likely situation where you might need this is in typing the
b37052ae
EZ
1345name of a C@t{++} function. This is because C@t{++} allows function
1346overloading (multiple definitions of the same function, distinguished
1347by argument type). For example, when you want to set a breakpoint you
1348may need to distinguish whether you mean the version of @code{name}
1349that takes an @code{int} parameter, @code{name(int)}, or the version
1350that takes a @code{float} parameter, @code{name(float)}. To use the
1351word-completion facilities in this situation, type a single quote
1352@code{'} at the beginning of the function name. This alerts
1353@value{GDBN} that it may need to consider more information than usual
1354when you press @key{TAB} or @kbd{M-?} to request word completion:
c906108c
SS
1355
1356@example
96a2c332 1357(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble( @kbd{M-?}
c906108c
SS
1358bubble(double,double) bubble(int,int)
1359(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1360@end example
1361
1362In some cases, @value{GDBN} can tell that completing a name requires using
1363quotes. When this happens, @value{GDBN} inserts the quote for you (while
1364completing as much as it can) if you do not type the quote in the first
1365place:
1366
1367@example
1368(@value{GDBP}) b bub @key{TAB}
1369@exdent @value{GDBN} alters your input line to the following, and rings a bell:
1370(@value{GDBP}) b 'bubble(
1371@end example
1372
1373@noindent
1374In general, @value{GDBN} can tell that a quote is needed (and inserts it) if
1375you have not yet started typing the argument list when you ask for
1376completion on an overloaded symbol.
1377
d4f3574e 1378For more information about overloaded functions, see @ref{C plus plus
b37052ae 1379expressions, ,C@t{++} expressions}. You can use the command @code{set
c906108c 1380overload-resolution off} to disable overload resolution;
b37052ae 1381see @ref{Debugging C plus plus, ,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c
SS
1382
1383
6d2ebf8b 1384@node Help
c906108c
SS
1385@section Getting help
1386@cindex online documentation
1387@kindex help
1388
5d161b24 1389You can always ask @value{GDBN} itself for information on its commands,
c906108c
SS
1390using the command @code{help}.
1391
1392@table @code
41afff9a 1393@kindex h @r{(@code{help})}
c906108c
SS
1394@item help
1395@itemx h
1396You can use @code{help} (abbreviated @code{h}) with no arguments to
1397display a short list of named classes of commands:
1398
1399@smallexample
1400(@value{GDBP}) help
1401List of classes of commands:
1402
2df3850c 1403aliases -- Aliases of other commands
c906108c 1404breakpoints -- Making program stop at certain points
2df3850c 1405data -- Examining data
c906108c 1406files -- Specifying and examining files
2df3850c
JM
1407internals -- Maintenance commands
1408obscure -- Obscure features
1409running -- Running the program
1410stack -- Examining the stack
c906108c
SS
1411status -- Status inquiries
1412support -- Support facilities
96a2c332
SS
1413tracepoints -- Tracing of program execution without@*
1414 stopping the program
c906108c 1415user-defined -- User-defined commands
c906108c 1416
5d161b24 1417Type "help" followed by a class name for a list of
c906108c 1418commands in that class.
5d161b24 1419Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1420documentation.
1421Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1422(@value{GDBP})
1423@end smallexample
96a2c332 1424@c the above line break eliminates huge line overfull...
c906108c
SS
1425
1426@item help @var{class}
1427Using one of the general help classes as an argument, you can get a
1428list of the individual commands in that class. For example, here is the
1429help display for the class @code{status}:
1430
1431@smallexample
1432(@value{GDBP}) help status
1433Status inquiries.
1434
1435List of commands:
1436
1437@c Line break in "show" line falsifies real output, but needed
1438@c to fit in smallbook page size.
2df3850c
JM
1439info -- Generic command for showing things
1440 about the program being debugged
1441show -- Generic command for showing things
1442 about the debugger
c906108c 1443
5d161b24 1444Type "help" followed by command name for full
c906108c
SS
1445documentation.
1446Command name abbreviations are allowed if unambiguous.
1447(@value{GDBP})
1448@end smallexample
1449
1450@item help @var{command}
1451With a command name as @code{help} argument, @value{GDBN} displays a
1452short paragraph on how to use that command.
1453
6837a0a2
DB
1454@kindex apropos
1455@item apropos @var{args}
1456The @code{apropos @var{args}} command searches through all of the @value{GDBN}
1457commands, and their documentation, for the regular expression specified in
1458@var{args}. It prints out all matches found. For example:
1459
1460@smallexample
1461apropos reload
1462@end smallexample
1463
b37052ae
EZ
1464@noindent
1465results in:
6837a0a2
DB
1466
1467@smallexample
6d2ebf8b
SS
1468@c @group
1469set symbol-reloading -- Set dynamic symbol table reloading
1470 multiple times in one run
1471show symbol-reloading -- Show dynamic symbol table reloading
1472 multiple times in one run
1473@c @end group
6837a0a2
DB
1474@end smallexample
1475
c906108c
SS
1476@kindex complete
1477@item complete @var{args}
1478The @code{complete @var{args}} command lists all the possible completions
1479for the beginning of a command. Use @var{args} to specify the beginning of the
1480command you want completed. For example:
1481
1482@smallexample
1483complete i
1484@end smallexample
1485
1486@noindent results in:
1487
1488@smallexample
1489@group
2df3850c
JM
1490if
1491ignore
c906108c
SS
1492info
1493inspect
c906108c
SS
1494@end group
1495@end smallexample
1496
1497@noindent This is intended for use by @sc{gnu} Emacs.
1498@end table
1499
1500In addition to @code{help}, you can use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{info}
1501and @code{show} to inquire about the state of your program, or the state
1502of @value{GDBN} itself. Each command supports many topics of inquiry; this
1503manual introduces each of them in the appropriate context. The listings
1504under @code{info} and under @code{show} in the Index point to
1505all the sub-commands. @xref{Index}.
1506
1507@c @group
1508@table @code
1509@kindex info
41afff9a 1510@kindex i @r{(@code{info})}
c906108c
SS
1511@item info
1512This command (abbreviated @code{i}) is for describing the state of your
1513program. For example, you can list the arguments given to your program
1514with @code{info args}, list the registers currently in use with @code{info
1515registers}, or list the breakpoints you have set with @code{info breakpoints}.
1516You can get a complete list of the @code{info} sub-commands with
1517@w{@code{help info}}.
1518
1519@kindex set
1520@item set
5d161b24 1521You can assign the result of an expression to an environment variable with
c906108c
SS
1522@code{set}. For example, you can set the @value{GDBN} prompt to a $-sign with
1523@code{set prompt $}.
1524
1525@kindex show
1526@item show
5d161b24 1527In contrast to @code{info}, @code{show} is for describing the state of
c906108c
SS
1528@value{GDBN} itself.
1529You can change most of the things you can @code{show}, by using the
1530related command @code{set}; for example, you can control what number
1531system is used for displays with @code{set radix}, or simply inquire
1532which is currently in use with @code{show radix}.
1533
1534@kindex info set
1535To display all the settable parameters and their current
1536values, you can use @code{show} with no arguments; you may also use
1537@code{info set}. Both commands produce the same display.
1538@c FIXME: "info set" violates the rule that "info" is for state of
1539@c FIXME...program. Ck w/ GNU: "info set" to be called something else,
1540@c FIXME...or change desc of rule---eg "state of prog and debugging session"?
1541@end table
1542@c @end group
1543
1544Here are three miscellaneous @code{show} subcommands, all of which are
1545exceptional in lacking corresponding @code{set} commands:
1546
1547@table @code
1548@kindex show version
1549@cindex version number
1550@item show version
1551Show what version of @value{GDBN} is running. You should include this
2df3850c
JM
1552information in @value{GDBN} bug-reports. If multiple versions of
1553@value{GDBN} are in use at your site, you may need to determine which
1554version of @value{GDBN} you are running; as @value{GDBN} evolves, new
1555commands are introduced, and old ones may wither away. Also, many
1556system vendors ship variant versions of @value{GDBN}, and there are
96a2c332 1557variant versions of @value{GDBN} in @sc{gnu}/Linux distributions as well.
2df3850c
JM
1558The version number is the same as the one announced when you start
1559@value{GDBN}.
c906108c
SS
1560
1561@kindex show copying
1562@item show copying
1563Display information about permission for copying @value{GDBN}.
1564
1565@kindex show warranty
1566@item show warranty
2df3850c 1567Display the @sc{gnu} ``NO WARRANTY'' statement, or a warranty,
96a2c332 1568if your version of @value{GDBN} comes with one.
2df3850c 1569
c906108c
SS
1570@end table
1571
6d2ebf8b 1572@node Running
c906108c
SS
1573@chapter Running Programs Under @value{GDBN}
1574
1575When you run a program under @value{GDBN}, you must first generate
1576debugging information when you compile it.
7a292a7a
SS
1577
1578You may start @value{GDBN} with its arguments, if any, in an environment
1579of your choice. If you are doing native debugging, you may redirect
1580your program's input and output, debug an already running process, or
1581kill a child process.
c906108c
SS
1582
1583@menu
1584* Compilation:: Compiling for debugging
1585* Starting:: Starting your program
c906108c
SS
1586* Arguments:: Your program's arguments
1587* Environment:: Your program's environment
c906108c
SS
1588
1589* Working Directory:: Your program's working directory
1590* Input/Output:: Your program's input and output
1591* Attach:: Debugging an already-running process
1592* Kill Process:: Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1593
1594* Threads:: Debugging programs with multiple threads
1595* Processes:: Debugging programs with multiple processes
1596@end menu
1597
6d2ebf8b 1598@node Compilation
c906108c
SS
1599@section Compiling for debugging
1600
1601In order to debug a program effectively, you need to generate
1602debugging information when you compile it. This debugging information
1603is stored in the object file; it describes the data type of each
1604variable or function and the correspondence between source line numbers
1605and addresses in the executable code.
1606
1607To request debugging information, specify the @samp{-g} option when you run
1608the compiler.
1609
1610Many C compilers are unable to handle the @samp{-g} and @samp{-O}
1611options together. Using those compilers, you cannot generate optimized
1612executables containing debugging information.
1613
53a5351d
JM
1614@value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C compiler, supports @samp{-g} with or
1615without @samp{-O}, making it possible to debug optimized code. We
1616recommend that you @emph{always} use @samp{-g} whenever you compile a
1617program. You may think your program is correct, but there is no sense
1618in pushing your luck.
c906108c
SS
1619
1620@cindex optimized code, debugging
1621@cindex debugging optimized code
1622When you debug a program compiled with @samp{-g -O}, remember that the
1623optimizer is rearranging your code; the debugger shows you what is
1624really there. Do not be too surprised when the execution path does not
1625exactly match your source file! An extreme example: if you define a
1626variable, but never use it, @value{GDBN} never sees that
1627variable---because the compiler optimizes it out of existence.
1628
1629Some things do not work as well with @samp{-g -O} as with just
1630@samp{-g}, particularly on machines with instruction scheduling. If in
1631doubt, recompile with @samp{-g} alone, and if this fixes the problem,
1632please report it to us as a bug (including a test case!).
1633
1634Older versions of the @sc{gnu} C compiler permitted a variant option
1635@w{@samp{-gg}} for debugging information. @value{GDBN} no longer supports this
1636format; if your @sc{gnu} C compiler has this option, do not use it.
1637
1638@need 2000
6d2ebf8b 1639@node Starting
c906108c
SS
1640@section Starting your program
1641@cindex starting
1642@cindex running
1643
1644@table @code
1645@kindex run
41afff9a 1646@kindex r @r{(@code{run})}
c906108c
SS
1647@item run
1648@itemx r
7a292a7a
SS
1649Use the @code{run} command to start your program under @value{GDBN}.
1650You must first specify the program name (except on VxWorks) with an
1651argument to @value{GDBN} (@pxref{Invocation, ,Getting In and Out of
1652@value{GDBN}}), or by using the @code{file} or @code{exec-file} command
1653(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
c906108c
SS
1654
1655@end table
1656
c906108c
SS
1657If you are running your program in an execution environment that
1658supports processes, @code{run} creates an inferior process and makes
1659that process run your program. (In environments without processes,
1660@code{run} jumps to the start of your program.)
1661
1662The execution of a program is affected by certain information it
1663receives from its superior. @value{GDBN} provides ways to specify this
1664information, which you must do @emph{before} starting your program. (You
1665can change it after starting your program, but such changes only affect
1666your program the next time you start it.) This information may be
1667divided into four categories:
1668
1669@table @asis
1670@item The @emph{arguments.}
1671Specify the arguments to give your program as the arguments of the
1672@code{run} command. If a shell is available on your target, the shell
1673is used to pass the arguments, so that you may use normal conventions
1674(such as wildcard expansion or variable substitution) in describing
1675the arguments.
1676In Unix systems, you can control which shell is used with the
1677@code{SHELL} environment variable.
1678@xref{Arguments, ,Your program's arguments}.
1679
1680@item The @emph{environment.}
1681Your program normally inherits its environment from @value{GDBN}, but you can
1682use the @value{GDBN} commands @code{set environment} and @code{unset
1683environment} to change parts of the environment that affect
1684your program. @xref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}.
1685
1686@item The @emph{working directory.}
1687Your program inherits its working directory from @value{GDBN}. You can set
1688the @value{GDBN} working directory with the @code{cd} command in @value{GDBN}.
1689@xref{Working Directory, ,Your program's working directory}.
1690
1691@item The @emph{standard input and output.}
1692Your program normally uses the same device for standard input and
1693standard output as @value{GDBN} is using. You can redirect input and output
1694in the @code{run} command line, or you can use the @code{tty} command to
1695set a different device for your program.
1696@xref{Input/Output, ,Your program's input and output}.
1697
1698@cindex pipes
1699@emph{Warning:} While input and output redirection work, you cannot use
1700pipes to pass the output of the program you are debugging to another
1701program; if you attempt this, @value{GDBN} is likely to wind up debugging the
1702wrong program.
1703@end table
c906108c
SS
1704
1705When you issue the @code{run} command, your program begins to execute
1706immediately. @xref{Stopping, ,Stopping and continuing}, for discussion
1707of how to arrange for your program to stop. Once your program has
1708stopped, you may call functions in your program, using the @code{print}
1709or @code{call} commands. @xref{Data, ,Examining Data}.
1710
1711If the modification time of your symbol file has changed since the last
1712time @value{GDBN} read its symbols, @value{GDBN} discards its symbol
1713table, and reads it again. When it does this, @value{GDBN} tries to retain
1714your current breakpoints.
1715
6d2ebf8b 1716@node Arguments
c906108c
SS
1717@section Your program's arguments
1718
1719@cindex arguments (to your program)
1720The arguments to your program can be specified by the arguments of the
5d161b24 1721@code{run} command.
c906108c
SS
1722They are passed to a shell, which expands wildcard characters and
1723performs redirection of I/O, and thence to your program. Your
1724@code{SHELL} environment variable (if it exists) specifies what shell
1725@value{GDBN} uses. If you do not define @code{SHELL}, @value{GDBN} uses
d4f3574e
SS
1726the default shell (@file{/bin/sh} on Unix).
1727
1728On non-Unix systems, the program is usually invoked directly by
1729@value{GDBN}, which emulates I/O redirection via the appropriate system
1730calls, and the wildcard characters are expanded by the startup code of
1731the program, not by the shell.
c906108c
SS
1732
1733@code{run} with no arguments uses the same arguments used by the previous
1734@code{run}, or those set by the @code{set args} command.
1735
c906108c 1736@table @code
41afff9a 1737@kindex set args
c906108c
SS
1738@item set args
1739Specify the arguments to be used the next time your program is run. If
1740@code{set args} has no arguments, @code{run} executes your program
1741with no arguments. Once you have run your program with arguments,
1742using @code{set args} before the next @code{run} is the only way to run
1743it again without arguments.
1744
1745@kindex show args
1746@item show args
1747Show the arguments to give your program when it is started.
1748@end table
1749
6d2ebf8b 1750@node Environment
c906108c
SS
1751@section Your program's environment
1752
1753@cindex environment (of your program)
1754The @dfn{environment} consists of a set of environment variables and
1755their values. Environment variables conventionally record such things as
1756your user name, your home directory, your terminal type, and your search
1757path for programs to run. Usually you set up environment variables with
1758the shell and they are inherited by all the other programs you run. When
1759debugging, it can be useful to try running your program with a modified
1760environment without having to start @value{GDBN} over again.
1761
1762@table @code
1763@kindex path
1764@item path @var{directory}
1765Add @var{directory} to the front of the @code{PATH} environment variable
17cc6a06
EZ
1766(the search path for executables) that will be passed to your program.
1767The value of @code{PATH} used by @value{GDBN} does not change.
d4f3574e
SS
1768You may specify several directory names, separated by whitespace or by a
1769system-dependent separator character (@samp{:} on Unix, @samp{;} on
1770MS-DOS and MS-Windows). If @var{directory} is already in the path, it
1771is moved to the front, so it is searched sooner.
c906108c
SS
1772
1773You can use the string @samp{$cwd} to refer to whatever is the current
1774working directory at the time @value{GDBN} searches the path. If you
1775use @samp{.} instead, it refers to the directory where you executed the
1776@code{path} command. @value{GDBN} replaces @samp{.} in the
1777@var{directory} argument (with the current path) before adding
1778@var{directory} to the search path.
1779@c 'path' is explicitly nonrepeatable, but RMS points out it is silly to
1780@c document that, since repeating it would be a no-op.
1781
1782@kindex show paths
1783@item show paths
1784Display the list of search paths for executables (the @code{PATH}
1785environment variable).
1786
1787@kindex show environment
1788@item show environment @r{[}@var{varname}@r{]}
1789Print the value of environment variable @var{varname} to be given to
1790your program when it starts. If you do not supply @var{varname},
1791print the names and values of all environment variables to be given to
1792your program. You can abbreviate @code{environment} as @code{env}.
1793
1794@kindex set environment
53a5351d 1795@item set environment @var{varname} @r{[}=@var{value}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
1796Set environment variable @var{varname} to @var{value}. The value
1797changes for your program only, not for @value{GDBN} itself. @var{value} may
1798be any string; the values of environment variables are just strings, and
1799any interpretation is supplied by your program itself. The @var{value}
1800parameter is optional; if it is eliminated, the variable is set to a
1801null value.
1802@c "any string" here does not include leading, trailing
1803@c blanks. Gnu asks: does anyone care?
1804
1805For example, this command:
1806
1807@example
1808set env USER = foo
1809@end example
1810
1811@noindent
d4f3574e 1812tells the debugged program, when subsequently run, that its user is named
c906108c
SS
1813@samp{foo}. (The spaces around @samp{=} are used for clarity here; they
1814are not actually required.)
1815
1816@kindex unset environment
1817@item unset environment @var{varname}
1818Remove variable @var{varname} from the environment to be passed to your
1819program. This is different from @samp{set env @var{varname} =};
1820@code{unset environment} removes the variable from the environment,
1821rather than assigning it an empty value.
1822@end table
1823
d4f3574e
SS
1824@emph{Warning:} On Unix systems, @value{GDBN} runs your program using
1825the shell indicated
c906108c
SS
1826by your @code{SHELL} environment variable if it exists (or
1827@code{/bin/sh} if not). If your @code{SHELL} variable names a shell
1828that runs an initialization file---such as @file{.cshrc} for C-shell, or
1829@file{.bashrc} for BASH---any variables you set in that file affect
1830your program. You may wish to move setting of environment variables to
1831files that are only run when you sign on, such as @file{.login} or
1832@file{.profile}.
1833
6d2ebf8b 1834@node Working Directory
c906108c
SS
1835@section Your program's working directory
1836
1837@cindex working directory (of your program)
1838Each time you start your program with @code{run}, it inherits its
1839working directory from the current working directory of @value{GDBN}.
1840The @value{GDBN} working directory is initially whatever it inherited
1841from its parent process (typically the shell), but you can specify a new
1842working directory in @value{GDBN} with the @code{cd} command.
1843
1844The @value{GDBN} working directory also serves as a default for the commands
1845that specify files for @value{GDBN} to operate on. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1846specify files}.
1847
1848@table @code
1849@kindex cd
1850@item cd @var{directory}
1851Set the @value{GDBN} working directory to @var{directory}.
1852
1853@kindex pwd
1854@item pwd
1855Print the @value{GDBN} working directory.
1856@end table
1857
6d2ebf8b 1858@node Input/Output
c906108c
SS
1859@section Your program's input and output
1860
1861@cindex redirection
1862@cindex i/o
1863@cindex terminal
1864By default, the program you run under @value{GDBN} does input and output to
5d161b24 1865the same terminal that @value{GDBN} uses. @value{GDBN} switches the terminal
c906108c
SS
1866to its own terminal modes to interact with you, but it records the terminal
1867modes your program was using and switches back to them when you continue
1868running your program.
1869
1870@table @code
1871@kindex info terminal
1872@item info terminal
1873Displays information recorded by @value{GDBN} about the terminal modes your
1874program is using.
1875@end table
1876
1877You can redirect your program's input and/or output using shell
1878redirection with the @code{run} command. For example,
1879
1880@example
1881run > outfile
1882@end example
1883
1884@noindent
1885starts your program, diverting its output to the file @file{outfile}.
1886
1887@kindex tty
1888@cindex controlling terminal
1889Another way to specify where your program should do input and output is
1890with the @code{tty} command. This command accepts a file name as
1891argument, and causes this file to be the default for future @code{run}
1892commands. It also resets the controlling terminal for the child
1893process, for future @code{run} commands. For example,
1894
1895@example
1896tty /dev/ttyb
1897@end example
1898
1899@noindent
1900directs that processes started with subsequent @code{run} commands
1901default to do input and output on the terminal @file{/dev/ttyb} and have
1902that as their controlling terminal.
1903
1904An explicit redirection in @code{run} overrides the @code{tty} command's
1905effect on the input/output device, but not its effect on the controlling
1906terminal.
1907
1908When you use the @code{tty} command or redirect input in the @code{run}
1909command, only the input @emph{for your program} is affected. The input
1910for @value{GDBN} still comes from your terminal.
1911
6d2ebf8b 1912@node Attach
c906108c
SS
1913@section Debugging an already-running process
1914@kindex attach
1915@cindex attach
1916
1917@table @code
1918@item attach @var{process-id}
1919This command attaches to a running process---one that was started
1920outside @value{GDBN}. (@code{info files} shows your active
1921targets.) The command takes as argument a process ID. The usual way to
1922find out the process-id of a Unix process is with the @code{ps} utility,
1923or with the @samp{jobs -l} shell command.
1924
1925@code{attach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} a second time after
1926executing the command.
1927@end table
1928
1929To use @code{attach}, your program must be running in an environment
1930which supports processes; for example, @code{attach} does not work for
1931programs on bare-board targets that lack an operating system. You must
1932also have permission to send the process a signal.
1933
1934When you use @code{attach}, the debugger finds the program running in
1935the process first by looking in the current working directory, then (if
1936the program is not found) by using the source file search path
1937(@pxref{Source Path, ,Specifying source directories}). You can also use
1938the @code{file} command to load the program. @xref{Files, ,Commands to
1939Specify Files}.
1940
1941The first thing @value{GDBN} does after arranging to debug the specified
1942process is to stop it. You can examine and modify an attached process
53a5351d
JM
1943with all the @value{GDBN} commands that are ordinarily available when
1944you start processes with @code{run}. You can insert breakpoints; you
1945can step and continue; you can modify storage. If you would rather the
1946process continue running, you may use the @code{continue} command after
c906108c
SS
1947attaching @value{GDBN} to the process.
1948
1949@table @code
1950@kindex detach
1951@item detach
1952When you have finished debugging the attached process, you can use the
1953@code{detach} command to release it from @value{GDBN} control. Detaching
1954the process continues its execution. After the @code{detach} command,
1955that process and @value{GDBN} become completely independent once more, and you
1956are ready to @code{attach} another process or start one with @code{run}.
1957@code{detach} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
1958executing the command.
1959@end table
1960
1961If you exit @value{GDBN} or use the @code{run} command while you have an
1962attached process, you kill that process. By default, @value{GDBN} asks
1963for confirmation if you try to do either of these things; you can
1964control whether or not you need to confirm by using the @code{set
1965confirm} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
1966messages}).
1967
6d2ebf8b 1968@node Kill Process
c906108c 1969@section Killing the child process
c906108c
SS
1970
1971@table @code
1972@kindex kill
1973@item kill
1974Kill the child process in which your program is running under @value{GDBN}.
1975@end table
1976
1977This command is useful if you wish to debug a core dump instead of a
1978running process. @value{GDBN} ignores any core dump file while your program
1979is running.
1980
1981On some operating systems, a program cannot be executed outside @value{GDBN}
1982while you have breakpoints set on it inside @value{GDBN}. You can use the
1983@code{kill} command in this situation to permit running your program
1984outside the debugger.
1985
1986The @code{kill} command is also useful if you wish to recompile and
1987relink your program, since on many systems it is impossible to modify an
1988executable file while it is running in a process. In this case, when you
1989next type @code{run}, @value{GDBN} notices that the file has changed, and
1990reads the symbol table again (while trying to preserve your current
1991breakpoint settings).
1992
6d2ebf8b 1993@node Threads
c906108c 1994@section Debugging programs with multiple threads
c906108c
SS
1995
1996@cindex threads of execution
1997@cindex multiple threads
1998@cindex switching threads
1999In some operating systems, such as HP-UX and Solaris, a single program
2000may have more than one @dfn{thread} of execution. The precise semantics
2001of threads differ from one operating system to another, but in general
2002the threads of a single program are akin to multiple processes---except
2003that they share one address space (that is, they can all examine and
2004modify the same variables). On the other hand, each thread has its own
2005registers and execution stack, and perhaps private memory.
2006
2007@value{GDBN} provides these facilities for debugging multi-thread
2008programs:
2009
2010@itemize @bullet
2011@item automatic notification of new threads
2012@item @samp{thread @var{threadno}}, a command to switch among threads
2013@item @samp{info threads}, a command to inquire about existing threads
5d161b24 2014@item @samp{thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}},
c906108c
SS
2015a command to apply a command to a list of threads
2016@item thread-specific breakpoints
2017@end itemize
2018
c906108c
SS
2019@quotation
2020@emph{Warning:} These facilities are not yet available on every
2021@value{GDBN} configuration where the operating system supports threads.
2022If your @value{GDBN} does not support threads, these commands have no
2023effect. For example, a system without thread support shows no output
2024from @samp{info threads}, and always rejects the @code{thread} command,
2025like this:
2026
2027@smallexample
2028(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2029(@value{GDBP}) thread 1
2030Thread ID 1 not known. Use the "info threads" command to
2031see the IDs of currently known threads.
2032@end smallexample
2033@c FIXME to implementors: how hard would it be to say "sorry, this GDB
2034@c doesn't support threads"?
2035@end quotation
c906108c
SS
2036
2037@cindex focus of debugging
2038@cindex current thread
2039The @value{GDBN} thread debugging facility allows you to observe all
2040threads while your program runs---but whenever @value{GDBN} takes
2041control, one thread in particular is always the focus of debugging.
2042This thread is called the @dfn{current thread}. Debugging commands show
2043program information from the perspective of the current thread.
2044
41afff9a 2045@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message
c906108c
SS
2046@cindex thread identifier (system)
2047@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2048@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2049@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2050Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2051the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2052form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2053whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2054LynxOS, you might see
2055
2056@example
2057[New process 35 thread 27]
2058@end example
2059
2060@noindent
2061when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread. In contrast, on an SGI system,
2062the @var{systag} is simply something like @samp{process 368}, with no
2063further qualifier.
2064
2065@c FIXME!! (1) Does the [New...] message appear even for the very first
2066@c thread of a program, or does it only appear for the
2067@c second---i.e., when it becomes obvious we have a multithread
2068@c program?
2069@c (2) *Is* there necessarily a first thread always? Or do some
2070@c multithread systems permit starting a program with multiple
5d161b24 2071@c threads ab initio?
c906108c
SS
2072
2073@cindex thread number
2074@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2075For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2076number---always a single integer---with each thread in your program.
2077
2078@table @code
2079@kindex info threads
2080@item info threads
2081Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2082program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2083
2084@enumerate
2085@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2086
2087@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2088
2089@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2090@end enumerate
2091
2092@noindent
2093An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2094indicates the current thread.
2095
5d161b24 2096For example,
c906108c
SS
2097@end table
2098@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2099
2100@smallexample
2101(@value{GDBP}) info threads
2102 3 process 35 thread 27 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2103 2 process 35 thread 23 0x34e5 in sigpause ()
2104* 1 process 35 thread 13 main (argc=1, argv=0x7ffffff8)
2105 at threadtest.c:68
2106@end smallexample
53a5351d
JM
2107
2108On HP-UX systems:
c906108c
SS
2109
2110@cindex thread number
2111@cindex thread identifier (GDB)
2112For debugging purposes, @value{GDBN} associates its own thread
2113number---a small integer assigned in thread-creation order---with each
2114thread in your program.
2115
41afff9a
EZ
2116@cindex @code{New} @var{systag} message, on HP-UX
2117@cindex thread identifier (system), on HP-UX
c906108c
SS
2118@c FIXME-implementors!! It would be more helpful if the [New...] message
2119@c included GDB's numeric thread handle, so you could just go to that
2120@c thread without first checking `info threads'.
2121Whenever @value{GDBN} detects a new thread in your program, it displays
2122both @value{GDBN}'s thread number and the target system's identification for the thread with a message in the
2123form @samp{[New @var{systag}]}. @var{systag} is a thread identifier
2124whose form varies depending on the particular system. For example, on
2125HP-UX, you see
2126
2127@example
2128[New thread 2 (system thread 26594)]
2129@end example
2130
2131@noindent
5d161b24 2132when @value{GDBN} notices a new thread.
c906108c
SS
2133
2134@table @code
2135@kindex info threads
2136@item info threads
2137Display a summary of all threads currently in your
2138program. @value{GDBN} displays for each thread (in this order):
2139
2140@enumerate
2141@item the thread number assigned by @value{GDBN}
2142
2143@item the target system's thread identifier (@var{systag})
2144
2145@item the current stack frame summary for that thread
2146@end enumerate
2147
2148@noindent
2149An asterisk @samp{*} to the left of the @value{GDBN} thread number
2150indicates the current thread.
2151
5d161b24 2152For example,
c906108c
SS
2153@end table
2154@c end table here to get a little more width for example
2155
2156@example
2157(@value{GDBP}) info threads
6d2ebf8b
SS
2158 * 3 system thread 26607 worker (wptr=0x7b09c318 "@@") \@*
2159 at quicksort.c:137
2160 2 system thread 26606 0x7b0030d8 in __ksleep () \@*
2161 from /usr/lib/libc.2
2162 1 system thread 27905 0x7b003498 in _brk () \@*
2163 from /usr/lib/libc.2
c906108c 2164@end example
c906108c
SS
2165
2166@table @code
2167@kindex thread @var{threadno}
2168@item thread @var{threadno}
2169Make thread number @var{threadno} the current thread. The command
2170argument @var{threadno} is the internal @value{GDBN} thread number, as
2171shown in the first field of the @samp{info threads} display.
2172@value{GDBN} responds by displaying the system identifier of the thread
2173you selected, and its current stack frame summary:
2174
2175@smallexample
2176@c FIXME!! This example made up; find a @value{GDBN} w/threads and get real one
2177(@value{GDBP}) thread 2
c906108c 2178[Switching to process 35 thread 23]
c906108c
SS
21790x34e5 in sigpause ()
2180@end smallexample
2181
2182@noindent
2183As with the @samp{[New @dots{}]} message, the form of the text after
2184@samp{Switching to} depends on your system's conventions for identifying
5d161b24 2185threads.
c906108c
SS
2186
2187@kindex thread apply
2188@item thread apply [@var{threadno}] [@var{all}] @var{args}
2189The @code{thread apply} command allows you to apply a command to one or
2190more threads. Specify the numbers of the threads that you want affected
2191with the command argument @var{threadno}. @var{threadno} is the internal
2192@value{GDBN} thread number, as shown in the first field of the @samp{info
5d161b24
DB
2193threads} display. To apply a command to all threads, use
2194@code{thread apply all} @var{args}.
c906108c
SS
2195@end table
2196
2197@cindex automatic thread selection
2198@cindex switching threads automatically
2199@cindex threads, automatic switching
2200Whenever @value{GDBN} stops your program, due to a breakpoint or a
2201signal, it automatically selects the thread where that breakpoint or
2202signal happened. @value{GDBN} alerts you to the context switch with a
2203message of the form @samp{[Switching to @var{systag}]} to identify the
2204thread.
2205
2206@xref{Thread Stops,,Stopping and starting multi-thread programs}, for
2207more information about how @value{GDBN} behaves when you stop and start
2208programs with multiple threads.
2209
2210@xref{Set Watchpoints,,Setting watchpoints}, for information about
2211watchpoints in programs with multiple threads.
c906108c 2212
6d2ebf8b 2213@node Processes
c906108c
SS
2214@section Debugging programs with multiple processes
2215
2216@cindex fork, debugging programs which call
2217@cindex multiple processes
2218@cindex processes, multiple
53a5351d
JM
2219On most systems, @value{GDBN} has no special support for debugging
2220programs which create additional processes using the @code{fork}
2221function. When a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug the
2222parent process and the child process will run unimpeded. If you have
2223set a breakpoint in any code which the child then executes, the child
2224will get a @code{SIGTRAP} signal which (unless it catches the signal)
2225will cause it to terminate.
c906108c
SS
2226
2227However, if you want to debug the child process there is a workaround
2228which isn't too painful. Put a call to @code{sleep} in the code which
2229the child process executes after the fork. It may be useful to sleep
2230only if a certain environment variable is set, or a certain file exists,
2231so that the delay need not occur when you don't want to run @value{GDBN}
2232on the child. While the child is sleeping, use the @code{ps} program to
2233get its process ID. Then tell @value{GDBN} (a new invocation of
2234@value{GDBN} if you are also debugging the parent process) to attach to
d4f3574e 2235the child process (@pxref{Attach}). From that point on you can debug
c906108c 2236the child process just like any other process which you attached to.
c906108c 2237
53a5351d
JM
2238On HP-UX (11.x and later only?), @value{GDBN} provides support for
2239debugging programs that create additional processes using the
2240@code{fork} or @code{vfork} function.
c906108c
SS
2241
2242By default, when a program forks, @value{GDBN} will continue to debug
2243the parent process and the child process will run unimpeded.
2244
2245If you want to follow the child process instead of the parent process,
2246use the command @w{@code{set follow-fork-mode}}.
2247
2248@table @code
2249@kindex set follow-fork-mode
2250@item set follow-fork-mode @var{mode}
2251Set the debugger response to a program call of @code{fork} or
2252@code{vfork}. A call to @code{fork} or @code{vfork} creates a new
2253process. The @var{mode} can be:
2254
2255@table @code
2256@item parent
2257The original process is debugged after a fork. The child process runs
2df3850c 2258unimpeded. This is the default.
c906108c
SS
2259
2260@item child
2261The new process is debugged after a fork. The parent process runs
2262unimpeded.
2263
2264@item ask
2265The debugger will ask for one of the above choices.
2266@end table
2267
2268@item show follow-fork-mode
2df3850c 2269Display the current debugger response to a @code{fork} or @code{vfork} call.
c906108c
SS
2270@end table
2271
2272If you ask to debug a child process and a @code{vfork} is followed by an
2273@code{exec}, @value{GDBN} executes the new target up to the first
2274breakpoint in the new target. If you have a breakpoint set on
2275@code{main} in your original program, the breakpoint will also be set on
2276the child process's @code{main}.
2277
2278When a child process is spawned by @code{vfork}, you cannot debug the
2279child or parent until an @code{exec} call completes.
2280
2281If you issue a @code{run} command to @value{GDBN} after an @code{exec}
2282call executes, the new target restarts. To restart the parent process,
2283use the @code{file} command with the parent executable name as its
2284argument.
2285
2286You can use the @code{catch} command to make @value{GDBN} stop whenever
2287a @code{fork}, @code{vfork}, or @code{exec} call is made. @xref{Set
2288Catchpoints, ,Setting catchpoints}.
c906108c 2289
6d2ebf8b 2290@node Stopping
c906108c
SS
2291@chapter Stopping and Continuing
2292
2293The principal purposes of using a debugger are so that you can stop your
2294program before it terminates; or so that, if your program runs into
2295trouble, you can investigate and find out why.
2296
7a292a7a
SS
2297Inside @value{GDBN}, your program may stop for any of several reasons,
2298such as a signal, a breakpoint, or reaching a new line after a
2299@value{GDBN} command such as @code{step}. You may then examine and
2300change variables, set new breakpoints or remove old ones, and then
2301continue execution. Usually, the messages shown by @value{GDBN} provide
2302ample explanation of the status of your program---but you can also
2303explicitly request this information at any time.
c906108c
SS
2304
2305@table @code
2306@kindex info program
2307@item info program
2308Display information about the status of your program: whether it is
7a292a7a 2309running or not, what process it is, and why it stopped.
c906108c
SS
2310@end table
2311
2312@menu
2313* Breakpoints:: Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2314* Continuing and Stepping:: Resuming execution
c906108c 2315* Signals:: Signals
c906108c 2316* Thread Stops:: Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
c906108c
SS
2317@end menu
2318
6d2ebf8b 2319@node Breakpoints
c906108c
SS
2320@section Breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints
2321
2322@cindex breakpoints
2323A @dfn{breakpoint} makes your program stop whenever a certain point in
2324the program is reached. For each breakpoint, you can add conditions to
2325control in finer detail whether your program stops. You can set
2326breakpoints with the @code{break} command and its variants (@pxref{Set
2327Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}), to specify the place where your program
2328should stop by line number, function name or exact address in the
2329program.
2330
2331In HP-UX, SunOS 4.x, SVR4, and Alpha OSF/1 configurations, you can set
2332breakpoints in shared libraries before the executable is run. There is
2333a minor limitation on HP-UX systems: you must wait until the executable
2334is run in order to set breakpoints in shared library routines that are
2335not called directly by the program (for example, routines that are
2336arguments in a @code{pthread_create} call).
2337
2338@cindex watchpoints
2339@cindex memory tracing
2340@cindex breakpoint on memory address
2341@cindex breakpoint on variable modification
2342A @dfn{watchpoint} is a special breakpoint that stops your program
2343when the value of an expression changes. You must use a different
2344command to set watchpoints (@pxref{Set Watchpoints, ,Setting
2345watchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a watchpoint like
2346any other breakpoint: you enable, disable, and delete both breakpoints
2347and watchpoints using the same commands.
2348
2349You can arrange to have values from your program displayed automatically
2350whenever @value{GDBN} stops at a breakpoint. @xref{Auto Display,,
2351Automatic display}.
2352
2353@cindex catchpoints
2354@cindex breakpoint on events
2355A @dfn{catchpoint} is another special breakpoint that stops your program
b37052ae 2356when a certain kind of event occurs, such as the throwing of a C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
2357exception or the loading of a library. As with watchpoints, you use a
2358different command to set a catchpoint (@pxref{Set Catchpoints, ,Setting
2359catchpoints}), but aside from that, you can manage a catchpoint like any
2360other breakpoint. (To stop when your program receives a signal, use the
d4f3574e 2361@code{handle} command; see @ref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
2362
2363@cindex breakpoint numbers
2364@cindex numbers for breakpoints
2365@value{GDBN} assigns a number to each breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2366catchpoint when you create it; these numbers are successive integers
2367starting with one. In many of the commands for controlling various
2368features of breakpoints you use the breakpoint number to say which
2369breakpoint you want to change. Each breakpoint may be @dfn{enabled} or
2370@dfn{disabled}; if disabled, it has no effect on your program until you
2371enable it again.
2372
c5394b80
JM
2373@cindex breakpoint ranges
2374@cindex ranges of breakpoints
2375Some @value{GDBN} commands accept a range of breakpoints on which to
2376operate. A breakpoint range is either a single breakpoint number, like
2377@samp{5}, or two such numbers, in increasing order, separated by a
2378hyphen, like @samp{5-7}. When a breakpoint range is given to a command,
2379all breakpoint in that range are operated on.
2380
c906108c
SS
2381@menu
2382* Set Breaks:: Setting breakpoints
2383* Set Watchpoints:: Setting watchpoints
2384* Set Catchpoints:: Setting catchpoints
2385* Delete Breaks:: Deleting breakpoints
2386* Disabling:: Disabling breakpoints
2387* Conditions:: Break conditions
2388* Break Commands:: Breakpoint command lists
c906108c 2389* Breakpoint Menus:: Breakpoint menus
d4f3574e 2390* Error in Breakpoints:: ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
2391@end menu
2392
6d2ebf8b 2393@node Set Breaks
c906108c
SS
2394@subsection Setting breakpoints
2395
5d161b24 2396@c FIXME LMB what does GDB do if no code on line of breakpt?
c906108c
SS
2397@c consider in particular declaration with/without initialization.
2398@c
2399@c FIXME 2 is there stuff on this already? break at fun start, already init?
2400
2401@kindex break
41afff9a
EZ
2402@kindex b @r{(@code{break})}
2403@vindex $bpnum@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
2404@cindex latest breakpoint
2405Breakpoints are set with the @code{break} command (abbreviated
5d161b24 2406@code{b}). The debugger convenience variable @samp{$bpnum} records the
f3b28801 2407number of the breakpoint you've set most recently; see @ref{Convenience
c906108c
SS
2408Vars,, Convenience variables}, for a discussion of what you can do with
2409convenience variables.
2410
2411You have several ways to say where the breakpoint should go.
2412
2413@table @code
2414@item break @var{function}
5d161b24 2415Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function}.
c906108c 2416When using source languages that permit overloading of symbols, such as
b37052ae 2417C@t{++}, @var{function} may refer to more than one possible place to break.
c906108c 2418@xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}, for a discussion of that situation.
c906108c
SS
2419
2420@item break +@var{offset}
2421@itemx break -@var{offset}
2422Set a breakpoint some number of lines forward or back from the position
d4f3574e 2423at which execution stopped in the currently selected @dfn{stack frame}.
2df3850c 2424(@xref{Frames, ,Frames}, for a description of stack frames.)
c906108c
SS
2425
2426@item break @var{linenum}
2427Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in the current source file.
d4f3574e
SS
2428The current source file is the last file whose source text was printed.
2429The breakpoint will stop your program just before it executes any of the
c906108c
SS
2430code on that line.
2431
2432@item break @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2433Set a breakpoint at line @var{linenum} in source file @var{filename}.
2434
2435@item break @var{filename}:@var{function}
2436Set a breakpoint at entry to function @var{function} found in file
2437@var{filename}. Specifying a file name as well as a function name is
2438superfluous except when multiple files contain similarly named
2439functions.
2440
2441@item break *@var{address}
2442Set a breakpoint at address @var{address}. You can use this to set
2443breakpoints in parts of your program which do not have debugging
2444information or source files.
2445
2446@item break
2447When called without any arguments, @code{break} sets a breakpoint at
2448the next instruction to be executed in the selected stack frame
2449(@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the Stack}). In any selected frame but the
2450innermost, this makes your program stop as soon as control
2451returns to that frame. This is similar to the effect of a
2452@code{finish} command in the frame inside the selected frame---except
2453that @code{finish} does not leave an active breakpoint. If you use
2454@code{break} without an argument in the innermost frame, @value{GDBN} stops
2455the next time it reaches the current location; this may be useful
2456inside loops.
2457
2458@value{GDBN} normally ignores breakpoints when it resumes execution, until at
2459least one instruction has been executed. If it did not do this, you
2460would be unable to proceed past a breakpoint without first disabling the
2461breakpoint. This rule applies whether or not the breakpoint already
2462existed when your program stopped.
2463
2464@item break @dots{} if @var{cond}
2465Set a breakpoint with condition @var{cond}; evaluate the expression
2466@var{cond} each time the breakpoint is reached, and stop only if the
2467value is nonzero---that is, if @var{cond} evaluates as true.
2468@samp{@dots{}} stands for one of the possible arguments described
2469above (or no argument) specifying where to break. @xref{Conditions,
2470,Break conditions}, for more information on breakpoint conditions.
2471
2472@kindex tbreak
2473@item tbreak @var{args}
2474Set a breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args} are the
2475same as for the @code{break} command, and the breakpoint is set in the same
2476way, but the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the first time your
2477program stops there. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
2478
c906108c
SS
2479@kindex hbreak
2480@item hbreak @var{args}
d4f3574e
SS
2481Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint. @var{args} are the same as for the
2482@code{break} command and the breakpoint is set in the same way, but the
c906108c
SS
2483breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware may not
2484have this support. The main purpose of this is EPROM/ROM code
d4f3574e
SS
2485debugging, so you can set a breakpoint at an instruction without
2486changing the instruction. This can be used with the new trap-generation
2487provided by SPARClite DSU and some x86-based targets. These targets
2488will generate traps when a program accesses some data or instruction
2489address that is assigned to the debug registers. However the hardware
2490breakpoint registers can take a limited number of breakpoints. For
2491example, on the DSU, only two data breakpoints can be set at a time, and
2492@value{GDBN} will reject this command if more than two are used. Delete
2493or disable unused hardware breakpoints before setting new ones
2494(@pxref{Disabling, ,Disabling}). @xref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2495
2496@kindex thbreak
2497@item thbreak @var{args}
2498Set a hardware-assisted breakpoint enabled only for one stop. @var{args}
2499are the same as for the @code{hbreak} command and the breakpoint is set in
5d161b24 2500the same way. However, like the @code{tbreak} command,
c906108c
SS
2501the breakpoint is automatically deleted after the
2502first time your program stops there. Also, like the @code{hbreak}
5d161b24
DB
2503command, the breakpoint requires hardware support and some target hardware
2504may not have this support. @xref{Disabling, ,Disabling breakpoints}.
d4f3574e 2505See also @ref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}.
c906108c
SS
2506
2507@kindex rbreak
2508@cindex regular expression
2509@item rbreak @var{regex}
c906108c 2510Set breakpoints on all functions matching the regular expression
11cf8741
JM
2511@var{regex}. This command sets an unconditional breakpoint on all
2512matches, printing a list of all breakpoints it set. Once these
2513breakpoints are set, they are treated just like the breakpoints set with
2514the @code{break} command. You can delete them, disable them, or make
2515them conditional the same way as any other breakpoint.
2516
2517The syntax of the regular expression is the standard one used with tools
2518like @file{grep}. Note that this is different from the syntax used by
2519shells, so for instance @code{foo*} matches all functions that include
2520an @code{fo} followed by zero or more @code{o}s. There is an implicit
2521@code{.*} leading and trailing the regular expression you supply, so to
2522match only functions that begin with @code{foo}, use @code{^foo}.
c906108c 2523
b37052ae 2524When debugging C@t{++} programs, @code{rbreak} is useful for setting
c906108c
SS
2525breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
2526classes.
c906108c
SS
2527
2528@kindex info breakpoints
2529@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info breakpoints}
2530@item info breakpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2531@itemx info break @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2532@itemx info watchpoints @r{[}@var{n}@r{]}
2533Print a table of all breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints set and
2534not deleted, with the following columns for each breakpoint:
2535
2536@table @emph
2537@item Breakpoint Numbers
2538@item Type
2539Breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint.
2540@item Disposition
2541Whether the breakpoint is marked to be disabled or deleted when hit.
2542@item Enabled or Disabled
2543Enabled breakpoints are marked with @samp{y}. @samp{n} marks breakpoints
2544that are not enabled.
2545@item Address
2df3850c 2546Where the breakpoint is in your program, as a memory address.
c906108c
SS
2547@item What
2548Where the breakpoint is in the source for your program, as a file and
2549line number.
2550@end table
2551
2552@noindent
2553If a breakpoint is conditional, @code{info break} shows the condition on
2554the line following the affected breakpoint; breakpoint commands, if any,
2555are listed after that.
2556
2557@noindent
2558@code{info break} with a breakpoint
2559number @var{n} as argument lists only that breakpoint. The
2560convenience variable @code{$_} and the default examining-address for
2561the @code{x} command are set to the address of the last breakpoint
5d161b24 2562listed (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}).
c906108c
SS
2563
2564@noindent
2565@code{info break} displays a count of the number of times the breakpoint
2566has been hit. This is especially useful in conjunction with the
2567@code{ignore} command. You can ignore a large number of breakpoint
2568hits, look at the breakpoint info to see how many times the breakpoint
2569was hit, and then run again, ignoring one less than that number. This
2570will get you quickly to the last hit of that breakpoint.
2571@end table
2572
2573@value{GDBN} allows you to set any number of breakpoints at the same place in
2574your program. There is nothing silly or meaningless about this. When
2575the breakpoints are conditional, this is even useful
2576(@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
2577
2578@cindex negative breakpoint numbers
2579@cindex internal @value{GDBN} breakpoints
eb12ee30
AC
2580@value{GDBN} itself sometimes sets breakpoints in your program for
2581special purposes, such as proper handling of @code{longjmp} (in C
2582programs). These internal breakpoints are assigned negative numbers,
2583starting with @code{-1}; @samp{info breakpoints} does not display them.
c906108c 2584You can see these breakpoints with the @value{GDBN} maintenance command
eb12ee30 2585@samp{maint info breakpoints} (@pxref{maint info breakpoints}).
c906108c
SS
2586
2587
6d2ebf8b 2588@node Set Watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2589@subsection Setting watchpoints
2590
2591@cindex setting watchpoints
2592@cindex software watchpoints
2593@cindex hardware watchpoints
2594You can use a watchpoint to stop execution whenever the value of an
2595expression changes, without having to predict a particular place where
2596this may happen.
2597
2598Depending on your system, watchpoints may be implemented in software or
2df3850c 2599hardware. @value{GDBN} does software watchpointing by single-stepping your
c906108c
SS
2600program and testing the variable's value each time, which is hundreds of
2601times slower than normal execution. (But this may still be worth it, to
2602catch errors where you have no clue what part of your program is the
2603culprit.)
2604
d4f3574e 2605On some systems, such as HP-UX, Linux and some other x86-based targets,
2df3850c 2606@value{GDBN} includes support for
c906108c
SS
2607hardware watchpoints, which do not slow down the running of your
2608program.
2609
2610@table @code
2611@kindex watch
2612@item watch @var{expr}
2613Set a watchpoint for an expression. @value{GDBN} will break when @var{expr}
2614is written into by the program and its value changes.
2615
2616@kindex rwatch
2617@item rwatch @var{expr}
2618Set a watchpoint that will break when watch @var{expr} is read by the program.
c906108c
SS
2619
2620@kindex awatch
2621@item awatch @var{expr}
2df3850c 2622Set a watchpoint that will break when @var{expr} is either read or written into
7be570e7 2623by the program.
c906108c
SS
2624
2625@kindex info watchpoints
2626@item info watchpoints
2627This command prints a list of watchpoints, breakpoints, and catchpoints;
2628it is the same as @code{info break}.
2629@end table
2630
2631@value{GDBN} sets a @dfn{hardware watchpoint} if possible. Hardware
2632watchpoints execute very quickly, and the debugger reports a change in
2633value at the exact instruction where the change occurs. If @value{GDBN}
2634cannot set a hardware watchpoint, it sets a software watchpoint, which
2635executes more slowly and reports the change in value at the next
2636statement, not the instruction, after the change occurs.
2637
2638When you issue the @code{watch} command, @value{GDBN} reports
2639
2640@example
2641Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: @var{expr}
2642@end example
2643
2644@noindent
2645if it was able to set a hardware watchpoint.
2646
7be570e7
JM
2647Currently, the @code{awatch} and @code{rwatch} commands can only set
2648hardware watchpoints, because accesses to data that don't change the
2649value of the watched expression cannot be detected without examining
2650every instruction as it is being executed, and @value{GDBN} does not do
2651that currently. If @value{GDBN} finds that it is unable to set a
2652hardware breakpoint with the @code{awatch} or @code{rwatch} command, it
2653will print a message like this:
2654
2655@smallexample
2656Expression cannot be implemented with read/access watchpoint.
2657@end smallexample
2658
2659Sometimes, @value{GDBN} cannot set a hardware watchpoint because the
2660data type of the watched expression is wider than what a hardware
2661watchpoint on the target machine can handle. For example, some systems
2662can only watch regions that are up to 4 bytes wide; on such systems you
2663cannot set hardware watchpoints for an expression that yields a
2664double-precision floating-point number (which is typically 8 bytes
2665wide). As a work-around, it might be possible to break the large region
2666into a series of smaller ones and watch them with separate watchpoints.
2667
2668If you set too many hardware watchpoints, @value{GDBN} might be unable
2669to insert all of them when you resume the execution of your program.
2670Since the precise number of active watchpoints is unknown until such
2671time as the program is about to be resumed, @value{GDBN} might not be
2672able to warn you about this when you set the watchpoints, and the
2673warning will be printed only when the program is resumed:
2674
2675@smallexample
2676Hardware watchpoint @var{num}: Could not insert watchpoint
2677@end smallexample
2678
2679@noindent
2680If this happens, delete or disable some of the watchpoints.
2681
2682The SPARClite DSU will generate traps when a program accesses some data
2683or instruction address that is assigned to the debug registers. For the
2684data addresses, DSU facilitates the @code{watch} command. However the
2685hardware breakpoint registers can only take two data watchpoints, and
2686both watchpoints must be the same kind. For example, you can set two
2687watchpoints with @code{watch} commands, two with @code{rwatch} commands,
2688@strong{or} two with @code{awatch} commands, but you cannot set one
2689watchpoint with one command and the other with a different command.
c906108c
SS
2690@value{GDBN} will reject the command if you try to mix watchpoints.
2691Delete or disable unused watchpoint commands before setting new ones.
2692
2693If you call a function interactively using @code{print} or @code{call},
2df3850c 2694any watchpoints you have set will be inactive until @value{GDBN} reaches another
c906108c
SS
2695kind of breakpoint or the call completes.
2696
7be570e7
JM
2697@value{GDBN} automatically deletes watchpoints that watch local
2698(automatic) variables, or expressions that involve such variables, when
2699they go out of scope, that is, when the execution leaves the block in
2700which these variables were defined. In particular, when the program
2701being debugged terminates, @emph{all} local variables go out of scope,
2702and so only watchpoints that watch global variables remain set. If you
2703rerun the program, you will need to set all such watchpoints again. One
2704way of doing that would be to set a code breakpoint at the entry to the
2705@code{main} function and when it breaks, set all the watchpoints.
2706
c906108c
SS
2707@quotation
2708@cindex watchpoints and threads
2709@cindex threads and watchpoints
c906108c
SS
2710@emph{Warning:} In multi-thread programs, watchpoints have only limited
2711usefulness. With the current watchpoint implementation, @value{GDBN}
2712can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a single thread}. If
2713you are confident that the expression can only change due to the current
2714thread's activity (and if you are also confident that no other thread
2715can become current), then you can use watchpoints as usual. However,
2716@value{GDBN} may not notice when a non-current thread's activity changes
2717the expression.
53a5351d 2718
d4f3574e 2719@c FIXME: this is almost identical to the previous paragraph.
53a5351d
JM
2720@emph{HP-UX Warning:} In multi-thread programs, software watchpoints
2721have only limited usefulness. If @value{GDBN} creates a software
2722watchpoint, it can only watch the value of an expression @emph{in a
2723single thread}. If you are confident that the expression can only
2724change due to the current thread's activity (and if you are also
2725confident that no other thread can become current), then you can use
2726software watchpoints as usual. However, @value{GDBN} may not notice
2727when a non-current thread's activity changes the expression. (Hardware
2728watchpoints, in contrast, watch an expression in all threads.)
c906108c 2729@end quotation
c906108c 2730
6d2ebf8b 2731@node Set Catchpoints
c906108c 2732@subsection Setting catchpoints
d4f3574e 2733@cindex catchpoints, setting
c906108c
SS
2734@cindex exception handlers
2735@cindex event handling
2736
2737You can use @dfn{catchpoints} to cause the debugger to stop for certain
b37052ae 2738kinds of program events, such as C@t{++} exceptions or the loading of a
c906108c
SS
2739shared library. Use the @code{catch} command to set a catchpoint.
2740
2741@table @code
2742@kindex catch
2743@item catch @var{event}
2744Stop when @var{event} occurs. @var{event} can be any of the following:
2745@table @code
2746@item throw
2747@kindex catch throw
b37052ae 2748The throwing of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2749
2750@item catch
2751@kindex catch catch
b37052ae 2752The catching of a C@t{++} exception.
c906108c
SS
2753
2754@item exec
2755@kindex catch exec
2756A call to @code{exec}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2757
2758@item fork
2759@kindex catch fork
2760A call to @code{fork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2761
2762@item vfork
2763@kindex catch vfork
2764A call to @code{vfork}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2765
2766@item load
2767@itemx load @var{libname}
2768@kindex catch load
2769The dynamic loading of any shared library, or the loading of the library
2770@var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2771
2772@item unload
2773@itemx unload @var{libname}
2774@kindex catch unload
2775The unloading of any dynamically loaded shared library, or the unloading
2776of the library @var{libname}. This is currently only available for HP-UX.
2777@end table
2778
2779@item tcatch @var{event}
2780Set a catchpoint that is enabled only for one stop. The catchpoint is
2781automatically deleted after the first time the event is caught.
2782
2783@end table
2784
2785Use the @code{info break} command to list the current catchpoints.
2786
b37052ae 2787There are currently some limitations to C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
2788(@code{catch throw} and @code{catch catch}) in @value{GDBN}:
2789
2790@itemize @bullet
2791@item
2792If you call a function interactively, @value{GDBN} normally returns
2793control to you when the function has finished executing. If the call
2794raises an exception, however, the call may bypass the mechanism that
2795returns control to you and cause your program either to abort or to
2796simply continue running until it hits a breakpoint, catches a signal
2797that @value{GDBN} is listening for, or exits. This is the case even if
2798you set a catchpoint for the exception; catchpoints on exceptions are
2799disabled within interactive calls.
2800
2801@item
2802You cannot raise an exception interactively.
2803
2804@item
2805You cannot install an exception handler interactively.
2806@end itemize
2807
2808@cindex raise exceptions
2809Sometimes @code{catch} is not the best way to debug exception handling:
2810if you need to know exactly where an exception is raised, it is better to
2811stop @emph{before} the exception handler is called, since that way you
2812can see the stack before any unwinding takes place. If you set a
2813breakpoint in an exception handler instead, it may not be easy to find
2814out where the exception was raised.
2815
2816To stop just before an exception handler is called, you need some
b37052ae 2817knowledge of the implementation. In the case of @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, exceptions are
c906108c
SS
2818raised by calling a library function named @code{__raise_exception}
2819which has the following ANSI C interface:
2820
2821@example
2822 /* @var{addr} is where the exception identifier is stored.
d4f3574e
SS
2823 @var{id} is the exception identifier. */
2824 void __raise_exception (void **addr, void *id);
c906108c
SS
2825@end example
2826
2827@noindent
2828To make the debugger catch all exceptions before any stack
2829unwinding takes place, set a breakpoint on @code{__raise_exception}
2830(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and exceptions}).
2831
2832With a conditional breakpoint (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions})
2833that depends on the value of @var{id}, you can stop your program when
2834a specific exception is raised. You can use multiple conditional
2835breakpoints to stop your program when any of a number of exceptions are
2836raised.
2837
2838
6d2ebf8b 2839@node Delete Breaks
c906108c
SS
2840@subsection Deleting breakpoints
2841
2842@cindex clearing breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2843@cindex deleting breakpoints, watchpoints, catchpoints
2844It is often necessary to eliminate a breakpoint, watchpoint, or
2845catchpoint once it has done its job and you no longer want your program
2846to stop there. This is called @dfn{deleting} the breakpoint. A
2847breakpoint that has been deleted no longer exists; it is forgotten.
2848
2849With the @code{clear} command you can delete breakpoints according to
2850where they are in your program. With the @code{delete} command you can
2851delete individual breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints by specifying
2852their breakpoint numbers.
2853
2854It is not necessary to delete a breakpoint to proceed past it. @value{GDBN}
2855automatically ignores breakpoints on the first instruction to be executed
2856when you continue execution without changing the execution address.
2857
2858@table @code
2859@kindex clear
2860@item clear
2861Delete any breakpoints at the next instruction to be executed in the
2862selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). When
2863the innermost frame is selected, this is a good way to delete a
2864breakpoint where your program just stopped.
2865
2866@item clear @var{function}
2867@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{function}
2868Delete any breakpoints set at entry to the function @var{function}.
2869
2870@item clear @var{linenum}
2871@itemx clear @var{filename}:@var{linenum}
2872Delete any breakpoints set at or within the code of the specified line.
2873
2874@cindex delete breakpoints
2875@kindex delete
41afff9a 2876@kindex d @r{(@code{delete})}
c5394b80
JM
2877@item delete @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
2878Delete the breakpoints, watchpoints, or catchpoints of the breakpoint
2879ranges specified as arguments. If no argument is specified, delete all
c906108c
SS
2880breakpoints (@value{GDBN} asks confirmation, unless you have @code{set
2881confirm off}). You can abbreviate this command as @code{d}.
2882@end table
2883
6d2ebf8b 2884@node Disabling
c906108c
SS
2885@subsection Disabling breakpoints
2886
2887@kindex disable breakpoints
2888@kindex enable breakpoints
2889Rather than deleting a breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint, you might
2890prefer to @dfn{disable} it. This makes the breakpoint inoperative as if
2891it had been deleted, but remembers the information on the breakpoint so
2892that you can @dfn{enable} it again later.
2893
2894You disable and enable breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints with
2895the @code{enable} and @code{disable} commands, optionally specifying one
2896or more breakpoint numbers as arguments. Use @code{info break} or
2897@code{info watch} to print a list of breakpoints, watchpoints, and
2898catchpoints if you do not know which numbers to use.
2899
2900A breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint can have any of four different
2901states of enablement:
2902
2903@itemize @bullet
2904@item
2905Enabled. The breakpoint stops your program. A breakpoint set
2906with the @code{break} command starts out in this state.
2907@item
2908Disabled. The breakpoint has no effect on your program.
2909@item
2910Enabled once. The breakpoint stops your program, but then becomes
d4f3574e 2911disabled.
c906108c
SS
2912@item
2913Enabled for deletion. The breakpoint stops your program, but
d4f3574e
SS
2914immediately after it does so it is deleted permanently. A breakpoint
2915set with the @code{tbreak} command starts out in this state.
c906108c
SS
2916@end itemize
2917
2918You can use the following commands to enable or disable breakpoints,
2919watchpoints, and catchpoints:
2920
2921@table @code
2922@kindex disable breakpoints
2923@kindex disable
41afff9a 2924@kindex dis @r{(@code{disable})}
c5394b80 2925@item disable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2926Disable the specified breakpoints---or all breakpoints, if none are
2927listed. A disabled breakpoint has no effect but is not forgotten. All
2928options such as ignore-counts, conditions and commands are remembered in
2929case the breakpoint is enabled again later. You may abbreviate
2930@code{disable} as @code{dis}.
2931
2932@kindex enable breakpoints
2933@kindex enable
c5394b80 2934@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} @r{[}@var{range}@dots{}@r{]}
c906108c
SS
2935Enable the specified breakpoints (or all defined breakpoints). They
2936become effective once again in stopping your program.
2937
c5394b80 2938@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} once @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2939Enable the specified breakpoints temporarily. @value{GDBN} disables any
2940of these breakpoints immediately after stopping your program.
2941
c5394b80 2942@item enable @r{[}breakpoints@r{]} delete @var{range}@dots{}
c906108c
SS
2943Enable the specified breakpoints to work once, then die. @value{GDBN}
2944deletes any of these breakpoints as soon as your program stops there.
2945@end table
2946
d4f3574e
SS
2947@c FIXME: I think the following ``Except for [...] @code{tbreak}'' is
2948@c confusing: tbreak is also initially enabled.
c906108c
SS
2949Except for a breakpoint set with @code{tbreak} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
2950,Setting breakpoints}), breakpoints that you set are initially enabled;
2951subsequently, they become disabled or enabled only when you use one of
2952the commands above. (The command @code{until} can set and delete a
2953breakpoint of its own, but it does not change the state of your other
2954breakpoints; see @ref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and
2955stepping}.)
2956
6d2ebf8b 2957@node Conditions
c906108c
SS
2958@subsection Break conditions
2959@cindex conditional breakpoints
2960@cindex breakpoint conditions
2961
2962@c FIXME what is scope of break condition expr? Context where wanted?
5d161b24 2963@c in particular for a watchpoint?
c906108c
SS
2964The simplest sort of breakpoint breaks every time your program reaches a
2965specified place. You can also specify a @dfn{condition} for a
2966breakpoint. A condition is just a Boolean expression in your
2967programming language (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). A breakpoint with
2968a condition evaluates the expression each time your program reaches it,
2969and your program stops only if the condition is @emph{true}.
2970
2971This is the converse of using assertions for program validation; in that
2972situation, you want to stop when the assertion is violated---that is,
2973when the condition is false. In C, if you want to test an assertion expressed
2974by the condition @var{assert}, you should set the condition
2975@samp{! @var{assert}} on the appropriate breakpoint.
2976
2977Conditions are also accepted for watchpoints; you may not need them,
2978since a watchpoint is inspecting the value of an expression anyhow---but
2979it might be simpler, say, to just set a watchpoint on a variable name,
2980and specify a condition that tests whether the new value is an interesting
2981one.
2982
2983Break conditions can have side effects, and may even call functions in
2984your program. This can be useful, for example, to activate functions
2985that log program progress, or to use your own print functions to
2986format special data structures. The effects are completely predictable
2987unless there is another enabled breakpoint at the same address. (In
2988that case, @value{GDBN} might see the other breakpoint first and stop your
2989program without checking the condition of this one.) Note that
d4f3574e
SS
2990breakpoint commands are usually more convenient and flexible than break
2991conditions for the
c906108c
SS
2992purpose of performing side effects when a breakpoint is reached
2993(@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint command lists}).
2994
2995Break conditions can be specified when a breakpoint is set, by using
2996@samp{if} in the arguments to the @code{break} command. @xref{Set
2997Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}. They can also be changed at any time
2998with the @code{condition} command.
53a5351d 2999
c906108c
SS
3000You can also use the @code{if} keyword with the @code{watch} command.
3001The @code{catch} command does not recognize the @code{if} keyword;
3002@code{condition} is the only way to impose a further condition on a
3003catchpoint.
c906108c
SS
3004
3005@table @code
3006@kindex condition
3007@item condition @var{bnum} @var{expression}
3008Specify @var{expression} as the break condition for breakpoint,
3009watchpoint, or catchpoint number @var{bnum}. After you set a condition,
3010breakpoint @var{bnum} stops your program only if the value of
3011@var{expression} is true (nonzero, in C). When you use
3012@code{condition}, @value{GDBN} checks @var{expression} immediately for
3013syntactic correctness, and to determine whether symbols in it have
d4f3574e
SS
3014referents in the context of your breakpoint. If @var{expression} uses
3015symbols not referenced in the context of the breakpoint, @value{GDBN}
3016prints an error message:
3017
3018@example
3019No symbol "foo" in current context.
3020@end example
3021
3022@noindent
c906108c
SS
3023@value{GDBN} does
3024not actually evaluate @var{expression} at the time the @code{condition}
d4f3574e
SS
3025command (or a command that sets a breakpoint with a condition, like
3026@code{break if @dots{}}) is given, however. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
c906108c
SS
3027
3028@item condition @var{bnum}
3029Remove the condition from breakpoint number @var{bnum}. It becomes
3030an ordinary unconditional breakpoint.
3031@end table
3032
3033@cindex ignore count (of breakpoint)
3034A special case of a breakpoint condition is to stop only when the
3035breakpoint has been reached a certain number of times. This is so
3036useful that there is a special way to do it, using the @dfn{ignore
3037count} of the breakpoint. Every breakpoint has an ignore count, which
3038is an integer. Most of the time, the ignore count is zero, and
3039therefore has no effect. But if your program reaches a breakpoint whose
3040ignore count is positive, then instead of stopping, it just decrements
3041the ignore count by one and continues. As a result, if the ignore count
3042value is @var{n}, the breakpoint does not stop the next @var{n} times
3043your program reaches it.
3044
3045@table @code
3046@kindex ignore
3047@item ignore @var{bnum} @var{count}
3048Set the ignore count of breakpoint number @var{bnum} to @var{count}.
3049The next @var{count} times the breakpoint is reached, your program's
3050execution does not stop; other than to decrement the ignore count, @value{GDBN}
3051takes no action.
3052
3053To make the breakpoint stop the next time it is reached, specify
3054a count of zero.
3055
3056When you use @code{continue} to resume execution of your program from a
3057breakpoint, you can specify an ignore count directly as an argument to
3058@code{continue}, rather than using @code{ignore}. @xref{Continuing and
3059Stepping,,Continuing and stepping}.
3060
3061If a breakpoint has a positive ignore count and a condition, the
3062condition is not checked. Once the ignore count reaches zero,
3063@value{GDBN} resumes checking the condition.
3064
3065You could achieve the effect of the ignore count with a condition such
3066as @w{@samp{$foo-- <= 0}} using a debugger convenience variable that
3067is decremented each time. @xref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
3068variables}.
3069@end table
3070
3071Ignore counts apply to breakpoints, watchpoints, and catchpoints.
3072
3073
6d2ebf8b 3074@node Break Commands
c906108c
SS
3075@subsection Breakpoint command lists
3076
3077@cindex breakpoint commands
3078You can give any breakpoint (or watchpoint or catchpoint) a series of
3079commands to execute when your program stops due to that breakpoint. For
3080example, you might want to print the values of certain expressions, or
3081enable other breakpoints.
3082
3083@table @code
3084@kindex commands
3085@kindex end
3086@item commands @r{[}@var{bnum}@r{]}
3087@itemx @dots{} @var{command-list} @dots{}
3088@itemx end
3089Specify a list of commands for breakpoint number @var{bnum}. The commands
3090themselves appear on the following lines. Type a line containing just
3091@code{end} to terminate the commands.
3092
3093To remove all commands from a breakpoint, type @code{commands} and
3094follow it immediately with @code{end}; that is, give no commands.
3095
3096With no @var{bnum} argument, @code{commands} refers to the last
3097breakpoint, watchpoint, or catchpoint set (not to the breakpoint most
3098recently encountered).
3099@end table
3100
3101Pressing @key{RET} as a means of repeating the last @value{GDBN} command is
3102disabled within a @var{command-list}.
3103
3104You can use breakpoint commands to start your program up again. Simply
3105use the @code{continue} command, or @code{step}, or any other command
3106that resumes execution.
3107
3108Any other commands in the command list, after a command that resumes
3109execution, are ignored. This is because any time you resume execution
3110(even with a simple @code{next} or @code{step}), you may encounter
3111another breakpoint---which could have its own command list, leading to
3112ambiguities about which list to execute.
3113
3114@kindex silent
3115If the first command you specify in a command list is @code{silent}, the
3116usual message about stopping at a breakpoint is not printed. This may
3117be desirable for breakpoints that are to print a specific message and
3118then continue. If none of the remaining commands print anything, you
3119see no sign that the breakpoint was reached. @code{silent} is
3120meaningful only at the beginning of a breakpoint command list.
3121
3122The commands @code{echo}, @code{output}, and @code{printf} allow you to
3123print precisely controlled output, and are often useful in silent
3124breakpoints. @xref{Output, ,Commands for controlled output}.
3125
3126For example, here is how you could use breakpoint commands to print the
3127value of @code{x} at entry to @code{foo} whenever @code{x} is positive.
3128
3129@example
3130break foo if x>0
3131commands
3132silent
3133printf "x is %d\n",x
3134cont
3135end
3136@end example
3137
3138One application for breakpoint commands is to compensate for one bug so
3139you can test for another. Put a breakpoint just after the erroneous line
3140of code, give it a condition to detect the case in which something
3141erroneous has been done, and give it commands to assign correct values
3142to any variables that need them. End with the @code{continue} command
3143so that your program does not stop, and start with the @code{silent}
3144command so that no output is produced. Here is an example:
3145
3146@example
3147break 403
3148commands
3149silent
3150set x = y + 4
3151cont
3152end
3153@end example
3154
6d2ebf8b 3155@node Breakpoint Menus
c906108c
SS
3156@subsection Breakpoint menus
3157@cindex overloading
3158@cindex symbol overloading
3159
b37052ae 3160Some programming languages (notably C@t{++}) permit a single function name
c906108c
SS
3161to be defined several times, for application in different contexts.
3162This is called @dfn{overloading}. When a function name is overloaded,
3163@samp{break @var{function}} is not enough to tell @value{GDBN} where you want
3164a breakpoint. If you realize this is a problem, you can use
3165something like @samp{break @var{function}(@var{types})} to specify which
3166particular version of the function you want. Otherwise, @value{GDBN} offers
3167you a menu of numbered choices for different possible breakpoints, and
3168waits for your selection with the prompt @samp{>}. The first two
3169options are always @samp{[0] cancel} and @samp{[1] all}. Typing @kbd{1}
3170sets a breakpoint at each definition of @var{function}, and typing
3171@kbd{0} aborts the @code{break} command without setting any new
3172breakpoints.
3173
3174For example, the following session excerpt shows an attempt to set a
3175breakpoint at the overloaded symbol @code{String::after}.
3176We choose three particular definitions of that function name:
3177
3178@c FIXME! This is likely to change to show arg type lists, at least
3179@smallexample
3180@group
3181(@value{GDBP}) b String::after
3182[0] cancel
3183[1] all
3184[2] file:String.cc; line number:867
3185[3] file:String.cc; line number:860
3186[4] file:String.cc; line number:875
3187[5] file:String.cc; line number:853
3188[6] file:String.cc; line number:846
3189[7] file:String.cc; line number:735
3190> 2 4 6
3191Breakpoint 1 at 0xb26c: file String.cc, line 867.
3192Breakpoint 2 at 0xb344: file String.cc, line 875.
3193Breakpoint 3 at 0xafcc: file String.cc, line 846.
3194Multiple breakpoints were set.
3195Use the "delete" command to delete unwanted
3196 breakpoints.
3197(@value{GDBP})
3198@end group
3199@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
3200
3201@c @ifclear BARETARGET
6d2ebf8b 3202@node Error in Breakpoints
d4f3574e 3203@subsection ``Cannot insert breakpoints''
c906108c
SS
3204@c
3205@c FIXME!! 14/6/95 Is there a real example of this? Let's use it.
3206@c
d4f3574e
SS
3207Under some operating systems, breakpoints cannot be used in a program if
3208any other process is running that program. In this situation,
5d161b24 3209attempting to run or continue a program with a breakpoint causes
d4f3574e
SS
3210@value{GDBN} to print an error message:
3211
3212@example
3213Cannot insert breakpoints.
3214The same program may be running in another process.
3215@end example
3216
3217When this happens, you have three ways to proceed:
3218
3219@enumerate
3220@item
3221Remove or disable the breakpoints, then continue.
3222
3223@item
5d161b24 3224Suspend @value{GDBN}, and copy the file containing your program to a new
d4f3574e 3225name. Resume @value{GDBN} and use the @code{exec-file} command to specify
5d161b24 3226that @value{GDBN} should run your program under that name.
d4f3574e
SS
3227Then start your program again.
3228
3229@item
3230Relink your program so that the text segment is nonsharable, using the
3231linker option @samp{-N}. The operating system limitation may not apply
3232to nonsharable executables.
3233@end enumerate
c906108c
SS
3234@c @end ifclear
3235
d4f3574e
SS
3236A similar message can be printed if you request too many active
3237hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints:
3238
3239@c FIXME: the precise wording of this message may change; the relevant
3240@c source change is not committed yet (Sep 3, 1999).
3241@smallexample
3242Stopped; cannot insert breakpoints.
3243You may have requested too many hardware breakpoints and watchpoints.
3244@end smallexample
3245
3246@noindent
3247This message is printed when you attempt to resume the program, since
3248only then @value{GDBN} knows exactly how many hardware breakpoints and
3249watchpoints it needs to insert.
3250
3251When this message is printed, you need to disable or remove some of the
3252hardware-assisted breakpoints and watchpoints, and then continue.
3253
3254
6d2ebf8b 3255@node Continuing and Stepping
c906108c
SS
3256@section Continuing and stepping
3257
3258@cindex stepping
3259@cindex continuing
3260@cindex resuming execution
3261@dfn{Continuing} means resuming program execution until your program
3262completes normally. In contrast, @dfn{stepping} means executing just
3263one more ``step'' of your program, where ``step'' may mean either one
3264line of source code, or one machine instruction (depending on what
7a292a7a
SS
3265particular command you use). Either when continuing or when stepping,
3266your program may stop even sooner, due to a breakpoint or a signal. (If
d4f3574e
SS
3267it stops due to a signal, you may want to use @code{handle}, or use
3268@samp{signal 0} to resume execution. @xref{Signals, ,Signals}.)
c906108c
SS
3269
3270@table @code
3271@kindex continue
41afff9a
EZ
3272@kindex c @r{(@code{continue})}
3273@kindex fg @r{(resume foreground execution)}
c906108c
SS
3274@item continue @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3275@itemx c @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3276@itemx fg @r{[}@var{ignore-count}@r{]}
3277Resume program execution, at the address where your program last stopped;
3278any breakpoints set at that address are bypassed. The optional argument
3279@var{ignore-count} allows you to specify a further number of times to
3280ignore a breakpoint at this location; its effect is like that of
3281@code{ignore} (@pxref{Conditions, ,Break conditions}).
3282
3283The argument @var{ignore-count} is meaningful only when your program
3284stopped due to a breakpoint. At other times, the argument to
3285@code{continue} is ignored.
3286
d4f3574e
SS
3287The synonyms @code{c} and @code{fg} (for @dfn{foreground}, as the
3288debugged program is deemed to be the foreground program) are provided
3289purely for convenience, and have exactly the same behavior as
3290@code{continue}.
c906108c
SS
3291@end table
3292
3293To resume execution at a different place, you can use @code{return}
3294(@pxref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}) to go back to the
3295calling function; or @code{jump} (@pxref{Jumping, ,Continuing at a
3296different address}) to go to an arbitrary location in your program.
3297
3298A typical technique for using stepping is to set a breakpoint
3299(@pxref{Breakpoints, ,Breakpoints; watchpoints; and catchpoints}) at the
3300beginning of the function or the section of your program where a problem
3301is believed to lie, run your program until it stops at that breakpoint,
3302and then step through the suspect area, examining the variables that are
3303interesting, until you see the problem happen.
3304
3305@table @code
3306@kindex step
41afff9a 3307@kindex s @r{(@code{step})}
c906108c
SS
3308@item step
3309Continue running your program until control reaches a different source
3310line, then stop it and return control to @value{GDBN}. This command is
3311abbreviated @code{s}.
3312
3313@quotation
3314@c "without debugging information" is imprecise; actually "without line
3315@c numbers in the debugging information". (gcc -g1 has debugging info but
3316@c not line numbers). But it seems complex to try to make that
3317@c distinction here.
3318@emph{Warning:} If you use the @code{step} command while control is
3319within a function that was compiled without debugging information,
3320execution proceeds until control reaches a function that does have
3321debugging information. Likewise, it will not step into a function which
3322is compiled without debugging information. To step through functions
3323without debugging information, use the @code{stepi} command, described
3324below.
3325@end quotation
3326
4a92d011
EZ
3327The @code{step} command only stops at the first instruction of a source
3328line. This prevents the multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
3329@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc. @code{step} continues
3330to stop if a function that has debugging information is called within
3331the line. In other words, @code{step} @emph{steps inside} any functions
3332called within the line.
c906108c 3333
d4f3574e
SS
3334Also, the @code{step} command only enters a function if there is line
3335number information for the function. Otherwise it acts like the
5d161b24 3336@code{next} command. This avoids problems when using @code{cc -gl}
c906108c 3337on MIPS machines. Previously, @code{step} entered subroutines if there
5d161b24 3338was any debugging information about the routine.
c906108c
SS
3339
3340@item step @var{count}
3341Continue running as in @code{step}, but do so @var{count} times. If a
7a292a7a
SS
3342breakpoint is reached, or a signal not related to stepping occurs before
3343@var{count} steps, stepping stops right away.
c906108c
SS
3344
3345@kindex next
41afff9a 3346@kindex n @r{(@code{next})}
c906108c
SS
3347@item next @r{[}@var{count}@r{]}
3348Continue to the next source line in the current (innermost) stack frame.
7a292a7a
SS
3349This is similar to @code{step}, but function calls that appear within
3350the line of code are executed without stopping. Execution stops when
3351control reaches a different line of code at the original stack level
3352that was executing when you gave the @code{next} command. This command
3353is abbreviated @code{n}.
c906108c
SS
3354
3355An argument @var{count} is a repeat count, as for @code{step}.
3356
3357
3358@c FIX ME!! Do we delete this, or is there a way it fits in with
3359@c the following paragraph? --- Vctoria
3360@c
3361@c @code{next} within a function that lacks debugging information acts like
3362@c @code{step}, but any function calls appearing within the code of the
3363@c function are executed without stopping.
3364
d4f3574e
SS
3365The @code{next} command only stops at the first instruction of a
3366source line. This prevents multiple stops that could otherwise occur in
4a92d011 3367@code{switch} statements, @code{for} loops, etc.
c906108c 3368
b90a5f51
CF
3369@kindex set step-mode
3370@item set step-mode
3371@cindex functions without line info, and stepping
3372@cindex stepping into functions with no line info
3373@itemx set step-mode on
4a92d011 3374The @code{set step-mode on} command causes the @code{step} command to
b90a5f51
CF
3375stop at the first instruction of a function which contains no debug line
3376information rather than stepping over it.
3377
4a92d011
EZ
3378This is useful in cases where you may be interested in inspecting the
3379machine instructions of a function which has no symbolic info and do not
3380want @value{GDBN} to automatically skip over this function.
b90a5f51
CF
3381
3382@item set step-mode off
4a92d011 3383Causes the @code{step} command to step over any functions which contains no
b90a5f51
CF
3384debug information. This is the default.
3385
c906108c
SS
3386@kindex finish
3387@item finish
3388Continue running until just after function in the selected stack frame
3389returns. Print the returned value (if any).
3390
3391Contrast this with the @code{return} command (@pxref{Returning,
3392,Returning from a function}).
3393
3394@kindex until
41afff9a 3395@kindex u @r{(@code{until})}
c906108c
SS
3396@item until
3397@itemx u
3398Continue running until a source line past the current line, in the
3399current stack frame, is reached. This command is used to avoid single
3400stepping through a loop more than once. It is like the @code{next}
3401command, except that when @code{until} encounters a jump, it
3402automatically continues execution until the program counter is greater
3403than the address of the jump.
3404
3405This means that when you reach the end of a loop after single stepping
3406though it, @code{until} makes your program continue execution until it
3407exits the loop. In contrast, a @code{next} command at the end of a loop
3408simply steps back to the beginning of the loop, which forces you to step
3409through the next iteration.
3410
3411@code{until} always stops your program if it attempts to exit the current
3412stack frame.
3413
3414@code{until} may produce somewhat counterintuitive results if the order
3415of machine code does not match the order of the source lines. For
3416example, in the following excerpt from a debugging session, the @code{f}
3417(@code{frame}) command shows that execution is stopped at line
3418@code{206}; yet when we use @code{until}, we get to line @code{195}:
3419
3420@example
3421(@value{GDBP}) f
3422#0 main (argc=4, argv=0xf7fffae8) at m4.c:206
3423206 expand_input();
3424(@value{GDBP}) until
3425195 for ( ; argc > 0; NEXTARG) @{
3426@end example
3427
3428This happened because, for execution efficiency, the compiler had
3429generated code for the loop closure test at the end, rather than the
3430start, of the loop---even though the test in a C @code{for}-loop is
3431written before the body of the loop. The @code{until} command appeared
3432to step back to the beginning of the loop when it advanced to this
3433expression; however, it has not really gone to an earlier
3434statement---not in terms of the actual machine code.
3435
3436@code{until} with no argument works by means of single
3437instruction stepping, and hence is slower than @code{until} with an
3438argument.
3439
3440@item until @var{location}
3441@itemx u @var{location}
3442Continue running your program until either the specified location is
3443reached, or the current stack frame returns. @var{location} is any of
3444the forms of argument acceptable to @code{break} (@pxref{Set Breaks,
3445,Setting breakpoints}). This form of the command uses breakpoints,
3446and hence is quicker than @code{until} without an argument.
3447
3448@kindex stepi
41afff9a 3449@kindex si @r{(@code{stepi})}
c906108c 3450@item stepi
96a2c332 3451@itemx stepi @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3452@itemx si
3453Execute one machine instruction, then stop and return to the debugger.
3454
3455It is often useful to do @samp{display/i $pc} when stepping by machine
3456instructions. This makes @value{GDBN} automatically display the next
3457instruction to be executed, each time your program stops. @xref{Auto
3458Display,, Automatic display}.
3459
3460An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{step}.
3461
3462@need 750
3463@kindex nexti
41afff9a 3464@kindex ni @r{(@code{nexti})}
c906108c 3465@item nexti
96a2c332 3466@itemx nexti @var{arg}
c906108c
SS
3467@itemx ni
3468Execute one machine instruction, but if it is a function call,
3469proceed until the function returns.
3470
3471An argument is a repeat count, as in @code{next}.
3472@end table
3473
6d2ebf8b 3474@node Signals
c906108c
SS
3475@section Signals
3476@cindex signals
3477
3478A signal is an asynchronous event that can happen in a program. The
3479operating system defines the possible kinds of signals, and gives each
3480kind a name and a number. For example, in Unix @code{SIGINT} is the
d4f3574e 3481signal a program gets when you type an interrupt character (often @kbd{C-c});
c906108c
SS
3482@code{SIGSEGV} is the signal a program gets from referencing a place in
3483memory far away from all the areas in use; @code{SIGALRM} occurs when
3484the alarm clock timer goes off (which happens only if your program has
3485requested an alarm).
3486
3487@cindex fatal signals
3488Some signals, including @code{SIGALRM}, are a normal part of the
3489functioning of your program. Others, such as @code{SIGSEGV}, indicate
d4f3574e 3490errors; these signals are @dfn{fatal} (they kill your program immediately) if the
c906108c
SS
3491program has not specified in advance some other way to handle the signal.
3492@code{SIGINT} does not indicate an error in your program, but it is normally
3493fatal so it can carry out the purpose of the interrupt: to kill the program.
3494
3495@value{GDBN} has the ability to detect any occurrence of a signal in your
3496program. You can tell @value{GDBN} in advance what to do for each kind of
3497signal.
3498
3499@cindex handling signals
24f93129
EZ
3500Normally, @value{GDBN} is set up to let the non-erroneous signals like
3501@code{SIGALRM} be silently passed to your program
3502(so as not to interfere with their role in the program's functioning)
c906108c
SS
3503but to stop your program immediately whenever an error signal happens.
3504You can change these settings with the @code{handle} command.
3505
3506@table @code
3507@kindex info signals
3508@item info signals
96a2c332 3509@itemx info handle
c906108c
SS
3510Print a table of all the kinds of signals and how @value{GDBN} has been told to
3511handle each one. You can use this to see the signal numbers of all
3512the defined types of signals.
3513
d4f3574e 3514@code{info handle} is an alias for @code{info signals}.
c906108c
SS
3515
3516@kindex handle
3517@item handle @var{signal} @var{keywords}@dots{}
5ece1a18
EZ
3518Change the way @value{GDBN} handles signal @var{signal}. @var{signal}
3519can be the number of a signal or its name (with or without the
24f93129 3520@samp{SIG} at the beginning); a list of signal numbers of the form
5ece1a18
EZ
3521@samp{@var{low}-@var{high}}; or the word @samp{all}, meaning all the
3522known signals. The @var{keywords} say what change to make.
c906108c
SS
3523@end table
3524
3525@c @group
3526The keywords allowed by the @code{handle} command can be abbreviated.
3527Their full names are:
3528
3529@table @code
3530@item nostop
3531@value{GDBN} should not stop your program when this signal happens. It may
3532still print a message telling you that the signal has come in.
3533
3534@item stop
3535@value{GDBN} should stop your program when this signal happens. This implies
3536the @code{print} keyword as well.
3537
3538@item print
3539@value{GDBN} should print a message when this signal happens.
3540
3541@item noprint
3542@value{GDBN} should not mention the occurrence of the signal at all. This
3543implies the @code{nostop} keyword as well.
3544
3545@item pass
5ece1a18 3546@itemx noignore
c906108c
SS
3547@value{GDBN} should allow your program to see this signal; your program
3548can handle the signal, or else it may terminate if the signal is fatal
5ece1a18 3549and not handled. @code{pass} and @code{noignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3550
3551@item nopass
5ece1a18 3552@itemx ignore
c906108c 3553@value{GDBN} should not allow your program to see this signal.
5ece1a18 3554@code{nopass} and @code{ignore} are synonyms.
c906108c
SS
3555@end table
3556@c @end group
3557
d4f3574e
SS
3558When a signal stops your program, the signal is not visible to the
3559program until you
c906108c
SS
3560continue. Your program sees the signal then, if @code{pass} is in
3561effect for the signal in question @emph{at that time}. In other words,
3562after @value{GDBN} reports a signal, you can use the @code{handle}
3563command with @code{pass} or @code{nopass} to control whether your
3564program sees that signal when you continue.
3565
24f93129
EZ
3566The default is set to @code{nostop}, @code{noprint}, @code{pass} for
3567non-erroneous signals such as @code{SIGALRM}, @code{SIGWINCH} and
3568@code{SIGCHLD}, and to @code{stop}, @code{print}, @code{pass} for the
3569erroneous signals.
3570
c906108c
SS
3571You can also use the @code{signal} command to prevent your program from
3572seeing a signal, or cause it to see a signal it normally would not see,
3573or to give it any signal at any time. For example, if your program stopped
3574due to some sort of memory reference error, you might store correct
3575values into the erroneous variables and continue, hoping to see more
3576execution; but your program would probably terminate immediately as
3577a result of the fatal signal once it saw the signal. To prevent this,
3578you can continue with @samp{signal 0}. @xref{Signaling, ,Giving your
5d161b24 3579program a signal}.
c906108c 3580
6d2ebf8b 3581@node Thread Stops
c906108c
SS
3582@section Stopping and starting multi-thread programs
3583
3584When your program has multiple threads (@pxref{Threads,, Debugging
3585programs with multiple threads}), you can choose whether to set
3586breakpoints on all threads, or on a particular thread.
3587
3588@table @code
3589@cindex breakpoints and threads
3590@cindex thread breakpoints
3591@kindex break @dots{} thread @var{threadno}
3592@item break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno}
3593@itemx break @var{linespec} thread @var{threadno} if @dots{}
3594@var{linespec} specifies source lines; there are several ways of
3595writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
3596
3597Use the qualifier @samp{thread @var{threadno}} with a breakpoint command
3598to specify that you only want @value{GDBN} to stop the program when a
3599particular thread reaches this breakpoint. @var{threadno} is one of the
3600numeric thread identifiers assigned by @value{GDBN}, shown in the first
3601column of the @samp{info threads} display.
3602
3603If you do not specify @samp{thread @var{threadno}} when you set a
3604breakpoint, the breakpoint applies to @emph{all} threads of your
3605program.
3606
3607You can use the @code{thread} qualifier on conditional breakpoints as
3608well; in this case, place @samp{thread @var{threadno}} before the
3609breakpoint condition, like this:
3610
3611@smallexample
2df3850c 3612(@value{GDBP}) break frik.c:13 thread 28 if bartab > lim
c906108c
SS
3613@end smallexample
3614
3615@end table
3616
3617@cindex stopped threads
3618@cindex threads, stopped
3619Whenever your program stops under @value{GDBN} for any reason,
3620@emph{all} threads of execution stop, not just the current thread. This
3621allows you to examine the overall state of the program, including
3622switching between threads, without worrying that things may change
3623underfoot.
3624
3625@cindex continuing threads
3626@cindex threads, continuing
3627Conversely, whenever you restart the program, @emph{all} threads start
3628executing. @emph{This is true even when single-stepping} with commands
5d161b24 3629like @code{step} or @code{next}.
c906108c
SS
3630
3631In particular, @value{GDBN} cannot single-step all threads in lockstep.
3632Since thread scheduling is up to your debugging target's operating
3633system (not controlled by @value{GDBN}), other threads may
3634execute more than one statement while the current thread completes a
3635single step. Moreover, in general other threads stop in the middle of a
3636statement, rather than at a clean statement boundary, when the program
3637stops.
3638
3639You might even find your program stopped in another thread after
3640continuing or even single-stepping. This happens whenever some other
3641thread runs into a breakpoint, a signal, or an exception before the
3642first thread completes whatever you requested.
3643
3644On some OSes, you can lock the OS scheduler and thus allow only a single
3645thread to run.
3646
3647@table @code
3648@item set scheduler-locking @var{mode}
3649Set the scheduler locking mode. If it is @code{off}, then there is no
3650locking and any thread may run at any time. If @code{on}, then only the
3651current thread may run when the inferior is resumed. The @code{step}
3652mode optimizes for single-stepping. It stops other threads from
3653``seizing the prompt'' by preempting the current thread while you are
3654stepping. Other threads will only rarely (or never) get a chance to run
d4f3574e 3655when you step. They are more likely to run when you @samp{next} over a
c906108c 3656function call, and they are completely free to run when you use commands
d4f3574e 3657like @samp{continue}, @samp{until}, or @samp{finish}. However, unless another
c906108c 3658thread hits a breakpoint during its timeslice, they will never steal the
2df3850c 3659@value{GDBN} prompt away from the thread that you are debugging.
c906108c
SS
3660
3661@item show scheduler-locking
3662Display the current scheduler locking mode.
3663@end table
3664
c906108c 3665
6d2ebf8b 3666@node Stack
c906108c
SS
3667@chapter Examining the Stack
3668
3669When your program has stopped, the first thing you need to know is where it
3670stopped and how it got there.
3671
3672@cindex call stack
5d161b24
DB
3673Each time your program performs a function call, information about the call
3674is generated.
3675That information includes the location of the call in your program,
3676the arguments of the call,
c906108c 3677and the local variables of the function being called.
5d161b24 3678The information is saved in a block of data called a @dfn{stack frame}.
c906108c
SS
3679The stack frames are allocated in a region of memory called the @dfn{call
3680stack}.
3681
3682When your program stops, the @value{GDBN} commands for examining the
3683stack allow you to see all of this information.
3684
3685@cindex selected frame
3686One of the stack frames is @dfn{selected} by @value{GDBN} and many
3687@value{GDBN} commands refer implicitly to the selected frame. In
3688particular, whenever you ask @value{GDBN} for the value of a variable in
3689your program, the value is found in the selected frame. There are
3690special @value{GDBN} commands to select whichever frame you are
3691interested in. @xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3692
3693When your program stops, @value{GDBN} automatically selects the
5d161b24 3694currently executing frame and describes it briefly, similar to the
c906108c
SS
3695@code{frame} command (@pxref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}).
3696
3697@menu
3698* Frames:: Stack frames
3699* Backtrace:: Backtraces
3700* Selection:: Selecting a frame
3701* Frame Info:: Information on a frame
c906108c
SS
3702
3703@end menu
3704
6d2ebf8b 3705@node Frames
c906108c
SS
3706@section Stack frames
3707
d4f3574e 3708@cindex frame, definition
c906108c
SS
3709@cindex stack frame
3710The call stack is divided up into contiguous pieces called @dfn{stack
3711frames}, or @dfn{frames} for short; each frame is the data associated
3712with one call to one function. The frame contains the arguments given
3713to the function, the function's local variables, and the address at
3714which the function is executing.
3715
3716@cindex initial frame
3717@cindex outermost frame
3718@cindex innermost frame
3719When your program is started, the stack has only one frame, that of the
3720function @code{main}. This is called the @dfn{initial} frame or the
3721@dfn{outermost} frame. Each time a function is called, a new frame is
3722made. Each time a function returns, the frame for that function invocation
3723is eliminated. If a function is recursive, there can be many frames for
3724the same function. The frame for the function in which execution is
3725actually occurring is called the @dfn{innermost} frame. This is the most
3726recently created of all the stack frames that still exist.
3727
3728@cindex frame pointer
3729Inside your program, stack frames are identified by their addresses. A
3730stack frame consists of many bytes, each of which has its own address; each
3731kind of computer has a convention for choosing one byte whose
3732address serves as the address of the frame. Usually this address is kept
3733in a register called the @dfn{frame pointer register} while execution is
3734going on in that frame.
3735
3736@cindex frame number
3737@value{GDBN} assigns numbers to all existing stack frames, starting with
3738zero for the innermost frame, one for the frame that called it,
3739and so on upward. These numbers do not really exist in your program;
3740they are assigned by @value{GDBN} to give you a way of designating stack
3741frames in @value{GDBN} commands.
3742
6d2ebf8b
SS
3743@c The -fomit-frame-pointer below perennially causes hbox overflow
3744@c underflow problems.
c906108c
SS
3745@cindex frameless execution
3746Some compilers provide a way to compile functions so that they operate
6d2ebf8b
SS
3747without stack frames. (For example, the @value{GCC} option
3748@example
3749@samp{-fomit-frame-pointer}
3750@end example
3751generates functions without a frame.)
c906108c
SS
3752This is occasionally done with heavily used library functions to save
3753the frame setup time. @value{GDBN} has limited facilities for dealing
3754with these function invocations. If the innermost function invocation
3755has no stack frame, @value{GDBN} nevertheless regards it as though
3756it had a separate frame, which is numbered zero as usual, allowing
3757correct tracing of the function call chain. However, @value{GDBN} has
3758no provision for frameless functions elsewhere in the stack.
3759
3760@table @code
d4f3574e 3761@kindex frame@r{, command}
41afff9a 3762@cindex current stack frame
c906108c 3763@item frame @var{args}
5d161b24 3764The @code{frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame to another,
c906108c 3765and to print the stack frame you select. @var{args} may be either the
5d161b24
DB
3766address of the frame or the stack frame number. Without an argument,
3767@code{frame} prints the current stack frame.
c906108c
SS
3768
3769@kindex select-frame
41afff9a 3770@cindex selecting frame silently
c906108c
SS
3771@item select-frame
3772The @code{select-frame} command allows you to move from one stack frame
3773to another without printing the frame. This is the silent version of
3774@code{frame}.
3775@end table
3776
6d2ebf8b 3777@node Backtrace
c906108c
SS
3778@section Backtraces
3779
3780@cindex backtraces
3781@cindex tracebacks
3782@cindex stack traces
3783A backtrace is a summary of how your program got where it is. It shows one
3784line per frame, for many frames, starting with the currently executing
3785frame (frame zero), followed by its caller (frame one), and on up the
3786stack.
3787
3788@table @code
3789@kindex backtrace
41afff9a 3790@kindex bt @r{(@code{backtrace})}
c906108c
SS
3791@item backtrace
3792@itemx bt
3793Print a backtrace of the entire stack: one line per frame for all
3794frames in the stack.
3795
3796You can stop the backtrace at any time by typing the system interrupt
3797character, normally @kbd{C-c}.
3798
3799@item backtrace @var{n}
3800@itemx bt @var{n}
3801Similar, but print only the innermost @var{n} frames.
3802
3803@item backtrace -@var{n}
3804@itemx bt -@var{n}
3805Similar, but print only the outermost @var{n} frames.
3806@end table
3807
3808@kindex where
3809@kindex info stack
41afff9a 3810@kindex info s @r{(@code{info stack})}
c906108c
SS
3811The names @code{where} and @code{info stack} (abbreviated @code{info s})
3812are additional aliases for @code{backtrace}.
3813
3814Each line in the backtrace shows the frame number and the function name.
3815The program counter value is also shown---unless you use @code{set
3816print address off}. The backtrace also shows the source file name and
3817line number, as well as the arguments to the function. The program
3818counter value is omitted if it is at the beginning of the code for that
3819line number.
3820
3821Here is an example of a backtrace. It was made with the command
3822@samp{bt 3}, so it shows the innermost three frames.
3823
3824@smallexample
3825@group
5d161b24 3826#0 m4_traceon (obs=0x24eb0, argc=1, argv=0x2b8c8)
c906108c
SS
3827 at builtin.c:993
3828#1 0x6e38 in expand_macro (sym=0x2b600) at macro.c:242
3829#2 0x6840 in expand_token (obs=0x0, t=177664, td=0xf7fffb08)
3830 at macro.c:71
3831(More stack frames follow...)
3832@end group
3833@end smallexample
3834
3835@noindent
3836The display for frame zero does not begin with a program counter
3837value, indicating that your program has stopped at the beginning of the
3838code for line @code{993} of @code{builtin.c}.
3839
6d2ebf8b 3840@node Selection
c906108c
SS
3841@section Selecting a frame
3842
3843Most commands for examining the stack and other data in your program work on
3844whichever stack frame is selected at the moment. Here are the commands for
3845selecting a stack frame; all of them finish by printing a brief description
3846of the stack frame just selected.
3847
3848@table @code
d4f3574e 3849@kindex frame@r{, selecting}
41afff9a 3850@kindex f @r{(@code{frame})}
c906108c
SS
3851@item frame @var{n}
3852@itemx f @var{n}
3853Select frame number @var{n}. Recall that frame zero is the innermost
3854(currently executing) frame, frame one is the frame that called the
3855innermost one, and so on. The highest-numbered frame is the one for
3856@code{main}.
3857
3858@item frame @var{addr}
3859@itemx f @var{addr}
3860Select the frame at address @var{addr}. This is useful mainly if the
3861chaining of stack frames has been damaged by a bug, making it
3862impossible for @value{GDBN} to assign numbers properly to all frames. In
3863addition, this can be useful when your program has multiple stacks and
3864switches between them.
3865
c906108c
SS
3866On the SPARC architecture, @code{frame} needs two addresses to
3867select an arbitrary frame: a frame pointer and a stack pointer.
3868
3869On the MIPS and Alpha architecture, it needs two addresses: a stack
3870pointer and a program counter.
3871
3872On the 29k architecture, it needs three addresses: a register stack
3873pointer, a program counter, and a memory stack pointer.
3874@c note to future updaters: this is conditioned on a flag
3875@c SETUP_ARBITRARY_FRAME in the tm-*.h files. The above is up to date
3876@c as of 27 Jan 1994.
c906108c
SS
3877
3878@kindex up
3879@item up @var{n}
3880Move @var{n} frames up the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3881advances toward the outermost frame, to higher frame numbers, to frames
3882that have existed longer. @var{n} defaults to one.
3883
3884@kindex down
41afff9a 3885@kindex do @r{(@code{down})}
c906108c
SS
3886@item down @var{n}
3887Move @var{n} frames down the stack. For positive numbers @var{n}, this
3888advances toward the innermost frame, to lower frame numbers, to frames
3889that were created more recently. @var{n} defaults to one. You may
3890abbreviate @code{down} as @code{do}.
3891@end table
3892
3893All of these commands end by printing two lines of output describing the
3894frame. The first line shows the frame number, the function name, the
3895arguments, and the source file and line number of execution in that
5d161b24 3896frame. The second line shows the text of that source line.
c906108c
SS
3897
3898@need 1000
3899For example:
3900
3901@smallexample
3902@group
3903(@value{GDBP}) up
3904#1 0x22f0 in main (argc=1, argv=0xf7fffbf4, env=0xf7fffbfc)
3905 at env.c:10
390610 read_input_file (argv[i]);
3907@end group
3908@end smallexample
3909
3910After such a printout, the @code{list} command with no arguments
3911prints ten lines centered on the point of execution in the frame.
3912@xref{List, ,Printing source lines}.
3913
3914@table @code
3915@kindex down-silently
3916@kindex up-silently
3917@item up-silently @var{n}
3918@itemx down-silently @var{n}
3919These two commands are variants of @code{up} and @code{down},
3920respectively; they differ in that they do their work silently, without
3921causing display of the new frame. They are intended primarily for use
3922in @value{GDBN} command scripts, where the output might be unnecessary and
3923distracting.
3924@end table
3925
6d2ebf8b 3926@node Frame Info
c906108c
SS
3927@section Information about a frame
3928
3929There are several other commands to print information about the selected
3930stack frame.
3931
3932@table @code
3933@item frame
3934@itemx f
3935When used without any argument, this command does not change which
3936frame is selected, but prints a brief description of the currently
3937selected stack frame. It can be abbreviated @code{f}. With an
3938argument, this command is used to select a stack frame.
3939@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3940
3941@kindex info frame
41afff9a 3942@kindex info f @r{(@code{info frame})}
c906108c
SS
3943@item info frame
3944@itemx info f
3945This command prints a verbose description of the selected stack frame,
3946including:
3947
3948@itemize @bullet
5d161b24
DB
3949@item
3950the address of the frame
c906108c
SS
3951@item
3952the address of the next frame down (called by this frame)
3953@item
3954the address of the next frame up (caller of this frame)
3955@item
3956the language in which the source code corresponding to this frame is written
3957@item
3958the address of the frame's arguments
3959@item
d4f3574e
SS
3960the address of the frame's local variables
3961@item
c906108c
SS
3962the program counter saved in it (the address of execution in the caller frame)
3963@item
3964which registers were saved in the frame
3965@end itemize
3966
3967@noindent The verbose description is useful when
3968something has gone wrong that has made the stack format fail to fit
3969the usual conventions.
3970
3971@item info frame @var{addr}
3972@itemx info f @var{addr}
3973Print a verbose description of the frame at address @var{addr}, without
3974selecting that frame. The selected frame remains unchanged by this
3975command. This requires the same kind of address (more than one for some
3976architectures) that you specify in the @code{frame} command.
3977@xref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}.
3978
3979@kindex info args
3980@item info args
3981Print the arguments of the selected frame, each on a separate line.
3982
3983@item info locals
3984@kindex info locals
3985Print the local variables of the selected frame, each on a separate
3986line. These are all variables (declared either static or automatic)
3987accessible at the point of execution of the selected frame.
3988
c906108c 3989@kindex info catch
d4f3574e
SS
3990@cindex catch exceptions, list active handlers
3991@cindex exception handlers, how to list
c906108c
SS
3992@item info catch
3993Print a list of all the exception handlers that are active in the
3994current stack frame at the current point of execution. To see other
3995exception handlers, visit the associated frame (using the @code{up},
3996@code{down}, or @code{frame} commands); then type @code{info catch}.
3997@xref{Set Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
53a5351d 3998
c906108c
SS
3999@end table
4000
c906108c 4001
6d2ebf8b 4002@node Source
c906108c
SS
4003@chapter Examining Source Files
4004
4005@value{GDBN} can print parts of your program's source, since the debugging
4006information recorded in the program tells @value{GDBN} what source files were
4007used to build it. When your program stops, @value{GDBN} spontaneously prints
4008the line where it stopped. Likewise, when you select a stack frame
4009(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}), @value{GDBN} prints the line where
4010execution in that frame has stopped. You can print other portions of
4011source files by explicit command.
4012
7a292a7a 4013If you use @value{GDBN} through its @sc{gnu} Emacs interface, you may
d4f3574e 4014prefer to use Emacs facilities to view source; see @ref{Emacs, ,Using
7a292a7a 4015@value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs}.
c906108c
SS
4016
4017@menu
4018* List:: Printing source lines
c906108c 4019* Search:: Searching source files
c906108c
SS
4020* Source Path:: Specifying source directories
4021* Machine Code:: Source and machine code
4022@end menu
4023
6d2ebf8b 4024@node List
c906108c
SS
4025@section Printing source lines
4026
4027@kindex list
41afff9a 4028@kindex l @r{(@code{list})}
c906108c 4029To print lines from a source file, use the @code{list} command
5d161b24 4030(abbreviated @code{l}). By default, ten lines are printed.
c906108c
SS
4031There are several ways to specify what part of the file you want to print.
4032
4033Here are the forms of the @code{list} command most commonly used:
4034
4035@table @code
4036@item list @var{linenum}
4037Print lines centered around line number @var{linenum} in the
4038current source file.
4039
4040@item list @var{function}
4041Print lines centered around the beginning of function
4042@var{function}.
4043
4044@item list
4045Print more lines. If the last lines printed were printed with a
4046@code{list} command, this prints lines following the last lines
4047printed; however, if the last line printed was a solitary line printed
4048as part of displaying a stack frame (@pxref{Stack, ,Examining the
4049Stack}), this prints lines centered around that line.
4050
4051@item list -
4052Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4053@end table
4054
4055By default, @value{GDBN} prints ten source lines with any of these forms of
4056the @code{list} command. You can change this using @code{set listsize}:
4057
4058@table @code
4059@kindex set listsize
4060@item set listsize @var{count}
4061Make the @code{list} command display @var{count} source lines (unless
4062the @code{list} argument explicitly specifies some other number).
4063
4064@kindex show listsize
4065@item show listsize
4066Display the number of lines that @code{list} prints.
4067@end table
4068
4069Repeating a @code{list} command with @key{RET} discards the argument,
4070so it is equivalent to typing just @code{list}. This is more useful
4071than listing the same lines again. An exception is made for an
4072argument of @samp{-}; that argument is preserved in repetition so that
4073each repetition moves up in the source file.
4074
4075@cindex linespec
4076In general, the @code{list} command expects you to supply zero, one or two
4077@dfn{linespecs}. Linespecs specify source lines; there are several ways
d4f3574e 4078of writing them, but the effect is always to specify some source line.
c906108c
SS
4079Here is a complete description of the possible arguments for @code{list}:
4080
4081@table @code
4082@item list @var{linespec}
4083Print lines centered around the line specified by @var{linespec}.
4084
4085@item list @var{first},@var{last}
4086Print lines from @var{first} to @var{last}. Both arguments are
4087linespecs.
4088
4089@item list ,@var{last}
4090Print lines ending with @var{last}.
4091
4092@item list @var{first},
4093Print lines starting with @var{first}.
4094
4095@item list +
4096Print lines just after the lines last printed.
4097
4098@item list -
4099Print lines just before the lines last printed.
4100
4101@item list
4102As described in the preceding table.
4103@end table
4104
4105Here are the ways of specifying a single source line---all the
4106kinds of linespec.
4107
4108@table @code
4109@item @var{number}
4110Specifies line @var{number} of the current source file.
4111When a @code{list} command has two linespecs, this refers to
4112the same source file as the first linespec.
4113
4114@item +@var{offset}
4115Specifies the line @var{offset} lines after the last line printed.
4116When used as the second linespec in a @code{list} command that has
4117two, this specifies the line @var{offset} lines down from the
4118first linespec.
4119
4120@item -@var{offset}
4121Specifies the line @var{offset} lines before the last line printed.
4122
4123@item @var{filename}:@var{number}
4124Specifies line @var{number} in the source file @var{filename}.
4125
4126@item @var{function}
4127Specifies the line that begins the body of the function @var{function}.
4128For example: in C, this is the line with the open brace.
4129
4130@item @var{filename}:@var{function}
4131Specifies the line of the open-brace that begins the body of the
4132function @var{function} in the file @var{filename}. You only need the
4133file name with a function name to avoid ambiguity when there are
4134identically named functions in different source files.
4135
4136@item *@var{address}
4137Specifies the line containing the program address @var{address}.
4138@var{address} may be any expression.
4139@end table
4140
6d2ebf8b 4141@node Search
c906108c
SS
4142@section Searching source files
4143@cindex searching
4144@kindex reverse-search
4145
4146There are two commands for searching through the current source file for a
4147regular expression.
4148
4149@table @code
4150@kindex search
4151@kindex forward-search
4152@item forward-search @var{regexp}
4153@itemx search @var{regexp}
4154The command @samp{forward-search @var{regexp}} checks each line,
4155starting with the one following the last line listed, for a match for
5d161b24 4156@var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can use the
c906108c
SS
4157synonym @samp{search @var{regexp}} or abbreviate the command name as
4158@code{fo}.
4159
4160@item reverse-search @var{regexp}
4161The command @samp{reverse-search @var{regexp}} checks each line, starting
4162with the one before the last line listed and going backward, for a match
4163for @var{regexp}. It lists the line that is found. You can abbreviate
4164this command as @code{rev}.
4165@end table
c906108c 4166
6d2ebf8b 4167@node Source Path
c906108c
SS
4168@section Specifying source directories
4169
4170@cindex source path
4171@cindex directories for source files
4172Executable programs sometimes do not record the directories of the source
4173files from which they were compiled, just the names. Even when they do,
4174the directories could be moved between the compilation and your debugging
4175session. @value{GDBN} has a list of directories to search for source files;
4176this is called the @dfn{source path}. Each time @value{GDBN} wants a source file,
4177it tries all the directories in the list, in the order they are present
4178in the list, until it finds a file with the desired name. Note that
4179the executable search path is @emph{not} used for this purpose. Neither is
4180the current working directory, unless it happens to be in the source
4181path.
4182
4183If @value{GDBN} cannot find a source file in the source path, and the
4184object program records a directory, @value{GDBN} tries that directory
4185too. If the source path is empty, and there is no record of the
4186compilation directory, @value{GDBN} looks in the current directory as a
4187last resort.
4188
4189Whenever you reset or rearrange the source path, @value{GDBN} clears out
4190any information it has cached about where source files are found and where
4191each line is in the file.
4192
4193@kindex directory
4194@kindex dir
d4f3574e
SS
4195When you start @value{GDBN}, its source path includes only @samp{cdir}
4196and @samp{cwd}, in that order.
c906108c
SS
4197To add other directories, use the @code{directory} command.
4198
4199@table @code
4200@item directory @var{dirname} @dots{}
4201@item dir @var{dirname} @dots{}
4202Add directory @var{dirname} to the front of the source path. Several
d4f3574e
SS
4203directory names may be given to this command, separated by @samp{:}
4204(@samp{;} on MS-DOS and MS-Windows, where @samp{:} usually appears as
4205part of absolute file names) or
c906108c
SS
4206whitespace. You may specify a directory that is already in the source
4207path; this moves it forward, so @value{GDBN} searches it sooner.
4208
4209@kindex cdir
4210@kindex cwd
41afff9a
EZ
4211@vindex $cdir@r{, convenience variable}
4212@vindex $cwdr@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
4213@cindex compilation directory
4214@cindex current directory
4215@cindex working directory
4216@cindex directory, current
4217@cindex directory, compilation
4218You can use the string @samp{$cdir} to refer to the compilation
4219directory (if one is recorded), and @samp{$cwd} to refer to the current
4220working directory. @samp{$cwd} is not the same as @samp{.}---the former
4221tracks the current working directory as it changes during your @value{GDBN}
4222session, while the latter is immediately expanded to the current
4223directory at the time you add an entry to the source path.
4224
4225@item directory
4226Reset the source path to empty again. This requires confirmation.
4227
4228@c RET-repeat for @code{directory} is explicitly disabled, but since
4229@c repeating it would be a no-op we do not say that. (thanks to RMS)
4230
4231@item show directories
4232@kindex show directories
4233Print the source path: show which directories it contains.
4234@end table
4235
4236If your source path is cluttered with directories that are no longer of
4237interest, @value{GDBN} may sometimes cause confusion by finding the wrong
4238versions of source. You can correct the situation as follows:
4239
4240@enumerate
4241@item
4242Use @code{directory} with no argument to reset the source path to empty.
4243
4244@item
4245Use @code{directory} with suitable arguments to reinstall the
4246directories you want in the source path. You can add all the
4247directories in one command.
4248@end enumerate
4249
6d2ebf8b 4250@node Machine Code
c906108c
SS
4251@section Source and machine code
4252
4253You can use the command @code{info line} to map source lines to program
4254addresses (and vice versa), and the command @code{disassemble} to display
4255a range of addresses as machine instructions. When run under @sc{gnu} Emacs
d4f3574e 4256mode, the @code{info line} command causes the arrow to point to the
5d161b24 4257line specified. Also, @code{info line} prints addresses in symbolic form as
c906108c
SS
4258well as hex.
4259
4260@table @code
4261@kindex info line
4262@item info line @var{linespec}
4263Print the starting and ending addresses of the compiled code for
4264source line @var{linespec}. You can specify source lines in any of
4265the ways understood by the @code{list} command (@pxref{List, ,Printing
4266source lines}).
4267@end table
4268
4269For example, we can use @code{info line} to discover the location of
4270the object code for the first line of function
4271@code{m4_changequote}:
4272
d4f3574e
SS
4273@c FIXME: I think this example should also show the addresses in
4274@c symbolic form, as they usually would be displayed.
c906108c 4275@smallexample
96a2c332 4276(@value{GDBP}) info line m4_changequote
c906108c
SS
4277Line 895 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x634c and ends at 0x6350.
4278@end smallexample
4279
4280@noindent
4281We can also inquire (using @code{*@var{addr}} as the form for
4282@var{linespec}) what source line covers a particular address:
4283@smallexample
4284(@value{GDBP}) info line *0x63ff
4285Line 926 of "builtin.c" starts at pc 0x63e4 and ends at 0x6404.
4286@end smallexample
4287
4288@cindex @code{$_} and @code{info line}
41afff9a 4289@kindex x@r{(examine), and} info line
c906108c
SS
4290After @code{info line}, the default address for the @code{x} command
4291is changed to the starting address of the line, so that @samp{x/i} is
4292sufficient to begin examining the machine code (@pxref{Memory,
4293,Examining memory}). Also, this address is saved as the value of the
4294convenience variable @code{$_} (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4295variables}).
4296
4297@table @code
4298@kindex disassemble
4299@cindex assembly instructions
4300@cindex instructions, assembly
4301@cindex machine instructions
4302@cindex listing machine instructions
4303@item disassemble
4304This specialized command dumps a range of memory as machine
4305instructions. The default memory range is the function surrounding the
4306program counter of the selected frame. A single argument to this
4307command is a program counter value; @value{GDBN} dumps the function
4308surrounding this value. Two arguments specify a range of addresses
4309(first inclusive, second exclusive) to dump.
4310@end table
4311
c906108c
SS
4312The following example shows the disassembly of a range of addresses of
4313HP PA-RISC 2.0 code:
4314
4315@smallexample
4316(@value{GDBP}) disas 0x32c4 0x32e4
4317Dump of assembler code from 0x32c4 to 0x32e4:
43180x32c4 <main+204>: addil 0,dp
43190x32c8 <main+208>: ldw 0x22c(sr0,r1),r26
43200x32cc <main+212>: ldil 0x3000,r31
43210x32d0 <main+216>: ble 0x3f8(sr4,r31)
43220x32d4 <main+220>: ldo 0(r31),rp
43230x32d8 <main+224>: addil -0x800,dp
43240x32dc <main+228>: ldo 0x588(r1),r26
43250x32e0 <main+232>: ldil 0x3000,r31
4326End of assembler dump.
4327@end smallexample
c906108c
SS
4328
4329Some architectures have more than one commonly-used set of instruction
4330mnemonics or other syntax.
4331
4332@table @code
d4f3574e 4333@kindex set disassembly-flavor
c906108c
SS
4334@cindex assembly instructions
4335@cindex instructions, assembly
4336@cindex machine instructions
4337@cindex listing machine instructions
d4f3574e
SS
4338@cindex Intel disassembly flavor
4339@cindex AT&T disassembly flavor
4340@item set disassembly-flavor @var{instruction-set}
c906108c
SS
4341Select the instruction set to use when disassembling the
4342program via the @code{disassemble} or @code{x/i} commands.
4343
4344Currently this command is only defined for the Intel x86 family. You
d4f3574e
SS
4345can set @var{instruction-set} to either @code{intel} or @code{att}.
4346The default is @code{att}, the AT&T flavor used by default by Unix
4347assemblers for x86-based targets.
c906108c
SS
4348@end table
4349
4350
6d2ebf8b 4351@node Data
c906108c
SS
4352@chapter Examining Data
4353
4354@cindex printing data
4355@cindex examining data
4356@kindex print
4357@kindex inspect
4358@c "inspect" is not quite a synonym if you are using Epoch, which we do not
4359@c document because it is nonstandard... Under Epoch it displays in a
4360@c different window or something like that.
4361The usual way to examine data in your program is with the @code{print}
7a292a7a
SS
4362command (abbreviated @code{p}), or its synonym @code{inspect}. It
4363evaluates and prints the value of an expression of the language your
4364program is written in (@pxref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with
4365Different Languages}).
c906108c
SS
4366
4367@table @code
d4f3574e
SS
4368@item print @var{expr}
4369@itemx print /@var{f} @var{expr}
4370@var{expr} is an expression (in the source language). By default the
4371value of @var{expr} is printed in a format appropriate to its data type;
c906108c 4372you can choose a different format by specifying @samp{/@var{f}}, where
d4f3574e 4373@var{f} is a letter specifying the format; see @ref{Output Formats,,Output
c906108c
SS
4374formats}.
4375
4376@item print
4377@itemx print /@var{f}
d4f3574e 4378If you omit @var{expr}, @value{GDBN} displays the last value again (from the
c906108c
SS
4379@dfn{value history}; @pxref{Value History, ,Value history}). This allows you to
4380conveniently inspect the same value in an alternative format.
4381@end table
4382
4383A more low-level way of examining data is with the @code{x} command.
4384It examines data in memory at a specified address and prints it in a
4385specified format. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4386
7a292a7a 4387If you are interested in information about types, or about how the
d4f3574e
SS
4388fields of a struct or a class are declared, use the @code{ptype @var{exp}}
4389command rather than @code{print}. @xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol
7a292a7a 4390Table}.
c906108c
SS
4391
4392@menu
4393* Expressions:: Expressions
4394* Variables:: Program variables
4395* Arrays:: Artificial arrays
4396* Output Formats:: Output formats
4397* Memory:: Examining memory
4398* Auto Display:: Automatic display
4399* Print Settings:: Print settings
4400* Value History:: Value history
4401* Convenience Vars:: Convenience variables
4402* Registers:: Registers
c906108c 4403* Floating Point Hardware:: Floating point hardware
29e57380 4404* Memory Region Attributes:: Memory region attributes
c906108c
SS
4405@end menu
4406
6d2ebf8b 4407@node Expressions
c906108c
SS
4408@section Expressions
4409
4410@cindex expressions
4411@code{print} and many other @value{GDBN} commands accept an expression and
4412compute its value. Any kind of constant, variable or operator defined
4413by the programming language you are using is valid in an expression in
4414@value{GDBN}. This includes conditional expressions, function calls, casts
4415and string constants. It unfortunately does not include symbols defined
4416by preprocessor @code{#define} commands.
4417
d4f3574e
SS
4418@value{GDBN} supports array constants in expressions input by
4419the user. The syntax is @{@var{element}, @var{element}@dots{}@}. For example,
5d161b24 4420you can use the command @code{print @{1, 2, 3@}} to build up an array in
d4f3574e 4421memory that is @code{malloc}ed in the target program.
c906108c 4422
c906108c
SS
4423Because C is so widespread, most of the expressions shown in examples in
4424this manual are in C. @xref{Languages, , Using @value{GDBN} with Different
4425Languages}, for information on how to use expressions in other
4426languages.
4427
4428In this section, we discuss operators that you can use in @value{GDBN}
4429expressions regardless of your programming language.
4430
4431Casts are supported in all languages, not just in C, because it is so
4432useful to cast a number into a pointer in order to examine a structure
4433at that address in memory.
4434@c FIXME: casts supported---Mod2 true?
c906108c
SS
4435
4436@value{GDBN} supports these operators, in addition to those common
4437to programming languages:
4438
4439@table @code
4440@item @@
4441@samp{@@} is a binary operator for treating parts of memory as arrays.
4442@xref{Arrays, ,Artificial arrays}, for more information.
4443
4444@item ::
4445@samp{::} allows you to specify a variable in terms of the file or
4446function where it is defined. @xref{Variables, ,Program variables}.
4447
4448@cindex @{@var{type}@}
4449@cindex type casting memory
4450@cindex memory, viewing as typed object
4451@cindex casts, to view memory
4452@item @{@var{type}@} @var{addr}
4453Refers to an object of type @var{type} stored at address @var{addr} in
4454memory. @var{addr} may be any expression whose value is an integer or
4455pointer (but parentheses are required around binary operators, just as in
4456a cast). This construct is allowed regardless of what kind of data is
4457normally supposed to reside at @var{addr}.
4458@end table
4459
6d2ebf8b 4460@node Variables
c906108c
SS
4461@section Program variables
4462
4463The most common kind of expression to use is the name of a variable
4464in your program.
4465
4466Variables in expressions are understood in the selected stack frame
4467(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}); they must be either:
4468
4469@itemize @bullet
4470@item
4471global (or file-static)
4472@end itemize
4473
5d161b24 4474@noindent or
c906108c
SS
4475
4476@itemize @bullet
4477@item
4478visible according to the scope rules of the
4479programming language from the point of execution in that frame
5d161b24 4480@end itemize
c906108c
SS
4481
4482@noindent This means that in the function
4483
4484@example
4485foo (a)
4486 int a;
4487@{
4488 bar (a);
4489 @{
4490 int b = test ();
4491 bar (b);
4492 @}
4493@}
4494@end example
4495
4496@noindent
4497you can examine and use the variable @code{a} whenever your program is
4498executing within the function @code{foo}, but you can only use or
4499examine the variable @code{b} while your program is executing inside
4500the block where @code{b} is declared.
4501
4502@cindex variable name conflict
4503There is an exception: you can refer to a variable or function whose
4504scope is a single source file even if the current execution point is not
4505in this file. But it is possible to have more than one such variable or
4506function with the same name (in different source files). If that
4507happens, referring to that name has unpredictable effects. If you wish,
4508you can specify a static variable in a particular function or file,
4509using the colon-colon notation:
4510
d4f3574e 4511@cindex colon-colon, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4512@iftex
4513@c info cannot cope with a :: index entry, but why deprive hard copy readers?
41afff9a 4514@cindex @code{::}, context for variables/functions
c906108c
SS
4515@end iftex
4516@example
4517@var{file}::@var{variable}
4518@var{function}::@var{variable}
4519@end example
4520
4521@noindent
4522Here @var{file} or @var{function} is the name of the context for the
4523static @var{variable}. In the case of file names, you can use quotes to
4524make sure @value{GDBN} parses the file name as a single word---for example,
4525to print a global value of @code{x} defined in @file{f2.c}:
4526
4527@example
4528(@value{GDBP}) p 'f2.c'::x
4529@end example
4530
b37052ae 4531@cindex C@t{++} scope resolution
c906108c 4532This use of @samp{::} is very rarely in conflict with the very similar
b37052ae 4533use of the same notation in C@t{++}. @value{GDBN} also supports use of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
4534scope resolution operator in @value{GDBN} expressions.
4535@c FIXME: Um, so what happens in one of those rare cases where it's in
4536@c conflict?? --mew
c906108c
SS
4537
4538@cindex wrong values
4539@cindex variable values, wrong
4540@quotation
4541@emph{Warning:} Occasionally, a local variable may appear to have the
4542wrong value at certain points in a function---just after entry to a new
4543scope, and just before exit.
4544@end quotation
4545You may see this problem when you are stepping by machine instructions.
4546This is because, on most machines, it takes more than one instruction to
4547set up a stack frame (including local variable definitions); if you are
4548stepping by machine instructions, variables may appear to have the wrong
4549values until the stack frame is completely built. On exit, it usually
4550also takes more than one machine instruction to destroy a stack frame;
4551after you begin stepping through that group of instructions, local
4552variable definitions may be gone.
4553
4554This may also happen when the compiler does significant optimizations.
4555To be sure of always seeing accurate values, turn off all optimization
4556when compiling.
4557
d4f3574e
SS
4558@cindex ``No symbol "foo" in current context''
4559Another possible effect of compiler optimizations is to optimize
4560unused variables out of existence, or assign variables to registers (as
4561opposed to memory addresses). Depending on the support for such cases
4562offered by the debug info format used by the compiler, @value{GDBN}
4563might not be able to display values for such local variables. If that
4564happens, @value{GDBN} will print a message like this:
4565
4566@example
4567No symbol "foo" in current context.
4568@end example
4569
4570To solve such problems, either recompile without optimizations, or use a
4571different debug info format, if the compiler supports several such
b37052ae 4572formats. For example, @value{NGCC}, the @sc{gnu} C/C@t{++} compiler usually
d4f3574e
SS
4573supports the @samp{-gstabs} option. @samp{-gstabs} produces debug info
4574in a format that is superior to formats such as COFF. You may be able
96c405b3 4575to use DWARF2 (@samp{-gdwarf-2}), which is also an effective form for
d4f3574e
SS
4576debug info. See @ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your
4577Program or @sc{gnu} CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more
4578information.
4579
4580
6d2ebf8b 4581@node Arrays
c906108c
SS
4582@section Artificial arrays
4583
4584@cindex artificial array
41afff9a 4585@kindex @@@r{, referencing memory as an array}
c906108c
SS
4586It is often useful to print out several successive objects of the
4587same type in memory; a section of an array, or an array of
4588dynamically determined size for which only a pointer exists in the
4589program.
4590
4591You can do this by referring to a contiguous span of memory as an
4592@dfn{artificial array}, using the binary operator @samp{@@}. The left
4593operand of @samp{@@} should be the first element of the desired array
4594and be an individual object. The right operand should be the desired length
4595of the array. The result is an array value whose elements are all of
4596the type of the left argument. The first element is actually the left
4597argument; the second element comes from bytes of memory immediately
4598following those that hold the first element, and so on. Here is an
4599example. If a program says
4600
4601@example
4602int *array = (int *) malloc (len * sizeof (int));
4603@end example
4604
4605@noindent
4606you can print the contents of @code{array} with
4607
4608@example
4609p *array@@len
4610@end example
4611
4612The left operand of @samp{@@} must reside in memory. Array values made
4613with @samp{@@} in this way behave just like other arrays in terms of
4614subscripting, and are coerced to pointers when used in expressions.
4615Artificial arrays most often appear in expressions via the value history
4616(@pxref{Value History, ,Value history}), after printing one out.
4617
4618Another way to create an artificial array is to use a cast.
4619This re-interprets a value as if it were an array.
4620The value need not be in memory:
4621@example
4622(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[2])0x12345678
4623$1 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4624@end example
4625
4626As a convenience, if you leave the array length out (as in
c3f6f71d 4627@samp{(@var{type}[])@var{value}}) @value{GDBN} calculates the size to fill
c906108c
SS
4628the value (as @samp{sizeof(@var{value})/sizeof(@var{type})}:
4629@example
4630(@value{GDBP}) p/x (short[])0x12345678
4631$2 = @{0x1234, 0x5678@}
4632@end example
4633
4634Sometimes the artificial array mechanism is not quite enough; in
4635moderately complex data structures, the elements of interest may not
4636actually be adjacent---for example, if you are interested in the values
4637of pointers in an array. One useful work-around in this situation is
4638to use a convenience variable (@pxref{Convenience Vars, ,Convenience
4639variables}) as a counter in an expression that prints the first
4640interesting value, and then repeat that expression via @key{RET}. For
4641instance, suppose you have an array @code{dtab} of pointers to
4642structures, and you are interested in the values of a field @code{fv}
4643in each structure. Here is an example of what you might type:
4644
4645@example
4646set $i = 0
4647p dtab[$i++]->fv
4648@key{RET}
4649@key{RET}
4650@dots{}
4651@end example
4652
6d2ebf8b 4653@node Output Formats
c906108c
SS
4654@section Output formats
4655
4656@cindex formatted output
4657@cindex output formats
4658By default, @value{GDBN} prints a value according to its data type. Sometimes
4659this is not what you want. For example, you might want to print a number
4660in hex, or a pointer in decimal. Or you might want to view data in memory
4661at a certain address as a character string or as an instruction. To do
4662these things, specify an @dfn{output format} when you print a value.
4663
4664The simplest use of output formats is to say how to print a value
4665already computed. This is done by starting the arguments of the
4666@code{print} command with a slash and a format letter. The format
4667letters supported are:
4668
4669@table @code
4670@item x
4671Regard the bits of the value as an integer, and print the integer in
4672hexadecimal.
4673
4674@item d
4675Print as integer in signed decimal.
4676
4677@item u
4678Print as integer in unsigned decimal.
4679
4680@item o
4681Print as integer in octal.
4682
4683@item t
4684Print as integer in binary. The letter @samp{t} stands for ``two''.
4685@footnote{@samp{b} cannot be used because these format letters are also
4686used with the @code{x} command, where @samp{b} stands for ``byte'';
d4f3574e 4687see @ref{Memory,,Examining memory}.}
c906108c
SS
4688
4689@item a
4690@cindex unknown address, locating
3d67e040 4691@cindex locate address
c906108c
SS
4692Print as an address, both absolute in hexadecimal and as an offset from
4693the nearest preceding symbol. You can use this format used to discover
4694where (in what function) an unknown address is located:
4695
4696@example
4697(@value{GDBP}) p/a 0x54320
4698$3 = 0x54320 <_initialize_vx+396>
4699@end example
4700
3d67e040
EZ
4701@noindent
4702The command @code{info symbol 0x54320} yields similar results.
4703@xref{Symbols, info symbol}.
4704
c906108c
SS
4705@item c
4706Regard as an integer and print it as a character constant.
4707
4708@item f
4709Regard the bits of the value as a floating point number and print
4710using typical floating point syntax.
4711@end table
4712
4713For example, to print the program counter in hex (@pxref{Registers}), type
4714
4715@example
4716p/x $pc
4717@end example
4718
4719@noindent
4720Note that no space is required before the slash; this is because command
4721names in @value{GDBN} cannot contain a slash.
4722
4723To reprint the last value in the value history with a different format,
4724you can use the @code{print} command with just a format and no
4725expression. For example, @samp{p/x} reprints the last value in hex.
4726
6d2ebf8b 4727@node Memory
c906108c
SS
4728@section Examining memory
4729
4730You can use the command @code{x} (for ``examine'') to examine memory in
4731any of several formats, independently of your program's data types.
4732
4733@cindex examining memory
4734@table @code
41afff9a 4735@kindex x @r{(examine memory)}
c906108c
SS
4736@item x/@var{nfu} @var{addr}
4737@itemx x @var{addr}
4738@itemx x
4739Use the @code{x} command to examine memory.
4740@end table
4741
4742@var{n}, @var{f}, and @var{u} are all optional parameters that specify how
4743much memory to display and how to format it; @var{addr} is an
4744expression giving the address where you want to start displaying memory.
4745If you use defaults for @var{nfu}, you need not type the slash @samp{/}.
4746Several commands set convenient defaults for @var{addr}.
4747
4748@table @r
4749@item @var{n}, the repeat count
4750The repeat count is a decimal integer; the default is 1. It specifies
4751how much memory (counting by units @var{u}) to display.
4752@c This really is **decimal**; unaffected by 'set radix' as of GDB
4753@c 4.1.2.
4754
4755@item @var{f}, the display format
4756The display format is one of the formats used by @code{print},
4757@samp{s} (null-terminated string), or @samp{i} (machine instruction).
4758The default is @samp{x} (hexadecimal) initially.
4759The default changes each time you use either @code{x} or @code{print}.
4760
4761@item @var{u}, the unit size
4762The unit size is any of
4763
4764@table @code
4765@item b
4766Bytes.
4767@item h
4768Halfwords (two bytes).
4769@item w
4770Words (four bytes). This is the initial default.
4771@item g
4772Giant words (eight bytes).
4773@end table
4774
4775Each time you specify a unit size with @code{x}, that size becomes the
4776default unit the next time you use @code{x}. (For the @samp{s} and
4777@samp{i} formats, the unit size is ignored and is normally not written.)
4778
4779@item @var{addr}, starting display address
4780@var{addr} is the address where you want @value{GDBN} to begin displaying
4781memory. The expression need not have a pointer value (though it may);
4782it is always interpreted as an integer address of a byte of memory.
4783@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information on expressions. The default for
4784@var{addr} is usually just after the last address examined---but several
4785other commands also set the default address: @code{info breakpoints} (to
4786the address of the last breakpoint listed), @code{info line} (to the
4787starting address of a line), and @code{print} (if you use it to display
4788a value from memory).
4789@end table
4790
4791For example, @samp{x/3uh 0x54320} is a request to display three halfwords
4792(@code{h}) of memory, formatted as unsigned decimal integers (@samp{u}),
4793starting at address @code{0x54320}. @samp{x/4xw $sp} prints the four
4794words (@samp{w}) of memory above the stack pointer (here, @samp{$sp};
d4f3574e 4795@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}) in hexadecimal (@samp{x}).
c906108c
SS
4796
4797Since the letters indicating unit sizes are all distinct from the
4798letters specifying output formats, you do not have to remember whether
4799unit size or format comes first; either order works. The output
4800specifications @samp{4xw} and @samp{4wx} mean exactly the same thing.
4801(However, the count @var{n} must come first; @samp{wx4} does not work.)
4802
4803Even though the unit size @var{u} is ignored for the formats @samp{s}
4804and @samp{i}, you might still want to use a count @var{n}; for example,
4805@samp{3i} specifies that you want to see three machine instructions,
4806including any operands. The command @code{disassemble} gives an
d4f3574e 4807alternative way of inspecting machine instructions; see @ref{Machine
c906108c
SS
4808Code,,Source and machine code}.
4809
4810All the defaults for the arguments to @code{x} are designed to make it
4811easy to continue scanning memory with minimal specifications each time
4812you use @code{x}. For example, after you have inspected three machine
4813instructions with @samp{x/3i @var{addr}}, you can inspect the next seven
4814with just @samp{x/7}. If you use @key{RET} to repeat the @code{x} command,
4815the repeat count @var{n} is used again; the other arguments default as
4816for successive uses of @code{x}.
4817
4818@cindex @code{$_}, @code{$__}, and value history
4819The addresses and contents printed by the @code{x} command are not saved
4820in the value history because there is often too much of them and they
4821would get in the way. Instead, @value{GDBN} makes these values available for
4822subsequent use in expressions as values of the convenience variables
4823@code{$_} and @code{$__}. After an @code{x} command, the last address
4824examined is available for use in expressions in the convenience variable
4825@code{$_}. The contents of that address, as examined, are available in
4826the convenience variable @code{$__}.
4827
4828If the @code{x} command has a repeat count, the address and contents saved
4829are from the last memory unit printed; this is not the same as the last
4830address printed if several units were printed on the last line of output.
4831
6d2ebf8b 4832@node Auto Display
c906108c
SS
4833@section Automatic display
4834@cindex automatic display
4835@cindex display of expressions
4836
4837If you find that you want to print the value of an expression frequently
4838(to see how it changes), you might want to add it to the @dfn{automatic
4839display list} so that @value{GDBN} prints its value each time your program stops.
4840Each expression added to the list is given a number to identify it;
4841to remove an expression from the list, you specify that number.
4842The automatic display looks like this:
4843
4844@example
48452: foo = 38
48463: bar[5] = (struct hack *) 0x3804
4847@end example
4848
4849@noindent
4850This display shows item numbers, expressions and their current values. As with
4851displays you request manually using @code{x} or @code{print}, you can
4852specify the output format you prefer; in fact, @code{display} decides
4853whether to use @code{print} or @code{x} depending on how elaborate your
4854format specification is---it uses @code{x} if you specify a unit size,
4855or one of the two formats (@samp{i} and @samp{s}) that are only
4856supported by @code{x}; otherwise it uses @code{print}.
4857
4858@table @code
4859@kindex display
d4f3574e
SS
4860@item display @var{expr}
4861Add the expression @var{expr} to the list of expressions to display
c906108c
SS
4862each time your program stops. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
4863
4864@code{display} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
4865
d4f3574e 4866@item display/@var{fmt} @var{expr}
c906108c 4867For @var{fmt} specifying only a display format and not a size or
d4f3574e 4868count, add the expression @var{expr} to the auto-display list but
c906108c
SS
4869arrange to display it each time in the specified format @var{fmt}.
4870@xref{Output Formats,,Output formats}.
4871
4872@item display/@var{fmt} @var{addr}
4873For @var{fmt} @samp{i} or @samp{s}, or including a unit-size or a
4874number of units, add the expression @var{addr} as a memory address to
4875be examined each time your program stops. Examining means in effect
4876doing @samp{x/@var{fmt} @var{addr}}. @xref{Memory, ,Examining memory}.
4877@end table
4878
4879For example, @samp{display/i $pc} can be helpful, to see the machine
4880instruction about to be executed each time execution stops (@samp{$pc}
d4f3574e 4881is a common name for the program counter; @pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
4882
4883@table @code
4884@kindex delete display
4885@kindex undisplay
4886@item undisplay @var{dnums}@dots{}
4887@itemx delete display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4888Remove item numbers @var{dnums} from the list of expressions to display.
4889
4890@code{undisplay} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
4891(Otherwise you would just get the error @samp{No display number @dots{}}.)
4892
4893@kindex disable display
4894@item disable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4895Disable the display of item numbers @var{dnums}. A disabled display
4896item is not printed automatically, but is not forgotten. It may be
4897enabled again later.
4898
4899@kindex enable display
4900@item enable display @var{dnums}@dots{}
4901Enable display of item numbers @var{dnums}. It becomes effective once
4902again in auto display of its expression, until you specify otherwise.
4903
4904@item display
4905Display the current values of the expressions on the list, just as is
4906done when your program stops.
4907
4908@kindex info display
4909@item info display
4910Print the list of expressions previously set up to display
4911automatically, each one with its item number, but without showing the
4912values. This includes disabled expressions, which are marked as such.
4913It also includes expressions which would not be displayed right now
4914because they refer to automatic variables not currently available.
4915@end table
4916
4917If a display expression refers to local variables, then it does not make
4918sense outside the lexical context for which it was set up. Such an
4919expression is disabled when execution enters a context where one of its
4920variables is not defined. For example, if you give the command
4921@code{display last_char} while inside a function with an argument
4922@code{last_char}, @value{GDBN} displays this argument while your program
4923continues to stop inside that function. When it stops elsewhere---where
4924there is no variable @code{last_char}---the display is disabled
4925automatically. The next time your program stops where @code{last_char}
4926is meaningful, you can enable the display expression once again.
4927
6d2ebf8b 4928@node Print Settings
c906108c
SS
4929@section Print settings
4930
4931@cindex format options
4932@cindex print settings
4933@value{GDBN} provides the following ways to control how arrays, structures,
4934and symbols are printed.
4935
4936@noindent
4937These settings are useful for debugging programs in any language:
4938
4939@table @code
4940@kindex set print address
4941@item set print address
4942@itemx set print address on
4943@value{GDBN} prints memory addresses showing the location of stack
4944traces, structure values, pointer values, breakpoints, and so forth,
4945even when it also displays the contents of those addresses. The default
4946is @code{on}. For example, this is what a stack frame display looks like with
4947@code{set print address on}:
4948
4949@smallexample
4950@group
4951(@value{GDBP}) f
4952#0 set_quotes (lq=0x34c78 "<<", rq=0x34c88 ">>")
4953 at input.c:530
4954530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4955@end group
4956@end smallexample
4957
4958@item set print address off
4959Do not print addresses when displaying their contents. For example,
4960this is the same stack frame displayed with @code{set print address off}:
4961
4962@smallexample
4963@group
4964(@value{GDBP}) set print addr off
4965(@value{GDBP}) f
4966#0 set_quotes (lq="<<", rq=">>") at input.c:530
4967530 if (lquote != def_lquote)
4968@end group
4969@end smallexample
4970
4971You can use @samp{set print address off} to eliminate all machine
4972dependent displays from the @value{GDBN} interface. For example, with
4973@code{print address off}, you should get the same text for backtraces on
4974all machines---whether or not they involve pointer arguments.
4975
4976@kindex show print address
4977@item show print address
4978Show whether or not addresses are to be printed.
4979@end table
4980
4981When @value{GDBN} prints a symbolic address, it normally prints the
4982closest earlier symbol plus an offset. If that symbol does not uniquely
4983identify the address (for example, it is a name whose scope is a single
4984source file), you may need to clarify. One way to do this is with
4985@code{info line}, for example @samp{info line *0x4537}. Alternately,
4986you can set @value{GDBN} to print the source file and line number when
4987it prints a symbolic address:
4988
4989@table @code
4990@kindex set print symbol-filename
4991@item set print symbol-filename on
4992Tell @value{GDBN} to print the source file name and line number of a
4993symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
4994
4995@item set print symbol-filename off
4996Do not print source file name and line number of a symbol. This is the
4997default.
4998
4999@kindex show print symbol-filename
5000@item show print symbol-filename
5001Show whether or not @value{GDBN} will print the source file name and
5002line number of a symbol in the symbolic form of an address.
5003@end table
5004
5005Another situation where it is helpful to show symbol filenames and line
5006numbers is when disassembling code; @value{GDBN} shows you the line
5007number and source file that corresponds to each instruction.
5008
5009Also, you may wish to see the symbolic form only if the address being
5010printed is reasonably close to the closest earlier symbol:
5011
5012@table @code
5013@kindex set print max-symbolic-offset
5014@item set print max-symbolic-offset @var{max-offset}
5015Tell @value{GDBN} to only display the symbolic form of an address if the
5016offset between the closest earlier symbol and the address is less than
5d161b24 5017@var{max-offset}. The default is 0, which tells @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
5018to always print the symbolic form of an address if any symbol precedes it.
5019
5020@kindex show print max-symbolic-offset
5021@item show print max-symbolic-offset
5022Ask how large the maximum offset is that @value{GDBN} prints in a
5023symbolic address.
5024@end table
5025
5026@cindex wild pointer, interpreting
5027@cindex pointer, finding referent
5028If you have a pointer and you are not sure where it points, try
5029@samp{set print symbol-filename on}. Then you can determine the name
5030and source file location of the variable where it points, using
5031@samp{p/a @var{pointer}}. This interprets the address in symbolic form.
5032For example, here @value{GDBN} shows that a variable @code{ptt} points
5033at another variable @code{t}, defined in @file{hi2.c}:
5034
5035@example
5036(@value{GDBP}) set print symbol-filename on
5037(@value{GDBP}) p/a ptt
5038$4 = 0xe008 <t in hi2.c>
5039@end example
5040
5041@quotation
5042@emph{Warning:} For pointers that point to a local variable, @samp{p/a}
5043does not show the symbol name and filename of the referent, even with
5044the appropriate @code{set print} options turned on.
5045@end quotation
5046
5047Other settings control how different kinds of objects are printed:
5048
5049@table @code
5050@kindex set print array
5051@item set print array
5052@itemx set print array on
5053Pretty print arrays. This format is more convenient to read,
5054but uses more space. The default is off.
5055
5056@item set print array off
5057Return to compressed format for arrays.
5058
5059@kindex show print array
5060@item show print array
5061Show whether compressed or pretty format is selected for displaying
5062arrays.
5063
5064@kindex set print elements
5065@item set print elements @var{number-of-elements}
5066Set a limit on how many elements of an array @value{GDBN} will print.
5067If @value{GDBN} is printing a large array, it stops printing after it has
5068printed the number of elements set by the @code{set print elements} command.
5069This limit also applies to the display of strings.
d4f3574e 5070When @value{GDBN} starts, this limit is set to 200.
c906108c
SS
5071Setting @var{number-of-elements} to zero means that the printing is unlimited.
5072
5073@kindex show print elements
5074@item show print elements
5075Display the number of elements of a large array that @value{GDBN} will print.
5076If the number is 0, then the printing is unlimited.
5077
5078@kindex set print null-stop
5079@item set print null-stop
5080Cause @value{GDBN} to stop printing the characters of an array when the first
d4f3574e 5081@sc{null} is encountered. This is useful when large arrays actually
c906108c 5082contain only short strings.
d4f3574e 5083The default is off.
c906108c
SS
5084
5085@kindex set print pretty
5086@item set print pretty on
5d161b24 5087Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in an indented format with one member
c906108c
SS
5088per line, like this:
5089
5090@smallexample
5091@group
5092$1 = @{
5093 next = 0x0,
5094 flags = @{
5095 sweet = 1,
5096 sour = 1
5097 @},
5098 meat = 0x54 "Pork"
5099@}
5100@end group
5101@end smallexample
5102
5103@item set print pretty off
5104Cause @value{GDBN} to print structures in a compact format, like this:
5105
5106@smallexample
5107@group
5108$1 = @{next = 0x0, flags = @{sweet = 1, sour = 1@}, \
5109meat = 0x54 "Pork"@}
5110@end group
5111@end smallexample
5112
5113@noindent
5114This is the default format.
5115
5116@kindex show print pretty
5117@item show print pretty
5118Show which format @value{GDBN} is using to print structures.
5119
5120@kindex set print sevenbit-strings
5121@item set print sevenbit-strings on
5122Print using only seven-bit characters; if this option is set,
5123@value{GDBN} displays any eight-bit characters (in strings or
5124character values) using the notation @code{\}@var{nnn}. This setting is
5125best if you are working in English (@sc{ascii}) and you use the
5126high-order bit of characters as a marker or ``meta'' bit.
5127
5128@item set print sevenbit-strings off
5129Print full eight-bit characters. This allows the use of more
5130international character sets, and is the default.
5131
5132@kindex show print sevenbit-strings
5133@item show print sevenbit-strings
5134Show whether or not @value{GDBN} is printing only seven-bit characters.
5135
5136@kindex set print union
5137@item set print union on
5d161b24 5138Tell @value{GDBN} to print unions which are contained in structures. This
c906108c
SS
5139is the default setting.
5140
5141@item set print union off
5142Tell @value{GDBN} not to print unions which are contained in structures.
5143
5144@kindex show print union
5145@item show print union
5146Ask @value{GDBN} whether or not it will print unions which are contained in
5147structures.
5148
5149For example, given the declarations
5150
5151@smallexample
5152typedef enum @{Tree, Bug@} Species;
5153typedef enum @{Big_tree, Acorn, Seedling@} Tree_forms;
5d161b24 5154typedef enum @{Caterpillar, Cocoon, Butterfly@}
c906108c
SS
5155 Bug_forms;
5156
5157struct thing @{
5158 Species it;
5159 union @{
5160 Tree_forms tree;
5161 Bug_forms bug;
5162 @} form;
5163@};
5164
5165struct thing foo = @{Tree, @{Acorn@}@};
5166@end smallexample
5167
5168@noindent
5169with @code{set print union on} in effect @samp{p foo} would print
5170
5171@smallexample
5172$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{tree = Acorn, bug = Cocoon@}@}
5173@end smallexample
5174
5175@noindent
5176and with @code{set print union off} in effect it would print
5177
5178@smallexample
5179$1 = @{it = Tree, form = @{...@}@}
5180@end smallexample
5181@end table
5182
c906108c
SS
5183@need 1000
5184@noindent
b37052ae 5185These settings are of interest when debugging C@t{++} programs:
c906108c
SS
5186
5187@table @code
5188@cindex demangling
5189@kindex set print demangle
5190@item set print demangle
5191@itemx set print demangle on
b37052ae 5192Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than in the encoded
c906108c 5193(``mangled'') form passed to the assembler and linker for type-safe
d4f3574e 5194linkage. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5195
5196@kindex show print demangle
5197@item show print demangle
b37052ae 5198Show whether C@t{++} names are printed in mangled or demangled form.
c906108c
SS
5199
5200@kindex set print asm-demangle
5201@item set print asm-demangle
5202@itemx set print asm-demangle on
b37052ae 5203Print C@t{++} names in their source form rather than their mangled form, even
c906108c
SS
5204in assembler code printouts such as instruction disassemblies.
5205The default is off.
5206
5207@kindex show print asm-demangle
5208@item show print asm-demangle
b37052ae 5209Show whether C@t{++} names in assembly listings are printed in mangled
c906108c
SS
5210or demangled form.
5211
5212@kindex set demangle-style
b37052ae
EZ
5213@cindex C@t{++} symbol decoding style
5214@cindex symbol decoding style, C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
5215@item set demangle-style @var{style}
5216Choose among several encoding schemes used by different compilers to
b37052ae 5217represent C@t{++} names. The choices for @var{style} are currently:
c906108c
SS
5218
5219@table @code
5220@item auto
5221Allow @value{GDBN} to choose a decoding style by inspecting your program.
5222
5223@item gnu
b37052ae 5224Decode based on the @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler (@code{g++}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c 5225This is the default.
c906108c
SS
5226
5227@item hp
b37052ae 5228Decode based on the HP ANSI C@t{++} (@code{aCC}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5229
5230@item lucid
b37052ae 5231Decode based on the Lucid C@t{++} compiler (@code{lcc}) encoding algorithm.
c906108c
SS
5232
5233@item arm
b37052ae 5234Decode using the algorithm in the @cite{C@t{++} Annotated Reference Manual}.
c906108c
SS
5235@strong{Warning:} this setting alone is not sufficient to allow
5236debugging @code{cfront}-generated executables. @value{GDBN} would
5237require further enhancement to permit that.
5238
5239@end table
5240If you omit @var{style}, you will see a list of possible formats.
5241
5242@kindex show demangle-style
5243@item show demangle-style
b37052ae 5244Display the encoding style currently in use for decoding C@t{++} symbols.
c906108c
SS
5245
5246@kindex set print object
5247@item set print object
5248@itemx set print object on
5249When displaying a pointer to an object, identify the @emph{actual}
5250(derived) type of the object rather than the @emph{declared} type, using
5251the virtual function table.
5252
5253@item set print object off
5254Display only the declared type of objects, without reference to the
5255virtual function table. This is the default setting.
5256
5257@kindex show print object
5258@item show print object
5259Show whether actual, or declared, object types are displayed.
5260
5261@kindex set print static-members
5262@item set print static-members
5263@itemx set print static-members on
b37052ae 5264Print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object. The default is on.
c906108c
SS
5265
5266@item set print static-members off
b37052ae 5267Do not print static members when displaying a C@t{++} object.
c906108c
SS
5268
5269@kindex show print static-members
5270@item show print static-members
b37052ae 5271Show whether C@t{++} static members are printed, or not.
c906108c
SS
5272
5273@c These don't work with HP ANSI C++ yet.
5274@kindex set print vtbl
5275@item set print vtbl
5276@itemx set print vtbl on
b37052ae 5277Pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables. The default is off.
c906108c 5278(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 5279ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
5280
5281@item set print vtbl off
b37052ae 5282Do not pretty print C@t{++} virtual function tables.
c906108c
SS
5283
5284@kindex show print vtbl
5285@item show print vtbl
b37052ae 5286Show whether C@t{++} virtual function tables are pretty printed, or not.
c906108c 5287@end table
c906108c 5288
6d2ebf8b 5289@node Value History
c906108c
SS
5290@section Value history
5291
5292@cindex value history
5d161b24
DB
5293Values printed by the @code{print} command are saved in the @value{GDBN}
5294@dfn{value history}. This allows you to refer to them in other expressions.
5295Values are kept until the symbol table is re-read or discarded
5296(for example with the @code{file} or @code{symbol-file} commands).
5297When the symbol table changes, the value history is discarded,
5298since the values may contain pointers back to the types defined in the
c906108c
SS
5299symbol table.
5300
5301@cindex @code{$}
5302@cindex @code{$$}
5303@cindex history number
5304The values printed are given @dfn{history numbers} by which you can
5305refer to them. These are successive integers starting with one.
5306@code{print} shows you the history number assigned to a value by
5307printing @samp{$@var{num} = } before the value; here @var{num} is the
5308history number.
5309
5310To refer to any previous value, use @samp{$} followed by the value's
5311history number. The way @code{print} labels its output is designed to
5312remind you of this. Just @code{$} refers to the most recent value in
5313the history, and @code{$$} refers to the value before that.
5314@code{$$@var{n}} refers to the @var{n}th value from the end; @code{$$2}
5315is the value just prior to @code{$$}, @code{$$1} is equivalent to
5316@code{$$}, and @code{$$0} is equivalent to @code{$}.
5317
5318For example, suppose you have just printed a pointer to a structure and
5319want to see the contents of the structure. It suffices to type
5320
5321@example
5322p *$
5323@end example
5324
5325If you have a chain of structures where the component @code{next} points
5326to the next one, you can print the contents of the next one with this:
5327
5328@example
5329p *$.next
5330@end example
5331
5332@noindent
5333You can print successive links in the chain by repeating this
5334command---which you can do by just typing @key{RET}.
5335
5336Note that the history records values, not expressions. If the value of
5337@code{x} is 4 and you type these commands:
5338
5339@example
5340print x
5341set x=5
5342@end example
5343
5344@noindent
5345then the value recorded in the value history by the @code{print} command
5346remains 4 even though the value of @code{x} has changed.
5347
5348@table @code
5349@kindex show values
5350@item show values
5351Print the last ten values in the value history, with their item numbers.
5352This is like @samp{p@ $$9} repeated ten times, except that @code{show
5353values} does not change the history.
5354
5355@item show values @var{n}
5356Print ten history values centered on history item number @var{n}.
5357
5358@item show values +
5359Print ten history values just after the values last printed. If no more
5360values are available, @code{show values +} produces no display.
5361@end table
5362
5363Pressing @key{RET} to repeat @code{show values @var{n}} has exactly the
5364same effect as @samp{show values +}.
5365
6d2ebf8b 5366@node Convenience Vars
c906108c
SS
5367@section Convenience variables
5368
5369@cindex convenience variables
5370@value{GDBN} provides @dfn{convenience variables} that you can use within
5371@value{GDBN} to hold on to a value and refer to it later. These variables
5372exist entirely within @value{GDBN}; they are not part of your program, and
5373setting a convenience variable has no direct effect on further execution
5374of your program. That is why you can use them freely.
5375
5376Convenience variables are prefixed with @samp{$}. Any name preceded by
5377@samp{$} can be used for a convenience variable, unless it is one of
d4f3574e 5378the predefined machine-specific register names (@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}).
c906108c
SS
5379(Value history references, in contrast, are @emph{numbers} preceded
5380by @samp{$}. @xref{Value History, ,Value history}.)
5381
5382You can save a value in a convenience variable with an assignment
5383expression, just as you would set a variable in your program.
5384For example:
5385
5386@example
5387set $foo = *object_ptr
5388@end example
5389
5390@noindent
5391would save in @code{$foo} the value contained in the object pointed to by
5392@code{object_ptr}.
5393
5394Using a convenience variable for the first time creates it, but its
5395value is @code{void} until you assign a new value. You can alter the
5396value with another assignment at any time.
5397
5398Convenience variables have no fixed types. You can assign a convenience
5399variable any type of value, including structures and arrays, even if
5400that variable already has a value of a different type. The convenience
5401variable, when used as an expression, has the type of its current value.
5402
5403@table @code
5404@kindex show convenience
5405@item show convenience
5406Print a list of convenience variables used so far, and their values.
d4f3574e 5407Abbreviated @code{show conv}.
c906108c
SS
5408@end table
5409
5410One of the ways to use a convenience variable is as a counter to be
5411incremented or a pointer to be advanced. For example, to print
5412a field from successive elements of an array of structures:
5413
5414@example
5415set $i = 0
5416print bar[$i++]->contents
5417@end example
5418
d4f3574e
SS
5419@noindent
5420Repeat that command by typing @key{RET}.
c906108c
SS
5421
5422Some convenience variables are created automatically by @value{GDBN} and given
5423values likely to be useful.
5424
5425@table @code
41afff9a 5426@vindex $_@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5427@item $_
5428The variable @code{$_} is automatically set by the @code{x} command to
5429the last address examined (@pxref{Memory, ,Examining memory}). Other
5430commands which provide a default address for @code{x} to examine also
5431set @code{$_} to that address; these commands include @code{info line}
5432and @code{info breakpoint}. The type of @code{$_} is @code{void *}
5433except when set by the @code{x} command, in which case it is a pointer
5434to the type of @code{$__}.
5435
41afff9a 5436@vindex $__@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5437@item $__
5438The variable @code{$__} is automatically set by the @code{x} command
5439to the value found in the last address examined. Its type is chosen
5440to match the format in which the data was printed.
5441
5442@item $_exitcode
41afff9a 5443@vindex $_exitcode@r{, convenience variable}
c906108c
SS
5444The variable @code{$_exitcode} is automatically set to the exit code when
5445the program being debugged terminates.
5446@end table
5447
53a5351d
JM
5448On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
5449begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
5450name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
c906108c 5451
6d2ebf8b 5452@node Registers
c906108c
SS
5453@section Registers
5454
5455@cindex registers
5456You can refer to machine register contents, in expressions, as variables
5457with names starting with @samp{$}. The names of registers are different
5458for each machine; use @code{info registers} to see the names used on
5459your machine.
5460
5461@table @code
5462@kindex info registers
5463@item info registers
5464Print the names and values of all registers except floating-point
5465registers (in the selected stack frame).
5466
5467@kindex info all-registers
5468@cindex floating point registers
5469@item info all-registers
5470Print the names and values of all registers, including floating-point
5471registers.
5472
5473@item info registers @var{regname} @dots{}
5474Print the @dfn{relativized} value of each specified register @var{regname}.
5d161b24
DB
5475As discussed in detail below, register values are normally relative to
5476the selected stack frame. @var{regname} may be any register name valid on
c906108c
SS
5477the machine you are using, with or without the initial @samp{$}.
5478@end table
5479
5480@value{GDBN} has four ``standard'' register names that are available (in
5481expressions) on most machines---whenever they do not conflict with an
5482architecture's canonical mnemonics for registers. The register names
5483@code{$pc} and @code{$sp} are used for the program counter register and
5484the stack pointer. @code{$fp} is used for a register that contains a
5485pointer to the current stack frame, and @code{$ps} is used for a
5486register that contains the processor status. For example,
5487you could print the program counter in hex with
5488
5489@example
5490p/x $pc
5491@end example
5492
5493@noindent
5494or print the instruction to be executed next with
5495
5496@example
5497x/i $pc
5498@end example
5499
5500@noindent
5501or add four to the stack pointer@footnote{This is a way of removing
5502one word from the stack, on machines where stacks grow downward in
5503memory (most machines, nowadays). This assumes that the innermost
5504stack frame is selected; setting @code{$sp} is not allowed when other
5505stack frames are selected. To pop entire frames off the stack,
5506regardless of machine architecture, use @code{return};
d4f3574e 5507see @ref{Returning, ,Returning from a function}.} with
c906108c
SS
5508
5509@example
5510set $sp += 4
5511@end example
5512
5513Whenever possible, these four standard register names are available on
5514your machine even though the machine has different canonical mnemonics,
5515so long as there is no conflict. The @code{info registers} command
5516shows the canonical names. For example, on the SPARC, @code{info
5517registers} displays the processor status register as @code{$psr} but you
d4f3574e
SS
5518can also refer to it as @code{$ps}; and on x86-based machines @code{$ps}
5519is an alias for the @sc{eflags} register.
c906108c
SS
5520
5521@value{GDBN} always considers the contents of an ordinary register as an
5522integer when the register is examined in this way. Some machines have
5523special registers which can hold nothing but floating point; these
5524registers are considered to have floating point values. There is no way
5525to refer to the contents of an ordinary register as floating point value
5526(although you can @emph{print} it as a floating point value with
5527@samp{print/f $@var{regname}}).
5528
5529Some registers have distinct ``raw'' and ``virtual'' data formats. This
5530means that the data format in which the register contents are saved by
5531the operating system is not the same one that your program normally
5532sees. For example, the registers of the 68881 floating point
5533coprocessor are always saved in ``extended'' (raw) format, but all C
5534programs expect to work with ``double'' (virtual) format. In such
5d161b24 5535cases, @value{GDBN} normally works with the virtual format only (the format
c906108c
SS
5536that makes sense for your program), but the @code{info registers} command
5537prints the data in both formats.
5538
5539Normally, register values are relative to the selected stack frame
5540(@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a frame}). This means that you get the
5541value that the register would contain if all stack frames farther in
5542were exited and their saved registers restored. In order to see the
5543true contents of hardware registers, you must select the innermost
5544frame (with @samp{frame 0}).
5545
5546However, @value{GDBN} must deduce where registers are saved, from the machine
5547code generated by your compiler. If some registers are not saved, or if
5548@value{GDBN} is unable to locate the saved registers, the selected stack
5549frame makes no difference.
5550
6d2ebf8b 5551@node Floating Point Hardware
c906108c
SS
5552@section Floating point hardware
5553@cindex floating point
5554
5555Depending on the configuration, @value{GDBN} may be able to give
5556you more information about the status of the floating point hardware.
5557
5558@table @code
5559@kindex info float
5560@item info float
5561Display hardware-dependent information about the floating
5562point unit. The exact contents and layout vary depending on the
5563floating point chip. Currently, @samp{info float} is supported on
5564the ARM and x86 machines.
5565@end table
c906108c 5566
29e57380
C
5567@node Memory Region Attributes
5568@section Memory Region Attributes
5569@cindex memory region attributes
5570
5571@dfn{Memory region attributes} allow you to describe special handling
5572required by regions of your target's memory. @value{GDBN} uses attributes
5573to determine whether to allow certain types of memory accesses; whether to
5574use specific width accesses; and whether to cache target memory.
5575
5576Defined memory regions can be individually enabled and disabled. When a
5577memory region is disabled, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when
5578accessing memory in that region. Similarly, if no memory regions have
5579been defined, @value{GDBN} uses the default attributes when accessing
5580all memory.
5581
5582When a memory region is defined, it is given a number to identify it;
5583to enable, disable, or remove a memory region, you specify that number.
5584
5585@table @code
5586@kindex mem
59649f2e 5587@item mem @var{address1} @var{address2} @var{attributes}@dots{}
29e57380
C
5588Define memory region bounded by @var{address1} and @var{address2}
5589with attributes @var{attributes}@dots{}.
5590
5591@kindex delete mem
5592@item delete mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5593Remove memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5594
5595@kindex disable mem
5596@item disable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5597Disable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5598A disabled memory region is not forgotten.
5599It may be enabled again later.
5600
5601@kindex enable mem
5602@item enable mem @var{nums}@dots{}
59649f2e 5603Enable memory regions @var{nums}@dots{}.
29e57380
C
5604
5605@kindex info mem
5606@item info mem
5607Print a table of all defined memory regions, with the following columns
5608for each region.
5609
5610@table @emph
5611@item Memory Region Number
5612@item Enabled or Disabled.
5613Enabled memory regions are marked with @samp{y}.
5614Disabled memory regions are marked with @samp{n}.
5615
5616@item Lo Address
5617The address defining the inclusive lower bound of the memory region.
5618
5619@item Hi Address
5620The address defining the exclusive upper bound of the memory region.
5621
5622@item Attributes
5623The list of attributes set for this memory region.
5624@end table
5625@end table
5626
5627
5628@subsection Attributes
5629
5630@subsubsection Memory Access Mode
5631The access mode attributes set whether @value{GDBN} may make read or
5632write accesses to a memory region.
5633
5634While these attributes prevent @value{GDBN} from performing invalid
5635memory accesses, they do nothing to prevent the target system, I/O DMA,
5636etc. from accessing memory.
5637
5638@table @code
5639@item ro
5640Memory is read only.
5641@item wo
5642Memory is write only.
5643@item rw
5644Memory is read/write (default).
5645@end table
5646
5647@subsubsection Memory Access Size
5648The acccess size attributes tells @value{GDBN} to use specific sized
5649accesses in the memory region. Often memory mapped device registers
5650require specific sized accesses. If no access size attribute is
5651specified, @value{GDBN} may use accesses of any size.
5652
5653@table @code
5654@item 8
5655Use 8 bit memory accesses.
5656@item 16
5657Use 16 bit memory accesses.
5658@item 32
5659Use 32 bit memory accesses.
5660@item 64
5661Use 64 bit memory accesses.
5662@end table
5663
5664@c @subsubsection Hardware/Software Breakpoints
5665@c The hardware/software breakpoint attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5666@c will use hardware or software breakpoints for the internal breakpoints
5667@c used by the step, next, finish, until, etc. commands.
5668@c
5669@c @table @code
5670@c @item hwbreak
5671@c Always use hardware breakpoints
5672@c @item swbreak (default)
5673@c @end table
5674
5675@subsubsection Data Cache
5676The data cache attributes set whether @value{GDBN} will cache target
5677memory. While this generally improves performance by reducing debug
5678protocol overhead, it can lead to incorrect results because @value{GDBN}
5679does not know about volatile variables or memory mapped device
5680registers.
5681
5682@table @code
5683@item cache
5684Enable @value{GDBN} to cache target memory.
5685@item nocache (default)
5686Disable @value{GDBN} from caching target memory.
5687@end table
5688
5689@c @subsubsection Memory Write Verification
5690@c The memory write verification attributes set whether @value{GDBN}
5691@c will re-reads data after each write to verify the write was successful.
5692@c
5693@c @table @code
5694@c @item verify
5695@c @item noverify (default)
5696@c @end table
5697
b37052ae
EZ
5698@node Tracepoints
5699@chapter Tracepoints
5700@c This chapter is based on the documentation written by Michael
5701@c Snyder, David Taylor, Jim Blandy, and Elena Zannoni.
5702
5703@cindex tracepoints
5704In some applications, it is not feasible for the debugger to interrupt
5705the program's execution long enough for the developer to learn
5706anything helpful about its behavior. If the program's correctness
5707depends on its real-time behavior, delays introduced by a debugger
5708might cause the program to change its behavior drastically, or perhaps
5709fail, even when the code itself is correct. It is useful to be able
5710to observe the program's behavior without interrupting it.
5711
5712Using @value{GDBN}'s @code{trace} and @code{collect} commands, you can
5713specify locations in the program, called @dfn{tracepoints}, and
5714arbitrary expressions to evaluate when those tracepoints are reached.
5715Later, using the @code{tfind} command, you can examine the values
5716those expressions had when the program hit the tracepoints. The
5717expressions may also denote objects in memory---structures or arrays,
5718for example---whose values @value{GDBN} should record; while visiting
5719a particular tracepoint, you may inspect those objects as if they were
5720in memory at that moment. However, because @value{GDBN} records these
5721values without interacting with you, it can do so quickly and
5722unobtrusively, hopefully not disturbing the program's behavior.
5723
5724The tracepoint facility is currently available only for remote
2c0069bb
EZ
5725targets. @xref{Targets}. In addition, your remote target must know how
5726to collect trace data. This functionality is implemented in the remote
5727stub; however, none of the stubs distributed with @value{GDBN} support
5728tracepoints as of this writing.
b37052ae
EZ
5729
5730This chapter describes the tracepoint commands and features.
5731
5732@menu
5733* Set Tracepoints::
5734* Analyze Collected Data::
5735* Tracepoint Variables::
5736@end menu
5737
5738@node Set Tracepoints
5739@section Commands to Set Tracepoints
5740
5741Before running such a @dfn{trace experiment}, an arbitrary number of
5742tracepoints can be set. Like a breakpoint (@pxref{Set Breaks}), a
5743tracepoint has a number assigned to it by @value{GDBN}. Like with
5744breakpoints, tracepoint numbers are successive integers starting from
5745one. Many of the commands associated with tracepoints take the
5746tracepoint number as their argument, to identify which tracepoint to
5747work on.
5748
5749For each tracepoint, you can specify, in advance, some arbitrary set
5750of data that you want the target to collect in the trace buffer when
5751it hits that tracepoint. The collected data can include registers,
5752local variables, or global data. Later, you can use @value{GDBN}
5753commands to examine the values these data had at the time the
5754tracepoint was hit.
5755
5756This section describes commands to set tracepoints and associated
5757conditions and actions.
5758
5759@menu
5760* Create and Delete Tracepoints::
5761* Enable and Disable Tracepoints::
5762* Tracepoint Passcounts::
5763* Tracepoint Actions::
5764* Listing Tracepoints::
5765* Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment::
5766@end menu
5767
5768@node Create and Delete Tracepoints
5769@subsection Create and Delete Tracepoints
5770
5771@table @code
5772@cindex set tracepoint
5773@kindex trace
5774@item trace
5775The @code{trace} command is very similar to the @code{break} command.
5776Its argument can be a source line, a function name, or an address in
5777the target program. @xref{Set Breaks}. The @code{trace} command
5778defines a tracepoint, which is a point in the target program where the
5779debugger will briefly stop, collect some data, and then allow the
5780program to continue. Setting a tracepoint or changing its commands
5781doesn't take effect until the next @code{tstart} command; thus, you
5782cannot change the tracepoint attributes once a trace experiment is
5783running.
5784
5785Here are some examples of using the @code{trace} command:
5786
5787@smallexample
5788(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo.c:121} // a source file and line number
5789
5790(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace +2} // 2 lines forward
5791
5792(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace my_function} // first source line of function
5793
5794(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *my_function} // EXACT start address of function
5795
5796(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace *0x2117c4} // an address
5797@end smallexample
5798
5799@noindent
5800You can abbreviate @code{trace} as @code{tr}.
5801
5802@vindex $tpnum
5803@cindex last tracepoint number
5804@cindex recent tracepoint number
5805@cindex tracepoint number
5806The convenience variable @code{$tpnum} records the tracepoint number
5807of the most recently set tracepoint.
5808
5809@kindex delete tracepoint
5810@cindex tracepoint deletion
5811@item delete tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5812Permanently delete one or more tracepoints. With no argument, the
5813default is to delete all tracepoints.
5814
5815Examples:
5816
5817@smallexample
5818(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace 1 2 3} // remove three tracepoints
5819
5820(@value{GDBP}) @b{delete trace} // remove all tracepoints
5821@end smallexample
5822
5823@noindent
5824You can abbreviate this command as @code{del tr}.
5825@end table
5826
5827@node Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5828@subsection Enable and Disable Tracepoints
5829
5830@table @code
5831@kindex disable tracepoint
5832@item disable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5833Disable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints if no argument
5834@var{num} is given. A disabled tracepoint will have no effect during
5835the next trace experiment, but it is not forgotten. You can re-enable
5836a disabled tracepoint using the @code{enable tracepoint} command.
5837
5838@kindex enable tracepoint
5839@item enable tracepoint @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5840Enable tracepoint @var{num}, or all tracepoints. The enabled
5841tracepoints will become effective the next time a trace experiment is
5842run.
5843@end table
5844
5845@node Tracepoint Passcounts
5846@subsection Tracepoint Passcounts
5847
5848@table @code
5849@kindex passcount
5850@cindex tracepoint pass count
5851@item passcount @r{[}@var{n} @r{[}@var{num}@r{]]}
5852Set the @dfn{passcount} of a tracepoint. The passcount is a way to
5853automatically stop a trace experiment. If a tracepoint's passcount is
5854@var{n}, then the trace experiment will be automatically stopped on
5855the @var{n}'th time that tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number
5856@var{num} is not specified, the @code{passcount} command sets the
5857passcount of the most recently defined tracepoint. If no passcount is
5858given, the trace experiment will run until stopped explicitly by the
5859user.
5860
5861Examples:
5862
5863@smallexample
6826cf00
EZ
5864(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 5 2} // Stop on the 5th execution of
5865@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// tracepoint 2}
b37052ae
EZ
5866
5867(@value{GDBP}) @b{passcount 12} // Stop on the 12th execution of the
6826cf00 5868@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// most recently defined tracepoint.}
b37052ae
EZ
5869(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5870(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 3}
5871(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace bar}
5872(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 2}
5873(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace baz}
5874(@value{GDBP}) @b{pass 1} // Stop tracing when foo has been
6826cf00
EZ
5875@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// executed 3 times OR when bar has}
5876@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// been executed 2 times}
5877@exdent @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @ @code{// OR when baz has been executed 1 time.}
b37052ae
EZ
5878@end smallexample
5879@end table
5880
5881@node Tracepoint Actions
5882@subsection Tracepoint Action Lists
5883
5884@table @code
5885@kindex actions
5886@cindex tracepoint actions
5887@item actions @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
5888This command will prompt for a list of actions to be taken when the
5889tracepoint is hit. If the tracepoint number @var{num} is not
5890specified, this command sets the actions for the one that was most
5891recently defined (so that you can define a tracepoint and then say
5892@code{actions} without bothering about its number). You specify the
5893actions themselves on the following lines, one action at a time, and
5894terminate the actions list with a line containing just @code{end}. So
5895far, the only defined actions are @code{collect} and
5896@code{while-stepping}.
5897
5898@cindex remove actions from a tracepoint
5899To remove all actions from a tracepoint, type @samp{actions @var{num}}
5900and follow it immediately with @samp{end}.
5901
5902@smallexample
5903(@value{GDBP}) @b{collect @var{data}} // collect some data
5904
6826cf00 5905(@value{GDBP}) @b{while-stepping 5} // single-step 5 times, collect data
b37052ae 5906
6826cf00 5907(@value{GDBP}) @b{end} // signals the end of actions.
b37052ae
EZ
5908@end smallexample
5909
5910In the following example, the action list begins with @code{collect}
5911commands indicating the things to be collected when the tracepoint is
5912hit. Then, in order to single-step and collect additional data
5913following the tracepoint, a @code{while-stepping} command is used,
5914followed by the list of things to be collected while stepping. The
5915@code{while-stepping} command is terminated by its own separate
5916@code{end} command. Lastly, the action list is terminated by an
5917@code{end} command.
5918
5919@smallexample
5920(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace foo}
5921(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
5922Enter actions for tracepoint 1, one per line:
5923> collect bar,baz
5924> collect $regs
5925> while-stepping 12
5926 > collect $fp, $sp
5927 > end
5928end
5929@end smallexample
5930
5931@kindex collect @r{(tracepoints)}
5932@item collect @var{expr1}, @var{expr2}, @dots{}
5933Collect values of the given expressions when the tracepoint is hit.
5934This command accepts a comma-separated list of any valid expressions.
5935In addition to global, static, or local variables, the following
5936special arguments are supported:
5937
5938@table @code
5939@item $regs
5940collect all registers
5941
5942@item $args
5943collect all function arguments
5944
5945@item $locals
5946collect all local variables.
5947@end table
5948
5949You can give several consecutive @code{collect} commands, each one
5950with a single argument, or one @code{collect} command with several
5951arguments separated by commas: the effect is the same.
5952
f5c37c66
EZ
5953The command @code{info scope} (@pxref{Symbols, info scope}) is
5954particularly useful for figuring out what data to collect.
5955
b37052ae
EZ
5956@kindex while-stepping @r{(tracepoints)}
5957@item while-stepping @var{n}
5958Perform @var{n} single-step traces after the tracepoint, collecting
5959new data at each step. The @code{while-stepping} command is
5960followed by the list of what to collect while stepping (followed by
5961its own @code{end} command):
5962
5963@smallexample
5964> while-stepping 12
5965 > collect $regs, myglobal
5966 > end
5967>
5968@end smallexample
5969
5970@noindent
5971You may abbreviate @code{while-stepping} as @code{ws} or
5972@code{stepping}.
5973@end table
5974
5975@node Listing Tracepoints
5976@subsection Listing Tracepoints
5977
5978@table @code
5979@kindex info tracepoints
5980@cindex information about tracepoints
5981@item info tracepoints @r{[}@var{num}@r{]}
8a037dd7 5982Display information about the tracepoint @var{num}. If you don't specify
798c8bc6 5983a tracepoint number, displays information about all the tracepoints
b37052ae
EZ
5984defined so far. For each tracepoint, the following information is
5985shown:
5986
5987@itemize @bullet
5988@item
5989its number
5990@item
5991whether it is enabled or disabled
5992@item
5993its address
5994@item
5995its passcount as given by the @code{passcount @var{n}} command
5996@item
5997its step count as given by the @code{while-stepping @var{n}} command
5998@item
5999where in the source files is the tracepoint set
6000@item
6001its action list as given by the @code{actions} command
6002@end itemize
6003
6004@smallexample
6005(@value{GDBP}) @b{info trace}
6006Num Enb Address PassC StepC What
60071 y 0x002117c4 0 0 <gdb_asm>
6826cf00
EZ
60082 y 0x0020dc64 0 0 in g_test at g_test.c:1375
60093 y 0x0020b1f4 0 0 in get_data at ../foo.c:41
b37052ae
EZ
6010(@value{GDBP})
6011@end smallexample
6012
6013@noindent
6014This command can be abbreviated @code{info tp}.
6015@end table
6016
6017@node Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6018@subsection Starting and Stopping Trace Experiment
6019
6020@table @code
6021@kindex tstart
6022@cindex start a new trace experiment
6023@cindex collected data discarded
6024@item tstart
6025This command takes no arguments. It starts the trace experiment, and
6026begins collecting data. This has the side effect of discarding all
6027the data collected in the trace buffer during the previous trace
6028experiment.
6029
6030@kindex tstop
6031@cindex stop a running trace experiment
6032@item tstop
6033This command takes no arguments. It ends the trace experiment, and
6034stops collecting data.
6035
6036@strong{Note:} a trace experiment and data collection may stop
6037automatically if any tracepoint's passcount is reached
6038(@pxref{Tracepoint Passcounts}), or if the trace buffer becomes full.
6039
6040@kindex tstatus
6041@cindex status of trace data collection
6042@cindex trace experiment, status of
6043@item tstatus
6044This command displays the status of the current trace data
6045collection.
6046@end table
6047
6048Here is an example of the commands we described so far:
6049
6050@smallexample
6051(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace gdb_c_test}
6052(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6053Enter actions for tracepoint #1, one per line.
6054> collect $regs,$locals,$args
6055> while-stepping 11
6056 > collect $regs
6057 > end
6058> end
6059(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6060 [time passes @dots{}]
6061(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstop}
6062@end smallexample
6063
6064
6065@node Analyze Collected Data
6066@section Using the collected data
6067
6068After the tracepoint experiment ends, you use @value{GDBN} commands
6069for examining the trace data. The basic idea is that each tracepoint
6070collects a trace @dfn{snapshot} every time it is hit and another
6071snapshot every time it single-steps. All these snapshots are
6072consecutively numbered from zero and go into a buffer, and you can
6073examine them later. The way you examine them is to @dfn{focus} on a
6074specific trace snapshot. When the remote stub is focused on a trace
6075snapshot, it will respond to all @value{GDBN} requests for memory and
6076registers by reading from the buffer which belongs to that snapshot,
6077rather than from @emph{real} memory or registers of the program being
6078debugged. This means that @strong{all} @value{GDBN} commands
6079(@code{print}, @code{info registers}, @code{backtrace}, etc.) will
6080behave as if we were currently debugging the program state as it was
6081when the tracepoint occurred. Any requests for data that are not in
6082the buffer will fail.
6083
6084@menu
6085* tfind:: How to select a trace snapshot
6086* tdump:: How to display all data for a snapshot
6087* save-tracepoints:: How to save tracepoints for a future run
6088@end menu
6089
6090@node tfind
6091@subsection @code{tfind @var{n}}
6092
6093@kindex tfind
6094@cindex select trace snapshot
6095@cindex find trace snapshot
6096The basic command for selecting a trace snapshot from the buffer is
6097@code{tfind @var{n}}, which finds trace snapshot number @var{n},
6098counting from zero. If no argument @var{n} is given, the next
6099snapshot is selected.
6100
6101Here are the various forms of using the @code{tfind} command.
6102
6103@table @code
6104@item tfind start
6105Find the first snapshot in the buffer. This is a synonym for
6106@code{tfind 0} (since 0 is the number of the first snapshot).
6107
6108@item tfind none
6109Stop debugging trace snapshots, resume @emph{live} debugging.
6110
6111@item tfind end
6112Same as @samp{tfind none}.
6113
6114@item tfind
6115No argument means find the next trace snapshot.
6116
6117@item tfind -
6118Find the previous trace snapshot before the current one. This permits
6119retracing earlier steps.
6120
6121@item tfind tracepoint @var{num}
6122Find the next snapshot associated with tracepoint @var{num}. Search
6123proceeds forward from the last examined trace snapshot. If no
6124argument @var{num} is given, it means find the next snapshot collected
6125for the same tracepoint as the current snapshot.
6126
6127@item tfind pc @var{addr}
6128Find the next snapshot associated with the value @var{addr} of the
6129program counter. Search proceeds forward from the last examined trace
6130snapshot. If no argument @var{addr} is given, it means find the next
6131snapshot with the same value of PC as the current snapshot.
6132
6133@item tfind outside @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6134Find the next snapshot whose PC is outside the given range of
6135addresses.
6136
6137@item tfind range @var{addr1}, @var{addr2}
6138Find the next snapshot whose PC is between @var{addr1} and
6139@var{addr2}. @c FIXME: Is the range inclusive or exclusive?
6140
6141@item tfind line @r{[}@var{file}:@r{]}@var{n}
6142Find the next snapshot associated with the source line @var{n}. If
6143the optional argument @var{file} is given, refer to line @var{n} in
6144that source file. Search proceeds forward from the last examined
6145trace snapshot. If no argument @var{n} is given, it means find the
6146next line other than the one currently being examined; thus saying
6147@code{tfind line} repeatedly can appear to have the same effect as
6148stepping from line to line in a @emph{live} debugging session.
6149@end table
6150
6151The default arguments for the @code{tfind} commands are specifically
6152designed to make it easy to scan through the trace buffer. For
6153instance, @code{tfind} with no argument selects the next trace
6154snapshot, and @code{tfind -} with no argument selects the previous
6155trace snapshot. So, by giving one @code{tfind} command, and then
6156simply hitting @key{RET} repeatedly you can examine all the trace
6157snapshots in order. Or, by saying @code{tfind -} and then hitting
6158@key{RET} repeatedly you can examine the snapshots in reverse order.
6159The @code{tfind line} command with no argument selects the snapshot
6160for the next source line executed. The @code{tfind pc} command with
6161no argument selects the next snapshot with the same program counter
6162(PC) as the current frame. The @code{tfind tracepoint} command with
6163no argument selects the next trace snapshot collected by the same
6164tracepoint as the current one.
6165
6166In addition to letting you scan through the trace buffer manually,
6167these commands make it easy to construct @value{GDBN} scripts that
6168scan through the trace buffer and print out whatever collected data
6169you are interested in. Thus, if we want to examine the PC, FP, and SP
6170registers from each trace frame in the buffer, we can say this:
6171
6172@smallexample
6173(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6174(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6175> printf "Frame %d, PC = %08X, SP = %08X, FP = %08X\n", \
6176 $trace_frame, $pc, $sp, $fp
6177> tfind
6178> end
6179
6180Frame 0, PC = 0020DC64, SP = 0030BF3C, FP = 0030BF44
6181Frame 1, PC = 0020DC6C, SP = 0030BF38, FP = 0030BF44
6182Frame 2, PC = 0020DC70, SP = 0030BF34, FP = 0030BF44
6183Frame 3, PC = 0020DC74, SP = 0030BF30, FP = 0030BF44
6184Frame 4, PC = 0020DC78, SP = 0030BF2C, FP = 0030BF44
6185Frame 5, PC = 0020DC7C, SP = 0030BF28, FP = 0030BF44
6186Frame 6, PC = 0020DC80, SP = 0030BF24, FP = 0030BF44
6187Frame 7, PC = 0020DC84, SP = 0030BF20, FP = 0030BF44
6188Frame 8, PC = 0020DC88, SP = 0030BF1C, FP = 0030BF44
6189Frame 9, PC = 0020DC8E, SP = 0030BF18, FP = 0030BF44
6190Frame 10, PC = 00203F6C, SP = 0030BE3C, FP = 0030BF14
6191@end smallexample
6192
6193Or, if we want to examine the variable @code{X} at each source line in
6194the buffer:
6195
6196@smallexample
6197(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6198(@value{GDBP}) @b{while ($trace_frame != -1)}
6199> printf "Frame %d, X == %d\n", $trace_frame, X
6200> tfind line
6201> end
6202
6203Frame 0, X = 1
6204Frame 7, X = 2
6205Frame 13, X = 255
6206@end smallexample
6207
6208@node tdump
6209@subsection @code{tdump}
6210@kindex tdump
6211@cindex dump all data collected at tracepoint
6212@cindex tracepoint data, display
6213
6214This command takes no arguments. It prints all the data collected at
6215the current trace snapshot.
6216
6217@smallexample
6218(@value{GDBP}) @b{trace 444}
6219(@value{GDBP}) @b{actions}
6220Enter actions for tracepoint #2, one per line:
6221> collect $regs, $locals, $args, gdb_long_test
6222> end
6223
6224(@value{GDBP}) @b{tstart}
6225
6226(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind line 444}
6227#0 gdb_test (p1=0x11, p2=0x22, p3=0x33, p4=0x44, p5=0x55, p6=0x66)
6228at gdb_test.c:444
6229444 printp( "%s: arguments = 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X 0x%X\n", )
6230
6231(@value{GDBP}) @b{tdump}
6232Data collected at tracepoint 2, trace frame 1:
6233d0 0xc4aa0085 -995491707
6234d1 0x18 24
6235d2 0x80 128
6236d3 0x33 51
6237d4 0x71aea3d 119204413
6238d5 0x22 34
6239d6 0xe0 224
6240d7 0x380035 3670069
6241a0 0x19e24a 1696330
6242a1 0x3000668 50333288
6243a2 0x100 256
6244a3 0x322000 3284992
6245a4 0x3000698 50333336
6246a5 0x1ad3cc 1758156
6247fp 0x30bf3c 0x30bf3c
6248sp 0x30bf34 0x30bf34
6249ps 0x0 0
6250pc 0x20b2c8 0x20b2c8
6251fpcontrol 0x0 0
6252fpstatus 0x0 0
6253fpiaddr 0x0 0
6254p = 0x20e5b4 "gdb-test"
6255p1 = (void *) 0x11
6256p2 = (void *) 0x22
6257p3 = (void *) 0x33
6258p4 = (void *) 0x44
6259p5 = (void *) 0x55
6260p6 = (void *) 0x66
6261gdb_long_test = 17 '\021'
6262
6263(@value{GDBP})
6264@end smallexample
6265
6266@node save-tracepoints
6267@subsection @code{save-tracepoints @var{filename}}
6268@kindex save-tracepoints
6269@cindex save tracepoints for future sessions
6270
6271This command saves all current tracepoint definitions together with
6272their actions and passcounts, into a file @file{@var{filename}}
6273suitable for use in a later debugging session. To read the saved
6274tracepoint definitions, use the @code{source} command (@pxref{Command
6275Files}).
6276
6277@node Tracepoint Variables
6278@section Convenience Variables for Tracepoints
6279@cindex tracepoint variables
6280@cindex convenience variables for tracepoints
6281
6282@table @code
6283@vindex $trace_frame
6284@item (int) $trace_frame
6285The current trace snapshot (a.k.a.@: @dfn{frame}) number, or -1 if no
6286snapshot is selected.
6287
6288@vindex $tracepoint
6289@item (int) $tracepoint
6290The tracepoint for the current trace snapshot.
6291
6292@vindex $trace_line
6293@item (int) $trace_line
6294The line number for the current trace snapshot.
6295
6296@vindex $trace_file
6297@item (char []) $trace_file
6298The source file for the current trace snapshot.
6299
6300@vindex $trace_func
6301@item (char []) $trace_func
6302The name of the function containing @code{$tracepoint}.
6303@end table
6304
6305Note: @code{$trace_file} is not suitable for use in @code{printf},
6306use @code{output} instead.
6307
6308Here's a simple example of using these convenience variables for
6309stepping through all the trace snapshots and printing some of their
6310data.
6311
6312@smallexample
6313(@value{GDBP}) @b{tfind start}
6314
6315(@value{GDBP}) @b{while $trace_frame != -1}
6316> output $trace_file
6317> printf ", line %d (tracepoint #%d)\n", $trace_line, $tracepoint
6318> tfind
6319> end
6320@end smallexample
6321
df0cd8c5
JB
6322@node Overlays
6323@chapter Debugging Programs That Use Overlays
6324@cindex overlays
6325
6326If your program is too large to fit completely in your target system's
6327memory, you can sometimes use @dfn{overlays} to work around this
6328problem. @value{GDBN} provides some support for debugging programs that
6329use overlays.
6330
6331@menu
6332* How Overlays Work:: A general explanation of overlays.
6333* Overlay Commands:: Managing overlays in @value{GDBN}.
6334* Automatic Overlay Debugging:: @value{GDBN} can find out which overlays are
6335 mapped by asking the inferior.
6336* Overlay Sample Program:: A sample program using overlays.
6337@end menu
6338
6339@node How Overlays Work
6340@section How Overlays Work
6341@cindex mapped overlays
6342@cindex unmapped overlays
6343@cindex load address, overlay's
6344@cindex mapped address
6345@cindex overlay area
6346
6347Suppose you have a computer whose instruction address space is only 64
6348kilobytes long, but which has much more memory which can be accessed by
6349other means: special instructions, segment registers, or memory
6350management hardware, for example. Suppose further that you want to
6351adapt a program which is larger than 64 kilobytes to run on this system.
6352
6353One solution is to identify modules of your program which are relatively
6354independent, and need not call each other directly; call these modules
6355@dfn{overlays}. Separate the overlays from the main program, and place
6356their machine code in the larger memory. Place your main program in
6357instruction memory, but leave at least enough space there to hold the
6358largest overlay as well.
6359
6360Now, to call a function located in an overlay, you must first copy that
6361overlay's machine code from the large memory into the space set aside
6362for it in the instruction memory, and then jump to its entry point
6363there.
6364
6365@example
6366@group
6367 Data Instruction Larger
6368Address Space Address Space Address Space
6369+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+
6370| | | | | |
6371+-----------+ +-----------+ +-----------+<-- overlay 1
6372| program | | main | | | load address
6373| variables | | program | | overlay 1 |
6374| and heap | | | ,---| |
6375+-----------+ | | | | |
6376| | +-----------+ | +-----------+
6377+-----------+ | | | | |
6378 mapped --->+-----------+ / +-----------+<-- overlay 2
6379 address | overlay | <-' | overlay 2 | load address
6380 | area | <-----| |
6381 | | <---. +-----------+
6382 | | | | |
6383 +-----------+ | | |
6384 | | | +-----------+<-- overlay 3
6385 +-----------+ `--| | load address
6386 | overlay 3 |
6387 | |
6388 +-----------+
6389 | |
6390 +-----------+
6391
6392 To map an overlay, copy its code from the larger address space
6393 to the instruction address space. Since the overlays shown here
6394 all use the same mapped address, only one may be mapped at a time.
6395@end group
6396@end example
6397
6398This diagram shows a system with separate data and instruction address
6399spaces. For a system with a single address space for data and
6400instructions, the diagram would be similar, except that the program
6401variables and heap would share an address space with the main program
6402and the overlay area.
6403
6404An overlay loaded into instruction memory and ready for use is called a
6405@dfn{mapped} overlay; its @dfn{mapped address} is its address in the
6406instruction memory. An overlay not present (or only partially present)
6407in instruction memory is called @dfn{unmapped}; its @dfn{load address}
6408is its address in the larger memory. The mapped address is also called
6409the @dfn{virtual memory address}, or @dfn{VMA}; the load address is also
6410called the @dfn{load memory address}, or @dfn{LMA}.
6411
6412Unfortunately, overlays are not a completely transparent way to adapt a
6413program to limited instruction memory. They introduce a new set of
6414global constraints you must keep in mind as you design your program:
6415
6416@itemize @bullet
6417
6418@item
6419Before calling or returning to a function in an overlay, your program
6420must make sure that overlay is actually mapped. Otherwise, the call or
6421return will transfer control to the right address, but in the wrong
6422overlay, and your program will probably crash.
6423
6424@item
6425If the process of mapping an overlay is expensive on your system, you
6426will need to choose your overlays carefully to minimize their effect on
6427your program's performance.
6428
6429@item
6430The executable file you load onto your system must contain each
6431overlay's instructions, appearing at the overlay's load address, not its
6432mapped address. However, each overlay's instructions must be relocated
6433and its symbols defined as if the overlay were at its mapped address.
6434You can use GNU linker scripts to specify different load and relocation
6435addresses for pieces of your program; see @ref{Overlay Description,,,
6436ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}.
6437
6438@item
6439The procedure for loading executable files onto your system must be able
6440to load their contents into the larger address space as well as the
6441instruction and data spaces.
6442
6443@end itemize
6444
6445The overlay system described above is rather simple, and could be
6446improved in many ways:
6447
6448@itemize @bullet
6449
6450@item
6451If your system has suitable bank switch registers or memory management
6452hardware, you could use those facilities to make an overlay's load area
6453contents simply appear at their mapped address in instruction space.
6454This would probably be faster than copying the overlay to its mapped
6455area in the usual way.
6456
6457@item
6458If your overlays are small enough, you could set aside more than one
6459overlay area, and have more than one overlay mapped at a time.
6460
6461@item
6462You can use overlays to manage data, as well as instructions. In
6463general, data overlays are even less transparent to your design than
6464code overlays: whereas code overlays only require care when you call or
6465return to functions, data overlays require care every time you access
6466the data. Also, if you change the contents of a data overlay, you
6467must copy its contents back out to its load address before you can copy a
6468different data overlay into the same mapped area.
6469
6470@end itemize
6471
6472
6473@node Overlay Commands
6474@section Overlay Commands
6475
6476To use @value{GDBN}'s overlay support, each overlay in your program must
6477correspond to a separate section of the executable file. The section's
6478virtual memory address and load memory address must be the overlay's
6479mapped and load addresses. Identifying overlays with sections allows
6480@value{GDBN} to determine the appropriate address of a function or
6481variable, depending on whether the overlay is mapped or not.
6482
6483@value{GDBN}'s overlay commands all start with the word @code{overlay};
6484you can abbreviate this as @code{ov} or @code{ovly}. The commands are:
6485
6486@table @code
6487@item overlay off
6488@kindex overlay off
6489Disable @value{GDBN}'s overlay support. When overlay support is
6490disabled, @value{GDBN} assumes that all functions and variables are
6491always present at their mapped addresses. By default, @value{GDBN}'s
6492overlay support is disabled.
6493
6494@item overlay manual
6495@kindex overlay manual
6496@cindex manual overlay debugging
6497Enable @dfn{manual} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6498relies on you to tell it which overlays are mapped, and which are not,
6499using the @code{overlay map-overlay} and @code{overlay unmap-overlay}
6500commands described below.
6501
6502@item overlay map-overlay @var{overlay}
6503@itemx overlay map @var{overlay}
6504@kindex overlay map-overlay
6505@cindex map an overlay
6506Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is now mapped; @var{overlay} must
6507be the name of the object file section containing the overlay. When an
6508overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the overlay's
6509functions and variables at their mapped addresses. @value{GDBN} assumes
6510that any other overlays whose mapped ranges overlap that of
6511@var{overlay} are now unmapped.
6512
6513@item overlay unmap-overlay @var{overlay}
6514@itemx overlay unmap @var{overlay}
6515@kindex overlay unmap-overlay
6516@cindex unmap an overlay
6517Tell @value{GDBN} that @var{overlay} is no longer mapped; @var{overlay}
6518must be the name of the object file section containing the overlay.
6519When an overlay is unmapped, @value{GDBN} assumes it can find the
6520overlay's functions and variables at their load addresses.
6521
6522@item overlay auto
6523@kindex overlay auto
6524Enable @dfn{automatic} overlay debugging. In this mode, @value{GDBN}
6525consults a data structure the overlay manager maintains in the inferior
6526to see which overlays are mapped. For details, see @ref{Automatic
6527Overlay Debugging}.
6528
6529@item overlay load-target
6530@itemx overlay load
6531@kindex overlay load-target
6532@cindex reloading the overlay table
6533Re-read the overlay table from the inferior. Normally, @value{GDBN}
6534re-reads the table @value{GDBN} automatically each time the inferior
6535stops, so this command should only be necessary if you have changed the
6536overlay mapping yourself using @value{GDBN}. This command is only
6537useful when using automatic overlay debugging.
6538
6539@item overlay list-overlays
6540@itemx overlay list
6541@cindex listing mapped overlays
6542Display a list of the overlays currently mapped, along with their mapped
6543addresses, load addresses, and sizes.
6544
6545@end table
6546
6547Normally, when @value{GDBN} prints a code address, it includes the name
6548of the function the address falls in:
6549
6550@example
6551(gdb) print main
6552$3 = @{int ()@} 0x11a0 <main>
6553@end example
6554@noindent
6555When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} recognizes code in
6556unmapped overlays, and prints the names of unmapped functions with
6557asterisks around them. For example, if @code{foo} is a function in an
6558unmapped overlay, @value{GDBN} prints it this way:
6559
6560@example
6561(gdb) overlay list
6562No sections are mapped.
6563(gdb) print foo
6564$5 = @{int (int)@} 0x100000 <*foo*>
6565@end example
6566@noindent
6567When @code{foo}'s overlay is mapped, @value{GDBN} prints the function's
6568name normally:
6569
6570@example
6571(gdb) overlay list
6572Section .ov.foo.text, loaded at 0x100000 - 0x100034,
6573 mapped at 0x1016 - 0x104a
6574(gdb) print foo
6575$6 = @{int (int)@} 0x1016 <foo>
6576@end example
6577
6578When overlay debugging is enabled, @value{GDBN} can find the correct
6579address for functions and variables in an overlay, whether or not the
6580overlay is mapped. This allows most @value{GDBN} commands, like
6581@code{break} and @code{disassemble}, to work normally, even on unmapped
6582code. However, @value{GDBN}'s breakpoint support has some limitations:
6583
6584@itemize @bullet
6585@item
6586@cindex breakpoints in overlays
6587@cindex overlays, setting breakpoints in
6588You can set breakpoints in functions in unmapped overlays, as long as
6589@value{GDBN} can write to the overlay at its load address.
6590@item
6591@value{GDBN} can not set hardware or simulator-based breakpoints in
6592unmapped overlays. However, if you set a breakpoint at the end of your
6593overlay manager (and tell @value{GDBN} which overlays are now mapped, if
6594you are using manual overlay management), @value{GDBN} will re-set its
6595breakpoints properly.
6596@end itemize
6597
6598
6599@node Automatic Overlay Debugging
6600@section Automatic Overlay Debugging
6601@cindex automatic overlay debugging
6602
6603@value{GDBN} can automatically track which overlays are mapped and which
6604are not, given some simple co-operation from the overlay manager in the
6605inferior. If you enable automatic overlay debugging with the
6606@code{overlay auto} command (@pxref{Overlay Commands}), @value{GDBN}
6607looks in the inferior's memory for certain variables describing the
6608current state of the overlays.
6609
6610Here are the variables your overlay manager must define to support
6611@value{GDBN}'s automatic overlay debugging:
6612
6613@table @asis
6614
6615@item @code{_ovly_table}:
6616This variable must be an array of the following structures:
6617
6618@example
6619struct
6620@{
6621 /* The overlay's mapped address. */
6622 unsigned long vma;
6623
6624 /* The size of the overlay, in bytes. */
6625 unsigned long size;
6626
6627 /* The overlay's load address. */
6628 unsigned long lma;
6629
6630 /* Non-zero if the overlay is currently mapped;
6631 zero otherwise. */
6632 unsigned long mapped;
6633@}
6634@end example
6635
6636@item @code{_novlys}:
6637This variable must be a four-byte signed integer, holding the total
6638number of elements in @code{_ovly_table}.
6639
6640@end table
6641
6642To decide whether a particular overlay is mapped or not, @value{GDBN}
6643looks for an entry in @w{@code{_ovly_table}} whose @code{vma} and
6644@code{lma} members equal the VMA and LMA of the overlay's section in the
6645executable file. When @value{GDBN} finds a matching entry, it consults
6646the entry's @code{mapped} member to determine whether the overlay is
6647currently mapped.
6648
6649
6650@node Overlay Sample Program
6651@section Overlay Sample Program
6652@cindex overlay example program
6653
6654When linking a program which uses overlays, you must place the overlays
6655at their load addresses, while relocating them to run at their mapped
6656addresses. To do this, you must write a linker script (@pxref{Overlay
6657Description,,, ld.info, Using ld: the GNU linker}). Unfortunately,
6658since linker scripts are specific to a particular host system, target
6659architecture, and target memory layout, this manual cannot provide
6660portable sample code demonstrating @value{GDBN}'s overlay support.
6661
6662However, the @value{GDBN} source distribution does contain an overlaid
6663program, with linker scripts for a few systems, as part of its test
6664suite. The program consists of the following files from
6665@file{gdb/testsuite/gdb.base}:
6666
6667@table @file
6668@item overlays.c
6669The main program file.
6670@item ovlymgr.c
6671A simple overlay manager, used by @file{overlays.c}.
6672@item foo.c
6673@itemx bar.c
6674@itemx baz.c
6675@itemx grbx.c
6676Overlay modules, loaded and used by @file{overlays.c}.
6677@item d10v.ld
6678@itemx m32r.ld
6679Linker scripts for linking the test program on the @code{d10v-elf}
6680and @code{m32r-elf} targets.
6681@end table
6682
6683You can build the test program using the @code{d10v-elf} GCC
6684cross-compiler like this:
6685
6686@example
6687$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c overlays.c
6688$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c ovlymgr.c
6689$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c foo.c
6690$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c bar.c
6691$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c baz.c
6692$ d10v-elf-gcc -g -c grbx.c
6693$ d10v-elf-gcc -g overlays.o ovlymgr.o foo.o bar.o \
6694 baz.o grbx.o -Wl,-Td10v.ld -o overlays
6695@end example
6696
6697The build process is identical for any other architecture, except that
6698you must substitute the appropriate compiler and linker script for the
6699target system for @code{d10v-elf-gcc} and @code{d10v.ld}.
6700
6701
6d2ebf8b 6702@node Languages
c906108c
SS
6703@chapter Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages
6704@cindex languages
6705
c906108c
SS
6706Although programming languages generally have common aspects, they are
6707rarely expressed in the same manner. For instance, in ANSI C,
6708dereferencing a pointer @code{p} is accomplished by @code{*p}, but in
6709Modula-2, it is accomplished by @code{p^}. Values can also be
5d161b24 6710represented (and displayed) differently. Hex numbers in C appear as
c906108c 6711@samp{0x1ae}, while in Modula-2 they appear as @samp{1AEH}.
c906108c
SS
6712
6713@cindex working language
6714Language-specific information is built into @value{GDBN} for some languages,
6715allowing you to express operations like the above in your program's
6716native language, and allowing @value{GDBN} to output values in a manner
6717consistent with the syntax of your program's native language. The
6718language you use to build expressions is called the @dfn{working
6719language}.
6720
6721@menu
6722* Setting:: Switching between source languages
6723* Show:: Displaying the language
c906108c 6724* Checks:: Type and range checks
c906108c
SS
6725* Support:: Supported languages
6726@end menu
6727
6d2ebf8b 6728@node Setting
c906108c
SS
6729@section Switching between source languages
6730
6731There are two ways to control the working language---either have @value{GDBN}
6732set it automatically, or select it manually yourself. You can use the
6733@code{set language} command for either purpose. On startup, @value{GDBN}
6734defaults to setting the language automatically. The working language is
6735used to determine how expressions you type are interpreted, how values
6736are printed, etc.
6737
6738In addition to the working language, every source file that
6739@value{GDBN} knows about has its own working language. For some object
6740file formats, the compiler might indicate which language a particular
6741source file is in. However, most of the time @value{GDBN} infers the
6742language from the name of the file. The language of a source file
b37052ae 6743controls whether C@t{++} names are demangled---this way @code{backtrace} can
c906108c 6744show each frame appropriately for its own language. There is no way to
d4f3574e
SS
6745set the language of a source file from within @value{GDBN}, but you can
6746set the language associated with a filename extension. @xref{Show, ,
6747Displaying the language}.
c906108c
SS
6748
6749This is most commonly a problem when you use a program, such
5d161b24 6750as @code{cfront} or @code{f2c}, that generates C but is written in
c906108c
SS
6751another language. In that case, make the
6752program use @code{#line} directives in its C output; that way
6753@value{GDBN} will know the correct language of the source code of the original
6754program, and will display that source code, not the generated C code.
6755
6756@menu
6757* Filenames:: Filename extensions and languages.
6758* Manually:: Setting the working language manually
6759* Automatically:: Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6760@end menu
6761
6d2ebf8b 6762@node Filenames
c906108c
SS
6763@subsection List of filename extensions and languages
6764
6765If a source file name ends in one of the following extensions, then
6766@value{GDBN} infers that its language is the one indicated.
6767
6768@table @file
6769
6770@item .c
6771C source file
6772
6773@item .C
6774@itemx .cc
6775@itemx .cp
6776@itemx .cpp
6777@itemx .cxx
6778@itemx .c++
b37052ae 6779C@t{++} source file
c906108c
SS
6780
6781@item .f
6782@itemx .F
6783Fortran source file
6784
c906108c
SS
6785@item .ch
6786@itemx .c186
6787@itemx .c286
96a2c332 6788CHILL source file
c906108c 6789
c906108c
SS
6790@item .mod
6791Modula-2 source file
c906108c
SS
6792
6793@item .s
6794@itemx .S
6795Assembler source file. This actually behaves almost like C, but
6796@value{GDBN} does not skip over function prologues when stepping.
6797@end table
6798
6799In addition, you may set the language associated with a filename
6800extension. @xref{Show, , Displaying the language}.
6801
6d2ebf8b 6802@node Manually
c906108c
SS
6803@subsection Setting the working language
6804
6805If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically,
6806expressions are interpreted the same way in your debugging session and
6807your program.
6808
6809@kindex set language
6810If you wish, you may set the language manually. To do this, issue the
6811command @samp{set language @var{lang}}, where @var{lang} is the name of
5d161b24 6812a language, such as
c906108c 6813@code{c} or @code{modula-2}.
c906108c
SS
6814For a list of the supported languages, type @samp{set language}.
6815
c906108c
SS
6816Setting the language manually prevents @value{GDBN} from updating the working
6817language automatically. This can lead to confusion if you try
6818to debug a program when the working language is not the same as the
6819source language, when an expression is acceptable to both
6820languages---but means different things. For instance, if the current
6821source file were written in C, and @value{GDBN} was parsing Modula-2, a
6822command such as:
6823
6824@example
6825print a = b + c
6826@end example
6827
6828@noindent
6829might not have the effect you intended. In C, this means to add
6830@code{b} and @code{c} and place the result in @code{a}. The result
6831printed would be the value of @code{a}. In Modula-2, this means to compare
6832@code{a} to the result of @code{b+c}, yielding a @code{BOOLEAN} value.
c906108c 6833
6d2ebf8b 6834@node Automatically
c906108c
SS
6835@subsection Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language
6836
6837To have @value{GDBN} set the working language automatically, use
6838@samp{set language local} or @samp{set language auto}. @value{GDBN}
6839then infers the working language. That is, when your program stops in a
6840frame (usually by encountering a breakpoint), @value{GDBN} sets the
6841working language to the language recorded for the function in that
6842frame. If the language for a frame is unknown (that is, if the function
6843or block corresponding to the frame was defined in a source file that
6844does not have a recognized extension), the current working language is
6845not changed, and @value{GDBN} issues a warning.
6846
6847This may not seem necessary for most programs, which are written
6848entirely in one source language. However, program modules and libraries
6849written in one source language can be used by a main program written in
6850a different source language. Using @samp{set language auto} in this
6851case frees you from having to set the working language manually.
6852
6d2ebf8b 6853@node Show
c906108c 6854@section Displaying the language
c906108c
SS
6855
6856The following commands help you find out which language is the
6857working language, and also what language source files were written in.
6858
6859@kindex show language
d4f3574e
SS
6860@kindex info frame@r{, show the source language}
6861@kindex info source@r{, show the source language}
c906108c
SS
6862@table @code
6863@item show language
6864Display the current working language. This is the
6865language you can use with commands such as @code{print} to
6866build and compute expressions that may involve variables in your program.
6867
6868@item info frame
5d161b24 6869Display the source language for this frame. This language becomes the
c906108c 6870working language if you use an identifier from this frame.
5d161b24 6871@xref{Frame Info, ,Information about a frame}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6872information listed here.
6873
6874@item info source
6875Display the source language of this source file.
5d161b24 6876@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}, to identify the other
c906108c
SS
6877information listed here.
6878@end table
6879
6880In unusual circumstances, you may have source files with extensions
6881not in the standard list. You can then set the extension associated
6882with a language explicitly:
6883
6884@kindex set extension-language
6885@kindex info extensions
6886@table @code
6887@item set extension-language @var{.ext} @var{language}
6888Set source files with extension @var{.ext} to be assumed to be in
6889the source language @var{language}.
6890
6891@item info extensions
6892List all the filename extensions and the associated languages.
6893@end table
6894
6d2ebf8b 6895@node Checks
c906108c
SS
6896@section Type and range checking
6897
6898@quotation
6899@emph{Warning:} In this release, the @value{GDBN} commands for type and range
6900checking are included, but they do not yet have any effect. This
6901section documents the intended facilities.
6902@end quotation
6903@c FIXME remove warning when type/range code added
6904
6905Some languages are designed to guard you against making seemingly common
6906errors through a series of compile- and run-time checks. These include
6907checking the type of arguments to functions and operators, and making
6908sure mathematical overflows are caught at run time. Checks such as
6909these help to ensure a program's correctness once it has been compiled
6910by eliminating type mismatches, and providing active checks for range
6911errors when your program is running.
6912
6913@value{GDBN} can check for conditions like the above if you wish.
6914Although @value{GDBN} does not check the statements in your program, it
6915can check expressions entered directly into @value{GDBN} for evaluation via
6916the @code{print} command, for example. As with the working language,
6917@value{GDBN} can also decide whether or not to check automatically based on
6918your program's source language. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages},
6919for the default settings of supported languages.
6920
6921@menu
6922* Type Checking:: An overview of type checking
6923* Range Checking:: An overview of range checking
6924@end menu
6925
6926@cindex type checking
6927@cindex checks, type
6d2ebf8b 6928@node Type Checking
c906108c
SS
6929@subsection An overview of type checking
6930
6931Some languages, such as Modula-2, are strongly typed, meaning that the
6932arguments to operators and functions have to be of the correct type,
6933otherwise an error occurs. These checks prevent type mismatch
6934errors from ever causing any run-time problems. For example,
6935
6936@smallexample
69371 + 2 @result{} 3
6938@exdent but
6939@error{} 1 + 2.3
6940@end smallexample
6941
6942The second example fails because the @code{CARDINAL} 1 is not
6943type-compatible with the @code{REAL} 2.3.
6944
5d161b24
DB
6945For the expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell the
6946@value{GDBN} type checker to skip checking;
6947to treat any mismatches as errors and abandon the expression;
6948or to only issue warnings when type mismatches occur,
c906108c
SS
6949but evaluate the expression anyway. When you choose the last of
6950these, @value{GDBN} evaluates expressions like the second example above, but
6951also issues a warning.
6952
5d161b24
DB
6953Even if you turn type checking off, there may be other reasons
6954related to type that prevent @value{GDBN} from evaluating an expression.
6955For instance, @value{GDBN} does not know how to add an @code{int} and
6956a @code{struct foo}. These particular type errors have nothing to do
6957with the language in use, and usually arise from expressions, such as
c906108c
SS
6958the one described above, which make little sense to evaluate anyway.
6959
6960Each language defines to what degree it is strict about type. For
6961instance, both Modula-2 and C require the arguments to arithmetical
6962operators to be numbers. In C, enumerated types and pointers can be
6963represented as numbers, so that they are valid arguments to mathematical
6964operators. @xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for further
6965details on specific languages.
6966
6967@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the type checker:
6968
d4f3574e 6969@kindex set check@r{, type}
c906108c
SS
6970@kindex set check type
6971@kindex show check type
6972@table @code
6973@item set check type auto
6974Set type checking on or off based on the current working language.
6975@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
6976each language.
6977
6978@item set check type on
6979@itemx set check type off
6980Set type checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
6981current working language. Issue a warning if the setting does not
6982match the language default. If any type mismatches occur in
d4f3574e 6983evaluating an expression while type checking is on, @value{GDBN} prints a
c906108c
SS
6984message and aborts evaluation of the expression.
6985
6986@item set check type warn
6987Cause the type checker to issue warnings, but to always attempt to
6988evaluate the expression. Evaluating the expression may still
6989be impossible for other reasons. For example, @value{GDBN} cannot add
6990numbers and structures.
6991
6992@item show type
5d161b24 6993Show the current setting of the type checker, and whether or not @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
6994is setting it automatically.
6995@end table
6996
6997@cindex range checking
6998@cindex checks, range
6d2ebf8b 6999@node Range Checking
c906108c
SS
7000@subsection An overview of range checking
7001
7002In some languages (such as Modula-2), it is an error to exceed the
7003bounds of a type; this is enforced with run-time checks. Such range
7004checking is meant to ensure program correctness by making sure
7005computations do not overflow, or indices on an array element access do
7006not exceed the bounds of the array.
7007
7008For expressions you use in @value{GDBN} commands, you can tell
7009@value{GDBN} to treat range errors in one of three ways: ignore them,
7010always treat them as errors and abandon the expression, or issue
7011warnings but evaluate the expression anyway.
7012
7013A range error can result from numerical overflow, from exceeding an
7014array index bound, or when you type a constant that is not a member
7015of any type. Some languages, however, do not treat overflows as an
7016error. In many implementations of C, mathematical overflow causes the
7017result to ``wrap around'' to lower values---for example, if @var{m} is
7018the largest integer value, and @var{s} is the smallest, then
7019
7020@example
7021@var{m} + 1 @result{} @var{s}
7022@end example
7023
7024This, too, is specific to individual languages, and in some cases
7025specific to individual compilers or machines. @xref{Support, ,
7026Supported languages}, for further details on specific languages.
7027
7028@value{GDBN} provides some additional commands for controlling the range checker:
7029
d4f3574e 7030@kindex set check@r{, range}
c906108c
SS
7031@kindex set check range
7032@kindex show check range
7033@table @code
7034@item set check range auto
7035Set range checking on or off based on the current working language.
7036@xref{Support, ,Supported languages}, for the default settings for
7037each language.
7038
7039@item set check range on
7040@itemx set check range off
7041Set range checking on or off, overriding the default setting for the
7042current working language. A warning is issued if the setting does not
c3f6f71d
JM
7043match the language default. If a range error occurs and range checking is on,
7044then a message is printed and evaluation of the expression is aborted.
c906108c
SS
7045
7046@item set check range warn
7047Output messages when the @value{GDBN} range checker detects a range error,
7048but attempt to evaluate the expression anyway. Evaluating the
7049expression may still be impossible for other reasons, such as accessing
7050memory that the process does not own (a typical example from many Unix
7051systems).
7052
7053@item show range
7054Show the current setting of the range checker, and whether or not it is
7055being set automatically by @value{GDBN}.
7056@end table
c906108c 7057
6d2ebf8b 7058@node Support
c906108c 7059@section Supported languages
c906108c 7060
b37052ae 7061@value{GDBN} supports C, C@t{++}, Fortran, Java, Chill, assembly, and Modula-2.
cce74817 7062@c This is false ...
c906108c
SS
7063Some @value{GDBN} features may be used in expressions regardless of the
7064language you use: the @value{GDBN} @code{@@} and @code{::} operators,
7065and the @samp{@{type@}addr} construct (@pxref{Expressions,
7066,Expressions}) can be used with the constructs of any supported
7067language.
7068
7069The following sections detail to what degree each source language is
7070supported by @value{GDBN}. These sections are not meant to be language
7071tutorials or references, but serve only as a reference guide to what the
7072@value{GDBN} expression parser accepts, and what input and output
7073formats should look like for different languages. There are many good
7074books written on each of these languages; please look to these for a
7075language reference or tutorial.
7076
c906108c 7077@menu
b37052ae 7078* C:: C and C@t{++}
cce74817 7079* Modula-2:: Modula-2
104c1213 7080* Chill:: Chill
c906108c
SS
7081@end menu
7082
6d2ebf8b 7083@node C
b37052ae 7084@subsection C and C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7085
b37052ae
EZ
7086@cindex C and C@t{++}
7087@cindex expressions in C or C@t{++}
c906108c 7088
b37052ae 7089Since C and C@t{++} are so closely related, many features of @value{GDBN} apply
c906108c
SS
7090to both languages. Whenever this is the case, we discuss those languages
7091together.
7092
41afff9a
EZ
7093@cindex C@t{++}
7094@cindex @code{g++}, @sc{gnu} C@t{++} compiler
b37052ae
EZ
7095@cindex @sc{gnu} C@t{++}
7096The C@t{++} debugging facilities are jointly implemented by the C@t{++}
7097compiler and @value{GDBN}. Therefore, to debug your C@t{++} code
7098effectively, you must compile your C@t{++} programs with a supported
7099C@t{++} compiler, such as @sc{gnu} @code{g++}, or the HP ANSI C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7100compiler (@code{aCC}).
7101
b37052ae 7102For best results when using @sc{gnu} C@t{++}, use the stabs debugging
c906108c
SS
7103format. You can select that format explicitly with the @code{g++}
7104command-line options @samp{-gstabs} or @samp{-gstabs+}. See
7105@ref{Debugging Options,,Options for Debugging Your Program or @sc{gnu}
7106CC, gcc.info, Using @sc{gnu} CC}, for more information.
c906108c 7107
c906108c 7108@menu
b37052ae
EZ
7109* C Operators:: C and C@t{++} operators
7110* C Constants:: C and C@t{++} constants
7111* C plus plus expressions:: C@t{++} expressions
7112* C Defaults:: Default settings for C and C@t{++}
7113* C Checks:: C and C@t{++} type and range checks
c906108c 7114* Debugging C:: @value{GDBN} and C
b37052ae 7115* Debugging C plus plus:: @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7116@end menu
c906108c 7117
6d2ebf8b 7118@node C Operators
b37052ae 7119@subsubsection C and C@t{++} operators
7a292a7a 7120
b37052ae 7121@cindex C and C@t{++} operators
c906108c
SS
7122
7123Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7124@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
5d161b24 7125often defined on groups of types.
c906108c 7126
b37052ae 7127For the purposes of C and C@t{++}, the following definitions hold:
c906108c
SS
7128
7129@itemize @bullet
53a5351d 7130
c906108c 7131@item
c906108c 7132@emph{Integral types} include @code{int} with any of its storage-class
b37052ae 7133specifiers; @code{char}; @code{enum}; and, for C@t{++}, @code{bool}.
c906108c
SS
7134
7135@item
d4f3574e
SS
7136@emph{Floating-point types} include @code{float}, @code{double}, and
7137@code{long double} (if supported by the target platform).
c906108c
SS
7138
7139@item
53a5351d 7140@emph{Pointer types} include all types defined as @code{(@var{type} *)}.
c906108c
SS
7141
7142@item
7143@emph{Scalar types} include all of the above.
53a5351d 7144
c906108c
SS
7145@end itemize
7146
7147@noindent
7148The following operators are supported. They are listed here
7149in order of increasing precedence:
7150
7151@table @code
7152@item ,
7153The comma or sequencing operator. Expressions in a comma-separated list
7154are evaluated from left to right, with the result of the entire
7155expression being the last expression evaluated.
7156
7157@item =
7158Assignment. The value of an assignment expression is the value
7159assigned. Defined on scalar types.
7160
7161@item @var{op}=
7162Used in an expression of the form @w{@code{@var{a} @var{op}= @var{b}}},
7163and translated to @w{@code{@var{a} = @var{a op b}}}.
d4f3574e 7164@w{@code{@var{op}=}} and @code{=} have the same precedence.
c906108c
SS
7165@var{op} is any one of the operators @code{|}, @code{^}, @code{&},
7166@code{<<}, @code{>>}, @code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{%}.
7167
7168@item ?:
7169The ternary operator. @code{@var{a} ? @var{b} : @var{c}} can be thought
7170of as: if @var{a} then @var{b} else @var{c}. @var{a} should be of an
7171integral type.
7172
7173@item ||
7174Logical @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7175
7176@item &&
7177Logical @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7178
7179@item |
7180Bitwise @sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7181
7182@item ^
7183Bitwise exclusive-@sc{or}. Defined on integral types.
7184
7185@item &
7186Bitwise @sc{and}. Defined on integral types.
7187
7188@item ==@r{, }!=
7189Equality and inequality. Defined on scalar types. The value of these
7190expressions is 0 for false and non-zero for true.
7191
7192@item <@r{, }>@r{, }<=@r{, }>=
7193Less than, greater than, less than or equal, greater than or equal.
7194Defined on scalar types. The value of these expressions is 0 for false
7195and non-zero for true.
7196
7197@item <<@r{, }>>
7198left shift, and right shift. Defined on integral types.
7199
7200@item @@
7201The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7202
7203@item +@r{, }-
7204Addition and subtraction. Defined on integral types, floating-point types and
7205pointer types.
7206
7207@item *@r{, }/@r{, }%
7208Multiplication, division, and modulus. Multiplication and division are
7209defined on integral and floating-point types. Modulus is defined on
7210integral types.
7211
7212@item ++@r{, }--
7213Increment and decrement. When appearing before a variable, the
7214operation is performed before the variable is used in an expression;
7215when appearing after it, the variable's value is used before the
7216operation takes place.
7217
7218@item *
7219Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types. Same precedence as
7220@code{++}.
7221
7222@item &
7223Address operator. Defined on variables. Same precedence as @code{++}.
7224
b37052ae
EZ
7225For debugging C@t{++}, @value{GDBN} implements a use of @samp{&} beyond what is
7226allowed in the C@t{++} language itself: you can use @samp{&(&@var{ref})}
c906108c 7227(or, if you prefer, simply @samp{&&@var{ref}}) to examine the address
b37052ae 7228where a C@t{++} reference variable (declared with @samp{&@var{ref}}) is
c906108c 7229stored.
c906108c
SS
7230
7231@item -
7232Negative. Defined on integral and floating-point types. Same
7233precedence as @code{++}.
7234
7235@item !
7236Logical negation. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7237@code{++}.
7238
7239@item ~
7240Bitwise complement operator. Defined on integral types. Same precedence as
7241@code{++}.
7242
7243
7244@item .@r{, }->
7245Structure member, and pointer-to-structure member. For convenience,
7246@value{GDBN} regards the two as equivalent, choosing whether to dereference a
7247pointer based on the stored type information.
7248Defined on @code{struct} and @code{union} data.
7249
c906108c
SS
7250@item .*@r{, }->*
7251Dereferences of pointers to members.
c906108c
SS
7252
7253@item []
7254Array indexing. @code{@var{a}[@var{i}]} is defined as
7255@code{*(@var{a}+@var{i})}. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7256
7257@item ()
7258Function parameter list. Same precedence as @code{->}.
7259
c906108c 7260@item ::
b37052ae 7261C@t{++} scope resolution operator. Defined on @code{struct}, @code{union},
7a292a7a 7262and @code{class} types.
c906108c
SS
7263
7264@item ::
7a292a7a
SS
7265Doubled colons also represent the @value{GDBN} scope operator
7266(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). Same precedence as @code{::},
7267above.
c906108c
SS
7268@end table
7269
c906108c
SS
7270If an operator is redefined in the user code, @value{GDBN} usually
7271attempts to invoke the redefined version instead of using the operator's
7272predefined meaning.
c906108c 7273
c906108c 7274@menu
5d161b24 7275* C Constants::
c906108c
SS
7276@end menu
7277
6d2ebf8b 7278@node C Constants
b37052ae 7279@subsubsection C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7280
b37052ae 7281@cindex C and C@t{++} constants
c906108c 7282
b37052ae 7283@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of C and C@t{++} in the
c906108c 7284following ways:
c906108c
SS
7285
7286@itemize @bullet
7287@item
7288Integer constants are a sequence of digits. Octal constants are
7289specified by a leading @samp{0} (i.e. zero), and hexadecimal constants by
7290a leading @samp{0x} or @samp{0X}. Constants may also end with a letter
7291@samp{l}, specifying that the constant should be treated as a
7292@code{long} value.
7293
7294@item
7295Floating point constants are a sequence of digits, followed by a decimal
7296point, followed by a sequence of digits, and optionally followed by an
7297exponent. An exponent is of the form:
7298@samp{@w{e@r{[[}+@r{]|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}}, where @var{nnn} is another
7299sequence of digits. The @samp{+} is optional for positive exponents.
d4f3574e
SS
7300A floating-point constant may also end with a letter @samp{f} or
7301@samp{F}, specifying that the constant should be treated as being of
7302the @code{float} (as opposed to the default @code{double}) type; or with
7303a letter @samp{l} or @samp{L}, which specifies a @code{long double}
7304constant.
c906108c
SS
7305
7306@item
7307Enumerated constants consist of enumerated identifiers, or their
7308integral equivalents.
7309
7310@item
7311Character constants are a single character surrounded by single quotes
7312(@code{'}), or a number---the ordinal value of the corresponding character
d4f3574e 7313(usually its @sc{ascii} value). Within quotes, the single character may
c906108c
SS
7314be represented by a letter or by @dfn{escape sequences}, which are of
7315the form @samp{\@var{nnn}}, where @var{nnn} is the octal representation
7316of the character's ordinal value; or of the form @samp{\@var{x}}, where
7317@samp{@var{x}} is a predefined special character---for example,
7318@samp{\n} for newline.
7319
7320@item
96a2c332
SS
7321String constants are a sequence of character constants surrounded by
7322double quotes (@code{"}). Any valid character constant (as described
7323above) may appear. Double quotes within the string must be preceded by
7324a backslash, so for instance @samp{"a\"b'c"} is a string of five
7325characters.
c906108c
SS
7326
7327@item
7328Pointer constants are an integral value. You can also write pointers
7329to constants using the C operator @samp{&}.
7330
7331@item
7332Array constants are comma-separated lists surrounded by braces @samp{@{}
7333and @samp{@}}; for example, @samp{@{1,2,3@}} is a three-element array of
7334integers, @samp{@{@{1,2@}, @{3,4@}, @{5,6@}@}} is a three-by-two array,
7335and @samp{@{&"hi", &"there", &"fred"@}} is a three-element array of pointers.
7336@end itemize
7337
c906108c 7338@menu
5d161b24
DB
7339* C plus plus expressions::
7340* C Defaults::
7341* C Checks::
c906108c 7342
5d161b24 7343* Debugging C::
c906108c
SS
7344@end menu
7345
6d2ebf8b 7346@node C plus plus expressions
b37052ae
EZ
7347@subsubsection C@t{++} expressions
7348
7349@cindex expressions in C@t{++}
7350@value{GDBN} expression handling can interpret most C@t{++} expressions.
7351
7352@cindex C@t{++} support, not in @sc{coff}
7353@cindex @sc{coff} versus C@t{++}
7354@cindex C@t{++} and object formats
7355@cindex object formats and C@t{++}
7356@cindex a.out and C@t{++}
7357@cindex @sc{ecoff} and C@t{++}
7358@cindex @sc{xcoff} and C@t{++}
7359@cindex @sc{elf}/stabs and C@t{++}
7360@cindex @sc{elf}/@sc{dwarf} and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7361@c FIXME!! GDB may eventually be able to debug C++ using DWARF; check
7362@c periodically whether this has happened...
7363@quotation
b37052ae
EZ
7364@emph{Warning:} @value{GDBN} can only debug C@t{++} code if you use the
7365proper compiler. Typically, C@t{++} debugging depends on the use of
c906108c
SS
7366additional debugging information in the symbol table, and thus requires
7367special support. In particular, if your compiler generates a.out, MIPS
7368@sc{ecoff}, RS/6000 @sc{xcoff}, or @sc{elf} with stabs extensions to the
7369symbol table, these facilities are all available. (With @sc{gnu} CC,
7370you can use the @samp{-gstabs} option to request stabs debugging
7371extensions explicitly.) Where the object code format is standard
b37052ae 7372@sc{coff} or @sc{dwarf} in @sc{elf}, on the other hand, most of the C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7373support in @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} work.
7374@end quotation
c906108c
SS
7375
7376@enumerate
7377
7378@cindex member functions
7379@item
7380Member function calls are allowed; you can use expressions like
7381
7382@example
7383count = aml->GetOriginal(x, y)
7384@end example
7385
41afff9a 7386@vindex this@r{, inside C@t{++} member functions}
b37052ae 7387@cindex namespace in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7388@item
7389While a member function is active (in the selected stack frame), your
7390expressions have the same namespace available as the member function;
7391that is, @value{GDBN} allows implicit references to the class instance
b37052ae 7392pointer @code{this} following the same rules as C@t{++}.
c906108c 7393
c906108c 7394@cindex call overloaded functions
d4f3574e 7395@cindex overloaded functions, calling
b37052ae 7396@cindex type conversions in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7397@item
7398You can call overloaded functions; @value{GDBN} resolves the function
d4f3574e 7399call to the right definition, with some restrictions. @value{GDBN} does not
c906108c
SS
7400perform overload resolution involving user-defined type conversions,
7401calls to constructors, or instantiations of templates that do not exist
7402in the program. It also cannot handle ellipsis argument lists or
7403default arguments.
7404
7405It does perform integral conversions and promotions, floating-point
7406promotions, arithmetic conversions, pointer conversions, conversions of
7407class objects to base classes, and standard conversions such as those of
7408functions or arrays to pointers; it requires an exact match on the
7409number of function arguments.
7410
7411Overload resolution is always performed, unless you have specified
7412@code{set overload-resolution off}. @xref{Debugging C plus plus,
b37052ae 7413,@value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}}.
c906108c 7414
d4f3574e 7415You must specify @code{set overload-resolution off} in order to use an
c906108c
SS
7416explicit function signature to call an overloaded function, as in
7417@smallexample
7418p 'foo(char,int)'('x', 13)
7419@end smallexample
d4f3574e 7420
c906108c 7421The @value{GDBN} command-completion facility can simplify this;
d4f3574e 7422see @ref{Completion, ,Command completion}.
c906108c 7423
c906108c
SS
7424@cindex reference declarations
7425@item
b37052ae
EZ
7426@value{GDBN} understands variables declared as C@t{++} references; you can use
7427them in expressions just as you do in C@t{++} source---they are automatically
c906108c
SS
7428dereferenced.
7429
7430In the parameter list shown when @value{GDBN} displays a frame, the values of
7431reference variables are not displayed (unlike other variables); this
7432avoids clutter, since references are often used for large structures.
7433The @emph{address} of a reference variable is always shown, unless
7434you have specified @samp{set print address off}.
7435
7436@item
b37052ae 7437@value{GDBN} supports the C@t{++} name resolution operator @code{::}---your
c906108c
SS
7438expressions can use it just as expressions in your program do. Since
7439one scope may be defined in another, you can use @code{::} repeatedly if
7440necessary, for example in an expression like
7441@samp{@var{scope1}::@var{scope2}::@var{name}}. @value{GDBN} also allows
b37052ae 7442resolving name scope by reference to source files, in both C and C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7443debugging (@pxref{Variables, ,Program variables}).
7444@end enumerate
7445
b37052ae 7446In addition, when used with HP's C@t{++} compiler, @value{GDBN} supports
53a5351d
JM
7447calling virtual functions correctly, printing out virtual bases of
7448objects, calling functions in a base subobject, casting objects, and
7449invoking user-defined operators.
c906108c 7450
6d2ebf8b 7451@node C Defaults
b37052ae 7452@subsubsection C and C@t{++} defaults
7a292a7a 7453
b37052ae 7454@cindex C and C@t{++} defaults
c906108c 7455
c906108c
SS
7456If you allow @value{GDBN} to set type and range checking automatically, they
7457both default to @code{off} whenever the working language changes to
b37052ae 7458C or C@t{++}. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c 7459selects the working language.
c906108c
SS
7460
7461If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, it
7462recognizes source files whose names end with @file{.c}, @file{.C}, or
7463@file{.cc}, etc, and when @value{GDBN} enters code compiled from one of
b37052ae 7464these files, it sets the working language to C or C@t{++}.
c906108c
SS
7465@xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} infer the source language},
7466for further details.
7467
c906108c
SS
7468@c Type checking is (a) primarily motivated by Modula-2, and (b)
7469@c unimplemented. If (b) changes, it might make sense to let this node
7470@c appear even if Mod-2 does not, but meanwhile ignore it. roland 16jul93.
7a292a7a 7471
6d2ebf8b 7472@node C Checks
b37052ae 7473@subsubsection C and C@t{++} type and range checks
7a292a7a 7474
b37052ae 7475@cindex C and C@t{++} checks
c906108c 7476
b37052ae 7477By default, when @value{GDBN} parses C or C@t{++} expressions, type checking
c906108c
SS
7478is not used. However, if you turn type checking on, @value{GDBN}
7479considers two variables type equivalent if:
7480
7481@itemize @bullet
7482@item
7483The two variables are structured and have the same structure, union, or
7484enumerated tag.
7485
7486@item
7487The two variables have the same type name, or types that have been
7488declared equivalent through @code{typedef}.
7489
7490@ignore
7491@c leaving this out because neither J Gilmore nor R Pesch understand it.
7492@c FIXME--beers?
7493@item
7494The two @code{struct}, @code{union}, or @code{enum} variables are
7495declared in the same declaration. (Note: this may not be true for all C
7496compilers.)
7497@end ignore
7498@end itemize
7499
7500Range checking, if turned on, is done on mathematical operations. Array
7501indices are not checked, since they are often used to index a pointer
7502that is not itself an array.
c906108c 7503
6d2ebf8b 7504@node Debugging C
c906108c 7505@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and C
c906108c
SS
7506
7507The @code{set print union} and @code{show print union} commands apply to
7508the @code{union} type. When set to @samp{on}, any @code{union} that is
7a292a7a
SS
7509inside a @code{struct} or @code{class} is also printed. Otherwise, it
7510appears as @samp{@{...@}}.
c906108c
SS
7511
7512The @code{@@} operator aids in the debugging of dynamic arrays, formed
7513with pointers and a memory allocation function. @xref{Expressions,
7514,Expressions}.
7515
c906108c 7516@menu
5d161b24 7517* Debugging C plus plus::
c906108c
SS
7518@end menu
7519
6d2ebf8b 7520@node Debugging C plus plus
b37052ae 7521@subsubsection @value{GDBN} features for C@t{++}
c906108c 7522
b37052ae 7523@cindex commands for C@t{++}
7a292a7a 7524
b37052ae
EZ
7525Some @value{GDBN} commands are particularly useful with C@t{++}, and some are
7526designed specifically for use with C@t{++}. Here is a summary:
c906108c
SS
7527
7528@table @code
7529@cindex break in overloaded functions
7530@item @r{breakpoint menus}
7531When you want a breakpoint in a function whose name is overloaded,
7532@value{GDBN} breakpoint menus help you specify which function definition
7533you want. @xref{Breakpoint Menus,,Breakpoint menus}.
7534
b37052ae 7535@cindex overloading in C@t{++}
c906108c
SS
7536@item rbreak @var{regex}
7537Setting breakpoints using regular expressions is helpful for setting
7538breakpoints on overloaded functions that are not members of any special
7539classes.
7540@xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting breakpoints}.
7541
b37052ae 7542@cindex C@t{++} exception handling
c906108c
SS
7543@item catch throw
7544@itemx catch catch
b37052ae 7545Debug C@t{++} exception handling using these commands. @xref{Set
c906108c
SS
7546Catchpoints, , Setting catchpoints}.
7547
7548@cindex inheritance
7549@item ptype @var{typename}
7550Print inheritance relationships as well as other information for type
7551@var{typename}.
7552@xref{Symbols, ,Examining the Symbol Table}.
7553
b37052ae 7554@cindex C@t{++} symbol display
c906108c
SS
7555@item set print demangle
7556@itemx show print demangle
7557@itemx set print asm-demangle
7558@itemx show print asm-demangle
b37052ae
EZ
7559Control whether C@t{++} symbols display in their source form, both when
7560displaying code as C@t{++} source and when displaying disassemblies.
c906108c
SS
7561@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7562
7563@item set print object
7564@itemx show print object
7565Choose whether to print derived (actual) or declared types of objects.
7566@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
7567
7568@item set print vtbl
7569@itemx show print vtbl
7570Control the format for printing virtual function tables.
7571@xref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}.
c906108c 7572(The @code{vtbl} commands do not work on programs compiled with the HP
b37052ae 7573ANSI C@t{++} compiler (@code{aCC}).)
c906108c
SS
7574
7575@kindex set overload-resolution
d4f3574e 7576@cindex overloaded functions, overload resolution
c906108c 7577@item set overload-resolution on
b37052ae 7578Enable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. The default
c906108c
SS
7579is on. For overloaded functions, @value{GDBN} evaluates the arguments
7580and searches for a function whose signature matches the argument types,
b37052ae 7581using the standard C@t{++} conversion rules (see @ref{C plus plus expressions, ,C@t{++}
d4f3574e 7582expressions}, for details). If it cannot find a match, it emits a
c906108c
SS
7583message.
7584
7585@item set overload-resolution off
b37052ae 7586Disable overload resolution for C@t{++} expression evaluation. For
c906108c
SS
7587overloaded functions that are not class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7588chooses the first function of the specified name that it finds in the
7589symbol table, whether or not its arguments are of the correct type. For
7590overloaded functions that are class member functions, @value{GDBN}
7591searches for a function whose signature @emph{exactly} matches the
7592argument types.
c906108c
SS
7593
7594@item @r{Overloaded symbol names}
7595You can specify a particular definition of an overloaded symbol, using
b37052ae 7596the same notation that is used to declare such symbols in C@t{++}: type
c906108c
SS
7597@code{@var{symbol}(@var{types})} rather than just @var{symbol}. You can
7598also use the @value{GDBN} command-line word completion facilities to list the
7599available choices, or to finish the type list for you.
7600@xref{Completion,, Command completion}, for details on how to do this.
7601@end table
c906108c 7602
6d2ebf8b 7603@node Modula-2
c906108c 7604@subsection Modula-2
7a292a7a 7605
d4f3574e 7606@cindex Modula-2, @value{GDBN} support
c906108c
SS
7607
7608The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Modula-2 only support
7609output from the @sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler (which is currently being
7610developed). Other Modula-2 compilers are not currently supported, and
7611attempting to debug executables produced by them is most likely
7612to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
7613table.
7614
7615@cindex expressions in Modula-2
7616@menu
7617* M2 Operators:: Built-in operators
7618* Built-In Func/Proc:: Built-in functions and procedures
7619* M2 Constants:: Modula-2 constants
7620* M2 Defaults:: Default settings for Modula-2
7621* Deviations:: Deviations from standard Modula-2
7622* M2 Checks:: Modula-2 type and range checks
7623* M2 Scope:: The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7624* GDB/M2:: @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
7625@end menu
7626
6d2ebf8b 7627@node M2 Operators
c906108c
SS
7628@subsubsection Operators
7629@cindex Modula-2 operators
7630
7631Operators must be defined on values of specific types. For instance,
7632@code{+} is defined on numbers, but not on structures. Operators are
7633often defined on groups of types. For the purposes of Modula-2, the
7634following definitions hold:
7635
7636@itemize @bullet
7637
7638@item
7639@emph{Integral types} consist of @code{INTEGER}, @code{CARDINAL}, and
7640their subranges.
7641
7642@item
7643@emph{Character types} consist of @code{CHAR} and its subranges.
7644
7645@item
7646@emph{Floating-point types} consist of @code{REAL}.
7647
7648@item
7649@emph{Pointer types} consist of anything declared as @code{POINTER TO
7650@var{type}}.
7651
7652@item
7653@emph{Scalar types} consist of all of the above.
7654
7655@item
7656@emph{Set types} consist of @code{SET} and @code{BITSET} types.
7657
7658@item
7659@emph{Boolean types} consist of @code{BOOLEAN}.
7660@end itemize
7661
7662@noindent
7663The following operators are supported, and appear in order of
7664increasing precedence:
7665
7666@table @code
7667@item ,
7668Function argument or array index separator.
7669
7670@item :=
7671Assignment. The value of @var{var} @code{:=} @var{value} is
7672@var{value}.
7673
7674@item <@r{, }>
7675Less than, greater than on integral, floating-point, or enumerated
7676types.
7677
7678@item <=@r{, }>=
96a2c332 7679Less than or equal to, greater than or equal to
c906108c
SS
7680on integral, floating-point and enumerated types, or set inclusion on
7681set types. Same precedence as @code{<}.
7682
7683@item =@r{, }<>@r{, }#
7684Equality and two ways of expressing inequality, valid on scalar types.
7685Same precedence as @code{<}. In @value{GDBN} scripts, only @code{<>} is
7686available for inequality, since @code{#} conflicts with the script
7687comment character.
7688
7689@item IN
7690Set membership. Defined on set types and the types of their members.
7691Same precedence as @code{<}.
7692
7693@item OR
7694Boolean disjunction. Defined on boolean types.
7695
7696@item AND@r{, }&
d4f3574e 7697Boolean conjunction. Defined on boolean types.
c906108c
SS
7698
7699@item @@
7700The @value{GDBN} ``artificial array'' operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}).
7701
7702@item +@r{, }-
7703Addition and subtraction on integral and floating-point types, or union
7704and difference on set types.
7705
7706@item *
7707Multiplication on integral and floating-point types, or set intersection
7708on set types.
7709
7710@item /
7711Division on floating-point types, or symmetric set difference on set
7712types. Same precedence as @code{*}.
7713
7714@item DIV@r{, }MOD
7715Integer division and remainder. Defined on integral types. Same
7716precedence as @code{*}.
7717
7718@item -
7719Negative. Defined on @code{INTEGER} and @code{REAL} data.
7720
7721@item ^
7722Pointer dereferencing. Defined on pointer types.
7723
7724@item NOT
7725Boolean negation. Defined on boolean types. Same precedence as
7726@code{^}.
7727
7728@item .
7729@code{RECORD} field selector. Defined on @code{RECORD} data. Same
7730precedence as @code{^}.
7731
7732@item []
7733Array indexing. Defined on @code{ARRAY} data. Same precedence as @code{^}.
7734
7735@item ()
7736Procedure argument list. Defined on @code{PROCEDURE} objects. Same precedence
7737as @code{^}.
7738
7739@item ::@r{, }.
7740@value{GDBN} and Modula-2 scope operators.
7741@end table
7742
7743@quotation
7744@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so @value{GDBN}
7745treats the use of the operator @code{IN}, or the use of operators
7746@code{+}, @code{-}, @code{*}, @code{/}, @code{=}, , @code{<>}, @code{#},
7747@code{<=}, and @code{>=} on sets as an error.
7748@end quotation
7749
cb51c4e0 7750
6d2ebf8b 7751@node Built-In Func/Proc
c906108c 7752@subsubsection Built-in functions and procedures
cb51c4e0 7753@cindex Modula-2 built-ins
c906108c
SS
7754
7755Modula-2 also makes available several built-in procedures and functions.
7756In describing these, the following metavariables are used:
7757
7758@table @var
7759
7760@item a
7761represents an @code{ARRAY} variable.
7762
7763@item c
7764represents a @code{CHAR} constant or variable.
7765
7766@item i
7767represents a variable or constant of integral type.
7768
7769@item m
7770represents an identifier that belongs to a set. Generally used in the
7771same function with the metavariable @var{s}. The type of @var{s} should
7772be @code{SET OF @var{mtype}} (where @var{mtype} is the type of @var{m}).
7773
7774@item n
7775represents a variable or constant of integral or floating-point type.
7776
7777@item r
7778represents a variable or constant of floating-point type.
7779
7780@item t
7781represents a type.
7782
7783@item v
7784represents a variable.
7785
7786@item x
7787represents a variable or constant of one of many types. See the
7788explanation of the function for details.
7789@end table
7790
7791All Modula-2 built-in procedures also return a result, described below.
7792
7793@table @code
7794@item ABS(@var{n})
7795Returns the absolute value of @var{n}.
7796
7797@item CAP(@var{c})
7798If @var{c} is a lower case letter, it returns its upper case
c3f6f71d 7799equivalent, otherwise it returns its argument.
c906108c
SS
7800
7801@item CHR(@var{i})
7802Returns the character whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7803
7804@item DEC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7805Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7806
7807@item DEC(@var{v},@var{i})
7808Decrements the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7809new value.
7810
7811@item EXCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7812Removes the element @var{m} from the set @var{s}. Returns the new
7813set.
7814
7815@item FLOAT(@var{i})
7816Returns the floating point equivalent of the integer @var{i}.
7817
7818@item HIGH(@var{a})
7819Returns the index of the last member of @var{a}.
7820
7821@item INC(@var{v})
c3f6f71d 7822Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by one. Returns the new value.
c906108c
SS
7823
7824@item INC(@var{v},@var{i})
7825Increments the value in the variable @var{v} by @var{i}. Returns the
7826new value.
7827
7828@item INCL(@var{m},@var{s})
7829Adds the element @var{m} to the set @var{s} if it is not already
7830there. Returns the new set.
7831
7832@item MAX(@var{t})
7833Returns the maximum value of the type @var{t}.
7834
7835@item MIN(@var{t})
7836Returns the minimum value of the type @var{t}.
7837
7838@item ODD(@var{i})
7839Returns boolean TRUE if @var{i} is an odd number.
7840
7841@item ORD(@var{x})
7842Returns the ordinal value of its argument. For example, the ordinal
c3f6f71d
JM
7843value of a character is its @sc{ascii} value (on machines supporting the
7844@sc{ascii} character set). @var{x} must be of an ordered type, which include
c906108c
SS
7845integral, character and enumerated types.
7846
7847@item SIZE(@var{x})
7848Returns the size of its argument. @var{x} can be a variable or a type.
7849
7850@item TRUNC(@var{r})
7851Returns the integral part of @var{r}.
7852
7853@item VAL(@var{t},@var{i})
7854Returns the member of the type @var{t} whose ordinal value is @var{i}.
7855@end table
7856
7857@quotation
7858@emph{Warning:} Sets and their operations are not yet supported, so
7859@value{GDBN} treats the use of procedures @code{INCL} and @code{EXCL} as
7860an error.
7861@end quotation
7862
7863@cindex Modula-2 constants
6d2ebf8b 7864@node M2 Constants
c906108c
SS
7865@subsubsection Constants
7866
7867@value{GDBN} allows you to express the constants of Modula-2 in the following
7868ways:
7869
7870@itemize @bullet
7871
7872@item
7873Integer constants are simply a sequence of digits. When used in an
7874expression, a constant is interpreted to be type-compatible with the
7875rest of the expression. Hexadecimal integers are specified by a
7876trailing @samp{H}, and octal integers by a trailing @samp{B}.
7877
7878@item
7879Floating point constants appear as a sequence of digits, followed by a
7880decimal point and another sequence of digits. An optional exponent can
7881then be specified, in the form @samp{E@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}}, where
7882@samp{@r{[}+@r{|}-@r{]}@var{nnn}} is the desired exponent. All of the
7883digits of the floating point constant must be valid decimal (base 10)
7884digits.
7885
7886@item
7887Character constants consist of a single character enclosed by a pair of
7888like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}). They may
c3f6f71d 7889also be expressed by their ordinal value (their @sc{ascii} value, usually)
c906108c
SS
7890followed by a @samp{C}.
7891
7892@item
7893String constants consist of a sequence of characters enclosed by a
7894pair of like quotes, either single (@code{'}) or double (@code{"}).
7895Escape sequences in the style of C are also allowed. @xref{C
b37052ae 7896Constants, ,C and C@t{++} constants}, for a brief explanation of escape
c906108c
SS
7897sequences.
7898
7899@item
7900Enumerated constants consist of an enumerated identifier.
7901
7902@item
7903Boolean constants consist of the identifiers @code{TRUE} and
7904@code{FALSE}.
7905
7906@item
7907Pointer constants consist of integral values only.
7908
7909@item
7910Set constants are not yet supported.
7911@end itemize
7912
6d2ebf8b 7913@node M2 Defaults
c906108c
SS
7914@subsubsection Modula-2 defaults
7915@cindex Modula-2 defaults
7916
7917If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
7918both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 7919Modula-2. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
7920selected the working language.
7921
7922If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
7923code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.mod} sets the
d4f3574e 7924working language to Modula-2. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
c906108c
SS
7925the language automatically}, for further details.
7926
6d2ebf8b 7927@node Deviations
c906108c
SS
7928@subsubsection Deviations from standard Modula-2
7929@cindex Modula-2, deviations from
7930
7931A few changes have been made to make Modula-2 programs easier to debug.
7932This is done primarily via loosening its type strictness:
7933
7934@itemize @bullet
7935@item
7936Unlike in standard Modula-2, pointer constants can be formed by
7937integers. This allows you to modify pointer variables during
7938debugging. (In standard Modula-2, the actual address contained in a
7939pointer variable is hidden from you; it can only be modified
7940through direct assignment to another pointer variable or expression that
7941returned a pointer.)
7942
7943@item
7944C escape sequences can be used in strings and characters to represent
7945non-printable characters. @value{GDBN} prints out strings with these
7946escape sequences embedded. Single non-printable characters are
7947printed using the @samp{CHR(@var{nnn})} format.
7948
7949@item
7950The assignment operator (@code{:=}) returns the value of its right-hand
7951argument.
7952
7953@item
7954All built-in procedures both modify @emph{and} return their argument.
7955@end itemize
7956
6d2ebf8b 7957@node M2 Checks
c906108c
SS
7958@subsubsection Modula-2 type and range checks
7959@cindex Modula-2 checks
7960
7961@quotation
7962@emph{Warning:} in this release, @value{GDBN} does not yet perform type or
7963range checking.
7964@end quotation
7965@c FIXME remove warning when type/range checks added
7966
7967@value{GDBN} considers two Modula-2 variables type equivalent if:
7968
7969@itemize @bullet
7970@item
7971They are of types that have been declared equivalent via a @code{TYPE
7972@var{t1} = @var{t2}} statement
7973
7974@item
7975They have been declared on the same line. (Note: This is true of the
7976@sc{gnu} Modula-2 compiler, but it may not be true of other compilers.)
7977@end itemize
7978
7979As long as type checking is enabled, any attempt to combine variables
7980whose types are not equivalent is an error.
7981
7982Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
7983index bounds, and all built-in functions and procedures.
7984
6d2ebf8b 7985@node M2 Scope
c906108c
SS
7986@subsubsection The scope operators @code{::} and @code{.}
7987@cindex scope
41afff9a 7988@cindex @code{.}, Modula-2 scope operator
c906108c
SS
7989@cindex colon, doubled as scope operator
7990@ifinfo
41afff9a 7991@vindex colon-colon@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7992@c Info cannot handle :: but TeX can.
7993@end ifinfo
7994@iftex
41afff9a 7995@vindex ::@r{, in Modula-2}
c906108c
SS
7996@end iftex
7997
7998There are a few subtle differences between the Modula-2 scope operator
7999(@code{.}) and the @value{GDBN} scope operator (@code{::}). The two have
8000similar syntax:
8001
8002@example
8003
8004@var{module} . @var{id}
8005@var{scope} :: @var{id}
8006@end example
8007
8008@noindent
8009where @var{scope} is the name of a module or a procedure,
8010@var{module} the name of a module, and @var{id} is any declared
8011identifier within your program, except another module.
8012
8013Using the @code{::} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the scope
8014specified by @var{scope} for the identifier @var{id}. If it is not
8015found in the specified scope, then @value{GDBN} searches all scopes
8016enclosing the one specified by @var{scope}.
8017
8018Using the @code{.} operator makes @value{GDBN} search the current scope for
8019the identifier specified by @var{id} that was imported from the
8020definition module specified by @var{module}. With this operator, it is
8021an error if the identifier @var{id} was not imported from definition
8022module @var{module}, or if @var{id} is not an identifier in
8023@var{module}.
8024
6d2ebf8b 8025@node GDB/M2
c906108c
SS
8026@subsubsection @value{GDBN} and Modula-2
8027
8028Some @value{GDBN} commands have little use when debugging Modula-2 programs.
8029Five subcommands of @code{set print} and @code{show print} apply
b37052ae 8030specifically to C and C@t{++}: @samp{vtbl}, @samp{demangle},
c906108c 8031@samp{asm-demangle}, @samp{object}, and @samp{union}. The first four
b37052ae 8032apply to C@t{++}, and the last to the C @code{union} type, which has no direct
c906108c
SS
8033analogue in Modula-2.
8034
8035The @code{@@} operator (@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}), while available
d4f3574e 8036with any language, is not useful with Modula-2. Its
c906108c 8037intent is to aid the debugging of @dfn{dynamic arrays}, which cannot be
b37052ae 8038created in Modula-2 as they can in C or C@t{++}. However, because an
c906108c 8039address can be specified by an integral constant, the construct
d4f3574e 8040@samp{@{@var{type}@}@var{adrexp}} is still useful.
c906108c
SS
8041
8042@cindex @code{#} in Modula-2
8043In @value{GDBN} scripts, the Modula-2 inequality operator @code{#} is
8044interpreted as the beginning of a comment. Use @code{<>} instead.
c906108c 8045
6d2ebf8b 8046@node Chill
cce74817
JM
8047@subsection Chill
8048
8049The extensions made to @value{GDBN} to support Chill only support output
d4f3574e 8050from the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler. Other Chill compilers are not currently
cce74817
JM
8051supported, and attempting to debug executables produced by them is most
8052likely to give an error as @value{GDBN} reads in the executable's symbol
8053table.
8054
d4f3574e
SS
8055@c This used to say "... following Chill related topics ...", but since
8056@c menus are not shown in the printed manual, it would look awkward.
8057This section covers the Chill related topics and the features
cce74817
JM
8058of @value{GDBN} which support these topics.
8059
8060@menu
104c1213
JM
8061* How modes are displayed:: How modes are displayed
8062* Locations:: Locations and their accesses
cce74817 8063* Values and their Operations:: Values and their Operations
5d161b24 8064* Chill type and range checks::
53a5351d 8065* Chill defaults::
cce74817
JM
8066@end menu
8067
6d2ebf8b 8068@node How modes are displayed
cce74817
JM
8069@subsubsection How modes are displayed
8070
8071The Chill Datatype- (Mode) support of @value{GDBN} is directly related
d4f3574e 8072with the functionality of the @sc{gnu} Chill compiler, and therefore deviates
cce74817
JM
8073slightly from the standard specification of the Chill language. The
8074provided modes are:
d4f3574e
SS
8075
8076@c FIXME: this @table's contents effectively disable @code by using @r
8077@c on every @item. So why does it need @code?
cce74817
JM
8078@table @code
8079@item @r{@emph{Discrete modes:}}
8080@itemize @bullet
8081@item
8082@emph{Integer Modes} which are predefined by @code{BYTE, UBYTE, INT,
8083UINT, LONG, ULONG},
8084@item
5d161b24 8085@emph{Boolean Mode} which is predefined by @code{BOOL},
cce74817 8086@item
5d161b24 8087@emph{Character Mode} which is predefined by @code{CHAR},
cce74817
JM
8088@item
8089@emph{Set Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{SET}.
8090@smallexample
8091(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8092type = SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8093@end smallexample
8094If the type is an unnumbered set the set element values are omitted.
8095@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8096@emph{Range Mode} which is displayed by
8097@smallexample
8098@code{type = <basemode>(<lower bound> : <upper bound>)}
8099@end smallexample
8100where @code{<lower bound>, <upper bound>} can be of any discrete literal
8101expression (e.g. set element names).
cce74817
JM
8102@end itemize
8103
8104@item @r{@emph{Powerset Mode:}}
8105A Powerset Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{POWERSET} followed by
d4f3574e 8106the member mode of the powerset. The member mode can be any discrete mode.
cce74817
JM
8107@smallexample
8108(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
8109type = POWERSET SET (egon, hugo, otto)
8110@end smallexample
8111
8112@item @r{@emph{Reference Modes:}}
8113@itemize @bullet
8114@item
d4f3574e 8115@emph{Bound Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{REF}
cce74817
JM
8116followed by the mode name to which the reference is bound.
8117@item
8118@emph{Free Reference Mode} which is displayed by the keyword @code{PTR}.
8119@end itemize
8120
8121@item @r{@emph{Procedure mode}}
8122The procedure mode is displayed by @code{type = PROC(<parameter list>)
8123<return mode> EXCEPTIONS (<exception list>)}. The @code{<parameter
d4f3574e
SS
8124list>} is a list of the parameter modes. @code{<return mode>} indicates
8125the mode of the result of the procedure if any. The exceptionlist lists
cce74817
JM
8126all possible exceptions which can be raised by the procedure.
8127
8128@ignore
8129@item @r{@emph{Instance mode}}
8130The instance mode is represented by a structure, which has a static
5d161b24 8131type, and is therefore not really of interest.
cce74817
JM
8132@end ignore
8133
5d161b24 8134@item @r{@emph{Synchronization Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8135@itemize @bullet
8136@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8137@emph{Event Mode} which is displayed by
8138@smallexample
8139@code{EVENT (<event length>)}
8140@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8141where @code{(<event length>)} is optional.
8142@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8143@emph{Buffer Mode} which is displayed by
8144@smallexample
8145@code{BUFFER (<buffer length>)<buffer element mode>}
8146@end smallexample
8147where @code{(<buffer length>)} is optional.
cce74817
JM
8148@end itemize
8149
5d161b24 8150@item @r{@emph{Timing Modes:}}
cce74817
JM
8151@itemize @bullet
8152@item
8153@emph{Duration Mode} which is predefined by @code{DURATION}
8154@item
8155@emph{Absolute Time Mode} which is predefined by @code{TIME}
8156@end itemize
8157
8158@item @r{@emph{Real Modes:}}
8159Real Modes are predefined with @code{REAL} and @code{LONG_REAL}.
8160
8161@item @r{@emph{String Modes:}}
8162@itemize @bullet
8163@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8164@emph{Character String Mode} which is displayed by
8165@smallexample
8166@code{CHARS(<string length>)}
8167@end smallexample
8168followed by the keyword @code{VARYING} if the String Mode is a varying
8169mode
cce74817 8170@item
6d2ebf8b
SS
8171@emph{Bit String Mode} which is displayed by
8172@smallexample
8173@code{BOOLS(<string
8174length>)}
8175@end smallexample
cce74817
JM
8176@end itemize
8177
8178@item @r{@emph{Array Mode:}}
8179The Array Mode is displayed by the keyword @code{ARRAY(<range>)}
8180followed by the element mode (which may in turn be an array mode).
8181@smallexample
8182(@value{GDBP}) ptype x
5d161b24
DB
8183type = ARRAY (1:42)
8184 ARRAY (1:20)
cce74817
JM
8185 SET (karli = 10, susi = 20, fritzi = 100)
8186@end smallexample
8187
5d161b24 8188@item @r{@emph{Structure Mode}}
cce74817 8189The Structure mode is displayed by the keyword @code{STRUCT(<field
d4f3574e
SS
8190list>)}. The @code{<field list>} consists of names and modes of fields
8191of the structure. Variant structures have the keyword @code{CASE <field>
8192OF <variant fields> ESAC} in their field list. Since the current version
cce74817
JM
8193of the GNU Chill compiler doesn't implement tag processing (no runtime
8194checks of variant fields, and therefore no debugging info), the output
8195always displays all variant fields.
8196@smallexample
8197(@value{GDBP}) ptype str
8198type = STRUCT (
8199 as x,
8200 bs x,
8201 CASE bs OF
8202 (karli):
8203 cs a
8204 (ott):
8205 ds x
8206 ESAC
8207)
8208@end smallexample
8209@end table
8210
6d2ebf8b 8211@node Locations
cce74817
JM
8212@subsubsection Locations and their accesses
8213
8214A location in Chill is an object which can contain values.
8215
8216A value of a location is generally accessed by the (declared) name of
d4f3574e
SS
8217the location. The output conforms to the specification of values in
8218Chill programs. How values are specified
8219is the topic of the next section, @ref{Values and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8220
8221The pseudo-location @code{RESULT} (or @code{result}) can be used to
8222display or change the result of a currently-active procedure:
d4f3574e 8223
cce74817
JM
8224@smallexample
8225set result := EXPR
8226@end smallexample
d4f3574e
SS
8227
8228@noindent
8229This does the same as the Chill action @code{RESULT EXPR} (which
c3f6f71d 8230is not available in @value{GDBN}).
cce74817
JM
8231
8232Values of reference mode locations are printed by @code{PTR(<hex
8233value>)} in case of a free reference mode, and by @code{(REF <reference
d4f3574e 8234mode>) (<hex-value>)} in case of a bound reference. @code{<hex value>}
cce74817
JM
8235represents the address where the reference points to. To access the
8236value of the location referenced by the pointer, use the dereference
d4f3574e 8237operator @samp{->}.
cce74817 8238
6d2ebf8b
SS
8239Values of procedure mode locations are displayed by
8240@smallexample
8241@code{@{ PROC
cce74817 8242(<argument modes> ) <return mode> @} <address> <name of procedure
6d2ebf8b
SS
8243location>}
8244@end smallexample
8245@code{<argument modes>} is a list of modes according to the parameter
8246specification of the procedure and @code{<address>} shows the address of
8247the entry point.
cce74817
JM
8248
8249@ignore
8250Locations of instance modes are displayed just like a structure with two
8251fields specifying the @emph{process type} and the @emph{copy number} of
8252the investigated instance location@footnote{This comes from the current
d4f3574e
SS
8253implementation of instances. They are implemented as a structure (no
8254na). The output should be something like @code{[<name of the process>;
8255<instance number>]}.}. The field names are @code{__proc_type} and
cce74817
JM
8256@code{__proc_copy}.
8257
8258Locations of synchronization modes are displayed like a structure with
8259the field name @code{__event_data} in case of a event mode location, and
8260like a structure with the field @code{__buffer_data} in case of a buffer
8261mode location (refer to previous paragraph).
8262
8263Structure Mode locations are printed by @code{[.<field name>: <value>,
d4f3574e 8264...]}. The @code{<field name>} corresponds to the structure mode
cce74817 8265definition and the layout of @code{<value>} varies depending of the mode
d4f3574e
SS
8266of the field. If the investigated structure mode location is of variant
8267structure mode, the variant parts of the structure are enclosed in curled
8268braces (@samp{@{@}}). Fields enclosed by @samp{@{,@}} are residing
cce74817 8269on the same memory location and represent the current values of the
d4f3574e 8270memory location in their specific modes. Since no tag processing is done
cce74817 8271all variants are displayed. A variant field is printed by
d4f3574e 8272@code{(<variant name>) = .<field name>: <value>}. (who implements the
cce74817
JM
8273stuff ???)
8274@smallexample
8275(@value{GDBP}) print str1 $4 = [.as: 0, .bs: karli, .<TAG>: { (karli) =
8276[.cs: []], (susi) = [.ds: susi]}]
8277@end smallexample
8278@end ignore
8279
8280Substructures of string mode-, array mode- or structure mode-values
8281(e.g. array slices, fields of structure locations) are accessed using
d4f3574e
SS
8282certain operations which are described in the next section, @ref{Values
8283and their Operations}.
cce74817
JM
8284
8285A location value may be interpreted as having a different mode using the
d4f3574e
SS
8286location conversion. This mode conversion is written as @code{<mode
8287name>(<location>)}. The user has to consider that the sizes of the modes
8288have to be equal otherwise an error occurs. Furthermore, no range
8289checking of the location against the destination mode is performed, and
cce74817 8290therefore the result can be quite confusing.
d4f3574e 8291
cce74817
JM
8292@smallexample
8293(@value{GDBP}) print int (s(3 up 4)) XXX TO be filled in !! XXX
8294@end smallexample
8295
6d2ebf8b 8296@node Values and their Operations
cce74817
JM
8297@subsubsection Values and their Operations
8298
8299Values are used to alter locations, to investigate complex structures in
8300more detail or to filter relevant information out of a large amount of
d4f3574e
SS
8301data. There are several (mode dependent) operations defined which enable
8302such investigations. These operations are not only applicable to
cce74817 8303constant values but also to locations, which can become quite useful
d4f3574e 8304when debugging complex structures. During parsing the command line
cce74817
JM
8305(e.g. evaluating an expression) @value{GDBN} treats location names as
8306the values behind these locations.
8307
d4f3574e 8308This section describes how values have to be specified and which
cce74817
JM
8309operations are legal to be used with such values.
8310
8311@table @code
8312@item Literal Values
d4f3574e
SS
8313Literal values are specified in the same manner as in @sc{gnu} Chill programs.
8314For detailed specification refer to the @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual
cce74817 8315chapter 1.5.
d4f3574e
SS
8316@c FIXME: if the Chill Manual is a Texinfo documents, the above should
8317@c be converted to a @ref.
cce74817 8318
5d161b24 8319@ignore
cce74817
JM
8320@itemize @bullet
8321@item
8322@emph{Integer Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
d4f3574e 8323programs (refer to the Chill Standard z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.2)
cce74817
JM
8324@item
8325@emph{Boolean Literals} are defined by @code{TRUE} and @code{FALSE}.
8326@item
8327@emph{Character Literals} are defined by @code{'<character>'}. (e.g.
8328@code{'M'})
8329@item
8330@emph{Set Literals} are defined by a name which was specified in a set
d4f3574e 8331mode. The value delivered by a Set Literal is the set value. This is
b37052ae 8332comparable to an enumeration in C/C@t{++} language.
cce74817 8333@item
d4f3574e 8334@emph{Emptiness Literal} is predefined by @code{NULL}. The value of the
cce74817 8335emptiness literal delivers either the empty reference value, the empty
5d161b24 8336procedure value or the empty instance value.
cce74817
JM
8337
8338@item
8339@emph{Character String Literals} are defined by a sequence of characters
d4f3574e 8340enclosed in single- or double quotes. If a single- or double quote has
cce74817
JM
8341to be part of the string literal it has to be stuffed (specified twice).
8342@item
8343@emph{Bitstring Literals} are specified in the same manner as in Chill
8344programs (refer z200/88 chpt 5.2.4.8).
8345@item
8346@emph{Floating point literals} are specified in the same manner as in
d4f3574e 8347(gnu-)Chill programs (refer @sc{gnu} Chill implementation Manual chapter 1.5).
cce74817
JM
8348@end itemize
8349@end ignore
8350
8351@item Tuple Values
8352A tuple is specified by @code{<mode name>[<tuple>]}, where @code{<mode
d4f3574e 8353name>} can be omitted if the mode of the tuple is unambiguous. This
cce74817
JM
8354unambiguity is derived from the context of a evaluated expression.
8355@code{<tuple>} can be one of the following:
d4f3574e 8356
cce74817
JM
8357@itemize @bullet
8358@item @emph{Powerset Tuple}
8359@item @emph{Array Tuple}
8360@item @emph{Structure Tuple}
8361Powerset tuples, array tuples and structure tuples are specified in the
d4f3574e 8362same manner as in Chill programs refer to z200/88 chpt 5.2.5.
cce74817
JM
8363@end itemize
8364
8365@item String Element Value
6d2ebf8b
SS
8366A string element value is specified by
8367@smallexample
8368@code{<string value>(<index>)}
8369@end smallexample
d4f3574e 8370where @code{<index>} is a integer expression. It delivers a character
cce74817
JM
8371value which is equivalent to the character indexed by @code{<index>} in
8372the string.
8373
8374@item String Slice Value
8375A string slice value is specified by @code{<string value>(<slice
8376spec>)}, where @code{<slice spec>} can be either a range of integer
8377expressions or specified by @code{<start expr> up <size>}.
8378@code{<size>} denotes the number of elements which the slice contains.
8379The delivered value is a string value, which is part of the specified
8380string.
8381
8382@item Array Element Values
8383An array element value is specified by @code{<array value>(<expr>)} and
8384delivers a array element value of the mode of the specified array.
8385
8386@item Array Slice Values
8387An array slice is specified by @code{<array value>(<slice spec>)}, where
8388@code{<slice spec>} can be either a range specified by expressions or by
d4f3574e
SS
8389@code{<start expr> up <size>}. @code{<size>} denotes the number of
8390arrayelements the slice contains. The delivered value is an array value
cce74817
JM
8391which is part of the specified array.
8392
8393@item Structure Field Values
8394A structure field value is derived by @code{<structure value>.<field
d4f3574e
SS
8395name>}, where @code{<field name>} indicates the name of a field specified
8396in the mode definition of the structure. The mode of the delivered value
cce74817
JM
8397corresponds to this mode definition in the structure definition.
8398
8399@item Procedure Call Value
8400The procedure call value is derived from the return value of the
8401procedure@footnote{If a procedure call is used for instance in an
8402expression, then this procedure is called with all its side
d4f3574e 8403effects. This can lead to confusing results if used carelessly.}.
cce74817 8404
d4f3574e 8405Values of duration mode locations are represented by @code{ULONG} literals.
cce74817 8406
6d2ebf8b
SS
8407Values of time mode locations appear as
8408@smallexample
8409@code{TIME(<secs>:<nsecs>)}
8410@end smallexample
8411
cce74817
JM
8412
8413@ignore
8414This is not implemented yet:
8415@item Built-in Value
8416@noindent
8417The following built in functions are provided:
d4f3574e 8418
cce74817
JM
8419@table @code
8420@item @code{ADDR()}
8421@item @code{NUM()}
8422@item @code{PRED()}
8423@item @code{SUCC()}
8424@item @code{ABS()}
8425@item @code{CARD()}
8426@item @code{MAX()}
8427@item @code{MIN()}
8428@item @code{SIZE()}
8429@item @code{UPPER()}
8430@item @code{LOWER()}
8431@item @code{LENGTH()}
8432@item @code{SIN()}
8433@item @code{COS()}
8434@item @code{TAN()}
8435@item @code{ARCSIN()}
8436@item @code{ARCCOS()}
8437@item @code{ARCTAN()}
8438@item @code{EXP()}
8439@item @code{LN()}
8440@item @code{LOG()}
8441@item @code{SQRT()}
8442@end table
8443
8444For a detailed description refer to the GNU Chill implementation manual
8445chapter 1.6.
8446@end ignore
8447
8448@item Zero-adic Operator Value
8449The zero-adic operator value is derived from the instance value for the
8450current active process.
8451
8452@item Expression Values
8453The value delivered by an expression is the result of the evaluation of
d4f3574e 8454the specified expression. If there are error conditions (mode
cce74817 8455incompatibility, etc.) the evaluation of expressions is aborted with a
d4f3574e 8456corresponding error message. Expressions may be parenthesised which
cce74817 8457causes the evaluation of this expression before any other expression
d4f3574e 8458which uses the result of the parenthesised expression. The following
cce74817 8459operators are supported by @value{GDBN}:
d4f3574e 8460
cce74817
JM
8461@table @code
8462@item @code{OR, ORIF, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8463@itemx @code{AND, ANDIF}
8464@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8465Logical operators defined over operands of boolean mode.
d4f3574e 8466
cce74817
JM
8467@item @code{=, /=}
8468Equality and inequality operators defined over all modes.
d4f3574e 8469
cce74817 8470@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8471@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8472Relational operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8473
cce74817 8474@item @code{+, -}
d4f3574e 8475@itemx @code{*, /, MOD, REM}
cce74817 8476Arithmetic operators defined over predefined modes.
d4f3574e 8477
cce74817
JM
8478@item @code{-}
8479Change sign operator.
d4f3574e 8480
cce74817
JM
8481@item @code{//}
8482String concatenation operator.
d4f3574e 8483
cce74817
JM
8484@item @code{()}
8485String repetition operator.
d4f3574e 8486
cce74817
JM
8487@item @code{->}
8488Referenced location operator which can be used either to take the
8489address of a location (@code{->loc}), or to dereference a reference
8490location (@code{loc->}).
d4f3574e 8491
cce74817 8492@item @code{OR, XOR}
d4f3574e
SS
8493@itemx @code{AND}
8494@itemx @code{NOT}
cce74817 8495Powerset and bitstring operators.
d4f3574e 8496
cce74817 8497@item @code{>, >=}
d4f3574e 8498@itemx @code{<, <=}
cce74817 8499Powerset inclusion operators.
d4f3574e 8500
cce74817
JM
8501@item @code{IN}
8502Membership operator.
8503@end table
8504@end table
8505
6d2ebf8b 8506@node Chill type and range checks
cce74817
JM
8507@subsubsection Chill type and range checks
8508
8509@value{GDBN} considers two Chill variables mode equivalent if the sizes
d4f3574e 8510of the two modes are equal. This rule applies recursively to more
cce74817 8511complex datatypes which means that complex modes are treated
d4f3574e 8512equivalent if all element modes (which also can be complex modes like
cce74817
JM
8513structures, arrays, etc.) have the same size.
8514
8515Range checking is done on all mathematical operations, assignment, array
8516index bounds and all built in procedures.
8517
8518Strong type checks are forced using the @value{GDBN} command @code{set
d4f3574e 8519check strong}. This enforces strong type and range checks on all
cce74817
JM
8520operations where Chill constructs are used (expressions, built in
8521functions, etc.) in respect to the semantics as defined in the z.200
8522language specification.
8523
cce74817
JM
8524All checks can be disabled by the @value{GDBN} command @code{set check
8525off}.
8526
5d161b24 8527@ignore
53a5351d 8528@c Deviations from the Chill Standard Z200/88
cce74817
JM
8529see last paragraph ?
8530@end ignore
8531
6d2ebf8b 8532@node Chill defaults
cce74817
JM
8533@subsubsection Chill defaults
8534
8535If type and range checking are set automatically by @value{GDBN}, they
8536both default to @code{on} whenever the working language changes to
d4f3574e 8537Chill. This happens regardless of whether you or @value{GDBN}
cce74817
JM
8538selected the working language.
8539
8540If you allow @value{GDBN} to set the language automatically, then entering
8541code compiled from a file whose name ends with @file{.ch} sets the
d4f3574e 8542working language to Chill. @xref{Automatically, ,Having @value{GDBN} set
cce74817
JM
8543the language automatically}, for further details.
8544
6d2ebf8b 8545@node Symbols
c906108c
SS
8546@chapter Examining the Symbol Table
8547
d4f3574e 8548The commands described in this chapter allow you to inquire about the
c906108c
SS
8549symbols (names of variables, functions and types) defined in your
8550program. This information is inherent in the text of your program and
8551does not change as your program executes. @value{GDBN} finds it in your
8552program's symbol table, in the file indicated when you started @value{GDBN}
8553(@pxref{File Options, ,Choosing files}), or by one of the
8554file-management commands (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
8555
8556@cindex symbol names
8557@cindex names of symbols
8558@cindex quoting names
8559Occasionally, you may need to refer to symbols that contain unusual
8560characters, which @value{GDBN} ordinarily treats as word delimiters. The
8561most frequent case is in referring to static variables in other
8562source files (@pxref{Variables,,Program variables}). File names
8563are recorded in object files as debugging symbols, but @value{GDBN} would
8564ordinarily parse a typical file name, like @file{foo.c}, as the three words
8565@samp{foo} @samp{.} @samp{c}. To allow @value{GDBN} to recognize
8566@samp{foo.c} as a single symbol, enclose it in single quotes; for example,
8567
8568@example
8569p 'foo.c'::x
8570@end example
8571
8572@noindent
8573looks up the value of @code{x} in the scope of the file @file{foo.c}.
8574
8575@table @code
8576@kindex info address
b37052ae 8577@cindex address of a symbol
c906108c
SS
8578@item info address @var{symbol}
8579Describe where the data for @var{symbol} is stored. For a register
8580variable, this says which register it is kept in. For a non-register
8581local variable, this prints the stack-frame offset at which the variable
8582is always stored.
8583
8584Note the contrast with @samp{print &@var{symbol}}, which does not work
8585at all for a register variable, and for a stack local variable prints
8586the exact address of the current instantiation of the variable.
8587
3d67e040 8588@kindex info symbol
b37052ae 8589@cindex symbol from address
3d67e040
EZ
8590@item info symbol @var{addr}
8591Print the name of a symbol which is stored at the address @var{addr}.
8592If no symbol is stored exactly at @var{addr}, @value{GDBN} prints the
8593nearest symbol and an offset from it:
8594
8595@example
8596(@value{GDBP}) info symbol 0x54320
8597_initialize_vx + 396 in section .text
8598@end example
8599
8600@noindent
8601This is the opposite of the @code{info address} command. You can use
8602it to find out the name of a variable or a function given its address.
8603
c906108c 8604@kindex whatis
d4f3574e
SS
8605@item whatis @var{expr}
8606Print the data type of expression @var{expr}. @var{expr} is not
c906108c
SS
8607actually evaluated, and any side-effecting operations (such as
8608assignments or function calls) inside it do not take place.
8609@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}.
8610
8611@item whatis
8612Print the data type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8613
8614@kindex ptype
8615@item ptype @var{typename}
8616Print a description of data type @var{typename}. @var{typename} may be
7a292a7a
SS
8617the name of a type, or for C code it may have the form @samp{class
8618@var{class-name}}, @samp{struct @var{struct-tag}}, @samp{union
8619@var{union-tag}} or @samp{enum @var{enum-tag}}.
c906108c 8620
d4f3574e 8621@item ptype @var{expr}
c906108c 8622@itemx ptype
d4f3574e 8623Print a description of the type of expression @var{expr}. @code{ptype}
c906108c
SS
8624differs from @code{whatis} by printing a detailed description, instead
8625of just the name of the type.
8626
8627For example, for this variable declaration:
8628
8629@example
8630struct complex @{double real; double imag;@} v;
8631@end example
8632
8633@noindent
8634the two commands give this output:
8635
8636@example
8637@group
8638(@value{GDBP}) whatis v
8639type = struct complex
8640(@value{GDBP}) ptype v
8641type = struct complex @{
8642 double real;
8643 double imag;
8644@}
8645@end group
8646@end example
8647
8648@noindent
8649As with @code{whatis}, using @code{ptype} without an argument refers to
8650the type of @code{$}, the last value in the value history.
8651
8652@kindex info types
8653@item info types @var{regexp}
8654@itemx info types
d4f3574e 8655Print a brief description of all types whose names match @var{regexp}
c906108c
SS
8656(or all types in your program, if you supply no argument). Each
8657complete typename is matched as though it were a complete line; thus,
8658@samp{i type value} gives information on all types in your program whose
d4f3574e 8659names include the string @code{value}, but @samp{i type ^value$} gives
c906108c
SS
8660information only on types whose complete name is @code{value}.
8661
8662This command differs from @code{ptype} in two ways: first, like
8663@code{whatis}, it does not print a detailed description; second, it
8664lists all source files where a type is defined.
8665
b37052ae
EZ
8666@kindex info scope
8667@cindex local variables
8668@item info scope @var{addr}
8669List all the variables local to a particular scope. This command
8670accepts a location---a function name, a source line, or an address
8671preceded by a @samp{*}, and prints all the variables local to the
8672scope defined by that location. For example:
8673
8674@smallexample
8675(@value{GDBP}) @b{info scope command_line_handler}
8676Scope for command_line_handler:
8677Symbol rl is an argument at stack/frame offset 8, length 4.
8678Symbol linebuffer is in static storage at address 0x150a18, length 4.
8679Symbol linelength is in static storage at address 0x150a1c, length 4.
8680Symbol p is a local variable in register $esi, length 4.
8681Symbol p1 is a local variable in register $ebx, length 4.
8682Symbol nline is a local variable in register $edx, length 4.
8683Symbol repeat is a local variable at frame offset -8, length 4.
8684@end smallexample
8685
f5c37c66
EZ
8686@noindent
8687This command is especially useful for determining what data to collect
8688during a @dfn{trace experiment}, see @ref{Tracepoint Actions,
8689collect}.
8690
c906108c
SS
8691@kindex info source
8692@item info source
8693Show the name of the current source file---that is, the source file for
8694the function containing the current point of execution---and the language
8695it was written in.
8696
8697@kindex info sources
8698@item info sources
8699Print the names of all source files in your program for which there is
8700debugging information, organized into two lists: files whose symbols
8701have already been read, and files whose symbols will be read when needed.
8702
8703@kindex info functions
8704@item info functions
8705Print the names and data types of all defined functions.
8706
8707@item info functions @var{regexp}
8708Print the names and data types of all defined functions
8709whose names contain a match for regular expression @var{regexp}.
8710Thus, @samp{info fun step} finds all functions whose names
8711include @code{step}; @samp{info fun ^step} finds those whose names
1c5dfdad
MS
8712start with @code{step}. If a function name contains characters
8713that conflict with the regular expression language (eg.
8714@samp{operator*()}), they may be quoted with a backslash.
c906108c
SS
8715
8716@kindex info variables
8717@item info variables
8718Print the names and data types of all variables that are declared
8719outside of functions (i.e., excluding local variables).
8720
8721@item info variables @var{regexp}
8722Print the names and data types of all variables (except for local
8723variables) whose names contain a match for regular expression
8724@var{regexp}.
8725
8726@ignore
8727This was never implemented.
8728@kindex info methods
8729@item info methods
8730@itemx info methods @var{regexp}
8731The @code{info methods} command permits the user to examine all defined
b37052ae
EZ
8732methods within C@t{++} program, or (with the @var{regexp} argument) a
8733specific set of methods found in the various C@t{++} classes. Many
8734C@t{++} classes provide a large number of methods. Thus, the output
c906108c
SS
8735from the @code{ptype} command can be overwhelming and hard to use. The
8736@code{info-methods} command filters the methods, printing only those
8737which match the regular-expression @var{regexp}.
8738@end ignore
8739
c906108c
SS
8740@cindex reloading symbols
8741Some systems allow individual object files that make up your program to
7a292a7a
SS
8742be replaced without stopping and restarting your program. For example,
8743in VxWorks you can simply recompile a defective object file and keep on
8744running. If you are running on one of these systems, you can allow
8745@value{GDBN} to reload the symbols for automatically relinked modules:
c906108c
SS
8746
8747@table @code
8748@kindex set symbol-reloading
8749@item set symbol-reloading on
8750Replace symbol definitions for the corresponding source file when an
8751object file with a particular name is seen again.
8752
8753@item set symbol-reloading off
6d2ebf8b
SS
8754Do not replace symbol definitions when encountering object files of the
8755same name more than once. This is the default state; if you are not
8756running on a system that permits automatic relinking of modules, you
8757should leave @code{symbol-reloading} off, since otherwise @value{GDBN}
8758may discard symbols when linking large programs, that may contain
8759several modules (from different directories or libraries) with the same
8760name.
c906108c
SS
8761
8762@kindex show symbol-reloading
8763@item show symbol-reloading
8764Show the current @code{on} or @code{off} setting.
8765@end table
c906108c 8766
c906108c
SS
8767@kindex set opaque-type-resolution
8768@item set opaque-type-resolution on
8769Tell @value{GDBN} to resolve opaque types. An opaque type is a type
8770declared as a pointer to a @code{struct}, @code{class}, or
8771@code{union}---for example, @code{struct MyType *}---that is used in one
8772source file although the full declaration of @code{struct MyType} is in
8773another source file. The default is on.
8774
8775A change in the setting of this subcommand will not take effect until
8776the next time symbols for a file are loaded.
8777
8778@item set opaque-type-resolution off
8779Tell @value{GDBN} not to resolve opaque types. In this case, the type
8780is printed as follows:
8781@smallexample
8782@{<no data fields>@}
8783@end smallexample
8784
8785@kindex show opaque-type-resolution
8786@item show opaque-type-resolution
8787Show whether opaque types are resolved or not.
c906108c
SS
8788
8789@kindex maint print symbols
8790@cindex symbol dump
8791@kindex maint print psymbols
8792@cindex partial symbol dump
8793@item maint print symbols @var{filename}
8794@itemx maint print psymbols @var{filename}
8795@itemx maint print msymbols @var{filename}
8796Write a dump of debugging symbol data into the file @var{filename}.
8797These commands are used to debug the @value{GDBN} symbol-reading code. Only
8798symbols with debugging data are included. If you use @samp{maint print
8799symbols}, @value{GDBN} includes all the symbols for which it has already
8800collected full details: that is, @var{filename} reflects symbols for
8801only those files whose symbols @value{GDBN} has read. You can use the
8802command @code{info sources} to find out which files these are. If you
8803use @samp{maint print psymbols} instead, the dump shows information about
8804symbols that @value{GDBN} only knows partially---that is, symbols defined in
8805files that @value{GDBN} has skimmed, but not yet read completely. Finally,
8806@samp{maint print msymbols} dumps just the minimal symbol information
8807required for each object file from which @value{GDBN} has read some symbols.
8808@xref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}, for a discussion of how
8809@value{GDBN} reads symbols (in the description of @code{symbol-file}).
8810@end table
8811
6d2ebf8b 8812@node Altering
c906108c
SS
8813@chapter Altering Execution
8814
8815Once you think you have found an error in your program, you might want to
8816find out for certain whether correcting the apparent error would lead to
8817correct results in the rest of the run. You can find the answer by
8818experiment, using the @value{GDBN} features for altering execution of the
8819program.
8820
8821For example, you can store new values into variables or memory
7a292a7a
SS
8822locations, give your program a signal, restart it at a different
8823address, or even return prematurely from a function.
c906108c
SS
8824
8825@menu
8826* Assignment:: Assignment to variables
8827* Jumping:: Continuing at a different address
c906108c 8828* Signaling:: Giving your program a signal
c906108c
SS
8829* Returning:: Returning from a function
8830* Calling:: Calling your program's functions
8831* Patching:: Patching your program
8832@end menu
8833
6d2ebf8b 8834@node Assignment
c906108c
SS
8835@section Assignment to variables
8836
8837@cindex assignment
8838@cindex setting variables
8839To alter the value of a variable, evaluate an assignment expression.
8840@xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}. For example,
8841
8842@example
8843print x=4
8844@end example
8845
8846@noindent
8847stores the value 4 into the variable @code{x}, and then prints the
5d161b24 8848value of the assignment expression (which is 4).
c906108c
SS
8849@xref{Languages, ,Using @value{GDBN} with Different Languages}, for more
8850information on operators in supported languages.
c906108c
SS
8851
8852@kindex set variable
8853@cindex variables, setting
8854If you are not interested in seeing the value of the assignment, use the
8855@code{set} command instead of the @code{print} command. @code{set} is
8856really the same as @code{print} except that the expression's value is
8857not printed and is not put in the value history (@pxref{Value History,
8858,Value history}). The expression is evaluated only for its effects.
8859
c906108c
SS
8860If the beginning of the argument string of the @code{set} command
8861appears identical to a @code{set} subcommand, use the @code{set
8862variable} command instead of just @code{set}. This command is identical
8863to @code{set} except for its lack of subcommands. For example, if your
8864program has a variable @code{width}, you get an error if you try to set
8865a new value with just @samp{set width=13}, because @value{GDBN} has the
8866command @code{set width}:
8867
8868@example
8869(@value{GDBP}) whatis width
8870type = double
8871(@value{GDBP}) p width
8872$4 = 13
8873(@value{GDBP}) set width=47
8874Invalid syntax in expression.
8875@end example
8876
8877@noindent
8878The invalid expression, of course, is @samp{=47}. In
8879order to actually set the program's variable @code{width}, use
8880
8881@example
8882(@value{GDBP}) set var width=47
8883@end example
53a5351d 8884
c906108c
SS
8885Because the @code{set} command has many subcommands that can conflict
8886with the names of program variables, it is a good idea to use the
8887@code{set variable} command instead of just @code{set}. For example, if
8888your program has a variable @code{g}, you run into problems if you try
8889to set a new value with just @samp{set g=4}, because @value{GDBN} has
8890the command @code{set gnutarget}, abbreviated @code{set g}:
8891
8892@example
8893@group
8894(@value{GDBP}) whatis g
8895type = double
8896(@value{GDBP}) p g
8897$1 = 1
8898(@value{GDBP}) set g=4
2df3850c 8899(@value{GDBP}) p g
c906108c
SS
8900$2 = 1
8901(@value{GDBP}) r
8902The program being debugged has been started already.
8903Start it from the beginning? (y or n) y
8904Starting program: /home/smith/cc_progs/a.out
6d2ebf8b
SS
8905"/home/smith/cc_progs/a.out": can't open to read symbols:
8906 Invalid bfd target.
c906108c
SS
8907(@value{GDBP}) show g
8908The current BFD target is "=4".
8909@end group
8910@end example
8911
8912@noindent
8913The program variable @code{g} did not change, and you silently set the
8914@code{gnutarget} to an invalid value. In order to set the variable
8915@code{g}, use
8916
8917@example
8918(@value{GDBP}) set var g=4
8919@end example
c906108c
SS
8920
8921@value{GDBN} allows more implicit conversions in assignments than C; you can
8922freely store an integer value into a pointer variable or vice versa,
8923and you can convert any structure to any other structure that is the
8924same length or shorter.
8925@comment FIXME: how do structs align/pad in these conversions?
8926@comment /doc@cygnus.com 18dec1990
8927
8928To store values into arbitrary places in memory, use the @samp{@{@dots{}@}}
8929construct to generate a value of specified type at a specified address
8930(@pxref{Expressions, ,Expressions}). For example, @code{@{int@}0x83040} refers
8931to memory location @code{0x83040} as an integer (which implies a certain size
8932and representation in memory), and
8933
8934@example
8935set @{int@}0x83040 = 4
8936@end example
8937
8938@noindent
8939stores the value 4 into that memory location.
8940
6d2ebf8b 8941@node Jumping
c906108c
SS
8942@section Continuing at a different address
8943
8944Ordinarily, when you continue your program, you do so at the place where
8945it stopped, with the @code{continue} command. You can instead continue at
8946an address of your own choosing, with the following commands:
8947
8948@table @code
8949@kindex jump
8950@item jump @var{linespec}
8951Resume execution at line @var{linespec}. Execution stops again
8952immediately if there is a breakpoint there. @xref{List, ,Printing
8953source lines}, for a description of the different forms of
8954@var{linespec}. It is common practice to use the @code{tbreak} command
8955in conjunction with @code{jump}. @xref{Set Breaks, ,Setting
8956breakpoints}.
8957
8958The @code{jump} command does not change the current stack frame, or
8959the stack pointer, or the contents of any memory location or any
8960register other than the program counter. If line @var{linespec} is in
8961a different function from the one currently executing, the results may
8962be bizarre if the two functions expect different patterns of arguments or
8963of local variables. For this reason, the @code{jump} command requests
8964confirmation if the specified line is not in the function currently
8965executing. However, even bizarre results are predictable if you are
8966well acquainted with the machine-language code of your program.
8967
8968@item jump *@var{address}
8969Resume execution at the instruction at address @var{address}.
8970@end table
8971
c906108c 8972@c Doesn't work on HP-UX; have to set $pcoqh and $pcoqt.
53a5351d
JM
8973On many systems, you can get much the same effect as the @code{jump}
8974command by storing a new value into the register @code{$pc}. The
8975difference is that this does not start your program running; it only
8976changes the address of where it @emph{will} run when you continue. For
8977example,
c906108c
SS
8978
8979@example
8980set $pc = 0x485
8981@end example
8982
8983@noindent
8984makes the next @code{continue} command or stepping command execute at
8985address @code{0x485}, rather than at the address where your program stopped.
8986@xref{Continuing and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}.
c906108c
SS
8987
8988The most common occasion to use the @code{jump} command is to back
8989up---perhaps with more breakpoints set---over a portion of a program
8990that has already executed, in order to examine its execution in more
8991detail.
8992
c906108c 8993@c @group
6d2ebf8b 8994@node Signaling
c906108c
SS
8995@section Giving your program a signal
8996
8997@table @code
8998@kindex signal
8999@item signal @var{signal}
9000Resume execution where your program stopped, but immediately give it the
9001signal @var{signal}. @var{signal} can be the name or the number of a
9002signal. For example, on many systems @code{signal 2} and @code{signal
9003SIGINT} are both ways of sending an interrupt signal.
9004
9005Alternatively, if @var{signal} is zero, continue execution without
9006giving a signal. This is useful when your program stopped on account of
9007a signal and would ordinary see the signal when resumed with the
9008@code{continue} command; @samp{signal 0} causes it to resume without a
9009signal.
9010
9011@code{signal} does not repeat when you press @key{RET} a second time
9012after executing the command.
9013@end table
9014@c @end group
9015
9016Invoking the @code{signal} command is not the same as invoking the
9017@code{kill} utility from the shell. Sending a signal with @code{kill}
9018causes @value{GDBN} to decide what to do with the signal depending on
9019the signal handling tables (@pxref{Signals}). The @code{signal} command
9020passes the signal directly to your program.
9021
c906108c 9022
6d2ebf8b 9023@node Returning
c906108c
SS
9024@section Returning from a function
9025
9026@table @code
9027@cindex returning from a function
9028@kindex return
9029@item return
9030@itemx return @var{expression}
9031You can cancel execution of a function call with the @code{return}
9032command. If you give an
9033@var{expression} argument, its value is used as the function's return
9034value.
9035@end table
9036
9037When you use @code{return}, @value{GDBN} discards the selected stack frame
9038(and all frames within it). You can think of this as making the
9039discarded frame return prematurely. If you wish to specify a value to
9040be returned, give that value as the argument to @code{return}.
9041
9042This pops the selected stack frame (@pxref{Selection, ,Selecting a
9043frame}), and any other frames inside of it, leaving its caller as the
9044innermost remaining frame. That frame becomes selected. The
9045specified value is stored in the registers used for returning values
9046of functions.
9047
9048The @code{return} command does not resume execution; it leaves the
9049program stopped in the state that would exist if the function had just
9050returned. In contrast, the @code{finish} command (@pxref{Continuing
9051and Stepping, ,Continuing and stepping}) resumes execution until the
9052selected stack frame returns naturally.
9053
6d2ebf8b 9054@node Calling
c906108c
SS
9055@section Calling program functions
9056
9057@cindex calling functions
9058@kindex call
9059@table @code
9060@item call @var{expr}
9061Evaluate the expression @var{expr} without displaying @code{void}
9062returned values.
9063@end table
9064
9065You can use this variant of the @code{print} command if you want to
9066execute a function from your program, but without cluttering the output
5d161b24
DB
9067with @code{void} returned values. If the result is not void, it
9068is printed and saved in the value history.
c906108c 9069
7d86b5d5
AC
9070@c OBSOLETE For the A29K, a user-controlled variable @code{call_scratch_address},
9071@c OBSOLETE specifies the location of a scratch area to be used when @value{GDBN}
9072@c OBSOLETE calls a function in the target. This is necessary because the usual
9073@c OBSOLETE method of putting the scratch area on the stack does not work in systems
9074@c OBSOLETE that have separate instruction and data spaces.
c906108c 9075
6d2ebf8b 9076@node Patching
c906108c 9077@section Patching programs
7a292a7a 9078
c906108c
SS
9079@cindex patching binaries
9080@cindex writing into executables
c906108c 9081@cindex writing into corefiles
c906108c 9082
7a292a7a
SS
9083By default, @value{GDBN} opens the file containing your program's
9084executable code (or the corefile) read-only. This prevents accidental
9085alterations to machine code; but it also prevents you from intentionally
9086patching your program's binary.
c906108c
SS
9087
9088If you'd like to be able to patch the binary, you can specify that
9089explicitly with the @code{set write} command. For example, you might
9090want to turn on internal debugging flags, or even to make emergency
9091repairs.
9092
9093@table @code
9094@kindex set write
9095@item set write on
9096@itemx set write off
7a292a7a
SS
9097If you specify @samp{set write on}, @value{GDBN} opens executable and
9098core files for both reading and writing; if you specify @samp{set write
c906108c
SS
9099off} (the default), @value{GDBN} opens them read-only.
9100
9101If you have already loaded a file, you must load it again (using the
7a292a7a
SS
9102@code{exec-file} or @code{core-file} command) after changing @code{set
9103write}, for your new setting to take effect.
c906108c
SS
9104
9105@item show write
9106@kindex show write
7a292a7a
SS
9107Display whether executable files and core files are opened for writing
9108as well as reading.
c906108c
SS
9109@end table
9110
6d2ebf8b 9111@node GDB Files
c906108c
SS
9112@chapter @value{GDBN} Files
9113
7a292a7a
SS
9114@value{GDBN} needs to know the file name of the program to be debugged,
9115both in order to read its symbol table and in order to start your
9116program. To debug a core dump of a previous run, you must also tell
9117@value{GDBN} the name of the core dump file.
c906108c
SS
9118
9119@menu
9120* Files:: Commands to specify files
9121* Symbol Errors:: Errors reading symbol files
9122@end menu
9123
6d2ebf8b 9124@node Files
c906108c 9125@section Commands to specify files
c906108c 9126
7a292a7a 9127@cindex symbol table
c906108c 9128@cindex core dump file
7a292a7a
SS
9129
9130You may want to specify executable and core dump file names. The usual
9131way to do this is at start-up time, using the arguments to
9132@value{GDBN}'s start-up commands (@pxref{Invocation, , Getting In and
9133Out of @value{GDBN}}).
c906108c
SS
9134
9135Occasionally it is necessary to change to a different file during a
9136@value{GDBN} session. Or you may run @value{GDBN} and forget to specify
9137a file you want to use. In these situations the @value{GDBN} commands
9138to specify new files are useful.
9139
9140@table @code
9141@cindex executable file
9142@kindex file
9143@item file @var{filename}
9144Use @var{filename} as the program to be debugged. It is read for its
9145symbols and for the contents of pure memory. It is also the program
9146executed when you use the @code{run} command. If you do not specify a
5d161b24
DB
9147directory and the file is not found in the @value{GDBN} working directory,
9148@value{GDBN} uses the environment variable @code{PATH} as a list of
9149directories to search, just as the shell does when looking for a program
9150to run. You can change the value of this variable, for both @value{GDBN}
c906108c
SS
9151and your program, using the @code{path} command.
9152
6d2ebf8b 9153On systems with memory-mapped files, an auxiliary file named
c906108c
SS
9154@file{@var{filename}.syms} may hold symbol table information for
9155@var{filename}. If so, @value{GDBN} maps in the symbol table from
9156@file{@var{filename}.syms}, starting up more quickly. See the
9157descriptions of the file options @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow}
9158(available on the command line, and with the commands @code{file},
5d161b24 9159@code{symbol-file}, or @code{add-symbol-file}, described below),
c906108c 9160for more information.
c906108c
SS
9161
9162@item file
9163@code{file} with no argument makes @value{GDBN} discard any information it
9164has on both executable file and the symbol table.
9165
9166@kindex exec-file
9167@item exec-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9168Specify that the program to be run (but not the symbol table) is found
9169in @var{filename}. @value{GDBN} searches the environment variable @code{PATH}
9170if necessary to locate your program. Omitting @var{filename} means to
9171discard information on the executable file.
9172
9173@kindex symbol-file
9174@item symbol-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9175Read symbol table information from file @var{filename}. @code{PATH} is
9176searched when necessary. Use the @code{file} command to get both symbol
9177table and program to run from the same file.
9178
9179@code{symbol-file} with no argument clears out @value{GDBN} information on your
9180program's symbol table.
9181
5d161b24 9182The @code{symbol-file} command causes @value{GDBN} to forget the contents
c906108c
SS
9183of its convenience variables, the value history, and all breakpoints and
9184auto-display expressions. This is because they may contain pointers to
9185the internal data recording symbols and data types, which are part of
9186the old symbol table data being discarded inside @value{GDBN}.
9187
9188@code{symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after
9189executing it once.
9190
9191When @value{GDBN} is configured for a particular environment, it
9192understands debugging information in whatever format is the standard
9193generated for that environment; you may use either a @sc{gnu} compiler, or
9194other compilers that adhere to the local conventions.
c906108c
SS
9195Best results are usually obtained from @sc{gnu} compilers; for example,
9196using @code{@value{GCC}} you can generate debugging information for
9197optimized code.
c906108c
SS
9198
9199For most kinds of object files, with the exception of old SVR3 systems
9200using COFF, the @code{symbol-file} command does not normally read the
9201symbol table in full right away. Instead, it scans the symbol table
9202quickly to find which source files and which symbols are present. The
9203details are read later, one source file at a time, as they are needed.
9204
9205The purpose of this two-stage reading strategy is to make @value{GDBN}
9206start up faster. For the most part, it is invisible except for
9207occasional pauses while the symbol table details for a particular source
9208file are being read. (The @code{set verbose} command can turn these
9209pauses into messages if desired. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional
9210warnings and messages}.)
9211
c906108c
SS
9212We have not implemented the two-stage strategy for COFF yet. When the
9213symbol table is stored in COFF format, @code{symbol-file} reads the
9214symbol table data in full right away. Note that ``stabs-in-COFF''
9215still does the two-stage strategy, since the debug info is actually
9216in stabs format.
9217
9218@kindex readnow
9219@cindex reading symbols immediately
9220@cindex symbols, reading immediately
9221@kindex mapped
9222@cindex memory-mapped symbol file
9223@cindex saving symbol table
9224@item symbol-file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9225@itemx file @var{filename} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
9226You can override the @value{GDBN} two-stage strategy for reading symbol
9227tables by using the @samp{-readnow} option with any of the commands that
9228load symbol table information, if you want to be sure @value{GDBN} has the
5d161b24 9229entire symbol table available.
c906108c 9230
c906108c
SS
9231If memory-mapped files are available on your system through the
9232@code{mmap} system call, you can use another option, @samp{-mapped}, to
9233cause @value{GDBN} to write the symbols for your program into a reusable
9234file. Future @value{GDBN} debugging sessions map in symbol information
9235from this auxiliary symbol file (if the program has not changed), rather
9236than spending time reading the symbol table from the executable
9237program. Using the @samp{-mapped} option has the same effect as
9238starting @value{GDBN} with the @samp{-mapped} command-line option.
9239
9240You can use both options together, to make sure the auxiliary symbol
9241file has all the symbol information for your program.
9242
9243The auxiliary symbol file for a program called @var{myprog} is called
9244@samp{@var{myprog}.syms}. Once this file exists (so long as it is newer
9245than the corresponding executable), @value{GDBN} always attempts to use
9246it when you debug @var{myprog}; no special options or commands are
9247needed.
9248
9249The @file{.syms} file is specific to the host machine where you run
9250@value{GDBN}. It holds an exact image of the internal @value{GDBN}
9251symbol table. It cannot be shared across multiple host platforms.
c906108c
SS
9252
9253@c FIXME: for now no mention of directories, since this seems to be in
9254@c flux. 13mar1992 status is that in theory GDB would look either in
9255@c current dir or in same dir as myprog; but issues like competing
9256@c GDB's, or clutter in system dirs, mean that in practice right now
9257@c only current dir is used. FFish says maybe a special GDB hierarchy
9258@c (eg rooted in val of env var GDBSYMS) could exist for mappable symbol
9259@c files.
9260
9261@kindex core
9262@kindex core-file
9263@item core-file @r{[} @var{filename} @r{]}
9264Specify the whereabouts of a core dump file to be used as the ``contents
9265of memory''. Traditionally, core files contain only some parts of the
9266address space of the process that generated them; @value{GDBN} can access the
9267executable file itself for other parts.
9268
9269@code{core-file} with no argument specifies that no core file is
9270to be used.
9271
9272Note that the core file is ignored when your program is actually running
7a292a7a
SS
9273under @value{GDBN}. So, if you have been running your program and you
9274wish to debug a core file instead, you must kill the subprocess in which
9275the program is running. To do this, use the @code{kill} command
c906108c 9276(@pxref{Kill Process, ,Killing the child process}).
c906108c 9277
c906108c
SS
9278@kindex add-symbol-file
9279@cindex dynamic linking
9280@item add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address}
9281@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @var{address} @r{[} -readnow @r{]} @r{[} -mapped @r{]}
17d9d558 9282@itemx add-symbol-file @var{filename} @r{-s}@var{section} @var{address} @dots{}
96a2c332
SS
9283The @code{add-symbol-file} command reads additional symbol table
9284information from the file @var{filename}. You would use this command
9285when @var{filename} has been dynamically loaded (by some other means)
9286into the program that is running. @var{address} should be the memory
9287address at which the file has been loaded; @value{GDBN} cannot figure
d167840f
EZ
9288this out for itself. You can additionally specify an arbitrary number
9289of @samp{@r{-s}@var{section} @var{address}} pairs, to give an explicit
9290section name and base address for that section. You can specify any
9291@var{address} as an expression.
c906108c
SS
9292
9293The symbol table of the file @var{filename} is added to the symbol table
9294originally read with the @code{symbol-file} command. You can use the
96a2c332
SS
9295@code{add-symbol-file} command any number of times; the new symbol data
9296thus read keeps adding to the old. To discard all old symbol data
9297instead, use the @code{symbol-file} command without any arguments.
c906108c 9298
17d9d558
JB
9299@cindex relocatable object files, reading symbols from
9300@cindex object files, relocatable, reading symbols from
9301@cindex reading symbols from relocatable object files
9302@cindex symbols, reading from relocatable object files
9303@cindex @file{.o} files, reading symbols from
9304Although @var{filename} is typically a shared library file, an
9305executable file, or some other object file which has been fully
9306relocated for loading into a process, you can also load symbolic
9307information from relocatable @file{.o} files, as long as:
9308
9309@itemize @bullet
9310@item
9311the file's symbolic information refers only to linker symbols defined in
9312that file, not to symbols defined by other object files,
9313@item
9314every section the file's symbolic information refers to has actually
9315been loaded into the inferior, as it appears in the file, and
9316@item
9317you can determine the address at which every section was loaded, and
9318provide these to the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9319@end itemize
9320
9321@noindent
9322Some embedded operating systems, like Sun Chorus and VxWorks, can load
9323relocatable files into an already running program; such systems
9324typically make the requirements above easy to meet. However, it's
9325important to recognize that many native systems use complex link
9326procedures (@code{.linkonce} section factoring and C++ constructor table
9327assembly, for example) that make the requirements difficult to meet. In
9328general, one cannot assume that using @code{add-symbol-file} to read a
9329relocatable object file's symbolic information will have the same effect
9330as linking the relocatable object file into the program in the normal
9331way.
9332
c906108c
SS
9333@code{add-symbol-file} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} after using it.
9334
9335You can use the @samp{-mapped} and @samp{-readnow} options just as with
9336the @code{symbol-file} command, to change how @value{GDBN} manages the symbol
9337table information for @var{filename}.
9338
9339@kindex add-shared-symbol-file
9340@item add-shared-symbol-file
9341The @code{add-shared-symbol-file} command can be used only under Harris' CXUX
5d161b24
DB
9342operating system for the Motorola 88k. @value{GDBN} automatically looks for
9343shared libraries, however if @value{GDBN} does not find yours, you can run
c906108c 9344@code{add-shared-symbol-file}. It takes no arguments.
c906108c 9345
c906108c
SS
9346@kindex section
9347@item section
5d161b24
DB
9348The @code{section} command changes the base address of section SECTION of
9349the exec file to ADDR. This can be used if the exec file does not contain
9350section addresses, (such as in the a.out format), or when the addresses
9351specified in the file itself are wrong. Each section must be changed
d4f3574e
SS
9352separately. The @code{info files} command, described below, lists all
9353the sections and their addresses.
c906108c
SS
9354
9355@kindex info files
9356@kindex info target
9357@item info files
9358@itemx info target
7a292a7a
SS
9359@code{info files} and @code{info target} are synonymous; both print the
9360current target (@pxref{Targets, ,Specifying a Debugging Target}),
9361including the names of the executable and core dump files currently in
9362use by @value{GDBN}, and the files from which symbols were loaded. The
9363command @code{help target} lists all possible targets rather than
9364current ones.
9365
fe95c787
MS
9366@kindex maint info sections
9367@item maint info sections
9368Another command that can give you extra information about program sections
9369is @code{maint info sections}. In addition to the section information
9370displayed by @code{info files}, this command displays the flags and file
9371offset of each section in the executable and core dump files. In addition,
9372@code{maint info sections} provides the following command options (which
9373may be arbitrarily combined):
9374
9375@table @code
9376@item ALLOBJ
9377Display sections for all loaded object files, including shared libraries.
9378@item @var{sections}
6600abed 9379Display info only for named @var{sections}.
fe95c787
MS
9380@item @var{section-flags}
9381Display info only for sections for which @var{section-flags} are true.
9382The section flags that @value{GDBN} currently knows about are:
9383@table @code
9384@item ALLOC
9385Section will have space allocated in the process when loaded.
9386Set for all sections except those containing debug information.
9387@item LOAD
9388Section will be loaded from the file into the child process memory.
9389Set for pre-initialized code and data, clear for @code{.bss} sections.
9390@item RELOC
9391Section needs to be relocated before loading.
9392@item READONLY
9393Section cannot be modified by the child process.
9394@item CODE
9395Section contains executable code only.
6600abed 9396@item DATA
fe95c787
MS
9397Section contains data only (no executable code).
9398@item ROM
9399Section will reside in ROM.
9400@item CONSTRUCTOR
9401Section contains data for constructor/destructor lists.
9402@item HAS_CONTENTS
9403Section is not empty.
9404@item NEVER_LOAD
9405An instruction to the linker to not output the section.
9406@item COFF_SHARED_LIBRARY
9407A notification to the linker that the section contains
9408COFF shared library information.
9409@item IS_COMMON
9410Section contains common symbols.
9411@end table
9412@end table
6763aef9
MS
9413@kindex set trust-readonly-sections
9414@item set trust-readonly-sections on
9415Tell @value{GDBN} that readonly sections in your object file
9416really are read-only (ie.@: that their contents will not change).
9417In that case, @value{GDBN} can fetch values from these sections
9418out of the object file, rather than from the target program.
9419For some targets (notably embedded ones), this can be a significant
9420enhancement to debugging performance.
9421
9422The default is off.
9423
9424@item set trust-readonly-sections off
9425Tell @value{gdbn} not to trust readonly sections. This means that
9426the contents of the section might change while the program is running,
9427and must therefore be fetched from the target when needed.
c906108c
SS
9428@end table
9429
9430All file-specifying commands allow both absolute and relative file names
9431as arguments. @value{GDBN} always converts the file name to an absolute file
9432name and remembers it that way.
9433
c906108c 9434@cindex shared libraries
c906108c
SS
9435@value{GDBN} supports HP-UX, SunOS, SVr4, Irix 5, and IBM RS/6000 shared
9436libraries.
53a5351d 9437
c906108c
SS
9438@value{GDBN} automatically loads symbol definitions from shared libraries
9439when you use the @code{run} command, or when you examine a core file.
9440(Before you issue the @code{run} command, @value{GDBN} does not understand
9441references to a function in a shared library, however---unless you are
9442debugging a core file).
53a5351d
JM
9443
9444On HP-UX, if the program loads a library explicitly, @value{GDBN}
9445automatically loads the symbols at the time of the @code{shl_load} call.
9446
c906108c
SS
9447@c FIXME: some @value{GDBN} release may permit some refs to undef
9448@c FIXME...symbols---eg in a break cmd---assuming they are from a shared
9449@c FIXME...lib; check this from time to time when updating manual
9450
b7209cb4
FF
9451There are times, however, when you may wish to not automatically load
9452symbol definitions from shared libraries, such as when they are
9453particularly large or there are many of them.
9454
9455To control the automatic loading of shared library symbols, use the
9456commands:
9457
9458@table @code
9459@kindex set auto-solib-add
9460@item set auto-solib-add @var{mode}
9461If @var{mode} is @code{on}, symbols from all shared object libraries
9462will be loaded automatically when the inferior begins execution, you
9463attach to an independently started inferior, or when the dynamic linker
9464informs @value{GDBN} that a new library has been loaded. If @var{mode}
9465is @code{off}, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
9466@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default value is @code{on}.
9467
9468@kindex show auto-solib-add
9469@item show auto-solib-add
9470Display the current autoloading mode.
9471@end table
9472
9473To explicitly load shared library symbols, use the @code{sharedlibrary}
9474command:
9475
c906108c
SS
9476@table @code
9477@kindex info sharedlibrary
9478@kindex info share
9479@item info share
9480@itemx info sharedlibrary
9481Print the names of the shared libraries which are currently loaded.
9482
9483@kindex sharedlibrary
9484@kindex share
9485@item sharedlibrary @var{regex}
9486@itemx share @var{regex}
c906108c
SS
9487Load shared object library symbols for files matching a
9488Unix regular expression.
9489As with files loaded automatically, it only loads shared libraries
9490required by your program for a core file or after typing @code{run}. If
9491@var{regex} is omitted all shared libraries required by your program are
9492loaded.
9493@end table
9494
b7209cb4
FF
9495On some systems, such as HP-UX systems, @value{GDBN} supports
9496autoloading shared library symbols until a limiting threshold size is
9497reached. This provides the benefit of allowing autoloading to remain on
9498by default, but avoids autoloading excessively large shared libraries,
9499up to a threshold that is initially set, but which you can modify if you
9500wish.
c906108c
SS
9501
9502Beyond that threshold, symbols from shared libraries must be explicitly
d4f3574e
SS
9503loaded. To load these symbols, use the command @code{sharedlibrary
9504@var{filename}}. The base address of the shared library is determined
c906108c
SS
9505automatically by @value{GDBN} and need not be specified.
9506
9507To display or set the threshold, use the commands:
9508
9509@table @code
b7209cb4
FF
9510@kindex set auto-solib-limit
9511@item set auto-solib-limit @var{threshold}
9512Set the autoloading size threshold, in an integral number of megabytes.
9513If @var{threshold} is nonzero and shared library autoloading is enabled,
9514symbols from all shared object libraries will be loaded until the total
9515size of the loaded shared library symbols exceeds this threshold.
c906108c 9516Otherwise, symbols must be loaded manually, using the
b7209cb4
FF
9517@code{sharedlibrary} command. The default threshold is 100 (i.e. 100
9518Mb).
c906108c 9519
b7209cb4
FF
9520@kindex show auto-solib-limit
9521@item show auto-solib-limit
c906108c
SS
9522Display the current autoloading size threshold, in megabytes.
9523@end table
c906108c 9524
6d2ebf8b 9525@node Symbol Errors
c906108c
SS
9526@section Errors reading symbol files
9527
9528While reading a symbol file, @value{GDBN} occasionally encounters problems,
9529such as symbol types it does not recognize, or known bugs in compiler
9530output. By default, @value{GDBN} does not notify you of such problems, since
9531they are relatively common and primarily of interest to people
9532debugging compilers. If you are interested in seeing information
9533about ill-constructed symbol tables, you can either ask @value{GDBN} to print
9534only one message about each such type of problem, no matter how many
9535times the problem occurs; or you can ask @value{GDBN} to print more messages,
9536to see how many times the problems occur, with the @code{set
9537complaints} command (@pxref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9538messages}).
9539
9540The messages currently printed, and their meanings, include:
9541
9542@table @code
9543@item inner block not inside outer block in @var{symbol}
9544
9545The symbol information shows where symbol scopes begin and end
9546(such as at the start of a function or a block of statements). This
9547error indicates that an inner scope block is not fully contained
9548in its outer scope blocks.
9549
9550@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the inner block as if it had
9551the same scope as the outer block. In the error message, @var{symbol}
9552may be shown as ``@code{(don't know)}'' if the outer block is not a
9553function.
9554
9555@item block at @var{address} out of order
9556
9557The symbol information for symbol scope blocks should occur in
9558order of increasing addresses. This error indicates that it does not
9559do so.
9560
9561@value{GDBN} does not circumvent this problem, and has trouble
9562locating symbols in the source file whose symbols it is reading. (You
9563can often determine what source file is affected by specifying
9564@code{set verbose on}. @xref{Messages/Warnings, ,Optional warnings and
9565messages}.)
9566
9567@item bad block start address patched
9568
9569The symbol information for a symbol scope block has a start address
9570smaller than the address of the preceding source line. This is known
9571to occur in the SunOS 4.1.1 (and earlier) C compiler.
9572
9573@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by treating the symbol scope block as
9574starting on the previous source line.
9575
9576@item bad string table offset in symbol @var{n}
9577
9578@cindex foo
9579Symbol number @var{n} contains a pointer into the string table which is
9580larger than the size of the string table.
9581
9582@value{GDBN} circumvents the problem by considering the symbol to have the
9583name @code{foo}, which may cause other problems if many symbols end up
9584with this name.
9585
9586@item unknown symbol type @code{0x@var{nn}}
9587
7a292a7a
SS
9588The symbol information contains new data types that @value{GDBN} does
9589not yet know how to read. @code{0x@var{nn}} is the symbol type of the
d4f3574e 9590uncomprehended information, in hexadecimal.
c906108c 9591
7a292a7a
SS
9592@value{GDBN} circumvents the error by ignoring this symbol information.
9593This usually allows you to debug your program, though certain symbols
c906108c 9594are not accessible. If you encounter such a problem and feel like
7a292a7a
SS
9595debugging it, you can debug @code{@value{GDBP}} with itself, breakpoint
9596on @code{complain}, then go up to the function @code{read_dbx_symtab}
9597and examine @code{*bufp} to see the symbol.
c906108c
SS
9598
9599@item stub type has NULL name
c906108c 9600
7a292a7a 9601@value{GDBN} could not find the full definition for a struct or class.
c906108c 9602
7a292a7a 9603@item const/volatile indicator missing (ok if using g++ v1.x), got@dots{}
b37052ae 9604The symbol information for a C@t{++} member function is missing some
7a292a7a
SS
9605information that recent versions of the compiler should have output for
9606it.
c906108c
SS
9607
9608@item info mismatch between compiler and debugger
9609
9610@value{GDBN} could not parse a type specification output by the compiler.
7a292a7a 9611
c906108c
SS
9612@end table
9613
6d2ebf8b 9614@node Targets
c906108c 9615@chapter Specifying a Debugging Target
7a292a7a 9616
c906108c
SS
9617@cindex debugging target
9618@kindex target
9619
9620A @dfn{target} is the execution environment occupied by your program.
53a5351d
JM
9621
9622Often, @value{GDBN} runs in the same host environment as your program;
9623in that case, the debugging target is specified as a side effect when
9624you use the @code{file} or @code{core} commands. When you need more
c906108c
SS
9625flexibility---for example, running @value{GDBN} on a physically separate
9626host, or controlling a standalone system over a serial port or a
53a5351d
JM
9627realtime system over a TCP/IP connection---you can use the @code{target}
9628command to specify one of the target types configured for @value{GDBN}
9629(@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
c906108c
SS
9630
9631@menu
9632* Active Targets:: Active targets
9633* Target Commands:: Commands for managing targets
c906108c
SS
9634* Byte Order:: Choosing target byte order
9635* Remote:: Remote debugging
96baa820 9636* KOD:: Kernel Object Display
c906108c
SS
9637
9638@end menu
9639
6d2ebf8b 9640@node Active Targets
c906108c 9641@section Active targets
7a292a7a 9642
c906108c
SS
9643@cindex stacking targets
9644@cindex active targets
9645@cindex multiple targets
9646
c906108c 9647There are three classes of targets: processes, core files, and
7a292a7a
SS
9648executable files. @value{GDBN} can work concurrently on up to three
9649active targets, one in each class. This allows you to (for example)
9650start a process and inspect its activity without abandoning your work on
9651a core file.
c906108c
SS
9652
9653For example, if you execute @samp{gdb a.out}, then the executable file
9654@code{a.out} is the only active target. If you designate a core file as
9655well---presumably from a prior run that crashed and coredumped---then
9656@value{GDBN} has two active targets and uses them in tandem, looking
9657first in the corefile target, then in the executable file, to satisfy
9658requests for memory addresses. (Typically, these two classes of target
9659are complementary, since core files contain only a program's
9660read-write memory---variables and so on---plus machine status, while
9661executable files contain only the program text and initialized data.)
c906108c
SS
9662
9663When you type @code{run}, your executable file becomes an active process
7a292a7a
SS
9664target as well. When a process target is active, all @value{GDBN}
9665commands requesting memory addresses refer to that target; addresses in
9666an active core file or executable file target are obscured while the
9667process target is active.
c906108c 9668
7a292a7a
SS
9669Use the @code{core-file} and @code{exec-file} commands to select a new
9670core file or executable target (@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify
c906108c 9671files}). To specify as a target a process that is already running, use
7a292a7a
SS
9672the @code{attach} command (@pxref{Attach, ,Debugging an already-running
9673process}).
c906108c 9674
6d2ebf8b 9675@node Target Commands
c906108c
SS
9676@section Commands for managing targets
9677
9678@table @code
9679@item target @var{type} @var{parameters}
7a292a7a
SS
9680Connects the @value{GDBN} host environment to a target machine or
9681process. A target is typically a protocol for talking to debugging
9682facilities. You use the argument @var{type} to specify the type or
9683protocol of the target machine.
c906108c
SS
9684
9685Further @var{parameters} are interpreted by the target protocol, but
9686typically include things like device names or host names to connect
9687with, process numbers, and baud rates.
c906108c
SS
9688
9689The @code{target} command does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again
9690after executing the command.
9691
9692@kindex help target
9693@item help target
9694Displays the names of all targets available. To display targets
9695currently selected, use either @code{info target} or @code{info files}
9696(@pxref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}).
9697
9698@item help target @var{name}
9699Describe a particular target, including any parameters necessary to
9700select it.
9701
9702@kindex set gnutarget
9703@item set gnutarget @var{args}
5d161b24 9704@value{GDBN} uses its own library BFD to read your files. @value{GDBN}
c906108c 9705knows whether it is reading an @dfn{executable},
5d161b24
DB
9706a @dfn{core}, or a @dfn{.o} file; however, you can specify the file format
9707with the @code{set gnutarget} command. Unlike most @code{target} commands,
c906108c
SS
9708with @code{gnutarget} the @code{target} refers to a program, not a machine.
9709
d4f3574e 9710@quotation
c906108c
SS
9711@emph{Warning:} To specify a file format with @code{set gnutarget},
9712you must know the actual BFD name.
d4f3574e 9713@end quotation
c906108c 9714
d4f3574e
SS
9715@noindent
9716@xref{Files, , Commands to specify files}.
c906108c 9717
5d161b24 9718@kindex show gnutarget
c906108c
SS
9719@item show gnutarget
9720Use the @code{show gnutarget} command to display what file format
9721@code{gnutarget} is set to read. If you have not set @code{gnutarget},
9722@value{GDBN} will determine the file format for each file automatically,
9723and @code{show gnutarget} displays @samp{The current BDF target is "auto"}.
9724@end table
9725
c906108c
SS
9726Here are some common targets (available, or not, depending on the GDB
9727configuration):
c906108c
SS
9728
9729@table @code
9730@kindex target exec
9731@item target exec @var{program}
9732An executable file. @samp{target exec @var{program}} is the same as
9733@samp{exec-file @var{program}}.
9734
c906108c
SS
9735@kindex target core
9736@item target core @var{filename}
9737A core dump file. @samp{target core @var{filename}} is the same as
9738@samp{core-file @var{filename}}.
c906108c
SS
9739
9740@kindex target remote
9741@item target remote @var{dev}
9742Remote serial target in GDB-specific protocol. The argument @var{dev}
9743specifies what serial device to use for the connection (e.g.
9744@file{/dev/ttya}). @xref{Remote, ,Remote debugging}. @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 9745supports the @code{load} command. This is only useful if you have
c906108c
SS
9746some other way of getting the stub to the target system, and you can put
9747it somewhere in memory where it won't get clobbered by the download.
9748
c906108c
SS
9749@kindex target sim
9750@item target sim
2df3850c 9751Builtin CPU simulator. @value{GDBN} includes simulators for most architectures.
104c1213
JM
9752In general,
9753@example
9754 target sim
9755 load
9756 run
9757@end example
d4f3574e 9758@noindent
104c1213 9759works; however, you cannot assume that a specific memory map, device
d4f3574e 9760drivers, or even basic I/O is available, although some simulators do
104c1213
JM
9761provide these. For info about any processor-specific simulator details,
9762see the appropriate section in @ref{Embedded Processors, ,Embedded
9763Processors}.
9764
c906108c
SS
9765@end table
9766
104c1213 9767Some configurations may include these targets as well:
c906108c
SS
9768
9769@table @code
9770
c906108c
SS
9771@kindex target nrom
9772@item target nrom @var{dev}
9773NetROM ROM emulator. This target only supports downloading.
9774
c906108c
SS
9775@end table
9776
5d161b24 9777Different targets are available on different configurations of @value{GDBN};
c906108c 9778your configuration may have more or fewer targets.
c906108c
SS
9779
9780Many remote targets require you to download the executable's code
9781once you've successfully established a connection.
9782
9783@table @code
9784
9785@kindex load @var{filename}
9786@item load @var{filename}
c906108c
SS
9787Depending on what remote debugging facilities are configured into
9788@value{GDBN}, the @code{load} command may be available. Where it exists, it
9789is meant to make @var{filename} (an executable) available for debugging
9790on the remote system---by downloading, or dynamic linking, for example.
9791@code{load} also records the @var{filename} symbol table in @value{GDBN}, like
9792the @code{add-symbol-file} command.
9793
9794If your @value{GDBN} does not have a @code{load} command, attempting to
9795execute it gets the error message ``@code{You can't do that when your
9796target is @dots{}}''
c906108c
SS
9797
9798The file is loaded at whatever address is specified in the executable.
9799For some object file formats, you can specify the load address when you
9800link the program; for other formats, like a.out, the object file format
9801specifies a fixed address.
9802@c FIXME! This would be a good place for an xref to the GNU linker doc.
9803
c906108c
SS
9804@code{load} does not repeat if you press @key{RET} again after using it.
9805@end table
9806
6d2ebf8b 9807@node Byte Order
c906108c 9808@section Choosing target byte order
7a292a7a 9809
c906108c
SS
9810@cindex choosing target byte order
9811@cindex target byte order
c906108c
SS
9812
9813Some types of processors, such as the MIPS, PowerPC, and Hitachi SH,
9814offer the ability to run either big-endian or little-endian byte
9815orders. Usually the executable or symbol will include a bit to
9816designate the endian-ness, and you will not need to worry about
9817which to use. However, you may still find it useful to adjust
d4f3574e 9818@value{GDBN}'s idea of processor endian-ness manually.
c906108c
SS
9819
9820@table @code
9821@kindex set endian big
9822@item set endian big
9823Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is big-endian.
9824
9825@kindex set endian little
9826@item set endian little
9827Instruct @value{GDBN} to assume the target is little-endian.
9828
9829@kindex set endian auto
9830@item set endian auto
9831Instruct @value{GDBN} to use the byte order associated with the
9832executable.
9833
9834@item show endian
9835Display @value{GDBN}'s current idea of the target byte order.
9836
9837@end table
9838
9839Note that these commands merely adjust interpretation of symbolic
9840data on the host, and that they have absolutely no effect on the
9841target system.
9842
6d2ebf8b 9843@node Remote
c906108c
SS
9844@section Remote debugging
9845@cindex remote debugging
9846
9847If you are trying to debug a program running on a machine that cannot run
5d161b24
DB
9848@value{GDBN} in the usual way, it is often useful to use remote debugging.
9849For example, you might use remote debugging on an operating system kernel,
c906108c
SS
9850or on a small system which does not have a general purpose operating system
9851powerful enough to run a full-featured debugger.
9852
9853Some configurations of @value{GDBN} have special serial or TCP/IP interfaces
9854to make this work with particular debugging targets. In addition,
5d161b24 9855@value{GDBN} comes with a generic serial protocol (specific to @value{GDBN},
c906108c
SS
9856but not specific to any particular target system) which you can use if you
9857write the remote stubs---the code that runs on the remote system to
9858communicate with @value{GDBN}.
9859
9860Other remote targets may be available in your
9861configuration of @value{GDBN}; use @code{help target} to list them.
c906108c 9862
6f05cf9f
AC
9863@node KOD
9864@section Kernel Object Display
9865
9866@cindex kernel object display
9867@cindex kernel object
9868@cindex KOD
9869
9870Some targets support kernel object display. Using this facility,
9871@value{GDBN} communicates specially with the underlying operating system
9872and can display information about operating system-level objects such as
9873mutexes and other synchronization objects. Exactly which objects can be
9874displayed is determined on a per-OS basis.
9875
9876Use the @code{set os} command to set the operating system. This tells
9877@value{GDBN} which kernel object display module to initialize:
9878
9879@example
9880(@value{GDBP}) set os cisco
9881@end example
9882
9883If @code{set os} succeeds, @value{GDBN} will display some information
9884about the operating system, and will create a new @code{info} command
9885which can be used to query the target. The @code{info} command is named
9886after the operating system:
c906108c 9887
6f05cf9f
AC
9888@example
9889(@value{GDBP}) info cisco
9890List of Cisco Kernel Objects
9891Object Description
9892any Any and all objects
9893@end example
9894
9895Further subcommands can be used to query about particular objects known
9896by the kernel.
9897
9898There is currently no way to determine whether a given operating system
9899is supported other than to try it.
9900
9901
9902@node Remote Debugging
9903@chapter Debugging remote programs
9904
6b2f586d
AC
9905@menu
9906* Server:: Using the gdbserver program
9907* NetWare:: Using the gdbserve.nlm program
9908* remote stub:: Implementing a remote stub
6b2f586d
AC
9909@end menu
9910
6f05cf9f
AC
9911@node Server
9912@section Using the @code{gdbserver} program
9913
9914@kindex gdbserver
9915@cindex remote connection without stubs
9916@code{gdbserver} is a control program for Unix-like systems, which
9917allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
9918@code{target remote}---but without linking in the usual debugging stub.
9919
9920@code{gdbserver} is not a complete replacement for the debugging stubs,
9921because it requires essentially the same operating-system facilities
9922that @value{GDBN} itself does. In fact, a system that can run
9923@code{gdbserver} to connect to a remote @value{GDBN} could also run
9924@value{GDBN} locally! @code{gdbserver} is sometimes useful nevertheless,
9925because it is a much smaller program than @value{GDBN} itself. It is
9926also easier to port than all of @value{GDBN}, so you may be able to get
9927started more quickly on a new system by using @code{gdbserver}.
9928Finally, if you develop code for real-time systems, you may find that
9929the tradeoffs involved in real-time operation make it more convenient to
9930do as much development work as possible on another system, for example
9931by cross-compiling. You can use @code{gdbserver} to make a similar
9932choice for debugging.
9933
9934@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserver} communicate via either a serial line
9935or a TCP connection, using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial
9936protocol.
9937
9938@table @emph
9939@item On the target machine,
9940you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
9941@code{gdbserver} does not need your program's symbol table, so you can
9942strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the host
9943system does all the symbol handling.
9944
9945To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with @value{GDBN};
9946the name of your program; and the arguments for your program. The
9947syntax is:
9948
9949@smallexample
9950target> gdbserver @var{comm} @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
9951@end smallexample
9952
9953@var{comm} is either a device name (to use a serial line) or a TCP
9954hostname and portnumber. For example, to debug Emacs with the argument
9955@samp{foo.txt} and communicate with @value{GDBN} over the serial port
9956@file{/dev/com1}:
9957
9958@smallexample
9959target> gdbserver /dev/com1 emacs foo.txt
9960@end smallexample
9961
9962@code{gdbserver} waits passively for the host @value{GDBN} to communicate
9963with it.
9964
9965To use a TCP connection instead of a serial line:
9966
9967@smallexample
9968target> gdbserver host:2345 emacs foo.txt
9969@end smallexample
9970
9971The only difference from the previous example is the first argument,
9972specifying that you are communicating with the host @value{GDBN} via
9973TCP. The @samp{host:2345} argument means that @code{gdbserver} is to
9974expect a TCP connection from machine @samp{host} to local TCP port 2345.
9975(Currently, the @samp{host} part is ignored.) You can choose any number
9976you want for the port number as long as it does not conflict with any
9977TCP ports already in use on the target system (for example, @code{23} is
9978reserved for @code{telnet}).@footnote{If you choose a port number that
9979conflicts with another service, @code{gdbserver} prints an error message
9980and exits.} You must use the same port number with the host @value{GDBN}
9981@code{target remote} command.
9982
9983@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
9984you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
9985symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
9986using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
9987(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
9988running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}.) After that, use @code{target
9989remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserver}. Its argument
9990is either a device name (usually a serial device, like
9991@file{/dev/ttyb}), or a TCP port descriptor in the form
9992@code{@var{host}:@var{PORT}}. For example:
9993
9994@smallexample
9995(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
9996@end smallexample
9997
9998@noindent
9999communicates with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}, and
10000
10001@smallexample
10002(@value{GDBP}) target remote the-target:2345
10003@end smallexample
10004
10005@noindent
10006communicates via a TCP connection to port 2345 on host @w{@file{the-target}}.
10007For TCP connections, you must start up @code{gdbserver} prior to using
10008the @code{target remote} command. Otherwise you may get an error whose
10009text depends on the host system, but which usually looks something like
10010@samp{Connection refused}.
10011@end table
10012
10013@node NetWare
10014@section Using the @code{gdbserve.nlm} program
10015
10016@kindex gdbserve.nlm
10017@code{gdbserve.nlm} is a control program for NetWare systems, which
10018allows you to connect your program with a remote @value{GDBN} via
10019@code{target remote}.
10020
10021@value{GDBN} and @code{gdbserve.nlm} communicate via a serial line,
10022using the standard @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol.
10023
10024@table @emph
10025@item On the target machine,
10026you need to have a copy of the program you want to debug.
10027@code{gdbserve.nlm} does not need your program's symbol table, so you
10028can strip the program if necessary to save space. @value{GDBN} on the
10029host system does all the symbol handling.
10030
10031To use the server, you must tell it how to communicate with
10032@value{GDBN}; the name of your program; and the arguments for your
10033program. The syntax is:
10034
10035@smallexample
10036load gdbserve [ BOARD=@var{board} ] [ PORT=@var{port} ]
10037 [ BAUD=@var{baud} ] @var{program} [ @var{args} @dots{} ]
10038@end smallexample
10039
10040@var{board} and @var{port} specify the serial line; @var{baud} specifies
10041the baud rate used by the connection. @var{port} and @var{node} default
10042to 0, @var{baud} defaults to 9600@dmn{bps}.
10043
10044For example, to debug Emacs with the argument @samp{foo.txt}and
10045communicate with @value{GDBN} over serial port number 2 or board 1
10046using a 19200@dmn{bps} connection:
10047
10048@smallexample
10049load gdbserve BOARD=1 PORT=2 BAUD=19200 emacs foo.txt
10050@end smallexample
10051
10052@item On the @value{GDBN} host machine,
10053you need an unstripped copy of your program, since @value{GDBN} needs
10054symbols and debugging information. Start up @value{GDBN} as usual,
10055using the name of the local copy of your program as the first argument.
10056(You may also need the @w{@samp{--baud}} option if the serial line is
10057running at anything other than 9600@dmn{bps}. After that, use @code{target
10058remote} to establish communications with @code{gdbserve.nlm}. Its
10059argument is a device name (usually a serial device, like
10060@file{/dev/ttyb}). For example:
10061
10062@smallexample
10063(@value{GDBP}) target remote /dev/ttyb
10064@end smallexample
10065
10066@noindent
10067communications with the server via serial line @file{/dev/ttyb}.
10068@end table
10069
10070@node remote stub
10071@section Implementing a remote stub
7a292a7a 10072
8e04817f
AC
10073@cindex debugging stub, example
10074@cindex remote stub, example
10075@cindex stub example, remote debugging
10076The stub files provided with @value{GDBN} implement the target side of the
10077communication protocol, and the @value{GDBN} side is implemented in the
10078@value{GDBN} source file @file{remote.c}. Normally, you can simply allow
10079these subroutines to communicate, and ignore the details. (If you're
10080implementing your own stub file, you can still ignore the details: start
10081with one of the existing stub files. @file{sparc-stub.c} is the best
10082organized, and therefore the easiest to read.)
10083
104c1213
JM
10084@cindex remote serial debugging, overview
10085To debug a program running on another machine (the debugging
10086@dfn{target} machine), you must first arrange for all the usual
10087prerequisites for the program to run by itself. For example, for a C
10088program, you need:
c906108c 10089
104c1213
JM
10090@enumerate
10091@item
10092A startup routine to set up the C runtime environment; these usually
10093have a name like @file{crt0}. The startup routine may be supplied by
10094your hardware supplier, or you may have to write your own.
96baa820 10095
5d161b24 10096@item
d4f3574e 10097A C subroutine library to support your program's
104c1213 10098subroutine calls, notably managing input and output.
96baa820 10099
104c1213
JM
10100@item
10101A way of getting your program to the other machine---for example, a
10102download program. These are often supplied by the hardware
10103manufacturer, but you may have to write your own from hardware
10104documentation.
10105@end enumerate
96baa820 10106
104c1213
JM
10107The next step is to arrange for your program to use a serial port to
10108communicate with the machine where @value{GDBN} is running (the @dfn{host}
10109machine). In general terms, the scheme looks like this:
96baa820 10110
104c1213
JM
10111@table @emph
10112@item On the host,
10113@value{GDBN} already understands how to use this protocol; when everything
10114else is set up, you can simply use the @samp{target remote} command
10115(@pxref{Targets,,Specifying a Debugging Target}).
10116
10117@item On the target,
10118you must link with your program a few special-purpose subroutines that
10119implement the @value{GDBN} remote serial protocol. The file containing these
10120subroutines is called a @dfn{debugging stub}.
10121
10122On certain remote targets, you can use an auxiliary program
10123@code{gdbserver} instead of linking a stub into your program.
10124@xref{Server,,Using the @code{gdbserver} program}, for details.
10125@end table
96baa820 10126
104c1213
JM
10127The debugging stub is specific to the architecture of the remote
10128machine; for example, use @file{sparc-stub.c} to debug programs on
10129@sc{sparc} boards.
96baa820 10130
104c1213
JM
10131@cindex remote serial stub list
10132These working remote stubs are distributed with @value{GDBN}:
96baa820 10133
104c1213
JM
10134@table @code
10135
10136@item i386-stub.c
41afff9a 10137@cindex @file{i386-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10138@cindex Intel
10139@cindex i386
10140For Intel 386 and compatible architectures.
10141
10142@item m68k-stub.c
41afff9a 10143@cindex @file{m68k-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10144@cindex Motorola 680x0
10145@cindex m680x0
10146For Motorola 680x0 architectures.
10147
10148@item sh-stub.c
41afff9a 10149@cindex @file{sh-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10150@cindex Hitachi
10151@cindex SH
10152For Hitachi SH architectures.
10153
10154@item sparc-stub.c
41afff9a 10155@cindex @file{sparc-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10156@cindex Sparc
10157For @sc{sparc} architectures.
10158
10159@item sparcl-stub.c
41afff9a 10160@cindex @file{sparcl-stub.c}
104c1213
JM
10161@cindex Fujitsu
10162@cindex SparcLite
10163For Fujitsu @sc{sparclite} architectures.
10164
10165@end table
10166
10167The @file{README} file in the @value{GDBN} distribution may list other
10168recently added stubs.
10169
10170@menu
10171* Stub Contents:: What the stub can do for you
10172* Bootstrapping:: What you must do for the stub
10173* Debug Session:: Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10174@end menu
10175
6d2ebf8b 10176@node Stub Contents
6f05cf9f 10177@subsection What the stub can do for you
104c1213
JM
10178
10179@cindex remote serial stub
10180The debugging stub for your architecture supplies these three
10181subroutines:
10182
10183@table @code
10184@item set_debug_traps
10185@kindex set_debug_traps
10186@cindex remote serial stub, initialization
10187This routine arranges for @code{handle_exception} to run when your
10188program stops. You must call this subroutine explicitly near the
10189beginning of your program.
10190
10191@item handle_exception
10192@kindex handle_exception
10193@cindex remote serial stub, main routine
10194This is the central workhorse, but your program never calls it
10195explicitly---the setup code arranges for @code{handle_exception} to
10196run when a trap is triggered.
10197
10198@code{handle_exception} takes control when your program stops during
10199execution (for example, on a breakpoint), and mediates communications
10200with @value{GDBN} on the host machine. This is where the communications
10201protocol is implemented; @code{handle_exception} acts as the @value{GDBN}
d4f3574e 10202representative on the target machine. It begins by sending summary
104c1213
JM
10203information on the state of your program, then continues to execute,
10204retrieving and transmitting any information @value{GDBN} needs, until you
10205execute a @value{GDBN} command that makes your program resume; at that point,
10206@code{handle_exception} returns control to your own code on the target
5d161b24 10207machine.
104c1213
JM
10208
10209@item breakpoint
10210@cindex @code{breakpoint} subroutine, remote
10211Use this auxiliary subroutine to make your program contain a
10212breakpoint. Depending on the particular situation, this may be the only
10213way for @value{GDBN} to get control. For instance, if your target
10214machine has some sort of interrupt button, you won't need to call this;
10215pressing the interrupt button transfers control to
10216@code{handle_exception}---in effect, to @value{GDBN}. On some machines,
10217simply receiving characters on the serial port may also trigger a trap;
10218again, in that situation, you don't need to call @code{breakpoint} from
10219your own program---simply running @samp{target remote} from the host
5d161b24 10220@value{GDBN} session gets control.
104c1213
JM
10221
10222Call @code{breakpoint} if none of these is true, or if you simply want
10223to make certain your program stops at a predetermined point for the
10224start of your debugging session.
10225@end table
10226
6d2ebf8b 10227@node Bootstrapping
6f05cf9f 10228@subsection What you must do for the stub
104c1213
JM
10229
10230@cindex remote stub, support routines
10231The debugging stubs that come with @value{GDBN} are set up for a particular
10232chip architecture, but they have no information about the rest of your
10233debugging target machine.
10234
10235First of all you need to tell the stub how to communicate with the
10236serial port.
10237
10238@table @code
10239@item int getDebugChar()
10240@kindex getDebugChar
10241Write this subroutine to read a single character from the serial port.
10242It may be identical to @code{getchar} for your target system; a
10243different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10244
10245@item void putDebugChar(int)
10246@kindex putDebugChar
10247Write this subroutine to write a single character to the serial port.
5d161b24 10248It may be identical to @code{putchar} for your target system; a
104c1213
JM
10249different name is used to allow you to distinguish the two if you wish.
10250@end table
10251
10252@cindex control C, and remote debugging
10253@cindex interrupting remote targets
10254If you want @value{GDBN} to be able to stop your program while it is
10255running, you need to use an interrupt-driven serial driver, and arrange
10256for it to stop when it receives a @code{^C} (@samp{\003}, the control-C
10257character). That is the character which @value{GDBN} uses to tell the
10258remote system to stop.
10259
10260Getting the debugging target to return the proper status to @value{GDBN}
10261probably requires changes to the standard stub; one quick and dirty way
10262is to just execute a breakpoint instruction (the ``dirty'' part is that
10263@value{GDBN} reports a @code{SIGTRAP} instead of a @code{SIGINT}).
10264
10265Other routines you need to supply are:
10266
10267@table @code
10268@item void exceptionHandler (int @var{exception_number}, void *@var{exception_address})
10269@kindex exceptionHandler
10270Write this function to install @var{exception_address} in the exception
10271handling tables. You need to do this because the stub does not have any
10272way of knowing what the exception handling tables on your target system
10273are like (for example, the processor's table might be in @sc{rom},
10274containing entries which point to a table in @sc{ram}).
10275@var{exception_number} is the exception number which should be changed;
10276its meaning is architecture-dependent (for example, different numbers
10277might represent divide by zero, misaligned access, etc). When this
10278exception occurs, control should be transferred directly to
10279@var{exception_address}, and the processor state (stack, registers,
10280and so on) should be just as it is when a processor exception occurs. So if
10281you want to use a jump instruction to reach @var{exception_address}, it
10282should be a simple jump, not a jump to subroutine.
10283
10284For the 386, @var{exception_address} should be installed as an interrupt
10285gate so that interrupts are masked while the handler runs. The gate
10286should be at privilege level 0 (the most privileged level). The
10287@sc{sparc} and 68k stubs are able to mask interrupts themselves without
10288help from @code{exceptionHandler}.
10289
10290@item void flush_i_cache()
10291@kindex flush_i_cache
d4f3574e 10292On @sc{sparc} and @sc{sparclite} only, write this subroutine to flush the
104c1213
JM
10293instruction cache, if any, on your target machine. If there is no
10294instruction cache, this subroutine may be a no-op.
10295
10296On target machines that have instruction caches, @value{GDBN} requires this
10297function to make certain that the state of your program is stable.
10298@end table
10299
10300@noindent
10301You must also make sure this library routine is available:
10302
10303@table @code
10304@item void *memset(void *, int, int)
10305@kindex memset
10306This is the standard library function @code{memset} that sets an area of
10307memory to a known value. If you have one of the free versions of
10308@code{libc.a}, @code{memset} can be found there; otherwise, you must
10309either obtain it from your hardware manufacturer, or write your own.
10310@end table
10311
10312If you do not use the GNU C compiler, you may need other standard
10313library subroutines as well; this varies from one stub to another,
10314but in general the stubs are likely to use any of the common library
d4f3574e 10315subroutines which @code{@value{GCC}} generates as inline code.
104c1213
JM
10316
10317
6d2ebf8b 10318@node Debug Session
6f05cf9f 10319@subsection Putting it all together
104c1213
JM
10320
10321@cindex remote serial debugging summary
10322In summary, when your program is ready to debug, you must follow these
10323steps.
10324
10325@enumerate
10326@item
6d2ebf8b 10327Make sure you have defined the supporting low-level routines
104c1213
JM
10328(@pxref{Bootstrapping,,What you must do for the stub}):
10329@display
10330@code{getDebugChar}, @code{putDebugChar},
10331@code{flush_i_cache}, @code{memset}, @code{exceptionHandler}.
10332@end display
10333
10334@item
10335Insert these lines near the top of your program:
10336
10337@example
10338set_debug_traps();
10339breakpoint();
10340@end example
10341
10342@item
10343For the 680x0 stub only, you need to provide a variable called
10344@code{exceptionHook}. Normally you just use:
10345
10346@example
10347void (*exceptionHook)() = 0;
10348@end example
10349
d4f3574e 10350@noindent
104c1213 10351but if before calling @code{set_debug_traps}, you set it to point to a
598ca718 10352function in your program, that function is called when
104c1213
JM
10353@code{@value{GDBN}} continues after stopping on a trap (for example, bus
10354error). The function indicated by @code{exceptionHook} is called with
10355one parameter: an @code{int} which is the exception number.
10356
10357@item
10358Compile and link together: your program, the @value{GDBN} debugging stub for
10359your target architecture, and the supporting subroutines.
10360
10361@item
10362Make sure you have a serial connection between your target machine and
10363the @value{GDBN} host, and identify the serial port on the host.
10364
10365@item
10366@c The "remote" target now provides a `load' command, so we should
10367@c document that. FIXME.
10368Download your program to your target machine (or get it there by
10369whatever means the manufacturer provides), and start it.
10370
10371@item
10372To start remote debugging, run @value{GDBN} on the host machine, and specify
10373as an executable file the program that is running in the remote machine.
10374This tells @value{GDBN} how to find your program's symbols and the contents
10375of its pure text.
10376
d4f3574e 10377@item
104c1213 10378@cindex serial line, @code{target remote}
d4f3574e 10379Establish communication using the @code{target remote} command.
104c1213
JM
10380Its argument specifies how to communicate with the target
10381machine---either via a devicename attached to a direct serial line, or a
10382TCP port (usually to a terminal server which in turn has a serial line
10383to the target). For example, to use a serial line connected to the
10384device named @file{/dev/ttyb}:
10385
10386@example
10387target remote /dev/ttyb
10388@end example
10389
10390@cindex TCP port, @code{target remote}
10391To use a TCP connection, use an argument of the form
10392@code{@var{host}:port}. For example, to connect to port 2828 on a
10393terminal server named @code{manyfarms}:
10394
10395@example
10396target remote manyfarms:2828
10397@end example
a2bea4c3
CV
10398
10399If your remote target is actually running on the same machine as
10400your debugger session (e.g.@: a simulator of your target running on
10401the same host), you can omit the hostname. For example, to connect
10402to port 1234 on your local machine:
10403
10404@example
10405target remote :1234
10406@end example
10407@noindent
10408
10409Note that the colon is still required here.
104c1213
JM
10410@end enumerate
10411
10412Now you can use all the usual commands to examine and change data and to
10413step and continue the remote program.
10414
10415To resume the remote program and stop debugging it, use the @code{detach}
10416command.
10417
10418@cindex interrupting remote programs
10419@cindex remote programs, interrupting
10420Whenever @value{GDBN} is waiting for the remote program, if you type the
10421interrupt character (often @key{C-C}), @value{GDBN} attempts to stop the
10422program. This may or may not succeed, depending in part on the hardware
10423and the serial drivers the remote system uses. If you type the
10424interrupt character once again, @value{GDBN} displays this prompt:
10425
10426@example
10427Interrupted while waiting for the program.
10428Give up (and stop debugging it)? (y or n)
10429@end example
10430
10431If you type @kbd{y}, @value{GDBN} abandons the remote debugging session.
10432(If you decide you want to try again later, you can use @samp{target
10433remote} again to connect once more.) If you type @kbd{n}, @value{GDBN}
10434goes back to waiting.
10435
104c1213 10436
8e04817f
AC
10437@node Configurations
10438@chapter Configuration-Specific Information
104c1213 10439
8e04817f
AC
10440While nearly all @value{GDBN} commands are available for all native and
10441cross versions of the debugger, there are some exceptions. This chapter
10442describes things that are only available in certain configurations.
104c1213 10443
8e04817f
AC
10444There are three major categories of configurations: native
10445configurations, where the host and target are the same, embedded
10446operating system configurations, which are usually the same for several
10447different processor architectures, and bare embedded processors, which
10448are quite different from each other.
104c1213 10449
8e04817f
AC
10450@menu
10451* Native::
10452* Embedded OS::
10453* Embedded Processors::
10454* Architectures::
10455@end menu
104c1213 10456
8e04817f
AC
10457@node Native
10458@section Native
104c1213 10459
8e04817f
AC
10460This section describes details specific to particular native
10461configurations.
6cf7e474 10462
8e04817f
AC
10463@menu
10464* HP-UX:: HP-UX
10465* SVR4 Process Information:: SVR4 process information
10466* DJGPP Native:: Features specific to the DJGPP port
10467@end menu
6cf7e474 10468
8e04817f
AC
10469@node HP-UX
10470@subsection HP-UX
104c1213 10471
8e04817f
AC
10472On HP-UX systems, if you refer to a function or variable name that
10473begins with a dollar sign, @value{GDBN} searches for a user or system
10474name first, before it searches for a convenience variable.
104c1213 10475
8e04817f
AC
10476@node SVR4 Process Information
10477@subsection SVR4 process information
104c1213 10478
8e04817f
AC
10479@kindex /proc
10480@cindex process image
104c1213 10481
8e04817f
AC
10482Many versions of SVR4 provide a facility called @samp{/proc} that can be
10483used to examine the image of a running process using file-system
10484subroutines. If @value{GDBN} is configured for an operating system with
10485this facility, the command @code{info proc} is available to report on
10486several kinds of information about the process running your program.
10487@code{info proc} works only on SVR4 systems that include the
10488@code{procfs} code. This includes OSF/1 (Digital Unix), Solaris, Irix,
10489and Unixware, but not HP-UX or Linux, for example.
104c1213 10490
8e04817f
AC
10491@table @code
10492@kindex info proc
10493@item info proc
10494Summarize available information about the process.
6cf7e474 10495
8e04817f
AC
10496@kindex info proc mappings
10497@item info proc mappings
10498Report on the address ranges accessible in the program, with information
10499on whether your program may read, write, or execute each range.
10500@ignore
10501@comment These sub-options of 'info proc' were not included when
10502@comment procfs.c was re-written. Keep their descriptions around
10503@comment against the day when someone finds the time to put them back in.
10504@kindex info proc times
10505@item info proc times
10506Starting time, user CPU time, and system CPU time for your program and
10507its children.
6cf7e474 10508
8e04817f
AC
10509@kindex info proc id
10510@item info proc id
10511Report on the process IDs related to your program: its own process ID,
10512the ID of its parent, the process group ID, and the session ID.
104c1213 10513
8e04817f
AC
10514@kindex info proc status
10515@item info proc status
10516General information on the state of the process. If the process is
10517stopped, this report includes the reason for stopping, and any signal
10518received.
d4f3574e 10519
8e04817f
AC
10520@item info proc all
10521Show all the above information about the process.
10522@end ignore
10523@end table
104c1213 10524
8e04817f
AC
10525@node DJGPP Native
10526@subsection Features for Debugging @sc{djgpp} Programs
10527@cindex @sc{djgpp} debugging
10528@cindex native @sc{djgpp} debugging
10529@cindex MS-DOS-specific commands
104c1213 10530
8e04817f
AC
10531@sc{djgpp} is the port of @sc{gnu} development tools to MS-DOS and
10532MS-Windows. @sc{djgpp} programs are 32-bit protected-mode programs
10533that use the @dfn{DPMI} (DOS Protected-Mode Interface) API to run on
10534top of real-mode DOS systems and their emulations.
104c1213 10535
8e04817f
AC
10536@value{GDBN} supports native debugging of @sc{djgpp} programs, and
10537defines a few commands specific to the @sc{djgpp} port. This
10538subsection describes those commands.
104c1213 10539
8e04817f
AC
10540@table @code
10541@kindex info dos
10542@item info dos
10543This is a prefix of @sc{djgpp}-specific commands which print
10544information about the target system and important OS structures.
f1251bdd 10545
8e04817f
AC
10546@kindex sysinfo
10547@cindex MS-DOS system info
10548@cindex free memory information (MS-DOS)
10549@item info dos sysinfo
10550This command displays assorted information about the underlying
10551platform: the CPU type and features, the OS version and flavor, the
10552DPMI version, and the available conventional and DPMI memory.
104c1213 10553
8e04817f
AC
10554@cindex GDT
10555@cindex LDT
10556@cindex IDT
10557@cindex segment descriptor tables
10558@cindex descriptor tables display
10559@item info dos gdt
10560@itemx info dos ldt
10561@itemx info dos idt
10562These 3 commands display entries from, respectively, Global, Local,
10563and Interrupt Descriptor Tables (GDT, LDT, and IDT). The descriptor
10564tables are data structures which store a descriptor for each segment
10565that is currently in use. The segment's selector is an index into a
10566descriptor table; the table entry for that index holds the
10567descriptor's base address and limit, and its attributes and access
10568rights.
104c1213 10569
8e04817f
AC
10570A typical @sc{djgpp} program uses 3 segments: a code segment, a data
10571segment (used for both data and the stack), and a DOS segment (which
10572allows access to DOS/BIOS data structures and absolute addresses in
10573conventional memory). However, the DPMI host will usually define
10574additional segments in order to support the DPMI environment.
d4f3574e 10575
8e04817f
AC
10576@cindex garbled pointers
10577These commands allow to display entries from the descriptor tables.
10578Without an argument, all entries from the specified table are
10579displayed. An argument, which should be an integer expression, means
10580display a single entry whose index is given by the argument. For
10581example, here's a convenient way to display information about the
10582debugged program's data segment:
104c1213 10583
8e04817f
AC
10584@smallexample
10585@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos ldt $ds}
10586@exdent @code{0x13f: base=0x11970000 limit=0x0009ffff 32-Bit Data (Read/Write, Exp-up)}
10587@end smallexample
104c1213 10588
8e04817f
AC
10589@noindent
10590This comes in handy when you want to see whether a pointer is outside
10591the data segment's limit (i.e.@: @dfn{garbled}).
104c1213 10592
8e04817f
AC
10593@cindex page tables display (MS-DOS)
10594@item info dos pde
10595@itemx info dos pte
10596These two commands display entries from, respectively, the Page
10597Directory and the Page Tables. Page Directories and Page Tables are
10598data structures which control how virtual memory addresses are mapped
10599into physical addresses. A Page Table includes an entry for every
10600page of memory that is mapped into the program's address space; there
10601may be several Page Tables, each one holding up to 4096 entries. A
10602Page Directory has up to 4096 entries, one each for every Page Table
10603that is currently in use.
104c1213 10604
8e04817f
AC
10605Without an argument, @kbd{info dos pde} displays the entire Page
10606Directory, and @kbd{info dos pte} displays all the entries in all of
10607the Page Tables. An argument, an integer expression, given to the
10608@kbd{info dos pde} command means display only that entry from the Page
10609Directory table. An argument given to the @kbd{info dos pte} command
10610means display entries from a single Page Table, the one pointed to by
10611the specified entry in the Page Directory.
104c1213 10612
8e04817f
AC
10613@cindex direct memory access (DMA) on MS-DOS
10614These commands are useful when your program uses @dfn{DMA} (Direct
10615Memory Access), which needs physical addresses to program the DMA
10616controller.
104c1213 10617
8e04817f 10618These commands are supported only with some DPMI servers.
104c1213 10619
8e04817f
AC
10620@cindex physical address from linear address
10621@item info dos address-pte @var{addr}
10622This command displays the Page Table entry for a specified linear
10623address. The argument linear address @var{addr} should already have the
10624appropriate segment's base address added to it, because this command
10625accepts addresses which may belong to @emph{any} segment. For
10626example, here's how to display the Page Table entry for the page where
10627the variable @code{i} is stored:
104c1213 10628
8e04817f
AC
10629@smallexample
10630@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte __djgpp_base_address + (char *)&i}
10631@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x11a00d30:}
10632@exdent @code{Base=0x02698000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0xd30}
10633@end smallexample
104c1213 10634
8e04817f
AC
10635@noindent
10636This says that @code{i} is stored at offset @code{0xd30} from the page
10637whose physical base address is @code{0x02698000}, and prints all the
10638attributes of that page.
104c1213 10639
8e04817f
AC
10640Note that you must cast the addresses of variables to a @code{char *},
10641since otherwise the value of @code{__djgpp_base_address}, the base
10642address of all variables and functions in a @sc{djgpp} program, will
10643be added using the rules of C pointer arithmetics: if @code{i} is
10644declared an @code{int}, @value{GDBN} will add 4 times the value of
10645@code{__djgpp_base_address} to the address of @code{i}.
104c1213 10646
8e04817f
AC
10647Here's another example, it displays the Page Table entry for the
10648transfer buffer:
104c1213 10649
8e04817f
AC
10650@smallexample
10651@exdent @code{(@value{GDBP}) info dos address-pte *((unsigned *)&_go32_info_block + 3)}
10652@exdent @code{Page Table entry for address 0x29110:}
10653@exdent @code{Base=0x00029000 Dirty Acc. Not-Cached Write-Back Usr Read-Write +0x110}
10654@end smallexample
104c1213 10655
8e04817f
AC
10656@noindent
10657(The @code{+ 3} offset is because the transfer buffer's address is the
106583rd member of the @code{_go32_info_block} structure.) The output of
10659this command clearly shows that addresses in conventional memory are
10660mapped 1:1, i.e.@: the physical and linear addresses are identical.
104c1213 10661
8e04817f
AC
10662This command is supported only with some DPMI servers.
10663@end table
104c1213 10664
8e04817f
AC
10665@node Embedded OS
10666@section Embedded Operating Systems
104c1213 10667
8e04817f
AC
10668This section describes configurations involving the debugging of
10669embedded operating systems that are available for several different
10670architectures.
d4f3574e 10671
8e04817f
AC
10672@menu
10673* VxWorks:: Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
10674@end menu
104c1213 10675
8e04817f
AC
10676@value{GDBN} includes the ability to debug programs running on
10677various real-time operating systems.
104c1213 10678
8e04817f
AC
10679@node VxWorks
10680@subsection Using @value{GDBN} with VxWorks
104c1213 10681
8e04817f 10682@cindex VxWorks
104c1213 10683
8e04817f 10684@table @code
104c1213 10685
8e04817f
AC
10686@kindex target vxworks
10687@item target vxworks @var{machinename}
10688A VxWorks system, attached via TCP/IP. The argument @var{machinename}
10689is the target system's machine name or IP address.
104c1213 10690
8e04817f 10691@end table
104c1213 10692
8e04817f
AC
10693On VxWorks, @code{load} links @var{filename} dynamically on the
10694current target system as well as adding its symbols in @value{GDBN}.
104c1213 10695
8e04817f
AC
10696@value{GDBN} enables developers to spawn and debug tasks running on networked
10697VxWorks targets from a Unix host. Already-running tasks spawned from
10698the VxWorks shell can also be debugged. @value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
10699both the Unix host and on the VxWorks target. The program
10700@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host. (It may be
10701installed with the name @code{vxgdb}, to distinguish it from a
10702@value{GDBN} for debugging programs on the host itself.)
104c1213 10703
8e04817f
AC
10704@table @code
10705@item VxWorks-timeout @var{args}
10706@kindex vxworks-timeout
10707All VxWorks-based targets now support the option @code{vxworks-timeout}.
10708This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
10709seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses to rpc's. You might use this if
10710your VxWorks target is a slow software simulator or is on the far side
10711of a thin network line.
10712@end table
104c1213 10713
8e04817f
AC
10714The following information on connecting to VxWorks was current when
10715this manual was produced; newer releases of VxWorks may use revised
10716procedures.
104c1213 10717
8e04817f
AC
10718@kindex INCLUDE_RDB
10719To use @value{GDBN} with VxWorks, you must rebuild your VxWorks kernel
10720to include the remote debugging interface routines in the VxWorks
10721library @file{rdb.a}. To do this, define @code{INCLUDE_RDB} in the
10722VxWorks configuration file @file{configAll.h} and rebuild your VxWorks
10723kernel. The resulting kernel contains @file{rdb.a}, and spawns the
10724source debugging task @code{tRdbTask} when VxWorks is booted. For more
10725information on configuring and remaking VxWorks, see the manufacturer's
10726manual.
10727@c VxWorks, see the @cite{VxWorks Programmer's Guide}.
104c1213 10728
8e04817f
AC
10729Once you have included @file{rdb.a} in your VxWorks system image and set
10730your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
10731run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}} (or
10732@code{vxgdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 10733
8e04817f 10734@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
104c1213 10735
8e04817f
AC
10736@example
10737(vxgdb)
10738@end example
104c1213 10739
8e04817f
AC
10740@menu
10741* VxWorks Connection:: Connecting to VxWorks
10742* VxWorks Download:: VxWorks download
10743* VxWorks Attach:: Running tasks
10744@end menu
104c1213 10745
8e04817f
AC
10746@node VxWorks Connection
10747@subsubsection Connecting to VxWorks
104c1213 10748
8e04817f
AC
10749The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a VxWorks target on the
10750network. To connect to a target whose host name is ``@code{tt}'', type:
104c1213 10751
8e04817f
AC
10752@example
10753(vxgdb) target vxworks tt
10754@end example
104c1213 10755
8e04817f
AC
10756@need 750
10757@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 10758
8e04817f
AC
10759@smallexample
10760Attaching remote machine across net...
10761Connected to tt.
10762@end smallexample
104c1213 10763
8e04817f
AC
10764@need 1000
10765@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol tables of any object modules
10766loaded into the VxWorks target since it was last booted. @value{GDBN} locates
10767these files by searching the directories listed in the command search
10768path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}); if it fails
10769to find an object file, it displays a message such as:
5d161b24 10770
8e04817f
AC
10771@example
10772prog.o: No such file or directory.
10773@end example
104c1213 10774
8e04817f
AC
10775When this happens, add the appropriate directory to the search path with
10776the @value{GDBN} command @code{path}, and execute the @code{target}
10777command again.
104c1213 10778
8e04817f
AC
10779@node VxWorks Download
10780@subsubsection VxWorks download
104c1213 10781
8e04817f
AC
10782@cindex download to VxWorks
10783If you have connected to the VxWorks target and you want to debug an
10784object that has not yet been loaded, you can use the @value{GDBN}
10785@code{load} command to download a file from Unix to VxWorks
10786incrementally. The object file given as an argument to the @code{load}
10787command is actually opened twice: first by the VxWorks target in order
10788to download the code, then by @value{GDBN} in order to read the symbol
10789table. This can lead to problems if the current working directories on
10790the two systems differ. If both systems have NFS mounted the same
10791filesystems, you can avoid these problems by using absolute paths.
10792Otherwise, it is simplest to set the working directory on both systems
10793to the directory in which the object file resides, and then to reference
10794the file by its name, without any path. For instance, a program
10795@file{prog.o} may reside in @file{@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb} in VxWorks
10796and in @file{@var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb} on the host. To load this
10797program, type this on VxWorks:
104c1213 10798
8e04817f
AC
10799@example
10800-> cd "@var{vxpath}/vw/demo/rdb"
10801@end example
104c1213 10802
8e04817f
AC
10803@noindent
10804Then, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 10805
8e04817f
AC
10806@example
10807(vxgdb) cd @var{hostpath}/vw/demo/rdb
10808(vxgdb) load prog.o
10809@end example
104c1213 10810
8e04817f 10811@value{GDBN} displays a response similar to this:
104c1213 10812
8e04817f
AC
10813@smallexample
10814Reading symbol data from wherever/vw/demo/rdb/prog.o... done.
10815@end smallexample
104c1213 10816
8e04817f
AC
10817You can also use the @code{load} command to reload an object module
10818after editing and recompiling the corresponding source file. Note that
10819this makes @value{GDBN} delete all currently-defined breakpoints,
10820auto-displays, and convenience variables, and to clear the value
10821history. (This is necessary in order to preserve the integrity of
10822debugger's data structures that reference the target system's symbol
10823table.)
104c1213 10824
8e04817f
AC
10825@node VxWorks Attach
10826@subsubsection Running tasks
104c1213
JM
10827
10828@cindex running VxWorks tasks
10829You can also attach to an existing task using the @code{attach} command as
10830follows:
10831
10832@example
10833(vxgdb) attach @var{task}
10834@end example
10835
10836@noindent
10837where @var{task} is the VxWorks hexadecimal task ID. The task can be running
10838or suspended when you attach to it. Running tasks are suspended at
10839the time of attachment.
10840
6d2ebf8b 10841@node Embedded Processors
104c1213
JM
10842@section Embedded Processors
10843
10844This section goes into details specific to particular embedded
10845configurations.
10846
7d86b5d5
AC
10847
10848@c OBSOLETE * A29K Embedded:: AMD A29K Embedded
104c1213 10849@menu
104c1213
JM
10850* ARM:: ARM
10851* H8/300:: Hitachi H8/300
10852* H8/500:: Hitachi H8/500
10853* i960:: Intel i960
10854* M32R/D:: Mitsubishi M32R/D
10855* M68K:: Motorola M68K
10856* M88K:: Motorola M88K
10857* MIPS Embedded:: MIPS Embedded
10858* PA:: HP PA Embedded
10859* PowerPC: PowerPC
10860* SH:: Hitachi SH
10861* Sparclet:: Tsqware Sparclet
10862* Sparclite:: Fujitsu Sparclite
10863* ST2000:: Tandem ST2000
10864* Z8000:: Zilog Z8000
10865@end menu
10866
7d86b5d5
AC
10867@c OBSOLETE @node A29K Embedded
10868@c OBSOLETE @subsection AMD A29K Embedded
10869@c OBSOLETE
10870@c OBSOLETE @menu
10871@c OBSOLETE * A29K UDI::
10872@c OBSOLETE * A29K EB29K::
10873@c OBSOLETE * Comms (EB29K):: Communications setup
10874@c OBSOLETE * gdb-EB29K:: EB29K cross-debugging
10875@c OBSOLETE * Remote Log:: Remote log
10876@c OBSOLETE @end menu
10877@c OBSOLETE
10878@c OBSOLETE @table @code
10879@c OBSOLETE
10880@c OBSOLETE @kindex target adapt
10881@c OBSOLETE @item target adapt @var{dev}
10882@c OBSOLETE Adapt monitor for A29K.
10883@c OBSOLETE
10884@c OBSOLETE @kindex target amd-eb
10885@c OBSOLETE @item target amd-eb @var{dev} @var{speed} @var{PROG}
10886@c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD EB29K
10887@c OBSOLETE Remote PC-resident AMD EB29K board, attached over serial lines.
10888@c OBSOLETE @var{dev} is the serial device, as for @code{target remote};
10889@c OBSOLETE @var{speed} allows you to specify the linespeed; and @var{PROG} is the
10890@c OBSOLETE name of the program to be debugged, as it appears to DOS on the PC.
10891@c OBSOLETE @xref{A29K EB29K, ,EBMON protocol for AMD29K}.
10892@c OBSOLETE
10893@c OBSOLETE @end table
10894@c OBSOLETE
10895@c OBSOLETE @node A29K UDI
10896@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection A29K UDI
10897@c OBSOLETE
10898@c OBSOLETE @cindex UDI
10899@c OBSOLETE @cindex AMD29K via UDI
10900@c OBSOLETE
10901@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} supports AMD's UDI (``Universal Debugger Interface'')
10902@c OBSOLETE protocol for debugging the a29k processor family. To use this
10903@c OBSOLETE configuration with AMD targets running the MiniMON monitor, you need the
10904@c OBSOLETE program @code{MONTIP}, available from AMD at no charge. You can also
10905@c OBSOLETE use @value{GDBN} with the UDI-conformant a29k simulator program
10906@c OBSOLETE @code{ISSTIP}, also available from AMD.
10907@c OBSOLETE
10908@c OBSOLETE @table @code
10909@c OBSOLETE @item target udi @var{keyword}
10910@c OBSOLETE @kindex udi
10911@c OBSOLETE Select the UDI interface to a remote a29k board or simulator, where
10912@c OBSOLETE @var{keyword} is an entry in the AMD configuration file @file{udi_soc}.
10913@c OBSOLETE This file contains keyword entries which specify parameters used to
10914@c OBSOLETE connect to a29k targets. If the @file{udi_soc} file is not in your
10915@c OBSOLETE working directory, you must set the environment variable @samp{UDICONF}
10916@c OBSOLETE to its pathname.
10917@c OBSOLETE @end table
10918@c OBSOLETE
10919@c OBSOLETE @node A29K EB29K
10920@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EBMON protocol for AMD29K
10921@c OBSOLETE
10922@c OBSOLETE @cindex EB29K board
10923@c OBSOLETE @cindex running 29K programs
10924@c OBSOLETE
10925@c OBSOLETE AMD distributes a 29K development board meant to fit in a PC, together
10926@c OBSOLETE with a DOS-hosted monitor program called @code{EBMON}. As a shorthand
10927@c OBSOLETE term, this development system is called the ``EB29K''. To use
10928@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBN} from a Unix system to run programs on the EB29K board, you
10929@c OBSOLETE must first connect a serial cable between the PC (which hosts the EB29K
10930@c OBSOLETE board) and a serial port on the Unix system. In the following, we
10931@c OBSOLETE assume you've hooked the cable between the PC's @file{COM1} port and
10932@c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} on the Unix system.
10933@c OBSOLETE
10934@c OBSOLETE @node Comms (EB29K)
10935@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Communications setup
10936@c OBSOLETE
10937@c OBSOLETE The next step is to set up the PC's port, by doing something like this
10938@c OBSOLETE in DOS on the PC:
10939@c OBSOLETE
10940@c OBSOLETE @example
10941@c OBSOLETE C:\> MODE com1:9600,n,8,1,none
10942@c OBSOLETE @end example
10943@c OBSOLETE
10944@c OBSOLETE @noindent
10945@c OBSOLETE This example---run on an MS DOS 4.0 system---sets the PC port to 9600
10946@c OBSOLETE bps, no parity, eight data bits, one stop bit, and no ``retry'' action;
10947@c OBSOLETE you must match the communications parameters when establishing the Unix
10948@c OBSOLETE end of the connection as well.
10949@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: Who knows what this "no retry action" crud from the DOS manual may
10950@c OBSOLETE @c mean? It's optional; leave it out? ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10951@c OBSOLETE @c
10952@c OBSOLETE @c It's optional, but it's unwise to omit it: who knows what is the
10953@c OBSOLETE @c default value set when the DOS machines boots? "No retry" means that
10954@c OBSOLETE @c the DOS serial device driver won't retry the operation if it fails;
10955@c OBSOLETE @c I understand that this is needed because the GDB serial protocol
10956@c OBSOLETE @c handles any errors and retransmissions itself. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3sep99
10957@c OBSOLETE
10958@c OBSOLETE To give control of the PC to the Unix side of the serial line, type
10959@c OBSOLETE the following at the DOS console:
10960@c OBSOLETE
10961@c OBSOLETE @example
10962@c OBSOLETE C:\> CTTY com1
10963@c OBSOLETE @end example
10964@c OBSOLETE
10965@c OBSOLETE @noindent
10966@c OBSOLETE (Later, if you wish to return control to the DOS console, you can use
10967@c OBSOLETE the command @code{CTTY con}---but you must send it over the device that
10968@c OBSOLETE had control, in our example over the @file{COM1} serial line.)
10969@c OBSOLETE
10970@c OBSOLETE From the Unix host, use a communications program such as @code{tip} or
10971@c OBSOLETE @code{cu} to communicate with the PC; for example,
10972@c OBSOLETE
10973@c OBSOLETE @example
10974@c OBSOLETE cu -s 9600 -l /dev/ttya
10975@c OBSOLETE @end example
10976@c OBSOLETE
10977@c OBSOLETE @noindent
10978@c OBSOLETE The @code{cu} options shown specify, respectively, the linespeed and the
10979@c OBSOLETE serial port to use. If you use @code{tip} instead, your command line
10980@c OBSOLETE may look something like the following:
10981@c OBSOLETE
10982@c OBSOLETE @example
10983@c OBSOLETE tip -9600 /dev/ttya
10984@c OBSOLETE @end example
10985@c OBSOLETE
10986@c OBSOLETE @noindent
10987@c OBSOLETE Your system may require a different name where we show
10988@c OBSOLETE @file{/dev/ttya} as the argument to @code{tip}. The communications
10989@c OBSOLETE parameters, including which port to use, are associated with the
10990@c OBSOLETE @code{tip} argument in the ``remote'' descriptions file---normally the
10991@c OBSOLETE system table @file{/etc/remote}.
10992@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: What if anything needs doing to match the "n,8,1,none" part of
10993@c OBSOLETE @c the DOS side's comms setup? cu can support -o (odd
10994@c OBSOLETE @c parity), -e (even parity)---apparently no settings for no parity or
10995@c OBSOLETE @c for character size. Taken from stty maybe...? John points out tip
10996@c OBSOLETE @c can set these as internal variables, eg ~s parity=none; man stty
10997@c OBSOLETE @c suggests that it *might* work to stty these options with stdin or
10998@c OBSOLETE @c stdout redirected... ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
10999@c OBSOLETE @c
11000@c OBSOLETE @c There's nothing to be done for the "none" part of the DOS MODE
11001@c OBSOLETE @c command. The rest of the parameters should be matched by the
11002@c OBSOLETE @c baudrate, bits, and parity used by the Unix side. ---Eli Zaretskii, 3Sep99
11003@c OBSOLETE
11004@c OBSOLETE @kindex EBMON
11005@c OBSOLETE Using the @code{tip} or @code{cu} connection, change the DOS working
11006@c OBSOLETE directory to the directory containing a copy of your 29K program, then
11007@c OBSOLETE start the PC program @code{EBMON} (an EB29K control program supplied
11008@c OBSOLETE with your board by AMD). You should see an initial display from
11009@c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} similar to the one that follows, ending with the
11010@c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON} prompt @samp{#}---
11011@c OBSOLETE
11012@c OBSOLETE @example
11013@c OBSOLETE C:\> G:
11014@c OBSOLETE
11015@c OBSOLETE G:\> CD \usr\joe\work29k
11016@c OBSOLETE
11017@c OBSOLETE G:\USR\JOE\WORK29K> EBMON
11018@c OBSOLETE Am29000 PC Coprocessor Board Monitor, version 3.0-18
11019@c OBSOLETE Copyright 1990 Advanced Micro Devices, Inc.
11020@c OBSOLETE Written by Gibbons and Associates, Inc.
11021@c OBSOLETE
11022@c OBSOLETE Enter '?' or 'H' for help
11023@c OBSOLETE
11024@c OBSOLETE PC Coprocessor Type = EB29K
11025@c OBSOLETE I/O Base = 0x208
11026@c OBSOLETE Memory Base = 0xd0000
11027@c OBSOLETE
11028@c OBSOLETE Data Memory Size = 2048KB
11029@c OBSOLETE Available I-RAM Range = 0x8000 to 0x1fffff
11030@c OBSOLETE Available D-RAM Range = 0x80002000 to 0x801fffff
11031@c OBSOLETE
11032@c OBSOLETE PageSize = 0x400
11033@c OBSOLETE Register Stack Size = 0x800
11034@c OBSOLETE Memory Stack Size = 0x1800
11035@c OBSOLETE
11036@c OBSOLETE CPU PRL = 0x3
11037@c OBSOLETE Am29027 Available = No
11038@c OBSOLETE Byte Write Available = Yes
11039@c OBSOLETE
11040@c OBSOLETE # ~.
11041@c OBSOLETE @end example
11042@c OBSOLETE
11043@c OBSOLETE Then exit the @code{cu} or @code{tip} program (done in the example by
11044@c OBSOLETE typing @code{~.} at the @code{EBMON} prompt). @code{EBMON} keeps
11045@c OBSOLETE running, ready for @value{GDBN} to take over.
11046@c OBSOLETE
11047@c OBSOLETE For this example, we've assumed what is probably the most convenient
11048@c OBSOLETE way to make sure the same 29K program is on both the PC and the Unix
11049@c OBSOLETE system: a PC/NFS connection that establishes ``drive @file{G:}'' on the
11050@c OBSOLETE PC as a file system on the Unix host. If you do not have PC/NFS or
11051@c OBSOLETE something similar connecting the two systems, you must arrange some
11052@c OBSOLETE other way---perhaps floppy-disk transfer---of getting the 29K program
11053@c OBSOLETE from the Unix system to the PC; @value{GDBN} does @emph{not} download it over the
11054@c OBSOLETE serial line.
11055@c OBSOLETE
11056@c OBSOLETE @node gdb-EB29K
11057@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection EB29K cross-debugging
11058@c OBSOLETE
11059@c OBSOLETE Finally, @code{cd} to the directory containing an image of your 29K
11060@c OBSOLETE program on the Unix system, and start @value{GDBN}---specifying as argument the
11061@c OBSOLETE name of your 29K program:
11062@c OBSOLETE
11063@c OBSOLETE @example
11064@c OBSOLETE cd /usr/joe/work29k
11065@c OBSOLETE @value{GDBP} myfoo
11066@c OBSOLETE @end example
11067@c OBSOLETE
11068@c OBSOLETE @need 500
11069@c OBSOLETE Now you can use the @code{target} command:
11070@c OBSOLETE
11071@c OBSOLETE @example
11072@c OBSOLETE target amd-eb /dev/ttya 9600 MYFOO
11073@c OBSOLETE @c FIXME: test above 'target amd-eb' as spelled, with caps! caps are meant to
11074@c OBSOLETE @c emphasize that this is the name as seen by DOS (since I think DOS is
11075@c OBSOLETE @c single-minded about case of letters). ---doc@cygnus.com, 25feb91
11076@c OBSOLETE @end example
11077@c OBSOLETE
11078@c OBSOLETE @noindent
11079@c OBSOLETE In this example, we've assumed your program is in a file called
11080@c OBSOLETE @file{myfoo}. Note that the filename given as the last argument to
11081@c OBSOLETE @code{target amd-eb} should be the name of the program as it appears to DOS.
11082@c OBSOLETE In our example this is simply @code{MYFOO}, but in general it can include
11083@c OBSOLETE a DOS path, and depending on your transfer mechanism may not resemble
11084@c OBSOLETE the name on the Unix side.
11085@c OBSOLETE
11086@c OBSOLETE At this point, you can set any breakpoints you wish; when you are ready
11087@c OBSOLETE to see your program run on the 29K board, use the @value{GDBN} command
11088@c OBSOLETE @code{run}.
11089@c OBSOLETE
11090@c OBSOLETE To stop debugging the remote program, use the @value{GDBN} @code{detach}
11091@c OBSOLETE command.
11092@c OBSOLETE
11093@c OBSOLETE To return control of the PC to its console, use @code{tip} or @code{cu}
11094@c OBSOLETE once again, after your @value{GDBN} session has concluded, to attach to
11095@c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}. You can then type the command @code{q} to shut down
11096@c OBSOLETE @code{EBMON}, returning control to the DOS command-line interpreter.
11097@c OBSOLETE Type @kbd{CTTY con} to return command input to the main DOS console,
11098@c OBSOLETE and type @kbd{~.} to leave @code{tip} or @code{cu}.
11099@c OBSOLETE
11100@c OBSOLETE @node Remote Log
11101@c OBSOLETE @subsubsection Remote log
11102@c OBSOLETE @cindex @file{eb.log}, a log file for EB29K
11103@c OBSOLETE @cindex log file for EB29K
11104@c OBSOLETE
11105@c OBSOLETE The @code{target amd-eb} command creates a file @file{eb.log} in the
11106@c OBSOLETE current working directory, to help debug problems with the connection.
11107@c OBSOLETE @file{eb.log} records all the output from @code{EBMON}, including echoes
11108@c OBSOLETE of the commands sent to it. Running @samp{tail -f} on this file in
11109@c OBSOLETE another window often helps to understand trouble with @code{EBMON}, or
11110@c OBSOLETE unexpected events on the PC side of the connection.
104c1213 11111
6d2ebf8b 11112@node ARM
104c1213
JM
11113@subsection ARM
11114
11115@table @code
11116
8e04817f
AC
11117@kindex target rdi
11118@item target rdi @var{dev}
11119ARM Angel monitor, via RDI library interface to ADP protocol. You may
11120use this target to communicate with both boards running the Angel
11121monitor, or with the EmbeddedICE JTAG debug device.
11122
11123@kindex target rdp
11124@item target rdp @var{dev}
11125ARM Demon monitor.
11126
11127@end table
11128
11129@node H8/300
11130@subsection Hitachi H8/300
11131
11132@table @code
11133
11134@kindex target hms@r{, with H8/300}
11135@item target hms @var{dev}
11136A Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500 board, attached via serial line to your host.
11137Use special commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial
11138line and the communications speed used.
11139
11140@kindex target e7000@r{, with H8/300}
11141@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11142E7000 emulator for Hitachi H8 and SH.
11143
11144@kindex target sh3@r{, with H8/300}
11145@kindex target sh3e@r{, with H8/300}
11146@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11147@itemx target sh3e @var{dev}
11148Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
11149
11150@end table
11151
11152@cindex download to H8/300 or H8/500
11153@cindex H8/300 or H8/500 download
11154@cindex download to Hitachi SH
11155@cindex Hitachi SH download
11156When you select remote debugging to a Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500
11157board, the @code{load} command downloads your program to the Hitachi
11158board and also opens it as the current executable target for
11159@value{GDBN} on your host (like the @code{file} command).
11160
11161@value{GDBN} needs to know these things to talk to your
11162Hitachi SH, H8/300, or H8/500:
11163
11164@enumerate
11165@item
11166that you want to use @samp{target hms}, the remote debugging interface
11167for Hitachi microprocessors, or @samp{target e7000}, the in-circuit
11168emulator for the Hitachi SH and the Hitachi 300H. (@samp{target hms} is
11169the default when @value{GDBN} is configured specifically for the Hitachi SH,
11170H8/300, or H8/500.)
11171
11172@item
11173what serial device connects your host to your Hitachi board (the first
11174serial device available on your host is the default).
11175
11176@item
11177what speed to use over the serial device.
11178@end enumerate
11179
11180@menu
11181* Hitachi Boards:: Connecting to Hitachi boards.
11182* Hitachi ICE:: Using the E7000 In-Circuit Emulator.
11183* Hitachi Special:: Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros.
11184@end menu
11185
11186@node Hitachi Boards
11187@subsubsection Connecting to Hitachi boards
11188
11189@c only for Unix hosts
11190@kindex device
11191@cindex serial device, Hitachi micros
11192Use the special @code{@value{GDBN}} command @samp{device @var{port}} if you
11193need to explicitly set the serial device. The default @var{port} is the
11194first available port on your host. This is only necessary on Unix
11195hosts, where it is typically something like @file{/dev/ttya}.
11196
11197@kindex speed
11198@cindex serial line speed, Hitachi micros
11199@code{@value{GDBN}} has another special command to set the communications
11200speed: @samp{speed @var{bps}}. This command also is only used from Unix
11201hosts; on DOS hosts, set the line speed as usual from outside @value{GDBN} with
11202the DOS @code{mode} command (for instance,
11203@w{@kbd{mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p}} for a 9600@dmn{bps} connection).
11204
11205The @samp{device} and @samp{speed} commands are available only when you
11206use a Unix host to debug your Hitachi microprocessor programs. If you
11207use a DOS host,
11208@value{GDBN} depends on an auxiliary terminate-and-stay-resident program
11209called @code{asynctsr} to communicate with the development board
11210through a PC serial port. You must also use the DOS @code{mode} command
11211to set up the serial port on the DOS side.
11212
11213The following sample session illustrates the steps needed to start a
11214program under @value{GDBN} control on an H8/300. The example uses a
11215sample H8/300 program called @file{t.x}. The procedure is the same for
11216the Hitachi SH and the H8/500.
11217
11218First hook up your development board. In this example, we use a
11219board attached to serial port @code{COM2}; if you use a different serial
11220port, substitute its name in the argument of the @code{mode} command.
11221When you call @code{asynctsr}, the auxiliary comms program used by the
11222debugger, you give it just the numeric part of the serial port's name;
11223for example, @samp{asyncstr 2} below runs @code{asyncstr} on
11224@code{COM2}.
11225
11226@example
11227C:\H8300\TEST> asynctsr 2
11228C:\H8300\TEST> mode com2:9600,n,8,1,p
11229
11230Resident portion of MODE loaded
11231
11232COM2: 9600, n, 8, 1, p
11233
11234@end example
11235
11236@quotation
11237@emph{Warning:} We have noticed a bug in PC-NFS that conflicts with
11238@code{asynctsr}. If you also run PC-NFS on your DOS host, you may need to
11239disable it, or even boot without it, to use @code{asynctsr} to control
11240your development board.
11241@end quotation
11242
11243@kindex target hms@r{, and serial protocol}
11244Now that serial communications are set up, and the development board is
11245connected, you can start up @value{GDBN}. Call @code{@value{GDBP}} with
11246the name of your program as the argument. @code{@value{GDBN}} prompts
11247you, as usual, with the prompt @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. Use two special
11248commands to begin your debugging session: @samp{target hms} to specify
11249cross-debugging to the Hitachi board, and the @code{load} command to
11250download your program to the board. @code{load} displays the names of
11251the program's sections, and a @samp{*} for each 2K of data downloaded.
11252(If you want to refresh @value{GDBN} data on symbols or on the
11253executable file without downloading, use the @value{GDBN} commands
11254@code{file} or @code{symbol-file}. These commands, and @code{load}
11255itself, are described in @ref{Files,,Commands to specify files}.)
11256
11257@smallexample
11258(eg-C:\H8300\TEST) @value{GDBP} t.x
11259@value{GDBN} is free software and you are welcome to distribute copies
11260 of it under certain conditions; type "show copying" to see
11261 the conditions.
11262There is absolutely no warranty for @value{GDBN}; type "show warranty"
11263for details.
11264@value{GDBN} @value{GDBVN}, Copyright 1992 Free Software Foundation, Inc...
11265(@value{GDBP}) target hms
11266Connected to remote H8/300 HMS system.
11267(@value{GDBP}) load t.x
11268.text : 0x8000 .. 0xabde ***********
11269.data : 0xabde .. 0xad30 *
11270.stack : 0xf000 .. 0xf014 *
11271@end smallexample
11272
11273At this point, you're ready to run or debug your program. From here on,
11274you can use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands. The @code{break} command
11275sets breakpoints; the @code{run} command starts your program;
11276@code{print} or @code{x} display data; the @code{continue} command
11277resumes execution after stopping at a breakpoint. You can use the
11278@code{help} command at any time to find out more about @value{GDBN} commands.
11279
11280Remember, however, that @emph{operating system} facilities aren't
11281available on your development board; for example, if your program hangs,
11282you can't send an interrupt---but you can press the @sc{reset} switch!
11283
11284Use the @sc{reset} button on the development board
11285@itemize @bullet
11286@item
11287to interrupt your program (don't use @kbd{ctl-C} on the DOS host---it has
11288no way to pass an interrupt signal to the development board); and
11289
11290@item
11291to return to the @value{GDBN} command prompt after your program finishes
11292normally. The communications protocol provides no other way for @value{GDBN}
11293to detect program completion.
11294@end itemize
11295
11296In either case, @value{GDBN} sees the effect of a @sc{reset} on the
11297development board as a ``normal exit'' of your program.
11298
11299@node Hitachi ICE
11300@subsubsection Using the E7000 in-circuit emulator
11301
11302@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi ICE}
11303You can use the E7000 in-circuit emulator to develop code for either the
11304Hitachi SH or the H8/300H. Use one of these forms of the @samp{target
11305e7000} command to connect @value{GDBN} to your E7000:
11306
11307@table @code
11308@item target e7000 @var{port} @var{speed}
11309Use this form if your E7000 is connected to a serial port. The
11310@var{port} argument identifies what serial port to use (for example,
11311@samp{com2}). The third argument is the line speed in bits per second
11312(for example, @samp{9600}).
11313
11314@item target e7000 @var{hostname}
11315If your E7000 is installed as a host on a TCP/IP network, you can just
11316specify its hostname; @value{GDBN} uses @code{telnet} to connect.
11317@end table
11318
11319@node Hitachi Special
11320@subsubsection Special @value{GDBN} commands for Hitachi micros
11321
11322Some @value{GDBN} commands are available only for the H8/300:
11323
11324@table @code
11325
11326@kindex set machine
11327@kindex show machine
11328@item set machine h8300
11329@itemx set machine h8300h
11330Condition @value{GDBN} for one of the two variants of the H8/300
11331architecture with @samp{set machine}. You can use @samp{show machine}
11332to check which variant is currently in effect.
104c1213
JM
11333
11334@end table
11335
8e04817f
AC
11336@node H8/500
11337@subsection H8/500
104c1213
JM
11338
11339@table @code
11340
8e04817f
AC
11341@kindex set memory @var{mod}
11342@cindex memory models, H8/500
11343@item set memory @var{mod}
11344@itemx show memory
11345Specify which H8/500 memory model (@var{mod}) you are using with
11346@samp{set memory}; check which memory model is in effect with @samp{show
11347memory}. The accepted values for @var{mod} are @code{small},
11348@code{big}, @code{medium}, and @code{compact}.
104c1213 11349
8e04817f 11350@end table
104c1213 11351
8e04817f
AC
11352@node i960
11353@subsection Intel i960
104c1213 11354
8e04817f 11355@table @code
104c1213 11356
8e04817f
AC
11357@kindex target mon960
11358@item target mon960 @var{dev}
11359MON960 monitor for Intel i960.
104c1213 11360
8e04817f
AC
11361@kindex target nindy
11362@item target nindy @var{devicename}
11363An Intel 960 board controlled by a Nindy Monitor. @var{devicename} is
11364the name of the serial device to use for the connection, e.g.
11365@file{/dev/ttya}.
104c1213 11366
8e04817f
AC
11367@end table
11368
11369@cindex Nindy
11370@cindex i960
11371@dfn{Nindy} is a ROM Monitor program for Intel 960 target systems. When
11372@value{GDBN} is configured to control a remote Intel 960 using Nindy, you can
11373tell @value{GDBN} how to connect to the 960 in several ways:
11374
11375@itemize @bullet
104c1213 11376@item
8e04817f
AC
11377Through command line options specifying serial port, version of the
11378Nindy protocol, and communications speed;
104c1213
JM
11379
11380@item
8e04817f 11381By responding to a prompt on startup;
104c1213
JM
11382
11383@item
8e04817f
AC
11384By using the @code{target} command at any point during your @value{GDBN}
11385session. @xref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}.
11386
11387@end itemize
11388
11389@cindex download to Nindy-960
11390With the Nindy interface to an Intel 960 board, @code{load}
11391downloads @var{filename} to the 960 as well as adding its symbols in
11392@value{GDBN}.
11393
11394@menu
11395* Nindy Startup:: Startup with Nindy
11396* Nindy Options:: Options for Nindy
11397* Nindy Reset:: Nindy reset command
11398@end menu
11399
11400@node Nindy Startup
11401@subsubsection Startup with Nindy
11402
11403If you simply start @code{@value{GDBP}} without using any command-line
11404options, you are prompted for what serial port to use, @emph{before} you
11405reach the ordinary @value{GDBN} prompt:
11406
11407@example
11408Attach /dev/ttyNN -- specify NN, or "quit" to quit:
11409@end example
11410
11411@noindent
11412Respond to the prompt with whatever suffix (after @samp{/dev/tty})
11413identifies the serial port you want to use. You can, if you choose,
11414simply start up with no Nindy connection by responding to the prompt
11415with an empty line. If you do this and later wish to attach to Nindy,
11416use @code{target} (@pxref{Target Commands, ,Commands for managing targets}).
11417
11418@node Nindy Options
11419@subsubsection Options for Nindy
11420
11421These are the startup options for beginning your @value{GDBN} session with a
11422Nindy-960 board attached:
11423
11424@table @code
11425@item -r @var{port}
11426Specify the serial port name of a serial interface to be used to connect
11427to the target system. This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is
11428configured for the Intel 960 target architecture. You may specify
11429@var{port} as any of: a full pathname (e.g. @samp{-r /dev/ttya}), a
11430device name in @file{/dev} (e.g. @samp{-r ttya}), or simply the unique
11431suffix for a specific @code{tty} (e.g. @samp{-r a}).
11432
11433@item -O
11434(An uppercase letter ``O'', not a zero.) Specify that @value{GDBN} should use
11435the ``old'' Nindy monitor protocol to connect to the target system.
11436This option is only available when @value{GDBN} is configured for the Intel 960
11437target architecture.
11438
11439@quotation
11440@emph{Warning:} if you specify @samp{-O}, but are actually trying to
11441connect to a target system that expects the newer protocol, the connection
11442fails, appearing to be a speed mismatch. @value{GDBN} repeatedly
11443attempts to reconnect at several different line speeds. You can abort
11444this process with an interrupt.
11445@end quotation
11446
11447@item -brk
11448Specify that @value{GDBN} should first send a @code{BREAK} signal to the target
11449system, in an attempt to reset it, before connecting to a Nindy target.
11450
11451@quotation
11452@emph{Warning:} Many target systems do not have the hardware that this
11453requires; it only works with a few boards.
11454@end quotation
11455@end table
11456
11457The standard @samp{-b} option controls the line speed used on the serial
11458port.
11459
11460@c @group
11461@node Nindy Reset
11462@subsubsection Nindy reset command
11463
11464@table @code
11465@item reset
11466@kindex reset
11467For a Nindy target, this command sends a ``break'' to the remote target
11468system; this is only useful if the target has been equipped with a
11469circuit to perform a hard reset (or some other interesting action) when
11470a break is detected.
11471@end table
11472@c @end group
11473
11474@node M32R/D
11475@subsection Mitsubishi M32R/D
11476
11477@table @code
11478
11479@kindex target m32r
11480@item target m32r @var{dev}
11481Mitsubishi M32R/D ROM monitor.
11482
11483@end table
11484
11485@node M68K
11486@subsection M68k
11487
11488The Motorola m68k configuration includes ColdFire support, and
11489target command for the following ROM monitors.
11490
11491@table @code
11492
11493@kindex target abug
11494@item target abug @var{dev}
11495ABug ROM monitor for M68K.
11496
11497@kindex target cpu32bug
11498@item target cpu32bug @var{dev}
11499CPU32BUG monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11500
11501@kindex target dbug
11502@item target dbug @var{dev}
11503dBUG ROM monitor for Motorola ColdFire.
11504
11505@kindex target est
11506@item target est @var{dev}
11507EST-300 ICE monitor, running on a CPU32 (M68K) board.
11508
11509@kindex target rom68k
11510@item target rom68k @var{dev}
11511ROM 68K monitor, running on an M68K IDP board.
11512
11513@end table
11514
11515If @value{GDBN} is configured with @code{m68*-ericsson-*}, it will
11516instead have only a single special target command:
11517
11518@table @code
11519
11520@kindex target es1800
11521@item target es1800 @var{dev}
11522ES-1800 emulator for M68K.
11523
11524@end table
11525
11526[context?]
11527
11528@table @code
11529
11530@kindex target rombug
11531@item target rombug @var{dev}
11532ROMBUG ROM monitor for OS/9000.
11533
11534@end table
11535
11536@node M88K
11537@subsection M88K
11538
11539@table @code
11540
11541@kindex target bug
11542@item target bug @var{dev}
11543BUG monitor, running on a MVME187 (m88k) board.
11544
11545@end table
11546
11547@node MIPS Embedded
11548@subsection MIPS Embedded
11549
11550@cindex MIPS boards
11551@value{GDBN} can use the MIPS remote debugging protocol to talk to a
11552MIPS board attached to a serial line. This is available when
11553you configure @value{GDBN} with @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.
104c1213 11554
8e04817f
AC
11555@need 1000
11556Use these @value{GDBN} commands to specify the connection to your target board:
104c1213 11557
8e04817f
AC
11558@table @code
11559@item target mips @var{port}
11560@kindex target mips @var{port}
11561To run a program on the board, start up @code{@value{GDBP}} with the
11562name of your program as the argument. To connect to the board, use the
11563command @samp{target mips @var{port}}, where @var{port} is the name of
11564the serial port connected to the board. If the program has not already
11565been downloaded to the board, you may use the @code{load} command to
11566download it. You can then use all the usual @value{GDBN} commands.
104c1213 11567
8e04817f
AC
11568For example, this sequence connects to the target board through a serial
11569port, and loads and runs a program called @var{prog} through the
11570debugger:
104c1213 11571
8e04817f
AC
11572@example
11573host$ @value{GDBP} @var{prog}
11574@value{GDBN} is free software and @dots{}
11575(@value{GDBP}) target mips /dev/ttyb
11576(@value{GDBP}) load @var{prog}
11577(@value{GDBP}) run
11578@end example
104c1213 11579
8e04817f
AC
11580@item target mips @var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}
11581On some @value{GDBN} host configurations, you can specify a TCP
11582connection (for instance, to a serial line managed by a terminal
11583concentrator) instead of a serial port, using the syntax
11584@samp{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11585
8e04817f
AC
11586@item target pmon @var{port}
11587@kindex target pmon @var{port}
11588PMON ROM monitor.
104c1213 11589
8e04817f
AC
11590@item target ddb @var{port}
11591@kindex target ddb @var{port}
11592NEC's DDB variant of PMON for Vr4300.
104c1213 11593
8e04817f
AC
11594@item target lsi @var{port}
11595@kindex target lsi @var{port}
11596LSI variant of PMON.
104c1213 11597
8e04817f
AC
11598@kindex target r3900
11599@item target r3900 @var{dev}
11600Densan DVE-R3900 ROM monitor for Toshiba R3900 Mips.
104c1213 11601
8e04817f
AC
11602@kindex target array
11603@item target array @var{dev}
11604Array Tech LSI33K RAID controller board.
104c1213 11605
8e04817f 11606@end table
104c1213 11607
104c1213 11608
8e04817f
AC
11609@noindent
11610@value{GDBN} also supports these special commands for MIPS targets:
104c1213 11611
8e04817f
AC
11612@table @code
11613@item set processor @var{args}
11614@itemx show processor
11615@kindex set processor @var{args}
11616@kindex show processor
11617Use the @code{set processor} command to set the type of MIPS
11618processor when you want to access processor-type-specific registers.
11619For example, @code{set processor @var{r3041}} tells @value{GDBN}
11620to use the CPU registers appropriate for the 3041 chip.
11621Use the @code{show processor} command to see what MIPS processor @value{GDBN}
11622is using. Use the @code{info reg} command to see what registers
11623@value{GDBN} is using.
104c1213 11624
8e04817f
AC
11625@item set mipsfpu double
11626@itemx set mipsfpu single
11627@itemx set mipsfpu none
11628@itemx show mipsfpu
11629@kindex set mipsfpu
11630@kindex show mipsfpu
11631@cindex MIPS remote floating point
11632@cindex floating point, MIPS remote
11633If your target board does not support the MIPS floating point
11634coprocessor, you should use the command @samp{set mipsfpu none} (if you
11635need this, you may wish to put the command in your @value{GDBN} init
11636file). This tells @value{GDBN} how to find the return value of
11637functions which return floating point values. It also allows
11638@value{GDBN} to avoid saving the floating point registers when calling
11639functions on the board. If you are using a floating point coprocessor
11640with only single precision floating point support, as on the @sc{r4650}
11641processor, use the command @samp{set mipsfpu single}. The default
11642double precision floating point coprocessor may be selected using
11643@samp{set mipsfpu double}.
104c1213 11644
8e04817f
AC
11645In previous versions the only choices were double precision or no
11646floating point, so @samp{set mipsfpu on} will select double precision
11647and @samp{set mipsfpu off} will select no floating point.
104c1213 11648
8e04817f
AC
11649As usual, you can inquire about the @code{mipsfpu} variable with
11650@samp{show mipsfpu}.
104c1213 11651
8e04817f
AC
11652@item set remotedebug @var{n}
11653@itemx show remotedebug
11654@kindex set remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11655@kindex show remotedebug@r{, MIPS protocol}
11656@cindex @code{remotedebug}, MIPS protocol
11657@cindex MIPS @code{remotedebug} protocol
11658@c FIXME! For this to be useful, you must know something about the MIPS
11659@c FIXME...protocol. Where is it described?
11660You can see some debugging information about communications with the board
11661by setting the @code{remotedebug} variable. If you set it to @code{1} using
11662@samp{set remotedebug 1}, every packet is displayed. If you set it
11663to @code{2}, every character is displayed. You can check the current value
11664at any time with the command @samp{show remotedebug}.
104c1213 11665
8e04817f
AC
11666@item set timeout @var{seconds}
11667@itemx set retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}
11668@itemx show timeout
11669@itemx show retransmit-timeout
11670@cindex @code{timeout}, MIPS protocol
11671@cindex @code{retransmit-timeout}, MIPS protocol
11672@kindex set timeout
11673@kindex show timeout
11674@kindex set retransmit-timeout
11675@kindex show retransmit-timeout
11676You can control the timeout used while waiting for a packet, in the MIPS
11677remote protocol, with the @code{set timeout @var{seconds}} command. The
11678default is 5 seconds. Similarly, you can control the timeout used while
11679waiting for an acknowledgement of a packet with the @code{set
11680retransmit-timeout @var{seconds}} command. The default is 3 seconds.
11681You can inspect both values with @code{show timeout} and @code{show
11682retransmit-timeout}. (These commands are @emph{only} available when
11683@value{GDBN} is configured for @samp{--target=mips-idt-ecoff}.)
104c1213 11684
8e04817f
AC
11685The timeout set by @code{set timeout} does not apply when @value{GDBN}
11686is waiting for your program to stop. In that case, @value{GDBN} waits
11687forever because it has no way of knowing how long the program is going
11688to run before stopping.
11689@end table
104c1213 11690
8e04817f
AC
11691@node PowerPC
11692@subsection PowerPC
104c1213
JM
11693
11694@table @code
104c1213 11695
8e04817f
AC
11696@kindex target dink32
11697@item target dink32 @var{dev}
11698DINK32 ROM monitor.
104c1213 11699
8e04817f
AC
11700@kindex target ppcbug
11701@item target ppcbug @var{dev}
11702@kindex target ppcbug1
11703@item target ppcbug1 @var{dev}
11704PPCBUG ROM monitor for PowerPC.
104c1213 11705
8e04817f
AC
11706@kindex target sds
11707@item target sds @var{dev}
11708SDS monitor, running on a PowerPC board (such as Motorola's ADS).
11709
11710@end table
11711
11712@node PA
11713@subsection HP PA Embedded
104c1213
JM
11714
11715@table @code
11716
8e04817f
AC
11717@kindex target op50n
11718@item target op50n @var{dev}
11719OP50N monitor, running on an OKI HPPA board.
11720
11721@kindex target w89k
11722@item target w89k @var{dev}
11723W89K monitor, running on a Winbond HPPA board.
104c1213
JM
11724
11725@end table
11726
8e04817f
AC
11727@node SH
11728@subsection Hitachi SH
104c1213
JM
11729
11730@table @code
11731
8e04817f
AC
11732@kindex target hms@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11733@item target hms @var{dev}
11734A Hitachi SH board attached via serial line to your host. Use special
11735commands @code{device} and @code{speed} to control the serial line and
11736the communications speed used.
104c1213 11737
8e04817f
AC
11738@kindex target e7000@r{, with Hitachi SH}
11739@item target e7000 @var{dev}
11740E7000 emulator for Hitachi SH.
104c1213 11741
8e04817f
AC
11742@kindex target sh3@r{, with SH}
11743@kindex target sh3e@r{, with SH}
11744@item target sh3 @var{dev}
11745@item target sh3e @var{dev}
11746Hitachi SH-3 and SH-3E target systems.
104c1213 11747
8e04817f 11748@end table
104c1213 11749
8e04817f
AC
11750@node Sparclet
11751@subsection Tsqware Sparclet
104c1213 11752
8e04817f
AC
11753@cindex Sparclet
11754
11755@value{GDBN} enables developers to debug tasks running on
11756Sparclet targets from a Unix host.
11757@value{GDBN} uses code that runs on
11758both the Unix host and on the Sparclet target. The program
11759@code{@value{GDBP}} is installed and executed on the Unix host.
104c1213 11760
8e04817f
AC
11761@table @code
11762@item remotetimeout @var{args}
11763@kindex remotetimeout
11764@value{GDBN} supports the option @code{remotetimeout}.
11765This option is set by the user, and @var{args} represents the number of
11766seconds @value{GDBN} waits for responses.
104c1213
JM
11767@end table
11768
8e04817f
AC
11769@cindex compiling, on Sparclet
11770When compiling for debugging, include the options @samp{-g} to get debug
11771information and @samp{-Ttext} to relocate the program to where you wish to
11772load it on the target. You may also want to add the options @samp{-n} or
11773@samp{-N} in order to reduce the size of the sections. Example:
104c1213 11774
8e04817f
AC
11775@example
11776sparclet-aout-gcc prog.c -Ttext 0x12010000 -g -o prog -N
11777@end example
104c1213 11778
8e04817f 11779You can use @code{objdump} to verify that the addresses are what you intended:
104c1213 11780
8e04817f
AC
11781@example
11782sparclet-aout-objdump --headers --syms prog
11783@end example
104c1213 11784
8e04817f
AC
11785@cindex running, on Sparclet
11786Once you have set
11787your Unix execution search path to find @value{GDBN}, you are ready to
11788run @value{GDBN}. From your Unix host, run @code{@value{GDBP}}
11789(or @code{sparclet-aout-gdb}, depending on your installation).
104c1213 11790
8e04817f
AC
11791@value{GDBN} comes up showing the prompt:
11792
11793@example
11794(gdbslet)
11795@end example
104c1213
JM
11796
11797@menu
8e04817f
AC
11798* Sparclet File:: Setting the file to debug
11799* Sparclet Connection:: Connecting to Sparclet
11800* Sparclet Download:: Sparclet download
11801* Sparclet Execution:: Running and debugging
104c1213
JM
11802@end menu
11803
8e04817f
AC
11804@node Sparclet File
11805@subsubsection Setting file to debug
104c1213 11806
8e04817f 11807The @value{GDBN} command @code{file} lets you choose with program to debug.
104c1213
JM
11808
11809@example
8e04817f 11810(gdbslet) file prog
104c1213
JM
11811@end example
11812
8e04817f
AC
11813@need 1000
11814@value{GDBN} then attempts to read the symbol table of @file{prog}.
11815@value{GDBN} locates
11816the file by searching the directories listed in the command search
11817path.
11818If the file was compiled with debug information (option "-g"), source
11819files will be searched as well.
11820@value{GDBN} locates
11821the source files by searching the directories listed in the directory search
11822path (@pxref{Environment, ,Your program's environment}).
11823If it fails
11824to find a file, it displays a message such as:
104c1213 11825
8e04817f
AC
11826@example
11827prog: No such file or directory.
11828@end example
104c1213 11829
8e04817f
AC
11830When this happens, add the appropriate directories to the search paths with
11831the @value{GDBN} commands @code{path} and @code{dir}, and execute the
11832@code{target} command again.
104c1213 11833
8e04817f
AC
11834@node Sparclet Connection
11835@subsubsection Connecting to Sparclet
104c1213 11836
8e04817f
AC
11837The @value{GDBN} command @code{target} lets you connect to a Sparclet target.
11838To connect to a target on serial port ``@code{ttya}'', type:
104c1213 11839
8e04817f
AC
11840@example
11841(gdbslet) target sparclet /dev/ttya
11842Remote target sparclet connected to /dev/ttya
11843main () at ../prog.c:3
11844@end example
104c1213 11845
8e04817f
AC
11846@need 750
11847@value{GDBN} displays messages like these:
104c1213 11848
8e04817f
AC
11849@example
11850Connected to ttya.
11851@end example
104c1213 11852
8e04817f
AC
11853@node Sparclet Download
11854@subsubsection Sparclet download
104c1213 11855
8e04817f
AC
11856@cindex download to Sparclet
11857Once connected to the Sparclet target,
11858you can use the @value{GDBN}
11859@code{load} command to download the file from the host to the target.
11860The file name and load offset should be given as arguments to the @code{load}
11861command.
11862Since the file format is aout, the program must be loaded to the starting
11863address. You can use @code{objdump} to find out what this value is. The load
11864offset is an offset which is added to the VMA (virtual memory address)
11865of each of the file's sections.
11866For instance, if the program
11867@file{prog} was linked to text address 0x1201000, with data at 0x12010160
11868and bss at 0x12010170, in @value{GDBN}, type:
104c1213 11869
8e04817f
AC
11870@example
11871(gdbslet) load prog 0x12010000
11872Loading section .text, size 0xdb0 vma 0x12010000
11873@end example
104c1213 11874
8e04817f
AC
11875If the code is loaded at a different address then what the program was linked
11876to, you may need to use the @code{section} and @code{add-symbol-file} commands
11877to tell @value{GDBN} where to map the symbol table.
11878
11879@node Sparclet Execution
11880@subsubsection Running and debugging
11881
11882@cindex running and debugging Sparclet programs
11883You can now begin debugging the task using @value{GDBN}'s execution control
11884commands, @code{b}, @code{step}, @code{run}, etc. See the @value{GDBN}
11885manual for the list of commands.
11886
11887@example
11888(gdbslet) b main
11889Breakpoint 1 at 0x12010000: file prog.c, line 3.
11890(gdbslet) run
11891Starting program: prog
11892Breakpoint 1, main (argc=1, argv=0xeffff21c) at prog.c:3
118933 char *symarg = 0;
11894(gdbslet) step
118954 char *execarg = "hello!";
11896(gdbslet)
11897@end example
11898
11899@node Sparclite
11900@subsection Fujitsu Sparclite
104c1213
JM
11901
11902@table @code
11903
8e04817f
AC
11904@kindex target sparclite
11905@item target sparclite @var{dev}
11906Fujitsu sparclite boards, used only for the purpose of loading.
11907You must use an additional command to debug the program.
11908For example: target remote @var{dev} using @value{GDBN} standard
11909remote protocol.
104c1213
JM
11910
11911@end table
11912
8e04817f
AC
11913@node ST2000
11914@subsection Tandem ST2000
104c1213 11915
8e04817f
AC
11916@value{GDBN} may be used with a Tandem ST2000 phone switch, running Tandem's
11917STDBUG protocol.
104c1213 11918
8e04817f
AC
11919To connect your ST2000 to the host system, see the manufacturer's
11920manual. Once the ST2000 is physically attached, you can run:
104c1213 11921
8e04817f
AC
11922@example
11923target st2000 @var{dev} @var{speed}
11924@end example
104c1213 11925
8e04817f
AC
11926@noindent
11927to establish it as your debugging environment. @var{dev} is normally
11928the name of a serial device, such as @file{/dev/ttya}, connected to the
11929ST2000 via a serial line. You can instead specify @var{dev} as a TCP
11930connection (for example, to a serial line attached via a terminal
11931concentrator) using the syntax @code{@var{hostname}:@var{portnumber}}.
104c1213 11932
8e04817f
AC
11933The @code{load} and @code{attach} commands are @emph{not} defined for
11934this target; you must load your program into the ST2000 as you normally
11935would for standalone operation. @value{GDBN} reads debugging information
11936(such as symbols) from a separate, debugging version of the program
11937available on your host computer.
11938@c FIXME!! This is terribly vague; what little content is here is
11939@c basically hearsay.
104c1213 11940
8e04817f
AC
11941@cindex ST2000 auxiliary commands
11942These auxiliary @value{GDBN} commands are available to help you with the ST2000
11943environment:
104c1213 11944
8e04817f
AC
11945@table @code
11946@item st2000 @var{command}
11947@kindex st2000 @var{cmd}
11948@cindex STDBUG commands (ST2000)
11949@cindex commands to STDBUG (ST2000)
11950Send a @var{command} to the STDBUG monitor. See the manufacturer's
11951manual for available commands.
104c1213 11952
8e04817f
AC
11953@item connect
11954@cindex connect (to STDBUG)
11955Connect the controlling terminal to the STDBUG command monitor. When
11956you are done interacting with STDBUG, typing either of two character
11957sequences gets you back to the @value{GDBN} command prompt:
11958@kbd{@key{RET}~.} (Return, followed by tilde and period) or
11959@kbd{@key{RET}~@key{C-d}} (Return, followed by tilde and control-D).
104c1213
JM
11960@end table
11961
8e04817f
AC
11962@node Z8000
11963@subsection Zilog Z8000
104c1213 11964
8e04817f
AC
11965@cindex Z8000
11966@cindex simulator, Z8000
11967@cindex Zilog Z8000 simulator
104c1213 11968
8e04817f
AC
11969When configured for debugging Zilog Z8000 targets, @value{GDBN} includes
11970a Z8000 simulator.
11971
11972For the Z8000 family, @samp{target sim} simulates either the Z8002 (the
11973unsegmented variant of the Z8000 architecture) or the Z8001 (the
11974segmented variant). The simulator recognizes which architecture is
11975appropriate by inspecting the object code.
104c1213 11976
8e04817f
AC
11977@table @code
11978@item target sim @var{args}
11979@kindex sim
11980@kindex target sim@r{, with Z8000}
11981Debug programs on a simulated CPU. If the simulator supports setup
11982options, specify them via @var{args}.
104c1213
JM
11983@end table
11984
8e04817f
AC
11985@noindent
11986After specifying this target, you can debug programs for the simulated
11987CPU in the same style as programs for your host computer; use the
11988@code{file} command to load a new program image, the @code{run} command
11989to run your program, and so on.
11990
11991As well as making available all the usual machine registers
11992(@pxref{Registers, ,Registers}), the Z8000 simulator provides three
11993additional items of information as specially named registers:
104c1213
JM
11994
11995@table @code
11996
8e04817f
AC
11997@item cycles
11998Counts clock-ticks in the simulator.
104c1213 11999
8e04817f
AC
12000@item insts
12001Counts instructions run in the simulator.
104c1213 12002
8e04817f
AC
12003@item time
12004Execution time in 60ths of a second.
104c1213 12005
8e04817f 12006@end table
104c1213 12007
8e04817f
AC
12008You can refer to these values in @value{GDBN} expressions with the usual
12009conventions; for example, @w{@samp{b fputc if $cycles>5000}} sets a
12010conditional breakpoint that suspends only after at least 5000
12011simulated clock ticks.
104c1213 12012
8e04817f
AC
12013@node Architectures
12014@section Architectures
104c1213 12015
8e04817f
AC
12016This section describes characteristics of architectures that affect
12017all uses of @value{GDBN} with the architecture, both native and cross.
104c1213 12018
8e04817f
AC
12019@menu
12020* A29K::
12021* Alpha::
12022* MIPS::
12023@end menu
104c1213 12024
8e04817f
AC
12025@node A29K
12026@subsection A29K
104c1213
JM
12027
12028@table @code
104c1213 12029
8e04817f
AC
12030@kindex set rstack_high_address
12031@cindex AMD 29K register stack
12032@cindex register stack, AMD29K
12033@item set rstack_high_address @var{address}
12034On AMD 29000 family processors, registers are saved in a separate
12035@dfn{register stack}. There is no way for @value{GDBN} to determine the
12036extent of this stack. Normally, @value{GDBN} just assumes that the
12037stack is ``large enough''. This may result in @value{GDBN} referencing
12038memory locations that do not exist. If necessary, you can get around
12039this problem by specifying the ending address of the register stack with
12040the @code{set rstack_high_address} command. The argument should be an
12041address, which you probably want to precede with @samp{0x} to specify in
12042hexadecimal.
104c1213 12043
8e04817f
AC
12044@kindex show rstack_high_address
12045@item show rstack_high_address
12046Display the current limit of the register stack, on AMD 29000 family
12047processors.
104c1213 12048
8e04817f 12049@end table
104c1213 12050
8e04817f
AC
12051@node Alpha
12052@subsection Alpha
104c1213 12053
8e04817f 12054See the following section.
104c1213 12055
8e04817f
AC
12056@node MIPS
12057@subsection MIPS
104c1213 12058
8e04817f
AC
12059@cindex stack on Alpha
12060@cindex stack on MIPS
12061@cindex Alpha stack
12062@cindex MIPS stack
12063Alpha- and MIPS-based computers use an unusual stack frame, which
12064sometimes requires @value{GDBN} to search backward in the object code to
12065find the beginning of a function.
104c1213 12066
8e04817f
AC
12067@cindex response time, MIPS debugging
12068To improve response time (especially for embedded applications, where
12069@value{GDBN} may be restricted to a slow serial line for this search)
12070you may want to limit the size of this search, using one of these
12071commands:
104c1213 12072
8e04817f
AC
12073@table @code
12074@cindex @code{heuristic-fence-post} (Alpha, MIPS)
12075@item set heuristic-fence-post @var{limit}
12076Restrict @value{GDBN} to examining at most @var{limit} bytes in its
12077search for the beginning of a function. A value of @var{0} (the
12078default) means there is no limit. However, except for @var{0}, the
12079larger the limit the more bytes @code{heuristic-fence-post} must search
12080and therefore the longer it takes to run.
104c1213 12081
8e04817f
AC
12082@item show heuristic-fence-post
12083Display the current limit.
12084@end table
104c1213
JM
12085
12086@noindent
8e04817f
AC
12087These commands are available @emph{only} when @value{GDBN} is configured
12088for debugging programs on Alpha or MIPS processors.
104c1213 12089
104c1213 12090
8e04817f
AC
12091@node Controlling GDB
12092@chapter Controlling @value{GDBN}
12093
12094You can alter the way @value{GDBN} interacts with you by using the
12095@code{set} command. For commands controlling how @value{GDBN} displays
12096data, see @ref{Print Settings, ,Print settings}. Other settings are
12097described here.
12098
12099@menu
12100* Prompt:: Prompt
12101* Editing:: Command editing
12102* History:: Command history
12103* Screen Size:: Screen size
12104* Numbers:: Numbers
12105* Messages/Warnings:: Optional warnings and messages
12106* Debugging Output:: Optional messages about internal happenings
12107@end menu
12108
12109@node Prompt
12110@section Prompt
104c1213 12111
8e04817f 12112@cindex prompt
104c1213 12113
8e04817f
AC
12114@value{GDBN} indicates its readiness to read a command by printing a string
12115called the @dfn{prompt}. This string is normally @samp{(@value{GDBP})}. You
12116can change the prompt string with the @code{set prompt} command. For
12117instance, when debugging @value{GDBN} with @value{GDBN}, it is useful to change
12118the prompt in one of the @value{GDBN} sessions so that you can always tell
12119which one you are talking to.
104c1213 12120
8e04817f
AC
12121@emph{Note:} @code{set prompt} does not add a space for you after the
12122prompt you set. This allows you to set a prompt which ends in a space
12123or a prompt that does not.
104c1213 12124
8e04817f
AC
12125@table @code
12126@kindex set prompt
12127@item set prompt @var{newprompt}
12128Directs @value{GDBN} to use @var{newprompt} as its prompt string henceforth.
104c1213 12129
8e04817f
AC
12130@kindex show prompt
12131@item show prompt
12132Prints a line of the form: @samp{Gdb's prompt is: @var{your-prompt}}
104c1213
JM
12133@end table
12134
8e04817f
AC
12135@node Editing
12136@section Command editing
12137@cindex readline
12138@cindex command line editing
104c1213 12139
8e04817f
AC
12140@value{GDBN} reads its input commands via the @dfn{readline} interface. This
12141@sc{gnu} library provides consistent behavior for programs which provide a
12142command line interface to the user. Advantages are @sc{gnu} Emacs-style
12143or @dfn{vi}-style inline editing of commands, @code{csh}-like history
12144substitution, and a storage and recall of command history across
12145debugging sessions.
104c1213 12146
8e04817f
AC
12147You may control the behavior of command line editing in @value{GDBN} with the
12148command @code{set}.
104c1213 12149
8e04817f
AC
12150@table @code
12151@kindex set editing
12152@cindex editing
12153@item set editing
12154@itemx set editing on
12155Enable command line editing (enabled by default).
104c1213 12156
8e04817f
AC
12157@item set editing off
12158Disable command line editing.
104c1213 12159
8e04817f
AC
12160@kindex show editing
12161@item show editing
12162Show whether command line editing is enabled.
104c1213
JM
12163@end table
12164
8e04817f
AC
12165@node History
12166@section Command history
12167
12168@value{GDBN} can keep track of the commands you type during your
12169debugging sessions, so that you can be certain of precisely what
12170happened. Use these commands to manage the @value{GDBN} command
12171history facility.
104c1213
JM
12172
12173@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12174@cindex history substitution
12175@cindex history file
12176@kindex set history filename
12177@kindex GDBHISTFILE
12178@item set history filename @var{fname}
12179Set the name of the @value{GDBN} command history file to @var{fname}.
12180This is the file where @value{GDBN} reads an initial command history
12181list, and where it writes the command history from this session when it
12182exits. You can access this list through history expansion or through
12183the history command editing characters listed below. This file defaults
12184to the value of the environment variable @code{GDBHISTFILE}, or to
12185@file{./.gdb_history} (@file{./_gdb_history} on MS-DOS) if this variable
12186is not set.
104c1213 12187
8e04817f
AC
12188@cindex history save
12189@kindex set history save
12190@item set history save
12191@itemx set history save on
12192Record command history in a file, whose name may be specified with the
12193@code{set history filename} command. By default, this option is disabled.
104c1213 12194
8e04817f
AC
12195@item set history save off
12196Stop recording command history in a file.
104c1213 12197
8e04817f
AC
12198@cindex history size
12199@kindex set history size
12200@item set history size @var{size}
12201Set the number of commands which @value{GDBN} keeps in its history list.
12202This defaults to the value of the environment variable
12203@code{HISTSIZE}, or to 256 if this variable is not set.
104c1213
JM
12204@end table
12205
8e04817f
AC
12206@cindex history expansion
12207History expansion assigns special meaning to the character @kbd{!}.
12208@ifset have-readline-appendices
12209@xref{Event Designators}.
12210@end ifset
12211
12212Since @kbd{!} is also the logical not operator in C, history expansion
12213is off by default. If you decide to enable history expansion with the
12214@code{set history expansion on} command, you may sometimes need to
12215follow @kbd{!} (when it is used as logical not, in an expression) with
12216a space or a tab to prevent it from being expanded. The readline
12217history facilities do not attempt substitution on the strings
12218@kbd{!=} and @kbd{!(}, even when history expansion is enabled.
12219
12220The commands to control history expansion are:
104c1213
JM
12221
12222@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12223@kindex set history expansion
12224@item set history expansion on
12225@itemx set history expansion
12226Enable history expansion. History expansion is off by default.
104c1213 12227
8e04817f
AC
12228@item set history expansion off
12229Disable history expansion.
104c1213 12230
8e04817f
AC
12231The readline code comes with more complete documentation of
12232editing and history expansion features. Users unfamiliar with @sc{gnu} Emacs
12233or @code{vi} may wish to read it.
12234@ifset have-readline-appendices
12235@xref{Command Line Editing}.
12236@end ifset
104c1213 12237
8e04817f
AC
12238@c @group
12239@kindex show history
12240@item show history
12241@itemx show history filename
12242@itemx show history save
12243@itemx show history size
12244@itemx show history expansion
12245These commands display the state of the @value{GDBN} history parameters.
12246@code{show history} by itself displays all four states.
12247@c @end group
12248@end table
12249
12250@table @code
12251@kindex shows
12252@item show commands
12253Display the last ten commands in the command history.
104c1213 12254
8e04817f
AC
12255@item show commands @var{n}
12256Print ten commands centered on command number @var{n}.
12257
12258@item show commands +
12259Print ten commands just after the commands last printed.
104c1213
JM
12260@end table
12261
8e04817f
AC
12262@node Screen Size
12263@section Screen size
12264@cindex size of screen
12265@cindex pauses in output
104c1213 12266
8e04817f
AC
12267Certain commands to @value{GDBN} may produce large amounts of
12268information output to the screen. To help you read all of it,
12269@value{GDBN} pauses and asks you for input at the end of each page of
12270output. Type @key{RET} when you want to continue the output, or @kbd{q}
12271to discard the remaining output. Also, the screen width setting
12272determines when to wrap lines of output. Depending on what is being
12273printed, @value{GDBN} tries to break the line at a readable place,
12274rather than simply letting it overflow onto the following line.
12275
12276Normally @value{GDBN} knows the size of the screen from the terminal
12277driver software. For example, on Unix @value{GDBN} uses the termcap data base
12278together with the value of the @code{TERM} environment variable and the
12279@code{stty rows} and @code{stty cols} settings. If this is not correct,
12280you can override it with the @code{set height} and @code{set
12281width} commands:
12282
12283@table @code
12284@kindex set height
12285@kindex set width
12286@kindex show width
12287@kindex show height
12288@item set height @var{lpp}
12289@itemx show height
12290@itemx set width @var{cpl}
12291@itemx show width
12292These @code{set} commands specify a screen height of @var{lpp} lines and
12293a screen width of @var{cpl} characters. The associated @code{show}
12294commands display the current settings.
104c1213 12295
8e04817f
AC
12296If you specify a height of zero lines, @value{GDBN} does not pause during
12297output no matter how long the output is. This is useful if output is to a
12298file or to an editor buffer.
104c1213 12299
8e04817f
AC
12300Likewise, you can specify @samp{set width 0} to prevent @value{GDBN}
12301from wrapping its output.
104c1213
JM
12302@end table
12303
8e04817f
AC
12304@node Numbers
12305@section Numbers
12306@cindex number representation
12307@cindex entering numbers
104c1213 12308
8e04817f
AC
12309You can always enter numbers in octal, decimal, or hexadecimal in
12310@value{GDBN} by the usual conventions: octal numbers begin with
12311@samp{0}, decimal numbers end with @samp{.}, and hexadecimal numbers
12312begin with @samp{0x}. Numbers that begin with none of these are, by
12313default, entered in base 10; likewise, the default display for
12314numbers---when no particular format is specified---is base 10. You can
12315change the default base for both input and output with the @code{set
12316radix} command.
104c1213 12317
8e04817f
AC
12318@table @code
12319@kindex set input-radix
12320@item set input-radix @var{base}
12321Set the default base for numeric input. Supported choices
12322for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12323specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix; for
12324example, any of
104c1213 12325
8e04817f
AC
12326@smallexample
12327set radix 012
12328set radix 10.
12329set radix 0xa
12330@end smallexample
104c1213 12331
8e04817f
AC
12332@noindent
12333sets the base to decimal. On the other hand, @samp{set radix 10}
12334leaves the radix unchanged no matter what it was.
104c1213 12335
8e04817f
AC
12336@kindex set output-radix
12337@item set output-radix @var{base}
12338Set the default base for numeric display. Supported choices
12339for @var{base} are decimal 8, 10, or 16. @var{base} must itself be
12340specified either unambiguously or using the current default radix.
104c1213 12341
8e04817f
AC
12342@kindex show input-radix
12343@item show input-radix
12344Display the current default base for numeric input.
104c1213 12345
8e04817f
AC
12346@kindex show output-radix
12347@item show output-radix
12348Display the current default base for numeric display.
12349@end table
104c1213 12350
8e04817f
AC
12351@node Messages/Warnings
12352@section Optional warnings and messages
104c1213 12353
8e04817f
AC
12354By default, @value{GDBN} is silent about its inner workings. If you are
12355running on a slow machine, you may want to use the @code{set verbose}
12356command. This makes @value{GDBN} tell you when it does a lengthy
12357internal operation, so you will not think it has crashed.
104c1213 12358
8e04817f
AC
12359Currently, the messages controlled by @code{set verbose} are those
12360which announce that the symbol table for a source file is being read;
12361see @code{symbol-file} in @ref{Files, ,Commands to specify files}.
104c1213 12362
8e04817f
AC
12363@table @code
12364@kindex set verbose
12365@item set verbose on
12366Enables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12367
8e04817f
AC
12368@item set verbose off
12369Disables @value{GDBN} output of certain informational messages.
104c1213 12370
8e04817f
AC
12371@kindex show verbose
12372@item show verbose
12373Displays whether @code{set verbose} is on or off.
12374@end table
104c1213 12375
8e04817f
AC
12376By default, if @value{GDBN} encounters bugs in the symbol table of an
12377object file, it is silent; but if you are debugging a compiler, you may
12378find this information useful (@pxref{Symbol Errors, ,Errors reading
12379symbol files}).
104c1213 12380
8e04817f 12381@table @code
104c1213 12382
8e04817f
AC
12383@kindex set complaints
12384@item set complaints @var{limit}
12385Permits @value{GDBN} to output @var{limit} complaints about each type of
12386unusual symbols before becoming silent about the problem. Set
12387@var{limit} to zero to suppress all complaints; set it to a large number
12388to prevent complaints from being suppressed.
104c1213 12389
8e04817f
AC
12390@kindex show complaints
12391@item show complaints
12392Displays how many symbol complaints @value{GDBN} is permitted to produce.
104c1213 12393
8e04817f 12394@end table
104c1213 12395
8e04817f
AC
12396By default, @value{GDBN} is cautious, and asks what sometimes seems to be a
12397lot of stupid questions to confirm certain commands. For example, if
12398you try to run a program which is already running:
104c1213
JM
12399
12400@example
8e04817f
AC
12401(@value{GDBP}) run
12402The program being debugged has been started already.
12403Start it from the beginning? (y or n)
104c1213
JM
12404@end example
12405
8e04817f
AC
12406If you are willing to unflinchingly face the consequences of your own
12407commands, you can disable this ``feature'':
104c1213 12408
8e04817f 12409@table @code
104c1213 12410
8e04817f
AC
12411@kindex set confirm
12412@cindex flinching
12413@cindex confirmation
12414@cindex stupid questions
12415@item set confirm off
12416Disables confirmation requests.
104c1213 12417
8e04817f
AC
12418@item set confirm on
12419Enables confirmation requests (the default).
104c1213 12420
8e04817f
AC
12421@kindex show confirm
12422@item show confirm
12423Displays state of confirmation requests.
12424
12425@end table
104c1213 12426
8e04817f
AC
12427@node Debugging Output
12428@section Optional messages about internal happenings
104c1213 12429@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12430@kindex set debug arch
12431@item set debug arch
12432Turns on or off display of gdbarch debugging info. The default is off
12433@kindex show debug arch
12434@item show debug arch
12435Displays the current state of displaying gdbarch debugging info.
12436@kindex set debug event
12437@item set debug event
12438Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} event debugging info. The
12439default is off.
12440@kindex show debug event
12441@item show debug event
12442Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} event debugging
12443info.
12444@kindex set debug expression
12445@item set debug expression
12446Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} expression debugging info. The
12447default is off.
12448@kindex show debug expression
12449@item show debug expression
12450Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} expression
12451debugging info.
12452@kindex set debug overload
12453@item set debug overload
12454Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload debugging
12455info. This includes info such as ranking of functions, etc. The default
12456is off.
12457@kindex show debug overload
12458@item show debug overload
12459Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} C@t{++} overload
12460debugging info.
12461@kindex set debug remote
12462@cindex packets, reporting on stdout
12463@cindex serial connections, debugging
12464@item set debug remote
12465Turns on or off display of reports on all packets sent back and forth across
12466the serial line to the remote machine. The info is printed on the
12467@value{GDBN} standard output stream. The default is off.
12468@kindex show debug remote
12469@item show debug remote
12470Displays the state of display of remote packets.
12471@kindex set debug serial
12472@item set debug serial
12473Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} serial debugging info. The
12474default is off.
12475@kindex show debug serial
12476@item show debug serial
12477Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} serial debugging
12478info.
12479@kindex set debug target
12480@item set debug target
12481Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} target debugging info. This info
12482includes what is going on at the target level of GDB, as it happens. The
12483default is off.
12484@kindex show debug target
12485@item show debug target
12486Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} target debugging
12487info.
12488@kindex set debug varobj
12489@item set debug varobj
12490Turns on or off display of @value{GDBN} variable object debugging
12491info. The default is off.
12492@kindex show debug varobj
12493@item show debug varobj
12494Displays the current state of displaying @value{GDBN} variable object
12495debugging info.
12496@end table
104c1213 12497
8e04817f
AC
12498@node Sequences
12499@chapter Canned Sequences of Commands
104c1213 12500
8e04817f
AC
12501Aside from breakpoint commands (@pxref{Break Commands, ,Breakpoint
12502command lists}), @value{GDBN} provides two ways to store sequences of
12503commands for execution as a unit: user-defined commands and command
12504files.
104c1213 12505
8e04817f
AC
12506@menu
12507* Define:: User-defined commands
12508* Hooks:: User-defined command hooks
12509* Command Files:: Command files
12510* Output:: Commands for controlled output
12511@end menu
104c1213 12512
8e04817f
AC
12513@node Define
12514@section User-defined commands
104c1213 12515
8e04817f
AC
12516@cindex user-defined command
12517A @dfn{user-defined command} is a sequence of @value{GDBN} commands to
12518which you assign a new name as a command. This is done with the
12519@code{define} command. User commands may accept up to 10 arguments
12520separated by whitespace. Arguments are accessed within the user command
12521via @var{$arg0@dots{}$arg9}. A trivial example:
104c1213 12522
8e04817f
AC
12523@smallexample
12524define adder
12525 print $arg0 + $arg1 + $arg2
12526@end smallexample
104c1213
JM
12527
12528@noindent
8e04817f 12529To execute the command use:
104c1213 12530
8e04817f
AC
12531@smallexample
12532adder 1 2 3
12533@end smallexample
104c1213 12534
8e04817f
AC
12535@noindent
12536This defines the command @code{adder}, which prints the sum of
12537its three arguments. Note the arguments are text substitutions, so they may
12538reference variables, use complex expressions, or even perform inferior
12539functions calls.
104c1213
JM
12540
12541@table @code
104c1213 12542
8e04817f
AC
12543@kindex define
12544@item define @var{commandname}
12545Define a command named @var{commandname}. If there is already a command
12546by that name, you are asked to confirm that you want to redefine it.
104c1213 12547
8e04817f
AC
12548The definition of the command is made up of other @value{GDBN} command lines,
12549which are given following the @code{define} command. The end of these
12550commands is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12551
8e04817f
AC
12552@kindex if
12553@kindex else
12554@item if
12555Takes a single argument, which is an expression to evaluate.
12556It is followed by a series of commands that are executed
12557only if the expression is true (nonzero).
12558There can then optionally be a line @code{else}, followed
12559by a series of commands that are only executed if the expression
12560was false. The end of the list is marked by a line containing @code{end}.
104c1213 12561
8e04817f
AC
12562@kindex while
12563@item while
12564The syntax is similar to @code{if}: the command takes a single argument,
12565which is an expression to evaluate, and must be followed by the commands to
12566execute, one per line, terminated by an @code{end}.
12567The commands are executed repeatedly as long as the expression
12568evaluates to true.
104c1213 12569
8e04817f
AC
12570@kindex document
12571@item document @var{commandname}
12572Document the user-defined command @var{commandname}, so that it can be
12573accessed by @code{help}. The command @var{commandname} must already be
12574defined. This command reads lines of documentation just as @code{define}
12575reads the lines of the command definition, ending with @code{end}.
12576After the @code{document} command is finished, @code{help} on command
12577@var{commandname} displays the documentation you have written.
104c1213 12578
8e04817f
AC
12579You may use the @code{document} command again to change the
12580documentation of a command. Redefining the command with @code{define}
12581does not change the documentation.
104c1213 12582
8e04817f
AC
12583@kindex help user-defined
12584@item help user-defined
12585List all user-defined commands, with the first line of the documentation
12586(if any) for each.
104c1213 12587
8e04817f
AC
12588@kindex show user
12589@item show user
12590@itemx show user @var{commandname}
12591Display the @value{GDBN} commands used to define @var{commandname} (but
12592not its documentation). If no @var{commandname} is given, display the
12593definitions for all user-defined commands.
104c1213
JM
12594
12595@end table
12596
8e04817f
AC
12597When user-defined commands are executed, the
12598commands of the definition are not printed. An error in any command
12599stops execution of the user-defined command.
104c1213 12600
8e04817f
AC
12601If used interactively, commands that would ask for confirmation proceed
12602without asking when used inside a user-defined command. Many @value{GDBN}
12603commands that normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the
12604messages when used in a user-defined command.
104c1213 12605
8e04817f
AC
12606@node Hooks
12607@section User-defined command hooks
12608@cindex command hooks
12609@cindex hooks, for commands
12610@cindex hooks, pre-command
104c1213 12611
8e04817f
AC
12612@kindex hook
12613@kindex hook-
12614You may define @dfn{hooks}, which are a special kind of user-defined
12615command. Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined
12616command @samp{hook-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments)
12617before that command.
104c1213 12618
8e04817f
AC
12619@cindex hooks, post-command
12620@kindex hookpost
12621@kindex hookpost-
12622A hook may also be defined which is run after the command you executed.
12623Whenever you run the command @samp{foo}, if the user-defined command
12624@samp{hookpost-foo} exists, it is executed (with no arguments) after
12625that command. Post-execution hooks may exist simultaneously with
12626pre-execution hooks, for the same command.
104c1213 12627
8e04817f
AC
12628It is valid for a hook to call the command which it hooks. If this
12629occurs, the hook is not re-executed, thereby avoiding infinte recursion.
104c1213 12630
8e04817f
AC
12631@c It would be nice if hookpost could be passed a parameter indicating
12632@c if the command it hooks executed properly or not. FIXME!
104c1213 12633
8e04817f
AC
12634@kindex stop@r{, a pseudo-command}
12635In addition, a pseudo-command, @samp{stop} exists. Defining
12636(@samp{hook-stop}) makes the associated commands execute every time
12637execution stops in your program: before breakpoint commands are run,
12638displays are printed, or the stack frame is printed.
104c1213 12639
8e04817f
AC
12640For example, to ignore @code{SIGALRM} signals while
12641single-stepping, but treat them normally during normal execution,
12642you could define:
104c1213 12643
8e04817f
AC
12644@example
12645define hook-stop
12646handle SIGALRM nopass
12647end
104c1213 12648
8e04817f
AC
12649define hook-run
12650handle SIGALRM pass
12651end
104c1213 12652
8e04817f
AC
12653define hook-continue
12654handle SIGLARM pass
12655end
12656@end example
104c1213 12657
8e04817f
AC
12658As a further example, to hook at the begining and end of the @code{echo}
12659command, and to add extra text to the beginning and end of the message,
12660you could define:
104c1213 12661
8e04817f
AC
12662@example
12663define hook-echo
12664echo <<<---
12665end
104c1213 12666
8e04817f
AC
12667define hookpost-echo
12668echo --->>>\n
12669end
104c1213 12670
8e04817f
AC
12671(@value{GDBP}) echo Hello World
12672<<<---Hello World--->>>
12673(@value{GDBP})
104c1213 12674
8e04817f 12675@end example
104c1213 12676
8e04817f
AC
12677You can define a hook for any single-word command in @value{GDBN}, but
12678not for command aliases; you should define a hook for the basic command
12679name, e.g. @code{backtrace} rather than @code{bt}.
12680@c FIXME! So how does Joe User discover whether a command is an alias
12681@c or not?
12682If an error occurs during the execution of your hook, execution of
12683@value{GDBN} commands stops and @value{GDBN} issues a prompt
12684(before the command that you actually typed had a chance to run).
104c1213 12685
8e04817f
AC
12686If you try to define a hook which does not match any known command, you
12687get a warning from the @code{define} command.
c906108c 12688
8e04817f
AC
12689@node Command Files
12690@section Command files
c906108c 12691
8e04817f
AC
12692@cindex command files
12693A command file for @value{GDBN} is a file of lines that are @value{GDBN}
12694commands. Comments (lines starting with @kbd{#}) may also be included.
12695An empty line in a command file does nothing; it does not mean to repeat
12696the last command, as it would from the terminal.
c906108c 12697
8e04817f
AC
12698@cindex init file
12699@cindex @file{.gdbinit}
12700@cindex @file{gdb.ini}
12701When you start @value{GDBN}, it automatically executes commands from its
12702@dfn{init files}, normally called @file{.gdbinit}@footnote{The DJGPP
12703port of @value{GDBN} uses the name @file{gdb.ini} instead, due to the
12704limitations of file names imposed by DOS filesystems.}.
12705During startup, @value{GDBN} does the following:
c906108c 12706
8e04817f
AC
12707@enumerate
12708@item
12709Reads the init file (if any) in your home directory@footnote{On
12710DOS/Windows systems, the home directory is the one pointed to by the
12711@code{HOME} environment variable.}.
c906108c 12712
8e04817f
AC
12713@item
12714Processes command line options and operands.
c906108c 12715
8e04817f
AC
12716@item
12717Reads the init file (if any) in the current working directory.
c906108c 12718
8e04817f
AC
12719@item
12720Reads command files specified by the @samp{-x} option.
12721@end enumerate
c906108c 12722
8e04817f
AC
12723The init file in your home directory can set options (such as @samp{set
12724complaints}) that affect subsequent processing of command line options
12725and operands. Init files are not executed if you use the @samp{-nx}
12726option (@pxref{Mode Options, ,Choosing modes}).
c906108c 12727
8e04817f
AC
12728@cindex init file name
12729On some configurations of @value{GDBN}, the init file is known by a
12730different name (these are typically environments where a specialized
12731form of @value{GDBN} may need to coexist with other forms, hence a
12732different name for the specialized version's init file). These are the
12733environments with special init file names:
c906108c 12734
8e04817f
AC
12735@cindex @file{.vxgdbinit}
12736@itemize @bullet
12737@item
12738VxWorks (Wind River Systems real-time OS): @file{.vxgdbinit}
c906108c 12739
8e04817f
AC
12740@cindex @file{.os68gdbinit}
12741@item
12742OS68K (Enea Data Systems real-time OS): @file{.os68gdbinit}
c906108c 12743
8e04817f
AC
12744@cindex @file{.esgdbinit}
12745@item
12746ES-1800 (Ericsson Telecom AB M68000 emulator): @file{.esgdbinit}
12747@end itemize
c906108c 12748
8e04817f
AC
12749You can also request the execution of a command file with the
12750@code{source} command:
c906108c 12751
8e04817f
AC
12752@table @code
12753@kindex source
12754@item source @var{filename}
12755Execute the command file @var{filename}.
c906108c
SS
12756@end table
12757
8e04817f
AC
12758The lines in a command file are executed sequentially. They are not
12759printed as they are executed. An error in any command terminates execution
12760of the command file.
c906108c 12761
8e04817f
AC
12762Commands that would ask for confirmation if used interactively proceed
12763without asking when used in a command file. Many @value{GDBN} commands that
12764normally print messages to say what they are doing omit the messages
12765when called from command files.
c906108c 12766
8e04817f
AC
12767@value{GDBN} also accepts command input from standard input. In this
12768mode, normal output goes to standard output and error output goes to
12769standard error. Errors in a command file supplied on standard input do
12770not terminate execution of the command file --- execution continues with
12771the next command.
c906108c 12772
8e04817f
AC
12773@example
12774gdb < cmds > log 2>&1
12775@end example
c906108c 12776
8e04817f
AC
12777(The syntax above will vary depending on the shell used.) This example
12778will execute commands from the file @file{cmds}. All output and errors
12779would be directed to @file{log}.
c906108c 12780
8e04817f
AC
12781@node Output
12782@section Commands for controlled output
c906108c 12783
8e04817f
AC
12784During the execution of a command file or a user-defined command, normal
12785@value{GDBN} output is suppressed; the only output that appears is what is
12786explicitly printed by the commands in the definition. This section
12787describes three commands useful for generating exactly the output you
12788want.
c906108c
SS
12789
12790@table @code
8e04817f
AC
12791@kindex echo
12792@item echo @var{text}
12793@c I do not consider backslash-space a standard C escape sequence
12794@c because it is not in ANSI.
12795Print @var{text}. Nonprinting characters can be included in
12796@var{text} using C escape sequences, such as @samp{\n} to print a
12797newline. @strong{No newline is printed unless you specify one.}
12798In addition to the standard C escape sequences, a backslash followed
12799by a space stands for a space. This is useful for displaying a
12800string with spaces at the beginning or the end, since leading and
12801trailing spaces are otherwise trimmed from all arguments.
12802To print @samp{@w{ }and foo =@w{ }}, use the command
12803@samp{echo \@w{ }and foo = \@w{ }}.
c906108c 12804
8e04817f
AC
12805A backslash at the end of @var{text} can be used, as in C, to continue
12806the command onto subsequent lines. For example,
c906108c 12807
8e04817f
AC
12808@example
12809echo This is some text\n\
12810which is continued\n\
12811onto several lines.\n
12812@end example
c906108c 12813
8e04817f 12814produces the same output as
c906108c 12815
8e04817f
AC
12816@example
12817echo This is some text\n
12818echo which is continued\n
12819echo onto several lines.\n
12820@end example
c906108c 12821
8e04817f
AC
12822@kindex output
12823@item output @var{expression}
12824Print the value of @var{expression} and nothing but that value: no
12825newlines, no @samp{$@var{nn} = }. The value is not entered in the
12826value history either. @xref{Expressions, ,Expressions}, for more information
12827on expressions.
c906108c 12828
8e04817f
AC
12829@item output/@var{fmt} @var{expression}
12830Print the value of @var{expression} in format @var{fmt}. You can use
12831the same formats as for @code{print}. @xref{Output Formats,,Output
12832formats}, for more information.
c906108c 12833
8e04817f
AC
12834@kindex printf
12835@item printf @var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{}
12836Print the values of the @var{expressions} under the control of
12837@var{string}. The @var{expressions} are separated by commas and may be
12838either numbers or pointers. Their values are printed as specified by
12839@var{string}, exactly as if your program were to execute the C
12840subroutine
12841@c FIXME: the above implies that at least all ANSI C formats are
12842@c supported, but it isn't true: %E and %G don't work (or so it seems).
12843@c Either this is a bug, or the manual should document what formats are
12844@c supported.
c906108c 12845
8e04817f
AC
12846@example
12847printf (@var{string}, @var{expressions}@dots{});
12848@end example
c906108c 12849
8e04817f 12850For example, you can print two values in hex like this:
c906108c 12851
8e04817f
AC
12852@smallexample
12853printf "foo, bar-foo = 0x%x, 0x%x\n", foo, bar-foo
12854@end smallexample
c906108c 12855
8e04817f
AC
12856The only backslash-escape sequences that you can use in the format
12857string are the simple ones that consist of backslash followed by a
12858letter.
c906108c
SS
12859@end table
12860
8e04817f
AC
12861@node TUI
12862@chapter @value{GDBN} Text User Interface
12863@cindex TUI
c906108c 12864
8e04817f
AC
12865@menu
12866* TUI Overview:: TUI overview
12867* TUI Keys:: TUI key bindings
12868* TUI Commands:: TUI specific commands
12869* TUI Configuration:: TUI configuration variables
12870@end menu
c906108c 12871
8e04817f
AC
12872The @value{GDBN} Text User Interface, TUI in short,
12873is a terminal interface which uses the @code{curses} library
12874to show the source file, the assembly output, the program registers
12875and @value{GDBN} commands in separate text windows.
12876The TUI is available only when @value{GDBN} is configured
12877with the @code{--enable-tui} configure option (@pxref{Configure Options}).
c906108c 12878
8e04817f
AC
12879@node TUI Overview
12880@section TUI overview
c906108c 12881
8e04817f
AC
12882The TUI has two display modes that can be switched while
12883@value{GDBN} runs:
c906108c 12884
8e04817f
AC
12885@itemize @bullet
12886@item
12887A curses (or TUI) mode in which it displays several text
12888windows on the terminal.
c906108c 12889
8e04817f
AC
12890@item
12891A standard mode which corresponds to the @value{GDBN} configured without
12892the TUI.
12893@end itemize
c906108c 12894
8e04817f
AC
12895In the TUI mode, @value{GDBN} can display several text window
12896on the terminal:
c906108c 12897
8e04817f
AC
12898@table @emph
12899@item command
12900This window is the @value{GDBN} command window with the @value{GDBN}
12901prompt and the @value{GDBN} outputs. The @value{GDBN} input is still
12902managed using readline but through the TUI. The @emph{command}
12903window is always visible.
c906108c 12904
8e04817f
AC
12905@item source
12906The source window shows the source file of the program. The current
12907line as well as active breakpoints are displayed in this window.
12908The current program position is shown with the @samp{>} marker and
12909active breakpoints are shown with @samp{*} markers.
c906108c 12910
8e04817f
AC
12911@item assembly
12912The assembly window shows the disassembly output of the program.
c906108c 12913
8e04817f
AC
12914@item register
12915This window shows the processor registers. It detects when
12916a register is changed and when this is the case, registers that have
12917changed are highlighted.
c906108c 12918
c906108c
SS
12919@end table
12920
8e04817f
AC
12921The source, assembly and register windows are attached to the thread
12922and the frame position. They are updated when the current thread
12923changes, when the frame changes or when the program counter changes.
12924These three windows are arranged by the TUI according to several
12925layouts. The layout defines which of these three windows are visible.
12926The following layouts are available:
c906108c 12927
8e04817f
AC
12928@itemize @bullet
12929@item
12930source
2df3850c 12931
8e04817f
AC
12932@item
12933assembly
12934
12935@item
12936source and assembly
12937
12938@item
12939source and registers
c906108c 12940
8e04817f
AC
12941@item
12942assembly and registers
2df3850c 12943
8e04817f 12944@end itemize
c906108c 12945
8e04817f
AC
12946@node TUI Keys
12947@section TUI Key Bindings
12948@cindex TUI key bindings
c906108c 12949
8e04817f
AC
12950The TUI installs several key bindings in the readline keymaps
12951(@pxref{Command Line Editing}).
12952They allow to leave or enter in the TUI mode or they operate
12953directly on the TUI layout and windows. The following key bindings
12954are installed for both TUI mode and the @value{GDBN} standard mode.
c906108c 12955
8e04817f
AC
12956@table @kbd
12957@kindex C-x C-a
12958@item C-x C-a
12959@kindex C-x a
12960@itemx C-x a
12961@kindex C-x A
12962@itemx C-x A
12963Enter or leave the TUI mode. When the TUI mode is left,
12964the curses window management is left and @value{GDBN} operates using
12965its standard mode writing on the terminal directly. When the TUI
12966mode is entered, the control is given back to the curses windows.
12967The screen is then refreshed.
c906108c 12968
8e04817f
AC
12969@kindex C-x 1
12970@item C-x 1
12971Use a TUI layout with only one window. The layout will
12972either be @samp{source} or @samp{assembly}. When the TUI mode
12973is not active, it will switch to the TUI mode.
2df3850c 12974
8e04817f 12975Think of this key binding as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 1} binding.
c906108c 12976
8e04817f
AC
12977@kindex C-x 2
12978@item C-x 2
12979Use a TUI layout with at least two windows. When the current
12980layout shows already two windows, a next layout with two windows is used.
12981When a new layout is chosen, one window will always be common to the
12982previous layout and the new one.
c906108c 12983
8e04817f 12984Think of it as the Emacs @kbd{C-x 2} binding.
2df3850c 12985
c906108c
SS
12986@end table
12987
8e04817f 12988The following key bindings are handled only by the TUI mode:
5d161b24 12989
8e04817f
AC
12990@table @key
12991@kindex PgUp
12992@item PgUp
12993Scroll the active window one page up.
c906108c 12994
8e04817f
AC
12995@kindex PgDn
12996@item PgDn
12997Scroll the active window one page down.
c906108c 12998
8e04817f
AC
12999@kindex Up
13000@item Up
13001Scroll the active window one line up.
c906108c 13002
8e04817f
AC
13003@kindex Down
13004@item Down
13005Scroll the active window one line down.
c906108c 13006
8e04817f
AC
13007@kindex Left
13008@item Left
13009Scroll the active window one column left.
c906108c 13010
8e04817f
AC
13011@kindex Right
13012@item Right
13013Scroll the active window one column right.
c906108c 13014
8e04817f
AC
13015@kindex C-L
13016@item C-L
13017Refresh the screen.
c906108c 13018
8e04817f 13019@end table
c906108c 13020
8e04817f
AC
13021In the TUI mode, the arrow keys are used by the active window
13022for scrolling. This means they are not available for readline. It is
13023necessary to use other readline key bindings such as @key{C-p}, @key{C-n},
13024@key{C-b} and @key{C-f}.
13025
13026@node TUI Commands
13027@section TUI specific commands
13028@cindex TUI commands
13029
13030The TUI has specific commands to control the text windows.
13031These commands are always available, that is they do not depend on
13032the current terminal mode in which @value{GDBN} runs. When @value{GDBN}
13033is in the standard mode, using these commands will automatically switch
13034in the TUI mode.
c906108c
SS
13035
13036@table @code
8e04817f
AC
13037@item layout next
13038@kindex layout next
13039Display the next layout.
2df3850c 13040
8e04817f
AC
13041@item layout prev
13042@kindex layout prev
13043Display the previous layout.
c906108c 13044
8e04817f
AC
13045@item layout src
13046@kindex layout src
13047Display the source window only.
c906108c 13048
8e04817f
AC
13049@item layout asm
13050@kindex layout asm
13051Display the assembly window only.
c906108c 13052
8e04817f
AC
13053@item layout split
13054@kindex layout split
13055Display the source and assembly window.
c906108c 13056
8e04817f
AC
13057@item layout regs
13058@kindex layout regs
13059Display the register window together with the source or assembly window.
13060
13061@item focus next | prev | src | asm | regs | split
13062@kindex focus
13063Set the focus to the named window.
13064This command allows to change the active window so that scrolling keys
13065can be affected to another window.
c906108c 13066
8e04817f
AC
13067@item refresh
13068@kindex refresh
13069Refresh the screen. This is similar to using @key{C-L} key.
c906108c 13070
8e04817f
AC
13071@item update
13072@kindex update
13073Update the source window and the current execution point.
c906108c 13074
8e04817f
AC
13075@item winheight @var{name} +@var{count}
13076@itemx winheight @var{name} -@var{count}
13077@kindex winheight
13078Change the height of the window @var{name} by @var{count}
13079lines. Positive counts increase the height, while negative counts
13080decrease it.
2df3850c 13081
c906108c
SS
13082@end table
13083
8e04817f
AC
13084@node TUI Configuration
13085@section TUI configuration variables
13086@cindex TUI configuration variables
c906108c 13087
8e04817f
AC
13088The TUI has several configuration variables that control the
13089appearance of windows on the terminal.
c906108c 13090
8e04817f
AC
13091@table @code
13092@item set tui border-kind @var{kind}
13093@kindex set tui border-kind
13094Select the border appearance for the source, assembly and register windows.
13095The possible values are the following:
13096@table @code
13097@item space
13098Use a space character to draw the border.
c906108c 13099
8e04817f
AC
13100@item ascii
13101Use ascii characters + - and | to draw the border.
c906108c 13102
8e04817f
AC
13103@item acs
13104Use the Alternate Character Set to draw the border. The border is
13105drawn using character line graphics if the terminal supports them.
c78b4128 13106
8e04817f 13107@end table
c78b4128 13108
8e04817f
AC
13109@item set tui active-border-mode @var{mode}
13110@kindex set tui active-border-mode
13111Select the attributes to display the border of the active window.
13112The possible values are @code{normal}, @code{standout}, @code{reverse},
13113@code{half}, @code{half-standout}, @code{bold} and @code{bold-standout}.
c78b4128 13114
8e04817f
AC
13115@item set tui border-mode @var{mode}
13116@kindex set tui border-mode
13117Select the attributes to display the border of other windows.
13118The @var{mode} can be one of the following:
13119@table @code
13120@item normal
13121Use normal attributes to display the border.
c906108c 13122
8e04817f
AC
13123@item standout
13124Use standout mode.
c906108c 13125
8e04817f
AC
13126@item reverse
13127Use reverse video mode.
c906108c 13128
8e04817f
AC
13129@item half
13130Use half bright mode.
c906108c 13131
8e04817f
AC
13132@item half-standout
13133Use half bright and standout mode.
c906108c 13134
8e04817f
AC
13135@item bold
13136Use extra bright or bold mode.
c78b4128 13137
8e04817f
AC
13138@item bold-standout
13139Use extra bright or bold and standout mode.
c78b4128 13140
8e04817f 13141@end table
c78b4128 13142
8e04817f 13143@end table
c78b4128 13144
8e04817f
AC
13145@node Emacs
13146@chapter Using @value{GDBN} under @sc{gnu} Emacs
c78b4128 13147
8e04817f
AC
13148@cindex Emacs
13149@cindex @sc{gnu} Emacs
13150A special interface allows you to use @sc{gnu} Emacs to view (and
13151edit) the source files for the program you are debugging with
13152@value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13153
8e04817f
AC
13154To use this interface, use the command @kbd{M-x gdb} in Emacs. Give the
13155executable file you want to debug as an argument. This command starts
13156@value{GDBN} as a subprocess of Emacs, with input and output through a newly
13157created Emacs buffer.
13158@c (Do not use the @code{-tui} option to run @value{GDBN} from Emacs.)
c906108c 13159
8e04817f
AC
13160Using @value{GDBN} under Emacs is just like using @value{GDBN} normally except for two
13161things:
c906108c 13162
8e04817f
AC
13163@itemize @bullet
13164@item
13165All ``terminal'' input and output goes through the Emacs buffer.
13166@end itemize
c906108c 13167
8e04817f
AC
13168This applies both to @value{GDBN} commands and their output, and to the input
13169and output done by the program you are debugging.
bf0184be 13170
8e04817f
AC
13171This is useful because it means that you can copy the text of previous
13172commands and input them again; you can even use parts of the output
13173in this way.
bf0184be 13174
8e04817f
AC
13175All the facilities of Emacs' Shell mode are available for interacting
13176with your program. In particular, you can send signals the usual
13177way---for example, @kbd{C-c C-c} for an interrupt, @kbd{C-c C-z} for a
13178stop.
bf0184be 13179
8e04817f 13180@itemize @bullet
bf0184be 13181@item
8e04817f
AC
13182@value{GDBN} displays source code through Emacs.
13183@end itemize
bf0184be 13184
8e04817f
AC
13185Each time @value{GDBN} displays a stack frame, Emacs automatically finds the
13186source file for that frame and puts an arrow (@samp{=>}) at the
13187left margin of the current line. Emacs uses a separate buffer for
13188source display, and splits the screen to show both your @value{GDBN} session
13189and the source.
bf0184be 13190
8e04817f
AC
13191Explicit @value{GDBN} @code{list} or search commands still produce output as
13192usual, but you probably have no reason to use them from Emacs.
c906108c 13193
8e04817f
AC
13194@quotation
13195@emph{Warning:} If the directory where your program resides is not your
13196current directory, it can be easy to confuse Emacs about the location of
13197the source files, in which case the auxiliary display buffer does not
13198appear to show your source. @value{GDBN} can find programs by searching your
13199environment's @code{PATH} variable, so the @value{GDBN} input and output
13200session proceeds normally; but Emacs does not get enough information
13201back from @value{GDBN} to locate the source files in this situation. To
13202avoid this problem, either start @value{GDBN} mode from the directory where
13203your program resides, or specify an absolute file name when prompted for the
13204@kbd{M-x gdb} argument.
c906108c 13205
8e04817f
AC
13206A similar confusion can result if you use the @value{GDBN} @code{file} command to
13207switch to debugging a program in some other location, from an existing
13208@value{GDBN} buffer in Emacs.
13209@end quotation
13210
13211By default, @kbd{M-x gdb} calls the program called @file{gdb}. If
13212you need to call @value{GDBN} by a different name (for example, if you keep
13213several configurations around, with different names) you can set the
13214Emacs variable @code{gdb-command-name}; for example,
13215
13216@example
13217(setq gdb-command-name "mygdb")
13218@end example
13219
13220@noindent
13221(preceded by @kbd{M-:} or @kbd{ESC :}, or typed in the @code{*scratch*} buffer, or
13222in your @file{.emacs} file) makes Emacs call the program named
13223``@code{mygdb}'' instead.
13224
13225In the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer, you can use these special Emacs commands in
13226addition to the standard Shell mode commands:
c906108c 13227
8e04817f
AC
13228@table @kbd
13229@item C-h m
13230Describe the features of Emacs' @value{GDBN} Mode.
c906108c 13231
8e04817f
AC
13232@item M-s
13233Execute to another source line, like the @value{GDBN} @code{step} command; also
13234update the display window to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13235
8e04817f
AC
13236@item M-n
13237Execute to next source line in this function, skipping all function
13238calls, like the @value{GDBN} @code{next} command. Then update the display window
13239to show the current file and location.
c906108c 13240
8e04817f
AC
13241@item M-i
13242Execute one instruction, like the @value{GDBN} @code{stepi} command; update
13243display window accordingly.
c906108c 13244
8e04817f
AC
13245@item M-x gdb-nexti
13246Execute to next instruction, using the @value{GDBN} @code{nexti} command; update
13247display window accordingly.
c906108c 13248
8e04817f
AC
13249@item C-c C-f
13250Execute until exit from the selected stack frame, like the @value{GDBN}
13251@code{finish} command.
c906108c 13252
8e04817f
AC
13253@item M-c
13254Continue execution of your program, like the @value{GDBN} @code{continue}
13255command.
b433d00b 13256
8e04817f 13257@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-p}.
b433d00b 13258
8e04817f
AC
13259@item M-u
13260Go up the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument
13261(@pxref{Arguments, , Numeric Arguments, Emacs, The @sc{gnu} Emacs Manual}),
13262like the @value{GDBN} @code{up} command.
b433d00b 13263
8e04817f 13264@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-u}.
c906108c 13265
8e04817f
AC
13266@item M-d
13267Go down the number of frames indicated by the numeric argument, like the
13268@value{GDBN} @code{down} command.
c906108c 13269
8e04817f 13270@emph{Warning:} In Emacs v19, this command is @kbd{C-c C-d}.
c906108c 13271
8e04817f
AC
13272@item C-x &
13273Read the number where the cursor is positioned, and insert it at the end
13274of the @value{GDBN} I/O buffer. For example, if you wish to disassemble code
13275around an address that was displayed earlier, type @kbd{disassemble};
13276then move the cursor to the address display, and pick up the
13277argument for @code{disassemble} by typing @kbd{C-x &}.
c906108c 13278
8e04817f
AC
13279You can customize this further by defining elements of the list
13280@code{gdb-print-command}; once it is defined, you can format or
13281otherwise process numbers picked up by @kbd{C-x &} before they are
13282inserted. A numeric argument to @kbd{C-x &} indicates that you
13283wish special formatting, and also acts as an index to pick an element of the
13284list. If the list element is a string, the number to be inserted is
13285formatted using the Emacs function @code{format}; otherwise the number
13286is passed as an argument to the corresponding list element.
13287@end table
c906108c 13288
8e04817f
AC
13289In any source file, the Emacs command @kbd{C-x SPC} (@code{gdb-break})
13290tells @value{GDBN} to set a breakpoint on the source line point is on.
c906108c 13291
8e04817f
AC
13292If you accidentally delete the source-display buffer, an easy way to get
13293it back is to type the command @code{f} in the @value{GDBN} buffer, to
13294request a frame display; when you run under Emacs, this recreates
13295the source buffer if necessary to show you the context of the current
13296frame.
c906108c 13297
8e04817f
AC
13298The source files displayed in Emacs are in ordinary Emacs buffers
13299which are visiting the source files in the usual way. You can edit
13300the files with these buffers if you wish; but keep in mind that @value{GDBN}
13301communicates with Emacs in terms of line numbers. If you add or
13302delete lines from the text, the line numbers that @value{GDBN} knows cease
13303to correspond properly with the code.
c906108c 13304
8e04817f
AC
13305@c The following dropped because Epoch is nonstandard. Reactivate
13306@c if/when v19 does something similar. ---doc@cygnus.com 19dec1990
13307@ignore
13308@kindex Emacs Epoch environment
13309@kindex Epoch
13310@kindex inspect
c906108c 13311
8e04817f
AC
13312Version 18 of @sc{gnu} Emacs has a built-in window system
13313called the @code{epoch}
13314environment. Users of this environment can use a new command,
13315@code{inspect} which performs identically to @code{print} except that
13316each value is printed in its own window.
13317@end ignore
c906108c 13318
8e04817f
AC
13319@include annotate.texi
13320@include gdbmi.texinfo
c906108c 13321
8e04817f
AC
13322@node GDB Bugs
13323@chapter Reporting Bugs in @value{GDBN}
13324@cindex bugs in @value{GDBN}
13325@cindex reporting bugs in @value{GDBN}
c906108c 13326
8e04817f 13327Your bug reports play an essential role in making @value{GDBN} reliable.
c906108c 13328
8e04817f
AC
13329Reporting a bug may help you by bringing a solution to your problem, or it
13330may not. But in any case the principal function of a bug report is to help
13331the entire community by making the next version of @value{GDBN} work better. Bug
13332reports are your contribution to the maintenance of @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13333
8e04817f
AC
13334In order for a bug report to serve its purpose, you must include the
13335information that enables us to fix the bug.
c4555f82
SC
13336
13337@menu
8e04817f
AC
13338* Bug Criteria:: Have you found a bug?
13339* Bug Reporting:: How to report bugs
c4555f82
SC
13340@end menu
13341
8e04817f
AC
13342@node Bug Criteria
13343@section Have you found a bug?
13344@cindex bug criteria
c4555f82 13345
8e04817f 13346If you are not sure whether you have found a bug, here are some guidelines:
c4555f82
SC
13347
13348@itemize @bullet
8e04817f
AC
13349@cindex fatal signal
13350@cindex debugger crash
13351@cindex crash of debugger
c4555f82 13352@item
8e04817f
AC
13353If the debugger gets a fatal signal, for any input whatever, that is a
13354@value{GDBN} bug. Reliable debuggers never crash.
13355
13356@cindex error on valid input
13357@item
13358If @value{GDBN} produces an error message for valid input, that is a
13359bug. (Note that if you're cross debugging, the problem may also be
13360somewhere in the connection to the target.)
c4555f82 13361
8e04817f 13362@cindex invalid input
c4555f82 13363@item
8e04817f
AC
13364If @value{GDBN} does not produce an error message for invalid input,
13365that is a bug. However, you should note that your idea of
13366``invalid input'' might be our idea of ``an extension'' or ``support
13367for traditional practice''.
13368
13369@item
13370If you are an experienced user of debugging tools, your suggestions
13371for improvement of @value{GDBN} are welcome in any case.
c4555f82
SC
13372@end itemize
13373
8e04817f
AC
13374@node Bug Reporting
13375@section How to report bugs
13376@cindex bug reports
13377@cindex @value{GDBN} bugs, reporting
13378
13379A number of companies and individuals offer support for @sc{gnu} products.
13380If you obtained @value{GDBN} from a support organization, we recommend you
13381contact that organization first.
13382
13383You can find contact information for many support companies and
13384individuals in the file @file{etc/SERVICE} in the @sc{gnu} Emacs
13385distribution.
13386@c should add a web page ref...
13387
13388In any event, we also recommend that you send bug reports for
13389@value{GDBN} to this addresses:
13390
13391@example
13392bug-gdb@@gnu.org
13393@end example
13394
13395@strong{Do not send bug reports to @samp{info-gdb}, or to
13396@samp{help-gdb}, or to any newsgroups.} Most users of @value{GDBN} do
13397not want to receive bug reports. Those that do have arranged to receive
13398@samp{bug-gdb}.
13399
13400The mailing list @samp{bug-gdb} has a newsgroup @samp{gnu.gdb.bug} which
13401serves as a repeater. The mailing list and the newsgroup carry exactly
13402the same messages. Often people think of posting bug reports to the
13403newsgroup instead of mailing them. This appears to work, but it has one
13404problem which can be crucial: a newsgroup posting often lacks a mail
13405path back to the sender. Thus, if we need to ask for more information,
13406we may be unable to reach you. For this reason, it is better to send
13407bug reports to the mailing list.
c4555f82 13408
8e04817f 13409As a last resort, send bug reports on paper to:
c4555f82 13410
8e04817f
AC
13411@example
13412@sc{gnu} Debugger Bugs
13413Free Software Foundation Inc.
1341459 Temple Place - Suite 330
13415Boston, MA 02111-1307
13416USA
13417@end example
c4555f82 13418
8e04817f
AC
13419The fundamental principle of reporting bugs usefully is this:
13420@strong{report all the facts}. If you are not sure whether to state a
13421fact or leave it out, state it!
c4555f82 13422
8e04817f
AC
13423Often people omit facts because they think they know what causes the
13424problem and assume that some details do not matter. Thus, you might
13425assume that the name of the variable you use in an example does not matter.
13426Well, probably it does not, but one cannot be sure. Perhaps the bug is a
13427stray memory reference which happens to fetch from the location where that
13428name is stored in memory; perhaps, if the name were different, the contents
13429of that location would fool the debugger into doing the right thing despite
13430the bug. Play it safe and give a specific, complete example. That is the
13431easiest thing for you to do, and the most helpful.
c4555f82 13432
8e04817f
AC
13433Keep in mind that the purpose of a bug report is to enable us to fix the
13434bug. It may be that the bug has been reported previously, but neither
13435you nor we can know that unless your bug report is complete and
13436self-contained.
c4555f82 13437
8e04817f
AC
13438Sometimes people give a few sketchy facts and ask, ``Does this ring a
13439bell?'' Those bug reports are useless, and we urge everyone to
13440@emph{refuse to respond to them} except to chide the sender to report
13441bugs properly.
13442
13443To enable us to fix the bug, you should include all these things:
c4555f82
SC
13444
13445@itemize @bullet
13446@item
8e04817f
AC
13447The version of @value{GDBN}. @value{GDBN} announces it if you start
13448with no arguments; you can also print it at any time using @code{show
13449version}.
c4555f82 13450
8e04817f
AC
13451Without this, we will not know whether there is any point in looking for
13452the bug in the current version of @value{GDBN}.
c4555f82
SC
13453
13454@item
8e04817f
AC
13455The type of machine you are using, and the operating system name and
13456version number.
c4555f82
SC
13457
13458@item
8e04817f
AC
13459What compiler (and its version) was used to compile @value{GDBN}---e.g.
13460``@value{GCC}--2.8.1''.
c4555f82
SC
13461
13462@item
8e04817f
AC
13463What compiler (and its version) was used to compile the program you are
13464debugging---e.g. ``@value{GCC}--2.8.1'', or ``HP92453-01 A.10.32.03 HP
13465C Compiler''. For GCC, you can say @code{gcc --version} to get this
13466information; for other compilers, see the documentation for those
13467compilers.
c4555f82 13468
8e04817f
AC
13469@item
13470The command arguments you gave the compiler to compile your example and
13471observe the bug. For example, did you use @samp{-O}? To guarantee
13472you will not omit something important, list them all. A copy of the
13473Makefile (or the output from make) is sufficient.
c4555f82 13474
8e04817f
AC
13475If we were to try to guess the arguments, we would probably guess wrong
13476and then we might not encounter the bug.
c4555f82 13477
8e04817f
AC
13478@item
13479A complete input script, and all necessary source files, that will
13480reproduce the bug.
c4555f82 13481
8e04817f
AC
13482@item
13483A description of what behavior you observe that you believe is
13484incorrect. For example, ``It gets a fatal signal.''
c4555f82 13485
8e04817f
AC
13486Of course, if the bug is that @value{GDBN} gets a fatal signal, then we
13487will certainly notice it. But if the bug is incorrect output, we might
13488not notice unless it is glaringly wrong. You might as well not give us
13489a chance to make a mistake.
c4555f82 13490
8e04817f
AC
13491Even if the problem you experience is a fatal signal, you should still
13492say so explicitly. Suppose something strange is going on, such as, your
13493copy of @value{GDBN} is out of synch, or you have encountered a bug in
13494the C library on your system. (This has happened!) Your copy might
13495crash and ours would not. If you told us to expect a crash, then when
13496ours fails to crash, we would know that the bug was not happening for
13497us. If you had not told us to expect a crash, then we would not be able
13498to draw any conclusion from our observations.
c4555f82 13499
8e04817f
AC
13500@item
13501If you wish to suggest changes to the @value{GDBN} source, send us context
13502diffs. If you even discuss something in the @value{GDBN} source, refer to
13503it by context, not by line number.
c4555f82 13504
8e04817f
AC
13505The line numbers in our development sources will not match those in your
13506sources. Your line numbers would convey no useful information to us.
c4555f82 13507
8e04817f 13508@end itemize
c4555f82 13509
8e04817f 13510Here are some things that are not necessary:
c4555f82 13511
8e04817f
AC
13512@itemize @bullet
13513@item
13514A description of the envelope of the bug.
c4555f82 13515
8e04817f
AC
13516Often people who encounter a bug spend a lot of time investigating
13517which changes to the input file will make the bug go away and which
13518changes will not affect it.
c4555f82 13519
8e04817f
AC
13520This is often time consuming and not very useful, because the way we
13521will find the bug is by running a single example under the debugger
13522with breakpoints, not by pure deduction from a series of examples.
13523We recommend that you save your time for something else.
c4555f82 13524
8e04817f
AC
13525Of course, if you can find a simpler example to report @emph{instead}
13526of the original one, that is a convenience for us. Errors in the
13527output will be easier to spot, running under the debugger will take
13528less time, and so on.
c4555f82 13529
8e04817f
AC
13530However, simplification is not vital; if you do not want to do this,
13531report the bug anyway and send us the entire test case you used.
c4555f82 13532
8e04817f
AC
13533@item
13534A patch for the bug.
c4555f82 13535
8e04817f
AC
13536A patch for the bug does help us if it is a good one. But do not omit
13537the necessary information, such as the test case, on the assumption that
13538a patch is all we need. We might see problems with your patch and decide
13539to fix the problem another way, or we might not understand it at all.
c4555f82 13540
8e04817f
AC
13541Sometimes with a program as complicated as @value{GDBN} it is very hard to
13542construct an example that will make the program follow a certain path
13543through the code. If you do not send us the example, we will not be able
13544to construct one, so we will not be able to verify that the bug is fixed.
c4555f82 13545
8e04817f
AC
13546And if we cannot understand what bug you are trying to fix, or why your
13547patch should be an improvement, we will not install it. A test case will
13548help us to understand.
c4555f82 13549
8e04817f
AC
13550@item
13551A guess about what the bug is or what it depends on.
c4555f82 13552
8e04817f
AC
13553Such guesses are usually wrong. Even we cannot guess right about such
13554things without first using the debugger to find the facts.
13555@end itemize
c4555f82 13556
8e04817f
AC
13557@c The readline documentation is distributed with the readline code
13558@c and consists of the two following files:
13559@c rluser.texinfo
13560@c inc-hist.texinfo
13561@c Use -I with makeinfo to point to the appropriate directory,
13562@c environment var TEXINPUTS with TeX.
13563@include rluser.texinfo
13564@include inc-hist.texinfo
c4555f82 13565
c4555f82 13566
8e04817f
AC
13567@node Formatting Documentation
13568@appendix Formatting Documentation
c4555f82 13569
8e04817f
AC
13570@cindex @value{GDBN} reference card
13571@cindex reference card
13572The @value{GDBN} 4 release includes an already-formatted reference card, ready
13573for printing with PostScript or Ghostscript, in the @file{gdb}
13574subdirectory of the main source directory@footnote{In
13575@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/refcard.ps} of the version @value{GDBVN}
13576release.}. If you can use PostScript or Ghostscript with your printer,
13577you can print the reference card immediately with @file{refcard.ps}.
c4555f82 13578
8e04817f
AC
13579The release also includes the source for the reference card. You
13580can format it, using @TeX{}, by typing:
c4555f82 13581
8e04817f
AC
13582@example
13583make refcard.dvi
13584@end example
c4555f82 13585
8e04817f
AC
13586The @value{GDBN} reference card is designed to print in @dfn{landscape}
13587mode on US ``letter'' size paper;
13588that is, on a sheet 11 inches wide by 8.5 inches
13589high. You will need to specify this form of printing as an option to
13590your @sc{dvi} output program.
c4555f82 13591
8e04817f 13592@cindex documentation
c4555f82 13593
8e04817f
AC
13594All the documentation for @value{GDBN} comes as part of the machine-readable
13595distribution. The documentation is written in Texinfo format, which is
13596a documentation system that uses a single source file to produce both
13597on-line information and a printed manual. You can use one of the Info
13598formatting commands to create the on-line version of the documentation
13599and @TeX{} (or @code{texi2roff}) to typeset the printed version.
c4555f82 13600
8e04817f
AC
13601@value{GDBN} includes an already formatted copy of the on-line Info
13602version of this manual in the @file{gdb} subdirectory. The main Info
13603file is @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb/gdb.info}, and it refers to
13604subordinate files matching @samp{gdb.info*} in the same directory. If
13605necessary, you can print out these files, or read them with any editor;
13606but they are easier to read using the @code{info} subsystem in @sc{gnu}
13607Emacs or the standalone @code{info} program, available as part of the
13608@sc{gnu} Texinfo distribution.
c4555f82 13609
8e04817f
AC
13610If you want to format these Info files yourself, you need one of the
13611Info formatting programs, such as @code{texinfo-format-buffer} or
13612@code{makeinfo}.
c4555f82 13613
8e04817f
AC
13614If you have @code{makeinfo} installed, and are in the top level
13615@value{GDBN} source directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, in the case of
13616version @value{GDBVN}), you can make the Info file by typing:
c4555f82 13617
8e04817f
AC
13618@example
13619cd gdb
13620make gdb.info
13621@end example
c4555f82 13622
8e04817f
AC
13623If you want to typeset and print copies of this manual, you need @TeX{},
13624a program to print its @sc{dvi} output files, and @file{texinfo.tex}, the
13625Texinfo definitions file.
c4555f82 13626
8e04817f
AC
13627@TeX{} is a typesetting program; it does not print files directly, but
13628produces output files called @sc{dvi} files. To print a typeset
13629document, you need a program to print @sc{dvi} files. If your system
13630has @TeX{} installed, chances are it has such a program. The precise
13631command to use depends on your system; @kbd{lpr -d} is common; another
13632(for PostScript devices) is @kbd{dvips}. The @sc{dvi} print command may
13633require a file name without any extension or a @samp{.dvi} extension.
c4555f82 13634
8e04817f
AC
13635@TeX{} also requires a macro definitions file called
13636@file{texinfo.tex}. This file tells @TeX{} how to typeset a document
13637written in Texinfo format. On its own, @TeX{} cannot either read or
13638typeset a Texinfo file. @file{texinfo.tex} is distributed with GDB
13639and is located in the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}/texinfo}
13640directory.
c4555f82 13641
8e04817f
AC
13642If you have @TeX{} and a @sc{dvi} printer program installed, you can
13643typeset and print this manual. First switch to the the @file{gdb}
13644subdirectory of the main source directory (for example, to
13645@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb}) and type:
c4555f82 13646
8e04817f
AC
13647@example
13648make gdb.dvi
13649@end example
c4555f82 13650
8e04817f 13651Then give @file{gdb.dvi} to your @sc{dvi} printing program.
c4555f82 13652
8e04817f
AC
13653@node Installing GDB
13654@appendix Installing @value{GDBN}
13655@cindex configuring @value{GDBN}
13656@cindex installation
c4555f82 13657
8e04817f
AC
13658@value{GDBN} comes with a @code{configure} script that automates the process
13659of preparing @value{GDBN} for installation; you can then use @code{make} to
13660build the @code{gdb} program.
13661@iftex
13662@c irrelevant in info file; it's as current as the code it lives with.
13663@footnote{If you have a more recent version of @value{GDBN} than @value{GDBVN},
13664look at the @file{README} file in the sources; we may have improved the
13665installation procedures since publishing this manual.}
13666@end iftex
c4555f82 13667
8e04817f
AC
13668The @value{GDBN} distribution includes all the source code you need for
13669@value{GDBN} in a single directory, whose name is usually composed by
13670appending the version number to @samp{gdb}.
c4555f82 13671
8e04817f
AC
13672For example, the @value{GDBN} version @value{GDBVN} distribution is in the
13673@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory. That directory contains:
c4555f82 13674
8e04817f
AC
13675@table @code
13676@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure @r{(and supporting files)}
13677script for configuring @value{GDBN} and all its supporting libraries
c4555f82 13678
8e04817f
AC
13679@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/gdb
13680the source specific to @value{GDBN} itself
c4555f82 13681
8e04817f
AC
13682@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13683source for the Binary File Descriptor library
c906108c 13684
8e04817f
AC
13685@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/include
13686@sc{gnu} include files
c906108c 13687
8e04817f
AC
13688@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/libiberty
13689source for the @samp{-liberty} free software library
c906108c 13690
8e04817f
AC
13691@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/opcodes
13692source for the library of opcode tables and disassemblers
c906108c 13693
8e04817f
AC
13694@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/readline
13695source for the @sc{gnu} command-line interface
c906108c 13696
8e04817f
AC
13697@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/glob
13698source for the @sc{gnu} filename pattern-matching subroutine
c906108c 13699
8e04817f
AC
13700@item gdb-@value{GDBVN}/mmalloc
13701source for the @sc{gnu} memory-mapped malloc package
13702@end table
c906108c 13703
8e04817f
AC
13704The simplest way to configure and build @value{GDBN} is to run @code{configure}
13705from the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory, which in
13706this example is the @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} directory.
c906108c 13707
8e04817f
AC
13708First switch to the @file{gdb-@var{version-number}} source directory
13709if you are not already in it; then run @code{configure}. Pass the
13710identifier for the platform on which @value{GDBN} will run as an
13711argument.
c906108c 13712
8e04817f 13713For example:
c906108c 13714
8e04817f
AC
13715@example
13716cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13717./configure @var{host}
13718make
13719@end example
c906108c 13720
8e04817f
AC
13721@noindent
13722where @var{host} is an identifier such as @samp{sun4} or
13723@samp{decstation}, that identifies the platform where @value{GDBN} will run.
13724(You can often leave off @var{host}; @code{configure} tries to guess the
13725correct value by examining your system.)
c906108c 13726
8e04817f
AC
13727Running @samp{configure @var{host}} and then running @code{make} builds the
13728@file{bfd}, @file{readline}, @file{mmalloc}, and @file{libiberty}
13729libraries, then @code{gdb} itself. The configured source files, and the
13730binaries, are left in the corresponding source directories.
c906108c 13731
8e04817f
AC
13732@need 750
13733@code{configure} is a Bourne-shell (@code{/bin/sh}) script; if your
13734system does not recognize this automatically when you run a different
13735shell, you may need to run @code{sh} on it explicitly:
c906108c
SS
13736
13737@example
8e04817f 13738sh configure @var{host}
c906108c
SS
13739@end example
13740
8e04817f
AC
13741If you run @code{configure} from a directory that contains source
13742directories for multiple libraries or programs, such as the
13743@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} source directory for version @value{GDBVN}, @code{configure}
13744creates configuration files for every directory level underneath (unless
13745you tell it not to, with the @samp{--norecursion} option).
13746
13747You can run the @code{configure} script from any of the
13748subordinate directories in the @value{GDBN} distribution if you only want to
13749configure that subdirectory, but be sure to specify a path to it.
c906108c 13750
8e04817f
AC
13751For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, type the following to configure only
13752the @code{bfd} subdirectory:
c906108c 13753
8e04817f
AC
13754@example
13755@group
13756cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}/bfd
13757../configure @var{host}
13758@end group
13759@end example
c906108c 13760
8e04817f
AC
13761You can install @code{@value{GDBP}} anywhere; it has no hardwired paths.
13762However, you should make sure that the shell on your path (named by
13763the @samp{SHELL} environment variable) is publicly readable. Remember
13764that @value{GDBN} uses the shell to start your program---some systems refuse to
13765let @value{GDBN} debug child processes whose programs are not readable.
c906108c 13766
8e04817f
AC
13767@menu
13768* Separate Objdir:: Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
13769* Config Names:: Specifying names for hosts and targets
13770* Configure Options:: Summary of options for configure
13771@end menu
c906108c 13772
8e04817f
AC
13773@node Separate Objdir
13774@section Compiling @value{GDBN} in another directory
c906108c 13775
8e04817f
AC
13776If you want to run @value{GDBN} versions for several host or target machines,
13777you need a different @code{gdb} compiled for each combination of
13778host and target. @code{configure} is designed to make this easy by
13779allowing you to generate each configuration in a separate subdirectory,
13780rather than in the source directory. If your @code{make} program
13781handles the @samp{VPATH} feature (@sc{gnu} @code{make} does), running
13782@code{make} in each of these directories builds the @code{gdb}
13783program specified there.
c906108c 13784
8e04817f
AC
13785To build @code{gdb} in a separate directory, run @code{configure}
13786with the @samp{--srcdir} option to specify where to find the source.
13787(You also need to specify a path to find @code{configure}
13788itself from your working directory. If the path to @code{configure}
13789would be the same as the argument to @samp{--srcdir}, you can leave out
13790the @samp{--srcdir} option; it is assumed.)
c906108c 13791
8e04817f
AC
13792For example, with version @value{GDBVN}, you can build @value{GDBN} in a
13793separate directory for a Sun 4 like this:
c906108c 13794
8e04817f
AC
13795@example
13796@group
13797cd gdb-@value{GDBVN}
13798mkdir ../gdb-sun4
13799cd ../gdb-sun4
13800../gdb-@value{GDBVN}/configure sun4
13801make
13802@end group
13803@end example
c906108c 13804
8e04817f
AC
13805When @code{configure} builds a configuration using a remote source
13806directory, it creates a tree for the binaries with the same structure
13807(and using the same names) as the tree under the source directory. In
13808the example, you'd find the Sun 4 library @file{libiberty.a} in the
13809directory @file{gdb-sun4/libiberty}, and @value{GDBN} itself in
13810@file{gdb-sun4/gdb}.
c906108c 13811
8e04817f
AC
13812One popular reason to build several @value{GDBN} configurations in separate
13813directories is to configure @value{GDBN} for cross-compiling (where
13814@value{GDBN} runs on one machine---the @dfn{host}---while debugging
13815programs that run on another machine---the @dfn{target}).
13816You specify a cross-debugging target by
13817giving the @samp{--target=@var{target}} option to @code{configure}.
c906108c 13818
8e04817f
AC
13819When you run @code{make} to build a program or library, you must run
13820it in a configured directory---whatever directory you were in when you
13821called @code{configure} (or one of its subdirectories).
c906108c 13822
8e04817f
AC
13823The @code{Makefile} that @code{configure} generates in each source
13824directory also runs recursively. If you type @code{make} in a source
13825directory such as @file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}} (or in a separate configured
13826directory configured with @samp{--srcdir=@var{dirname}/gdb-@value{GDBVN}}), you
13827will build all the required libraries, and then build GDB.
c906108c 13828
8e04817f
AC
13829When you have multiple hosts or targets configured in separate
13830directories, you can run @code{make} on them in parallel (for example,
13831if they are NFS-mounted on each of the hosts); they will not interfere
13832with each other.
c906108c 13833
8e04817f
AC
13834@node Config Names
13835@section Specifying names for hosts and targets
c906108c 13836
8e04817f
AC
13837The specifications used for hosts and targets in the @code{configure}
13838script are based on a three-part naming scheme, but some short predefined
13839aliases are also supported. The full naming scheme encodes three pieces
13840of information in the following pattern:
c906108c 13841
8e04817f
AC
13842@example
13843@var{architecture}-@var{vendor}-@var{os}
13844@end example
c906108c 13845
8e04817f
AC
13846For example, you can use the alias @code{sun4} as a @var{host} argument,
13847or as the value for @var{target} in a @code{--target=@var{target}}
13848option. The equivalent full name is @samp{sparc-sun-sunos4}.
c906108c 13849
8e04817f
AC
13850The @code{configure} script accompanying @value{GDBN} does not provide
13851any query facility to list all supported host and target names or
13852aliases. @code{configure} calls the Bourne shell script
13853@code{config.sub} to map abbreviations to full names; you can read the
13854script, if you wish, or you can use it to test your guesses on
13855abbreviations---for example:
c906108c 13856
8e04817f
AC
13857@smallexample
13858% sh config.sub i386-linux
13859i386-pc-linux-gnu
13860% sh config.sub alpha-linux
13861alpha-unknown-linux-gnu
13862% sh config.sub hp9k700
13863hppa1.1-hp-hpux
13864% sh config.sub sun4
13865sparc-sun-sunos4.1.1
13866% sh config.sub sun3
13867m68k-sun-sunos4.1.1
13868% sh config.sub i986v
13869Invalid configuration `i986v': machine `i986v' not recognized
13870@end smallexample
c906108c 13871
8e04817f
AC
13872@noindent
13873@code{config.sub} is also distributed in the @value{GDBN} source
13874directory (@file{gdb-@value{GDBVN}}, for version @value{GDBVN}).
d700128c 13875
8e04817f
AC
13876@node Configure Options
13877@section @code{configure} options
c906108c 13878
8e04817f
AC
13879Here is a summary of the @code{configure} options and arguments that
13880are most often useful for building @value{GDBN}. @code{configure} also has
13881several other options not listed here. @inforef{What Configure
13882Does,,configure.info}, for a full explanation of @code{configure}.
c906108c 13883
8e04817f
AC
13884@example
13885configure @r{[}--help@r{]}
13886 @r{[}--prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13887 @r{[}--exec-prefix=@var{dir}@r{]}
13888 @r{[}--srcdir=@var{dirname}@r{]}
13889 @r{[}--norecursion@r{]} @r{[}--rm@r{]}
13890 @r{[}--target=@var{target}@r{]}
13891 @var{host}
13892@end example
c906108c 13893
8e04817f
AC
13894@noindent
13895You may introduce options with a single @samp{-} rather than
13896@samp{--} if you prefer; but you may abbreviate option names if you use
13897@samp{--}.
c906108c 13898
8e04817f
AC
13899@table @code
13900@item --help
13901Display a quick summary of how to invoke @code{configure}.
c906108c 13902
8e04817f
AC
13903@item --prefix=@var{dir}
13904Configure the source to install programs and files under directory
13905@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 13906
8e04817f
AC
13907@item --exec-prefix=@var{dir}
13908Configure the source to install programs under directory
13909@file{@var{dir}}.
c906108c 13910
8e04817f
AC
13911@c avoid splitting the warning from the explanation:
13912@need 2000
13913@item --srcdir=@var{dirname}
13914@strong{Warning: using this option requires @sc{gnu} @code{make}, or another
13915@code{make} that implements the @code{VPATH} feature.}@*
13916Use this option to make configurations in directories separate from the
13917@value{GDBN} source directories. Among other things, you can use this to
13918build (or maintain) several configurations simultaneously, in separate
13919directories. @code{configure} writes configuration specific files in
13920the current directory, but arranges for them to use the source in the
13921directory @var{dirname}. @code{configure} creates directories under
13922the working directory in parallel to the source directories below
13923@var{dirname}.
c906108c 13924
8e04817f
AC
13925@item --norecursion
13926Configure only the directory level where @code{configure} is executed; do not
13927propagate configuration to subdirectories.
c906108c 13928
8e04817f
AC
13929@item --target=@var{target}
13930Configure @value{GDBN} for cross-debugging programs running on the specified
13931@var{target}. Without this option, @value{GDBN} is configured to debug
13932programs that run on the same machine (@var{host}) as @value{GDBN} itself.
c906108c 13933
8e04817f 13934There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available targets.
c906108c 13935
8e04817f
AC
13936@item @var{host} @dots{}
13937Configure @value{GDBN} to run on the specified @var{host}.
c906108c 13938
8e04817f
AC
13939There is no convenient way to generate a list of all available hosts.
13940@end table
c906108c 13941
8e04817f
AC
13942There are many other options available as well, but they are generally
13943needed for special purposes only.
c906108c 13944
8e04817f
AC
13945@node Maintenance Commands
13946@appendix Maintenance Commands
13947@cindex maintenance commands
13948@cindex internal commands
c906108c 13949
8e04817f
AC
13950In addition to commands intended for @value{GDBN} users, @value{GDBN}
13951includes a number of commands intended for @value{GDBN} developers.
13952These commands are provided here for reference.
c906108c 13953
8e04817f
AC
13954@table @code
13955@kindex maint info breakpoints
13956@item @anchor{maint info breakpoints}maint info breakpoints
13957Using the same format as @samp{info breakpoints}, display both the
13958breakpoints you've set explicitly, and those @value{GDBN} is using for
13959internal purposes. Internal breakpoints are shown with negative
13960breakpoint numbers. The type column identifies what kind of breakpoint
13961is shown:
c906108c 13962
8e04817f
AC
13963@table @code
13964@item breakpoint
13965Normal, explicitly set breakpoint.
c906108c 13966
8e04817f
AC
13967@item watchpoint
13968Normal, explicitly set watchpoint.
c906108c 13969
8e04817f
AC
13970@item longjmp
13971Internal breakpoint, used to handle correctly stepping through
13972@code{longjmp} calls.
c906108c 13973
8e04817f
AC
13974@item longjmp resume
13975Internal breakpoint at the target of a @code{longjmp}.
c906108c 13976
8e04817f
AC
13977@item until
13978Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{until} command.
c906108c 13979
8e04817f
AC
13980@item finish
13981Temporary internal breakpoint used by the @value{GDBN} @code{finish} command.
c906108c 13982
8e04817f
AC
13983@item shlib events
13984Shared library events.
c906108c 13985
8e04817f 13986@end table
c906108c 13987
8e04817f 13988@end table
c906108c 13989
c906108c 13990
e0ce93ac 13991@node Remote Protocol
8e04817f 13992@appendix @value{GDBN} Remote Serial Protocol
c906108c 13993
8e04817f
AC
13994There may be occasions when you need to know something about the
13995protocol---for example, if there is only one serial port to your target
13996machine, you might want your program to do something special if it
13997recognizes a packet meant for @value{GDBN}.
c906108c 13998
8e04817f
AC
13999In the examples below, @samp{<-} and @samp{->} are used to indicate
14000transmitted and received data respectfully.
c906108c 14001
8e04817f
AC
14002@cindex protocol, @value{GDBN} remote serial
14003@cindex serial protocol, @value{GDBN} remote
14004@cindex remote serial protocol
14005All @value{GDBN} commands and responses (other than acknowledgments) are
14006sent as a @var{packet}. A @var{packet} is introduced with the character
14007@samp{$}, the actual @var{packet-data}, and the terminating character
14008@samp{#} followed by a two-digit @var{checksum}:
c906108c 14009
8e04817f
AC
14010@example
14011@code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14012@end example
14013@noindent
c906108c 14014
8e04817f
AC
14015@cindex checksum, for @value{GDBN} remote
14016@noindent
14017The two-digit @var{checksum} is computed as the modulo 256 sum of all
14018characters between the leading @samp{$} and the trailing @samp{#} (an
14019eight bit unsigned checksum).
c906108c 14020
8e04817f
AC
14021Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0 the protocol
14022specification also included an optional two-digit @var{sequence-id}:
c906108c 14023
8e04817f
AC
14024@example
14025@code{$}@var{sequence-id}@code{:}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14026@end example
c906108c 14027
8e04817f
AC
14028@cindex sequence-id, for @value{GDBN} remote
14029@noindent
14030That @var{sequence-id} was appended to the acknowledgment. @value{GDBN}
14031has never output @var{sequence-id}s. Stubs that handle packets added
14032since @value{GDBN} 5.0 must not accept @var{sequence-id}.
c906108c 14033
8e04817f
AC
14034@cindex acknowledgment, for @value{GDBN} remote
14035When either the host or the target machine receives a packet, the first
14036response expected is an acknowledgment: either @samp{+} (to indicate
14037the package was received correctly) or @samp{-} (to request
14038retransmission):
c906108c 14039
8e04817f
AC
14040@example
14041<- @code{$}@var{packet-data}@code{#}@var{checksum}
14042-> @code{+}
14043@end example
14044@noindent
53a5351d 14045
8e04817f
AC
14046The host (@value{GDBN}) sends @var{command}s, and the target (the
14047debugging stub incorporated in your program) sends a @var{response}. In
14048the case of step and continue @var{command}s, the response is only sent
14049when the operation has completed (the target has again stopped).
c906108c 14050
8e04817f
AC
14051@var{packet-data} consists of a sequence of characters with the
14052exception of @samp{#} and @samp{$} (see @samp{X} packet for additional
14053exceptions).
c906108c 14054
8e04817f
AC
14055Fields within the packet should be separated using @samp{,} @samp{;} or
14056@samp{:}. Except where otherwise noted all numbers are represented in
14057HEX with leading zeros suppressed.
c906108c 14058
8e04817f
AC
14059Implementors should note that prior to @value{GDBN} 5.0, the character
14060@samp{:} could not appear as the third character in a packet (as it
14061would potentially conflict with the @var{sequence-id}).
c906108c 14062
8e04817f
AC
14063Response @var{data} can be run-length encoded to save space. A @samp{*}
14064means that the next character is an @sc{ascii} encoding giving a repeat count
14065which stands for that many repetitions of the character preceding the
14066@samp{*}. The encoding is @code{n+29}, yielding a printable character
14067where @code{n >=3} (which is where rle starts to win). The printable
14068characters @samp{$}, @samp{#}, @samp{+} and @samp{-} or with a numeric
14069value greater than 126 should not be used.
c906108c 14070
8e04817f
AC
14071Some remote systems have used a different run-length encoding mechanism
14072loosely refered to as the cisco encoding. Following the @samp{*}
14073character are two hex digits that indicate the size of the packet.
c906108c 14074
8e04817f
AC
14075So:
14076@example
14077"@code{0* }"
14078@end example
14079@noindent
14080means the same as "0000".
c906108c 14081
8e04817f
AC
14082The error response returned for some packets includes a two character
14083error number. That number is not well defined.
c906108c 14084
8e04817f
AC
14085For any @var{command} not supported by the stub, an empty response
14086(@samp{$#00}) should be returned. That way it is possible to extend the
14087protocol. A newer @value{GDBN} can tell if a packet is supported based
14088on that response.
c906108c 14089
8e04817f
AC
14090A stub is required to support the @samp{g}, @samp{G}, @samp{m}, @samp{M},
14091@samp{c}, and @samp{s} @var{command}s. All other @var{command}s are
14092optional.
c906108c 14093
8e04817f
AC
14094Below is a complete list of all currently defined @var{command}s and
14095their corresponding response @var{data}:
14096@page
14097@multitable @columnfractions .30 .30 .40
14098@item Packet
14099@tab Request
14100@tab Description
c906108c 14101
8e04817f
AC
14102@item extended mode
14103@tab @code{!}
14104@tab
14105Enable extended mode. In extended mode, the remote server is made
14106persistent. The @samp{R} packet is used to restart the program being
14107debugged.
c906108c 14108@item
8e04817f
AC
14109@tab reply @samp{OK}
14110@tab
14111The remote target both supports and has enabled extended mode.
c906108c 14112
8e04817f
AC
14113@item last signal
14114@tab @code{?}
14115@tab
14116Indicate the reason the target halted. The reply is the same as for step
14117and continue.
14118@item
14119@tab reply
14120@tab see below
c906108c
SS
14121
14122
8e04817f
AC
14123@item reserved
14124@tab @code{a}
14125@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14126
8e04817f
AC
14127@item set program arguments @strong{(reserved)}
14128@tab @code{A}@var{arglen}@code{,}@var{argnum}@code{,}@var{arg}@code{,...}
14129@tab
14130@item
14131@tab
14132@tab
14133Initialized @samp{argv[]} array passed into program. @var{arglen}
14134specifies the number of bytes in the hex encoded byte stream @var{arg}.
14135See @file{gdbserver} for more details.
14136@item
14137@tab reply @code{OK}
14138@item
14139@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
c906108c 14140
8e04817f
AC
14141@item set baud @strong{(deprecated)}
14142@tab @code{b}@var{baud}
14143@tab
14144Change the serial line speed to @var{baud}. JTC: @emph{When does the
14145transport layer state change? When it's received, or after the ACK is
14146transmitted. In either case, there are problems if the command or the
14147acknowledgment packet is dropped.} Stan: @emph{If people really wanted
14148to add something like this, and get it working for the first time, they
14149ought to modify ser-unix.c to send some kind of out-of-band message to a
14150specially-setup stub and have the switch happen "in between" packets, so
14151that from remote protocol's point of view, nothing actually
14152happened.}
c906108c 14153
8e04817f
AC
14154@item set breakpoint @strong{(deprecated)}
14155@tab @code{B}@var{addr},@var{mode}
14156@tab
14157Set (@var{mode} is @samp{S}) or clear (@var{mode} is @samp{C}) a
14158breakpoint at @var{addr}. @emph{This has been replaced by the @samp{Z} and
14159@samp{z} packets.}
c906108c 14160
8e04817f
AC
14161@item continue
14162@tab @code{c}@var{addr}
14163@tab
14164@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14165current address.
14166@item
14167@tab reply
14168@tab see below
c906108c 14169
8e04817f
AC
14170@item continue with signal
14171@tab @code{C}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14172@tab
14173Continue with signal @var{sig} (hex signal number). If
14174@code{;}@var{addr} is omitted, resume at same address.
14175@item
14176@tab reply
14177@tab see below
c906108c 14178
8e04817f
AC
14179@item toggle debug @strong{(deprecated)}
14180@tab @code{d}
14181@tab
14182toggle debug flag.
c906108c 14183
8e04817f
AC
14184@item detach
14185@tab @code{D}
14186@tab
14187Detach @value{GDBN} from the remote system. Sent to the remote target before
14188@value{GDBN} disconnects.
14189@item
14190@tab reply @emph{no response}
14191@tab
14192@value{GDBN} does not check for any response after sending this packet.
c906108c 14193
8e04817f
AC
14194@item reserved
14195@tab @code{e}
14196@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14197
8e04817f
AC
14198@item reserved
14199@tab @code{E}
14200@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14201
8e04817f
AC
14202@item reserved
14203@tab @code{f}
14204@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14205
8e04817f
AC
14206@item reserved
14207@tab @code{F}
14208@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14209
8e04817f
AC
14210@item read registers
14211@tab @code{g}
14212@tab Read general registers.
14213@item
14214@tab reply @var{XX...}
14215@tab
14216Each byte of register data is described by two hex digits. The bytes
14217with the register are transmitted in target byte order. The size of
14218each register and their position within the @samp{g} @var{packet} are
14219determined by the @value{GDBN} internal macros @var{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE} and
14220@var{REGISTER_NAME} macros. The specification of several standard
14221@code{g} packets is specified below.
14222@item
14223@tab @code{E}@var{NN}
14224@tab for an error.
c906108c 14225
8e04817f
AC
14226@item write regs
14227@tab @code{G}@var{XX...}
14228@tab
14229See @samp{g} for a description of the @var{XX...} data.
14230@item
14231@tab reply @code{OK}
14232@tab for success
14233@item
14234@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14235@tab for an error
c906108c 14236
8e04817f
AC
14237@item reserved
14238@tab @code{h}
14239@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14240
8e04817f
AC
14241@item set thread
14242@tab @code{H}@var{c}@var{t...}
14243@tab
14244Set thread for subsequent operations (@samp{m}, @samp{M}, @samp{g},
14245@samp{G}, et.al.). @var{c} = @samp{c} for thread used in step and
14246continue; @var{t...} can be -1 for all threads. @var{c} = @samp{g} for
14247thread used in other operations. If zero, pick a thread, any thread.
14248@item
14249@tab reply @code{OK}
14250@tab for success
14251@item
14252@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14253@tab for an error
c906108c 14254
8e04817f
AC
14255@c FIXME: JTC:
14256@c 'H': How restrictive (or permissive) is the thread model. If a
14257@c thread is selected and stopped, are other threads allowed
14258@c to continue to execute? As I mentioned above, I think the
14259@c semantics of each command when a thread is selected must be
14260@c described. For example:
14261@c
14262@c 'g': If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14263@c selected, returns the register block from that thread;
14264@c otherwise returns current registers.
14265@c
14266@c 'G' If the stub supports threads and a specific thread is
14267@c selected, sets the registers of the register block of
14268@c that thread; otherwise sets current registers.
c906108c 14269
8e04817f
AC
14270@item cycle step @strong{(draft)}
14271@tab @code{i}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{nnn}
14272@tab
14273Step the remote target by a single clock cycle. If @code{,}@var{nnn} is
14274present, cycle step @var{nnn} cycles. If @var{addr} is present, cycle
14275step starting at that address.
c906108c 14276
8e04817f
AC
14277@item signal then cycle step @strong{(reserved)}
14278@tab @code{I}
14279@tab
14280See @samp{i} and @samp{S} for likely syntax and semantics.
c906108c 14281
8e04817f
AC
14282@item reserved
14283@tab @code{j}
14284@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14285
8e04817f
AC
14286@item reserved
14287@tab @code{J}
14288@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14289
8e04817f
AC
14290@item kill request
14291@tab @code{k}
14292@tab
ac282366
MS
14293FIXME: @emph{There is no description of how to operate when a specific
14294thread context has been selected (ie.@: does 'k' kill only that thread?)}.
c906108c 14295
8e04817f
AC
14296@item reserved
14297@tab @code{l}
14298@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14299
8e04817f
AC
14300@item reserved
14301@tab @code{L}
14302@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14303
8e04817f
AC
14304@item read memory
14305@tab @code{m}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14306@tab
14307Read @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14308Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that sized memory transfers are assumed
14309using word alligned accesses. FIXME: @emph{A word aligned memory
14310transfer mechanism is needed.}
14311@item
14312@tab reply @var{XX...}
14313@tab
14314@var{XX...} is mem contents. Can be fewer bytes than requested if able
14315to read only part of the data. Neither @value{GDBN} nor the stub assume that
14316sized memory transfers are assumed using word alligned accesses. FIXME:
14317@emph{A word aligned memory transfer mechanism is needed.}
14318@item
14319@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14320@tab @var{NN} is errno
c906108c 14321
8e04817f
AC
14322@item write mem
14323@tab @code{M}@var{addr},@var{length}@code{:}@var{XX...}
14324@tab
14325Write @var{length} bytes of memory starting at address @var{addr}.
14326@var{XX...} is the data.
14327@item
14328@tab reply @code{OK}
14329@tab for success
14330@item
14331@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14332@tab
14333for an error (this includes the case where only part of the data was
14334written).
c906108c 14335
8e04817f
AC
14336@item reserved
14337@tab @code{n}
14338@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14339
8e04817f
AC
14340@item reserved
14341@tab @code{N}
14342@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14343
8e04817f
AC
14344@item reserved
14345@tab @code{o}
14346@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14347
8e04817f
AC
14348@item reserved
14349@tab @code{O}
14350@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14351
8e04817f
AC
14352@item read reg @strong{(reserved)}
14353@tab @code{p}@var{n...}
14354@tab
14355See write register.
14356@item
14357@tab return @var{r....}
14358@tab The hex encoded value of the register in target byte order.
c906108c 14359
8e04817f
AC
14360@item write reg
14361@tab @code{P}@var{n...}@code{=}@var{r...}
14362@tab
14363Write register @var{n...} with value @var{r...}, which contains two hex
14364digits for each byte in the register (target byte order).
14365@item
14366@tab reply @code{OK}
14367@tab for success
14368@item
14369@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14370@tab for an error
c906108c 14371
8e04817f
AC
14372@item general query
14373@tab @code{q}@var{query}
14374@tab
14375Request info about @var{query}. In general @value{GDBN} queries
14376have a leading upper case letter. Custom vendor queries should use a
14377company prefix (in lower case) ex: @samp{qfsf.var}. @var{query} may
14378optionally be followed by a @samp{,} or @samp{;} separated list. Stubs
14379must ensure that they match the full @var{query} name.
14380@item
14381@tab reply @code{XX...}
14382@tab Hex encoded data from query. The reply can not be empty.
14383@item
14384@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14385@tab error reply
14386@item
14387@tab reply @samp{}
14388@tab Indicating an unrecognized @var{query}.
c906108c 14389
8e04817f
AC
14390@item general set
14391@tab @code{Q}@var{var}@code{=}@var{val}
14392@tab
14393Set value of @var{var} to @var{val}. See @samp{q} for a discussing of
14394naming conventions.
c906108c 14395
8e04817f
AC
14396@item reset @strong{(deprecated)}
14397@tab @code{r}
14398@tab
14399Reset the entire system.
c906108c 14400
8e04817f
AC
14401@item remote restart
14402@tab @code{R}@var{XX}
14403@tab
14404Restart the program being debugged. @var{XX}, while needed, is ignored.
14405This packet is only available in extended mode.
14406@item
14407@tab
14408no reply
14409@tab
14410The @samp{R} packet has no reply.
c906108c 14411
8e04817f
AC
14412@item step
14413@tab @code{s}@var{addr}
14414@tab
14415@var{addr} is address to resume. If @var{addr} is omitted, resume at
14416same address.
14417@item
14418@tab reply
14419@tab see below
c906108c 14420
8e04817f
AC
14421@item step with signal
14422@tab @code{S}@var{sig}@code{;}@var{addr}
14423@tab
14424Like @samp{C} but step not continue.
14425@item
14426@tab reply
14427@tab see below
c906108c 14428
8e04817f
AC
14429@item search
14430@tab @code{t}@var{addr}@code{:}@var{PP}@code{,}@var{MM}
14431@tab
14432Search backwards starting at address @var{addr} for a match with pattern
14433@var{PP} and mask @var{MM}. @var{PP} and @var{MM} are 4
14434bytes. @var{addr} must be at least 3 digits.
c906108c 14435
8e04817f
AC
14436@item thread alive
14437@tab @code{T}@var{XX}
14438@tab Find out if the thread XX is alive.
14439@item
14440@tab reply @code{OK}
14441@tab thread is still alive
14442@item
14443@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14444@tab thread is dead
c906108c 14445
8e04817f
AC
14446@item reserved
14447@tab @code{u}
14448@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14449
8e04817f
AC
14450@item reserved
14451@tab @code{U}
14452@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14453
8e04817f
AC
14454@item reserved
14455@tab @code{v}
14456@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14457
8e04817f
AC
14458@item reserved
14459@tab @code{V}
14460@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14461
8e04817f
AC
14462@item reserved
14463@tab @code{w}
14464@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14465
8e04817f
AC
14466@item reserved
14467@tab @code{W}
14468@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14469
8e04817f
AC
14470@item reserved
14471@tab @code{x}
14472@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14473
8e04817f
AC
14474@item write mem (binary)
14475@tab @code{X}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}@var{:}@var{XX...}
14476@tab
14477@var{addr} is address, @var{length} is number of bytes, @var{XX...} is
14478binary data. The characters @code{$}, @code{#}, and @code{0x7d} are
14479escaped using @code{0x7d}.
14480@item
14481@tab reply @code{OK}
14482@tab for success
14483@item
14484@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14485@tab for an error
c906108c 14486
8e04817f
AC
14487@item reserved
14488@tab @code{y}
14489@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14490
8e04817f
AC
14491@item reserved
14492@tab @code{Y}
14493@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14494
8e04817f
AC
14495@item remove break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14496@tab @code{z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14497@tab
14498See @samp{Z}.
c906108c 14499
8e04817f
AC
14500@item insert break or watchpoint @strong{(draft)}
14501@tab @code{Z}@var{t}@code{,}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14502@tab
14503@var{t} is type: @samp{0} - software breakpoint, @samp{1} - hardware
14504breakpoint, @samp{2} - write watchpoint, @samp{3} - read watchpoint,
14505@samp{4} - access watchpoint; @var{addr} is address; @var{length} is in
14506bytes. For a software breakpoint, @var{length} specifies the size of
14507the instruction to be patched. For hardware breakpoints and watchpoints
14508@var{length} specifies the memory region to be monitored. To avoid
14509potential problems with duplicate packets, the operations should be
14510implemented in an idempotent way.
14511@item
14512@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14513@tab for an error
14514@item
14515@tab reply @code{OK}
14516@tab for success
14517@item
14518@tab @samp{}
14519@tab If not supported.
c906108c 14520
8e04817f
AC
14521@item reserved
14522@tab <other>
14523@tab Reserved for future use
c906108c 14524
8e04817f 14525@end multitable
c906108c 14526
8e04817f
AC
14527The @samp{C}, @samp{c}, @samp{S}, @samp{s} and @samp{?} packets can
14528receive any of the below as a reply. In the case of the @samp{C},
14529@samp{c}, @samp{S} and @samp{s} packets, that reply is only returned
14530when the target halts. In the below the exact meaning of @samp{signal
14531number} is poorly defined. In general one of the UNIX signal numbering
14532conventions is used.
c906108c 14533
8e04817f 14534@multitable @columnfractions .4 .6
c906108c 14535
8e04817f
AC
14536@item @code{S}@var{AA}
14537@tab @var{AA} is the signal number
c906108c 14538
8e04817f
AC
14539@item @code{T}@var{AA}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}@var{n...}@code{:}@var{r...}@code{;}
14540@tab
14541@var{AA} = two hex digit signal number; @var{n...} = register number
14542(hex), @var{r...} = target byte ordered register contents, size defined
14543by @code{REGISTER_RAW_SIZE}; @var{n...} = @samp{thread}, @var{r...} =
14544thread process ID, this is a hex integer; @var{n...} = other string not
14545starting with valid hex digit. @value{GDBN} should ignore this
14546@var{n...}, @var{r...} pair and go on to the next. This way we can
14547extend the protocol.
c906108c 14548
8e04817f
AC
14549@item @code{W}@var{AA}
14550@tab
14551The process exited, and @var{AA} is the exit status. This is only
14552applicable for certains sorts of targets.
c906108c 14553
8e04817f
AC
14554@item @code{X}@var{AA}
14555@tab
14556The process terminated with signal @var{AA}.
c906108c 14557
8e04817f
AC
14558@item @code{N}@var{AA}@code{;}@var{t...}@code{;}@var{d...}@code{;}@var{b...} @strong{(obsolete)}
14559@tab
14560@var{AA} = signal number; @var{t...} = address of symbol "_start";
14561@var{d...} = base of data section; @var{b...} = base of bss section.
14562@emph{Note: only used by Cisco Systems targets. The difference between
14563this reply and the "qOffsets" query is that the 'N' packet may arrive
14564spontaneously whereas the 'qOffsets' is a query initiated by the host
14565debugger.}
c906108c 14566
8e04817f
AC
14567@item @code{O}@var{XX...}
14568@tab
14569@var{XX...} is hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data. This can happen at any time
14570while the program is running and the debugger should continue to wait
14571for 'W', 'T', etc.
c906108c 14572
8e04817f 14573@end multitable
c906108c 14574
8e04817f 14575The following set and query packets have already been defined.
c906108c 14576
8e04817f 14577@multitable @columnfractions .2 .2 .6
c906108c 14578
8e04817f
AC
14579@item current thread
14580@tab @code{q}@code{C}
14581@tab Return the current thread id.
14582@item
14583@tab reply @code{QC}@var{pid}
14584@tab
14585Where @var{pid} is a HEX encoded 16 bit process id.
14586@item
14587@tab reply *
14588@tab Any other reply implies the old pid.
c906108c 14589
8e04817f
AC
14590@item all thread ids
14591@tab @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14592@item
14593@tab @code{q}@code{sThreadInfo}
14594@tab
14595Obtain a list of active thread ids from the target (OS). Since there
14596may be too many active threads to fit into one reply packet, this query
14597works iteratively: it may require more than one query/reply sequence to
14598obtain the entire list of threads. The first query of the sequence will
14599be the @code{qf}@code{ThreadInfo} query; subsequent queries in the
14600sequence will be the @code{qs}@code{ThreadInfo} query.
14601@item
14602@tab
14603@tab NOTE: replaces the @code{qL} query (see below).
14604@item
14605@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>}
14606@tab A single thread id
14607@item
14608@tab reply @code{m}@var{<id>},@var{<id>...}
14609@tab a comma-separated list of thread ids
14610@item
14611@tab reply @code{l}
14612@tab (lower case 'el') denotes end of list.
14613@item
14614@tab
14615@tab
14616In response to each query, the target will reply with a list of one
14617or more thread ids, in big-endian hex, separated by commas. GDB will
14618respond to each reply with a request for more thread ids (using the
14619@code{qs} form of the query), until the target responds with @code{l}
14620(lower-case el, for @code{'last'}).
c906108c 14621
8e04817f
AC
14622@item extra thread info
14623@tab @code{q}@code{ThreadExtraInfo}@code{,}@var{id}
14624@tab
14625@item
14626@tab
14627@tab
14628Where @var{<id>} is a thread-id in big-endian hex.
14629Obtain a printable string description of a thread's attributes from
14630the target OS. This string may contain anything that the target OS
14631thinks is interesting for @value{GDBN} to tell the user about the thread.
14632The string is displayed in @value{GDBN}'s @samp{info threads} display.
14633Some examples of possible thread extra info strings are "Runnable", or
14634"Blocked on Mutex".
14635@item
14636@tab reply @var{XX...}
14637@tab
14638Where @var{XX...} is a hex encoding of @sc{ascii} data, comprising the
14639printable string containing the extra information about the thread's
14640attributes.
c906108c 14641
8e04817f
AC
14642@item query @var{LIST} or @var{threadLIST} @strong{(deprecated)}
14643@tab @code{q}@code{L}@var{startflag}@var{threadcount}@var{nextthread}
14644@tab
14645@item
14646@tab
14647@tab
14648Obtain thread information from RTOS. Where: @var{startflag} (one hex
14649digit) is one to indicate the first query and zero to indicate a
14650subsequent query; @var{threadcount} (two hex digits) is the maximum
14651number of threads the response packet can contain; and @var{nextthread}
14652(eight hex digits), for subsequent queries (@var{startflag} is zero), is
14653returned in the response as @var{argthread}.
14654@item
14655@tab
14656@tab NOTE: this query is replaced by the @code{q}@code{fThreadInfo}
14657query (see above).
14658@item
14659@tab reply @code{q}@code{M}@var{count}@var{done}@var{argthread}@var{thread...}
14660@tab
14661@item
14662@tab
14663@tab
14664Where: @var{count} (two hex digits) is the number of threads being
14665returned; @var{done} (one hex digit) is zero to indicate more threads
14666and one indicates no further threads; @var{argthreadid} (eight hex
14667digits) is @var{nextthread} from the request packet; @var{thread...} is
14668a sequence of thread IDs from the target. @var{threadid} (eight hex
14669digits). See @code{remote.c:parse_threadlist_response()}.
c906108c 14670
8e04817f
AC
14671@item compute CRC of memory block
14672@tab @code{q}@code{CRC:}@var{addr}@code{,}@var{length}
14673@tab
14674@item
14675@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14676@tab An error (such as memory fault)
14677@item
14678@tab reply @code{C}@var{CRC32}
14679@tab A 32 bit cyclic redundancy check of the specified memory region.
c906108c 14680
8e04817f
AC
14681@item query sect offs
14682@tab @code{q}@code{Offsets}
14683@tab
14684Get section offsets that the target used when re-locating the downloaded
14685image. @emph{Note: while a @code{Bss} offset is included in the
14686response, @value{GDBN} ignores this and instead applies the @code{Data}
14687offset to the @code{Bss} section.}
14688@item
14689@tab reply @code{Text=}@var{xxx}@code{;Data=}@var{yyy}@code{;Bss=}@var{zzz}
c906108c 14690
8e04817f
AC
14691@item thread info request
14692@tab @code{q}@code{P}@var{mode}@var{threadid}
14693@tab
14694@item
14695@tab
14696@tab
14697Returns information on @var{threadid}. Where: @var{mode} is a hex
14698encoded 32 bit mode; @var{threadid} is a hex encoded 64 bit thread ID.
14699@item
14700@tab reply *
14701@tab
14702See @code{remote.c:remote_unpack_thread_info_response()}.
c906108c 14703
8e04817f
AC
14704@item remote command
14705@tab @code{q}@code{Rcmd,}@var{COMMAND}
14706@tab
14707@item
14708@tab
14709@tab
14710@var{COMMAND} (hex encoded) is passed to the local interpreter for
14711execution. Invalid commands should be reported using the output string.
14712Before the final result packet, the target may also respond with a
14713number of intermediate @code{O}@var{OUTPUT} console output
14714packets. @emph{Implementors should note that providing access to a
14715stubs's interpreter may have security implications}.
14716@item
14717@tab reply @code{OK}
14718@tab
14719A command response with no output.
14720@item
14721@tab reply @var{OUTPUT}
14722@tab
14723A command response with the hex encoded output string @var{OUTPUT}.
14724@item
14725@tab reply @code{E}@var{NN}
14726@tab
14727Indicate a badly formed request.
c906108c 14728
8e04817f
AC
14729@item
14730@tab reply @samp{}
14731@tab
14732When @samp{q}@samp{Rcmd} is not recognized.
c906108c 14733
8e04817f
AC
14734@item symbol lookup
14735@tab @code{qSymbol::}
14736@tab
14737Notify the target that @value{GDBN} is prepared to serve symbol lookup
14738requests. Accept requests from the target for the values of symbols.
14739@item
14740@tab
14741@tab
14742@item
14743@tab reply @code{OK}
14744@tab
14745The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14746@item
14747@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14748@tab
14749@sp 2
14750@noindent
14751The target requests the value of symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14752@value{GDBN} may provide the value by using the
14753@code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14754message, described below.
5d161b24 14755
8e04817f
AC
14756@item symbol value
14757@tab @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_value}:@var{sym_name}
14758@tab
14759@sp 1
14760@noindent
14761Set the value of SYM_NAME to SYM_VALUE.
14762@item
14763@tab
14764@tab
14765@var{sym_name} (hex encoded) is the name of a symbol whose value
14766the target has previously requested.
14767@item
14768@tab
14769@tab
14770@var{sym_value} (hex) is the value for symbol @var{sym_name}.
14771If @value{GDBN} cannot supply a value for @var{sym_name}, then this
14772field will be empty.
14773@item
14774@tab reply @code{OK}
14775@tab
14776The target does not need to look up any (more) symbols.
14777@item
14778@tab reply @code{qSymbol:}@var{sym_name}
14779@tab
14780@sp 2
14781@noindent
14782The target requests the value of a new symbol @var{sym_name} (hex encoded).
14783@value{GDBN} will continue to supply the values of symbols (if available),
14784until the target ceases to request them.
eb12ee30 14785
8e04817f 14786@end multitable
eb12ee30 14787
8e04817f
AC
14788The following @samp{g}/@samp{G} packets have previously been defined.
14789In the below, some thirty-two bit registers are transferred as sixty-four
14790bits. Those registers should be zero/sign extended (which?) to fill the
14791space allocated. Register bytes are transfered in target byte order.
14792The two nibbles within a register byte are transfered most-significant -
14793least-significant.
eb12ee30 14794
8e04817f 14795@multitable @columnfractions .5 .5
eb12ee30 14796
8e04817f
AC
14797@item MIPS32
14798@tab
14799All registers are transfered as thirty-two bit quantities in the order:
1480032 general-purpose; sr; lo; hi; bad; cause; pc; 32 floating-point
14801registers; fsr; fir; fp.
eb12ee30 14802
8e04817f
AC
14803@item MIPS64
14804@tab
14805All registers are transfered as sixty-four bit quantities (including
14806thirty-two bit registers such as @code{sr}). The ordering is the same
14807as @code{MIPS32}.
eb12ee30 14808
8e04817f 14809@end multitable
eb12ee30 14810
8e04817f
AC
14811Example sequence of a target being re-started. Notice how the restart
14812does not get any direct output:
eb12ee30 14813
8e04817f
AC
14814@example
14815<- @code{R00}
14816-> @code{+}
14817@emph{target restarts}
14818<- @code{?}
14819-> @code{+}
14820-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14821<- @code{+}
14822@end example
eb12ee30 14823
8e04817f 14824Example sequence of a target being stepped by a single instruction:
eb12ee30 14825
8e04817f
AC
14826@example
14827<- @code{G1445...}
14828-> @code{+}
14829<- @code{s}
14830-> @code{+}
14831@emph{time passes}
14832-> @code{T001:1234123412341234}
14833<- @code{+}
14834<- @code{g}
14835-> @code{+}
14836-> @code{1455...}
14837<- @code{+}
14838@end example
eb12ee30 14839
eb12ee30 14840
6826cf00
EZ
14841@include fdl.texi
14842
6d2ebf8b 14843@node Index
c906108c
SS
14844@unnumbered Index
14845
14846@printindex cp
14847
14848@tex
14849% I think something like @colophon should be in texinfo. In the
14850% meantime:
14851\long\def\colophon{\hbox to0pt{}\vfill
14852\centerline{The body of this manual is set in}
14853\centerline{\fontname\tenrm,}
14854\centerline{with headings in {\bf\fontname\tenbf}}
14855\centerline{and examples in {\tt\fontname\tentt}.}
14856\centerline{{\it\fontname\tenit\/},}
14857\centerline{{\bf\fontname\tenbf}, and}
14858\centerline{{\sl\fontname\tensl\/}}
14859\centerline{are used for emphasis.}\vfill}
14860\page\colophon
14861% Blame: doc@cygnus.com, 1991.
14862@end tex
14863
c906108c 14864@bye
This page took 0.946253 seconds and 4 git commands to generate.